Very Substantial Acquisition
Transcription
Very Substantial Acquisition
THIS CIRCULAR REQUIRES YOUR IMMEDIATE ATTENTION The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited takes no responsibility for the contents of this circular, makes no representation as to its accuracy or completeness and expressly disclaims any liability whatsoever for any loss howsoever arising from or in reliance upon the whole or any part of the contents of this circular. This circular appears for information purposes only and does not constitute an invitation or offer to acquire purchase or subscribe for the securities of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited, If you are in doubt as to any aspect of this circular or as to the action to be taken, you should consult a stockbroker or other registered dealer in securities, bank manager, solicitor, professional accountant or other appropriate independent adviser. If you have sold or transferred all your shares in Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited, you should at once hand this circular and the accompanying form of proxy to the purchaser or the transferee or to the bank, stockbroker or other agent through whom the sale or transfer was effected for transmission to the purchaser or the transferee. AURORA GLOBAL INVESTMENT HOLDINGS LIMITED ρˀଈҙ༅ઁٖτࠉʔ̇* (Incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) (Stock code: 353) VERY SUBSTANTIAL ACQUISITION: ACQUISITION OF INTERESTS IN A COMPANY INVOLVING ISSUE OF CONSIDERATION SHARES AND CONVERTIBLE BONDS; REFRESHMENT OF GENERAL MANDATE TO ALLOT AND ISSUE SHARES; REFRESHMENT OF SCHEME MANDATE LIMIT; AND NOTICE OF EXTRAORDINARY GENERAL MEETING Financial adviser to the Company Independent financial adviser to the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders A notice of the extraordinary general meeting of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited convened to be held at Suites 5303-5304, 53rd Floor, Central Plaza, 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong on 31 October 2007 at 10:30 a.m. is set out on pages 340 to 343 of this circular. Whether or not you are able to attend the meeting, you are requested to complete the accompanying form of proxy in accordance with the instructions printed thereon and return the same to the Company’s branch share registrar in Hong Kong, Tricor Tengis Limited at 26th Floor, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong as soon as possible and in any event not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for the holding of the meeting or any adjournment thereof. Completion and return of the form of proxy shall not preclude you from attending and voting at the meeting if you so wish. 15 October 2007 * for identification purpose only CONTENTS Page Definition ................................................................................................................................... 1 Letter from the Board ............................................................................................................. 7 Letter from the Independent Board Committee ................................................................. 41 Letter from Veda Capital........................................................................................................ 42 Appendix I — Financial information on the Group ............................................. 47 Appendix IIA — Accountants’ report on the Target Group ................................... 137 Appendix IIB — Financial information on the Target Group ................................ 167 Appendix III — Unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group ...................................................................... 169 Appendix IV — Valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion ............................ 184 Appendix V — Reports on forecasts underlying the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion ............................................... 212 Appendix VI — Property valuation ........................................................................... 215 Appendix VII — Technical report ............................................................................... 225 Appendix VIII — General information ........................................................................ 331 Notice of EGM .......................................................................................................................... 340 –i– DEFINITIONS In this circular, unless the context otherwise requires, the following expressions have the following meanings: “AGM” the annual general meeting of the Company held on 28 June 2007 in which the Shareholders had approved, among other things, the Existing General Mandate “Acquisition” the acquisition of the Sale Interests of the Target Company by Smooth Way from the Vendor in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Share Transfer Agreement “associate(s)” has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules “Board” the board of Directors “Business Day” a day (excluding Saturday and any day on which a tropical cyclone warning signal no. 8 or above is hoisted or remains hoisted between 9:00 a.m. and 12:00 noon and is not lowered at or before 12:00 noon or on which a “black” rainstorm warning signal is hoisted or remains in effect between 9:00 a.m. and 12:00 noon and is not discontinued at or before 12:00 noon) on which licensed banks in Hong Kong are open for business “Carve-out Mine” such portion of the Existing LRM Mine which excludes the Target Mine. “CB Instrument” the instrument to be executed on the Completion Date by the Company by way of a deed poll constituting the Convertible Bonds “Company” Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited, an exempted company incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability, the Shares of which are listed on the Stock Exchange “Completion” completion of the Acquisition in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Share Transfer Agreement “Completion Accounts” the profit and loss account for the period commencing from 1 January 2007 and ending on the Completion Date and the consolidated balance sheet of the Target Group as at the Completion Date “Completion Date” the date on which Completion takes place “connected person” has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules –1– DEFINITIONS “Consideration” the total consideration payable by Smooth Way to the Vendor for the Acquisition, the particulars of which are set out in the paragraph headed “Consideration” in the letter from the Board “Consideration Shares” 270 million Shares to be issued and allotted to the Vendor at the Issue Price for the partial settlement of the Consideration pursuant to the term of the Share Transfer Agreement “Conversion Price” HK$0.6 per Share (subject to adjustment) “Conversion Shares” Shares to be allotted and issued upon conversion of the Convertible Bonds “Convertible Bonds” the Tranche 1 Bonds and the Tranche 2 Bonds “Director(s)” the director(s) of the Company “EGM” an extraordinary general meeting of the Company convened and to be held on 31 October 2007, for the purpose of considering, and if thought fit, approving the Share Transfer Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder, the grant of specific mandate to issue the Consideration Shares, the issue of the Convertible Bonds, the refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit by the Shareholders; and the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate by the Independent Shareholders “Encumbrance” any mortgage, charge, pledge, lien (otherwise than arising by statute or operation of law), hypothecation, equities, adverse claims, or other encumbrances, or rights of whatsoever nature or interest or any agreement for any of the same “Enlarged Group” the Group and the Target Group “Existing General Mandate” the general mandate granted to the Directors by the Shareholders at the AGM of the Company to, among others, exercise the power of the Company to allot, issue or otherwise deal with 162,690,000 Shares, representing 20% of the then issued share capital of the Company and to repurchase up to 81,345,000 Shares, representing 10% of the then issued share capital of the Company “Existing LRM Mine” the Xiaohongshan (Little Red Mountain) iron-titanium-vanadium mine located in Inner Mongolia at approximately 180 km north of the city of Jiayugan, central-western PRC, and such mine is constituted by the Target Mine and the Carve-out Mine “Exploration Licence(s)” the current exploration licence held by Qinghai Senyuan and the right to conduct exploration work for Mineral Resources over the Existing LRM Mine or, as the case may be, the Target Mine pursuant to the Mineral Laws –2– DEFINITIONS “Extension Mandate” a general and unconditional mandate to the Directors to the effect that the nominal value of any Shares repurchased (up to a maximum of 10 percent of the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company in issue on the date of the AGM) will be added to the nominal value of the Shares which may be allotted and issued under the Refreshed Issue Mandate “Group” collectively, the Company and its subsidiaries from time to time “Hong Kong FSMI” Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited, a company incorporated in Hong Kong “HK$” Hong Kong dollars, the lawful currency of Hong Kong “Hong Kong” the Hong Kong Special Administrative Region of the PRC “Independent Board Committee” the independent board committee of the Board comprising all independent non-executive Directors, established for the purpose of advising the Independent Shareholders in relation to the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate “Independent Shareholder(s)” Shareholders other than Directors (excluding the independent nonexecutive Directors) and the chief executive and their respective associates “Issue Price” HK$0.5 per Share, being the issue price of the Consideration Shares “LCH” LCH (Asia-Pacific) Surveyors Limited, an independent valuer appointed by the Company to appraise the market value of the Target Mine — First Portion and property interest of the Group “Latest Practicable Date” 12 October 2007, being the latest practicable date prior to the printing of this circular for inclusion of certain information in this circular “Listing Rules” the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on the Stock Exchange “Loan Capitalisation” capitalisation by the issue of shares in the relevant companies in the Target Group for the purpose of capitalisation of the entirety of the Shareholder Loans such that immediately after such capitalisation, there will not be any Shareholder Loans “Long Stop Date” 5:00 p.m. on 8 November 2007 (being the date falling of expiry of four months after the date of signing of the Share Transfer Agreement) or such later time and date as Smooth Way and the Vendor may agree in writing “Maturity Date” the date falling five years from the date of issue of the Convertible Bonds –3– DEFINITIONS “Mineral Laws” the Mineral Resources Law (ᘊଐ༅ؒ) of the PRC, as amended, modified or replaced from time to time, and such other rules, regulations, measures and policies formulated and promulgated by the governmental agencies or public bodies of the PRC (including without limitation national, provincial and other local authorities) “Mineral Resources” mineral resources containing iron, vanadium and titanium in the Target Mine or, as the case may be, the Existing LRM Mine “Mining Licence(s)” the mining licence(s) held or to be held by the Target Group and the right to conduct mining and exploitation work for the Mineral Resources over the Existing LRM Mine (or, as the case may be, the Target Mine) exclusively pursuant to the Mineral Laws “PRC” the People’s Republic of China which, for the purposes of this circular, excludes Hong Kong, the Macau Special Administrative Region of the PRC and Taiwan “PRC Entities” Qinghai Senyuan and such other companies to be set up in the PRC before Completion for the exploitation of Mineral Resources and/or mineral processing in respect of the Target Mine “Qinghai Senyuan” the holder of the Exploration Licence in respect of the Existing LRM Mine, ࣵڇᘊพೕτࠉʔ̇ (Qinghai Forest Source Mining Industry Developing Company Limited), a wholly foreign owned enterprise established in the PRC and wholly owned by Hong Kong FSMI “Refreshed Issue Mandate” a general and unconditional mandate to the Directors to exercise the power of the Company to allot, issue or otherwise deal with shares up to a maximum of 20% of the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company in issue as the date of at the EGM “Reorganisation” the reorganisation involving the members of the Target Group as set out in the paragraph headed “Reorganisation” in the letter from the Board “RMB” renminbi yuan, the lawful currency of the PRC “Sale Interests” such number of shares of US$1 each of the Target Company as shall represent 51% of its issued share capital and held by the Vendor immediately before Completion “SFO” Securities and Futures Ordinance, Chapter 571 of the Laws of Hong Kong –4– DEFINITIONS “Scheme Mandate Limit” 10% of the issued share capital of the Company as at the date of the extraordinary general meeting of the Company held on 10 March 2006 which may be issued upon exercise of the options to be granted under the Share Option Scheme “Share Option Scheme” the share option scheme adopted by the Company on 6 June 2002 “Share Transfer Agreement” the conditional agreement entered into on 8 July 2007 between, among other persons, Smooth Way and the Vendor in relation to, among others, the Acquisition “Share(s)” ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each in the share capital of the Company “Shareholders” holders of Shares “Shareholders’ Agreement” the shareholders’ agreement to be entered into between Smooth Way (or such nominee which will become the owner of the Sale Interests), the Company, the Vendor and the Target Company upon Completion “Shareholder Loans” the interest-free loans owing from time to time by members of the Target Group to the Vendor and its associates “Smooth Way” Smooth Way International Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company “Stock Exchange” The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited “substantial shareholder” has the meaning ascribed to it under the Listing Rules “Target Company” Kanson Development Limited, a company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands and the entire issued share capital of which is currently held by the Vendor and will be so held by the Vendor before the Completion “Target Group” the group of companies consisting of the Target Company, Hong Kong FSMI and the PRC Entities and, where the context so requires, the businesses carried on by them or (as the case may be) their predecessors “Target Mine” the mine in a 2km by 1km rectangular area which is or to be held by Qinghai Senyuan, which forms part of the Existing LRM Mine “Target Mine — First Portion” such portion of the Target Mine having a site area of approximately 0.7 square km –5– DEFINITIONS “Tranche 1 Bonds” the HK$365 million zero coupon convertible bonds due on the fifth anniversary of the date of issue, falling on the Completion Date, in registered form to be created (for the purpose of settlement of part of the Consideration) by the CB Instrument and for the time being outstanding (as defined therein) or, as the context may require, any number of them “Tranche 2 Bonds” the HK$400 million zero coupon convertible bonds due on the fifth anniversary of the date of issue, falling on the fifth Business Days following the date of issue of the Mining Licence to a subsidiary wholly owned (directly or indirectly) by the Company in registered form to be created (for the purpose of settlement of part of the Consideration) by the CB Instrument and for the time being outstanding (as defined therein) or, as the context may require, any number of them “US$” United States dollar(s), the lawful currency of the United States of America “Veda Capital” Veda Capital Limited, a licensed corporation to carry out business in type 6 regulated activity (advising on corporate finance) under the SFO, being the independent financial adviser to the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders in relation to the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate “Vendor” Ms Leung Lai Ching, Margaret “km” kilometer(s) “%” per cent. In this circular, for purpose of illustration only, amounts quoted in RMB have been converted into Hong Kong dollars at the rate of RMB1 to HK$1.00 and vice versa. Such exchange rate has been used, where applicable, for purposes of illustration only and does not constitute a representation that any amounts were or may have been exchanged at this or any other rates or at all. –6– LETTER FROM THE BOARD AURORA GLOBAL INVESTMENT HOLDINGS LIMITED ρˀଈҙ༅ઁٖτࠉʔ̇* (Incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) (Stock code: 353) Executive Directors: Mr Owen Tam Mr Tsao Ke Wen Calvin Mr Law Fei Shing Mr So Chi Keung Mr Fok Po Tin Mr Leung Kai Hung Mr Delon Yeung Registered Office: Cricket Squares Hutchins Drive, P. O. Box 2681 Grand Cayman KY1-1111 Cayman Islands Principal place of business in Hong Kong: Suites 5303-4, 53rd Floor Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai Hong Kong Non-executive Director: Dr Ma Chung Wo, Cameron Independent non-executive Directors: Mr Lum Pak Sum Mr Wan Hon Keung Mr Sun Tak Keung To the Shareholders and the Independent Shareholders 15 October 2007 Dear Sir or Madam VERY SUBSTANTIAL ACQUISITION: ACQUISITION OF INTERESTS IN A COMPANY INVOLVING ISSUE OF CONSIDERATION SHARES AND CONVERTIBLE BONDS; REFRESHMENT OF GENERAL MANDATE TO ALLOT AND ISSUE SHARES; REFRESHMENT OF SCHEME MANDATE LIMIT; AND NOTICE OF EXTRAORDINARY GENERAL MEETING INTRODUCTION On 20 July 2007, the Board announces that on 8 July 2007, Smooth Way, which is a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, entered into the conditional Share Transfer Agreement with, among others, the Vendor. Under the Share Transfer Agreement, Smooth Way has agreed to acquire 51% of the * for identification purpose only –7– LETTER FROM THE BOARD entire issued share capital of the Target Company at Completion from the Vendor at the Consideration totaling HK$1,000 million in value. The Acquisition is the acquisition of 51% of the issued share capital of the Target Company, which shall hold 100% interest in Hong Kong FSMI immediately after the completion of the Reorganisation and at Completion. At present and at Completion, Hong Kong FSMI is and will be the sole shareholder of Qinghai Senyuan. Qinghai Senyuan is a wholly foreign owned enterprise established in the PRC and is the holder of the Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine (i.e. which covers both the Carve-out Mine and the Target Mine), which confers to Qinghai Senyuan the right to, among other things, (1) carry out exploration (such as diamond drilling) of the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine; (2) facilitate the construction of wiring at the Target Mine and neighboring areas for communication purpose and facilitate the supply of water and electricity to the Target Mine; (3) access to the Target Mine and neighboring areas; (4) use the land on a temporary basis in accordance with the exploration work being carried out at the Target Mine; (5) be entitled to priority in exploring new type(s) of mineral resources (if any) discovered at the Target Mine; and (6) be entitled to priority in obtaining the mining right of the Target Mine. At Completion, the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine may not have been issued. Accordingly, if the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine has been issued at Completion, the Target Group will have both the exploration and the mining rights on the Target Mine. On the other hand, if the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine has not been issued at Completion, the Target Group will only have the exploration rights on the Target Mine. Given that preparation work for application for the Mining Licence of the Target Mine is being made and application for the Mining Licence will be made in the fourth quarter of 2007, the Directors consider that, provided that the application documents are in order and barring unforeseen circumstances, there is no legal obstacle for obtaining the Mining Licence of the Target Mine. When the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine is issued, the Target Group will have both the exploration and the mining rights on the Target Mine. It is provided in the Share Transfer Agreement that all such rights and interests to and in the exploration in respect of the Carve-out Mine held by Qinghai Senyuan will, at nil consideration, be transferred and/or exclusively licensed to the Vendor or such entity controlled by the Vendor. Therefore, the exploration rights of the Target Mine will be transferred to the Group pursuant to the Acquisition while the exploration right in respect of the Carve-out Mine is not the subject matter of the Acquisition. The purpose of this circular is to give you information regarding (i) further details of the Acquisition, the Consideration Shares and the Convertible Bonds; (ii) the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate; (iii) the proposed refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit; (iv) the recommendation from the Independent Board Committee to the Independent Shareholders on the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate; (v) the recommendation from Veda Capital to the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders on the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate; and (vi) a notice of the EGM, at which the necessary resolutions will be proposed to the Shareholders to consider and, if thought fit, to approve the Share Transfer Agreement and the refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit, and to the Independent Shareholders to consider and, if thought fit, to approve the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate by way of poll. –8– LETTER FROM THE BOARD SHARE TRANSFER AGREEMENT Date 8 July 2007 Parties (1) Ms Leung Lai Ching, Margaret, as vendor (2) Smooth Way, as purchaser (3) The Company, as warrantor giving representations, warranties and undertakings jointly and severally with Smooth Way in favour of the Vendor To the best of the Directors’ knowledge, information and belief having made all reasonable enquiry, the Vendor is a third party who is independent of the Company and its subsidiaries and connected persons of the Company. Subject matter The Sale Interests will comprise such number of shares of US$1 each of the Target Company as shall represent 51% of its issued share capital and held by the Vendor immediately before Completion. The Target Company is an investment holding company which is wholly owned by the Vendor as at the date of this circular and which shall hold 100% interest in Hong Kong FSMI immediately after the completion of the Reorganisation (details of which are set out under the paragraph “Reorganisation” below, which is expected to be completed before Completion). Consideration The Consideration of HK$1,000 million is to be satisfied: (a) as to HK$100 million in cash payable by Smooth Way to the Vendor or its nominee; (b) as to HK$135 million by the issue of the Consideration Shares by the Company to the Vendor; and (c) as to HK$765 million by the issue of the Convertible Bonds by the Company to the Vendor (or such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor). –9– LETTER FROM THE BOARD The cash portion in the sum of HK$60 million (“Deposit”) has been paid by Smooth Way to the Vendor upon the signing of the Share Transfer Agreement as a refundable deposit. On the 30th calendar day from 8 July 2007 (or such later date as the Vendor may agree), a further refundable deposit (“Further Deposit”) of HK$40 million in cash has to be paid by Smooth Way to the Vendor or its nominee, provided that if Smooth Way on a reasonable basis is not satisfied with the results of the due diligence exercise on the Target Group, the Target Mine and their related business, operations and other status which Smooth Way, its agents or professional advisers think necessary and appropriate to conduct, the Deposit shall be refunded to Smooth Way and Smooth Way shall not be obliged to pay the Further Deposit. In addition, if the conditions precedent to the Acquisition (details of which are set out in the paragraph headed “Conditions precedent” below) are not fulfilled or waived on or before the Long Stop Date, the Vendor shall within six months after the Long Stop Date repay to Smooth Way an amount equivalent to the aggregate of the Deposit and the Further Deposit. On 8 August 2007, the Further Deposit has been paid to the Vendor. The non-cash portion in a total sum of HK$900 million shall be settled: (i) as to HK$135 million, at Completion by the Company’s issue and allotment of the Consideration Shares to the Vendor; (ii) as to HK$365 million, at Completion by the Company’s issue to the Vendor (or such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor) of the Tranche 1 Bonds; and (iii) as to HK$400 million, on the fifth Business Day following the date of receipt of the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine, by the Company’s issue to the Vendor (or such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor) of the Tranche 2 Bonds. Status at Completion At Completion, the Company will be required to pay items (i) and (ii) above (which together with the payment of the Deposit and the Further Deposit, add up to HK$600 million out of the Consideration); 51% equity interests in the Target Company will be transferred to the Group; the Target Company holds 100% interest in Hong Kong FSMI, which in turn holds 100% of Qinghai Senyuan, the holder of the Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine (i.e. including the Target Mine) which confers to Qinghai Senyuan, the exploration rights of the Target Mine. At Completion, the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine may not have been issued. In the event the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine cannot be obtained by the Target Group eventually, it has not been provided in the Share Transfer Agreement that the Deposit, the Further Deposit and the Consideration Shares (i.e. item (i) above) above shall be returned by the Vendor to the Company. However, in such event, the Tranche 2 Bonds will not be issued to the Vendor. Shareholders’ attention is drawn to the paragraph headed “Risk Factors” below. – 10 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD At Completion and before the Tranche 1 Bonds are converted by the Vendor (or such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor), the Vendor will be interested in 22.08% of the issued share capital of the Company. Assuming the Tranche 1 Bonds are converted by the Vendor (or such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor) in full and taking into account the 25% restriction on the shareholding of the Vendor in the Company upon conversion of the Convertible Bonds (details are set out in the paragraph headed “Convertible Bonds” below), the Vendor will be interested in 25% of the issued share capital of the Company. Status when the Mining Licence is obtained The Company will issue the Tranche 2 Bonds (i.e. item (iii) above) only if the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine has been received by the Group. At this stage and with the Mining Licence of the Target Mine, the Group will get the mining rights of the Target Mine through its indirect shareholding in Hong Kong FSMI and Qinghai Senyuan. Given that preparation work for application for the Mining Licence of the Target Mine is being made and application for the Mining Licence of the Target Mine will be made in the fourth quarter of 2007, the Directors consider that, provided that the application documents are in order and barring unforeseen circumstances, there is no legal obstacle for obtaining the Mining Licence of the Target Mine. For an introduction to the possible unforeseen circumstances which might affect the grant of the Mining Licence to the Group, please refer to the paragraph headed “Risk Factors” below. The parties agree that the Convertible Bonds could be issued to such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor to permit the Vendor to hold the Convertible Bonds through companies owned/controlled or to be owned/controlled by her. Particulars of the Consideration Shares and the Convertible Bonds are set out in the paragraph headed “Non-cash portion of the Consideration” below. Source of financing of the Consideration As set out in the announcement issued by the Company dated 20 July 2007 regarding the placing agreement entered into by the Company and the placing agent, Guotai Junan Securities (Hong Kong) Limited on 18 July 2007 to place 135,000,000 new Shares at HK$0.69 per Share, net proceeds of approximately HK$90,700,000 have been raised, which were used to settle the cash portion of the Consideration. With regard to the capital investment to bring the Target Mine to commercial production, the Company intends to finance the same by the Company’s internal resources, bank borrowings, and if considered appropriate, proceeds from any future fund raising activity of the Company. The Company has appointed Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited as its financial advisor to advise the Company on the fund raising, which is intended to be finalised subsequent to the completion of the feasibility study on the Target Mine. The capital investment shall be significantly contingent on the results of those fund raising activities, after the completion of the feasibility study on the Target Mine. – 11 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD The estimated funds required of the Group for the two years following the issue of this circular is RMB1,080,000,000, in order to bring the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine into commercial production, which includes the funds required to obtain the Mining Licence and to conduct a drilling program to further exploit the proven reserves of the Target Mine. As it will typically take 12 months to 18 months to establish the mining operation upon obtaining of the Mining Licence, the Target Mine is not expected to generate any revenue for at least the next 12 months from the date of this circular. If the Group cannot in the two years following the issue of this circular raise sufficient proceeds from any future fund raising activities of the Company or bank borrowings mentioned above, the Group may consider establishing the mining operation by stages and it may take relatively longer time to bring the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine into commercial production. Adjustment to the Consideration The Consideration shall be adjusted if, as at the Completion Date: (1) the audited consolidated net tangible assets of the Target Group (before any adjustment in relation to any valuation of the Mining Licence(s) in respect of the Target Mine or the Existing LRM Mine) as shown in the Completion Accounts is less than HK$50 million, the Consideration shall be reduced by an amount equal to 51% of the shortfall; and/or (2) there are other borrowings, obligations or liabilities (whether actual or contingent) of the Target Group owing to any other party (whether the Vendor or its associates or otherwise) and reflected in the Completion Accounts, the Consideration shall be reduced by an amount equal to 51% of the aggregate amount of such additional liabilities; and/or (3) there are guarantees given by any members of the Target Group whatsoever and howsoever, the Consideration shall be reduced by an amount equal to 51% of the aggregate amount of such additional liabilities, provided that if the shortfall in the audited consolidated net tangible assets of the Target Group as set out in paragraph (1) above is caused by the same liabilities as set out in paragraph (2), the above adjustment to the Consideration shall be made once and shall not be double-counted. The parties to the Share Transfer Agreement shall procure that audit of the Completion Accounts be completed within 90 days of the Completion Date, unless a longer period is required for such audit. In the event there is a reduction of the Consideration pursuant to the above, Smooth Way shall, issue and deliver to the Vendor, against the delivery up for cancellation of the then Convertible Bonds held by it new Convertible Bonds for the balance of the Consideration payable on the basis of the Consideration as adjusted and the Consideration would be adjusted only in this manner. Basis of determination of the Consideration The Consideration was determined after taking into consideration factors including the present prices of titanium, iron and vanadium products and the estimated amount of the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine — First Portion. – 12 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD To the best knowledge of the Directors, the present market price of titanium, iron and vanadium products are in the range of about RMB1,100 to RMB1,200 per tonne (for titanium concentrate), about RMB2,150 to RMB2,200 per tonne (for direct reduced iron) and about RMB108,000 to RMB110,000 per tonne (for direct reduced vanadium) respectively depending on factors such as the grade of the products and the demand and supply. According to information provided by the Vendor, the indicated Mineral Resources of the Target Mine — First Portion amounted to 16.2 million tonnes at 19.5% total iron, 3.86% titanium (in the form of titanium oxide) and 0.03% vanadium (in the form of vanadium oxide), and the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion is estimated to be not less than HK$2.0 billion. As set out in the paragraph headed “Conditions precedent’ below, one of the conditions precedent to Completion of the Acquisition includes Smooth Way having obtained a technical report issued by a qualified technical adviser that indicates the Target Mine — First Portion has an indicated Mineral Resources of not less than 16 million tonnes. The Consideration was reached after arm’s length commercial negotiations between the parties to the Share Transfer Agreement. Based on the factors mentioned above, the Directors (including independent non-executive Directors) consider that the terms of the Acquisition and the Consideration are normal commercial terms and fair and reasonable. A valuation report on the Target Mine — First Portion prepared by LCH is set out in Appendix IV to this circular. As set out in the valuation report, the value of the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 was about RMB2,255,000,000. Based on such valuation, the Directors considered that the Consideration was fair and reasonable. Details of the estimated amount of the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine are set out in the paragraph headed “Information on the Target Mine” below. Consideration payable at Completion As mentioned in the sub-paragraph headed “Status at Completion” under the paragraph headed “Share Transfer Agreement” above, at Completion, the Company will be required to pay (i) HK$135 million by way of allotment and issue of the Consideration Shares and (ii) HK$365 million by way of issue of the Tranche 1 Bonds, which together with the payment of the Deposit and the Further Deposit, add up to HK$600 million. In arriving at the amount of HK$600 million payable at Completion, the Directors have taken into account the following factors: (a) The Vendor has been taking the position that any amount to be paid at Completion must not be less than 60% of the Consideration, which she considers to be normal commercial terms for any transaction on arm’s length basis. If such term had not been agreed upon, the Vendor would not have entered into the Share Transfer Agreement. (b) The Target Mine — First Portion occupies a site area of approximately 0.7 sq.km. The valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion is estimated to be not less than HK$2 billion. The Target Mine has a total site area of approximately 2 sq.km.. As set out in the technical report of the Target Mine prepared by WGM contained in Appendix VII to this circular, with continued ongoing exploration by diamond drilling, the potential for increasing resources and reserves in – 13 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD the proposed pit area and in the remaining portion of the Target Mine (i.e. the portion other than the Target Mine — First Portion) is considered to be good. In such respect, the Directors believe there is a fair chance for the valuation of the entire Target Mine to be greater than HK$2 billion. (c) So far as the Directors are aware, it is more common in the PRC for the holder of a mineexploration licence to be granted mine-exploitation licence than it is not. There has not been any finding of any material breach of any condition under the Exploration Licence granted to Qinghai Senyuan. The Directors also note that Qinghai Senyuan and other members of the Target Group have been conducting exploration activities in accordance with the Exploration Licence and taking all other preliminary steps for obtaining the Mining Licence. There is no evidence to show that the Target Group cannot obtain the Mining Licence. (d) If the Share Transfer Agreement were not entered into in accordance with the existing terms and conditions, the Company would lose the opportunity of pursuing the investment in the Target Mine. Alternatively when the share transfer agreement were to be entered into upon (1) further exploration of the Target Mine, which proves up a high quantity of indicated Mineral Resources, and/or (2) the obtaining of the Mining Licence by the Target Group, the consideration of the Target Mine would increase due to the inherent de-risking. On balance, the Directors consider that it is in the interest of the Company to secure the Share Transfer Agreement now in order to avoid a possible higher Consideration. Taking into account of the above and in order to safeguard the interest of the Company and its shareholders, the Directors convinced the Vendor to agree to receiving the balance of the Consideration in the sum of HK$400 million only upon the obtaining of the Mining Licence, while the Company accepting the term of paying HK$600 million upon Completion. Conditions precedent Completion of the Acquisition is subject to the following conditions precedent: (a) Smooth Way having obtained a PRC legal opinion (in such form and substance to its satisfaction), covering matters relating to the PRC Entities and the Target Mine; (b) Smooth Way having obtained a technical report issued by a qualified technical adviser that indicates the Target Mine — First Portion has an indicated Mineral Resources of not less than 16 million tonnes; (c) the Listing Committee of the Stock Exchange having granted or having agreed to grant the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares; (d) the approval by the Shareholders (or, as the case may be, the independent Shareholders) at the EGM of the Share Transfer Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereby (including but not limited to the allotment and issue of the Consideration Shares or the Conversion Share) and all other consents and acts required under the Listing Rules having been obtained and completed or, as the case may be, the relevant waiver from compliance with any of such rules having been obtained from the Stock Exchange; – 14 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD (e) (if required) all requisite waivers, consents and approvals from any relevant governments or regulatory authorities of Hong Kong in connection with the transactions contemplated by the Share Transfer Agreement having been obtained; (f) evidence to the reasonable satisfaction of Smooth Way that a sum of HK$50 million shall after the date of the Share Transfer Agreement but before the Completion Date have been injected as equity capital into Hong Kong FSMI; (g) Smooth Way being satisfied, from the date of the Share Transfer Agreement and at any time before the Completion, that the representations, warranties and undertakings given under the Share Transfer Agreement remain true, accurate, not misleading or in breach in any material respect and that no events have suggested that there were any breach in any material respect of any warranties, representations and undertakings given by the Vendor or other provisions of the Share Transfer Agreement by the Vendor; (h) Smooth Way being satisfied that, from the date of the Share Transfer Agreement to Completion, there has not been any material adverse change (being any change which has a material and adverse effect on the financial position, business or operations of the Target Group as a whole) in respect of any member of the Target Group; and (i) the Vendor providing Smooth Way with a confirmation or other documents, showing that all fees required to be paid by Qinghai Senyuan to the State-owned Land and Resources Authority of the PRC and/or other governmental authorities in respect of exploration of the Target Mine having been fully paid and there is no outstanding fees. The PRC legal opinion referred to in condition (a) above is required to cover the following areas: (A) whether the PRC Entities have been duly established and validly subsisting; (B) whether the PRC Entities have obtained all relevant operating permits required at the time of their establishment and such permits remaining valid; (C) the PRC Entities’ legality of the operation and business; (D) if required, whether the PRC Entities have obtained and effected all necessary approval, authorisation, consent, registration and filings required (where applicable) in relation to the Share Transfer Agreement, and the transactions contemplated thereunder; (E) whether Qinghai Senyuan has obtained the Exploration Licence(s) in respect of the Existing LRM Mine and whether such licence(s) are in full force and effect; and whether the registered capital of Qinghai Senyuan has been paid up to the extent of no less than RMB20 million; (F) whether each of the companies of the Target Group has obtained the rights to use and occupy all the properties leased by the Target Group; and (G) such other aspects of PRC law as Smooth Way may reasonably consider appropriate or relevant to the transactions contemplated by the Share Transfer Agreement. – 15 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD The PRC legal opinion referred to in condition (a) above would only cover the PRC Entities but not the whole Target Group. As the principal operation of the Target Group is carried out by the PRC Entities in the PRC, a PRC legal opinion covering the PRC Entities (and it being one of the conditions precedent to the Share Transfer Agreement) is considered important, necessary and sufficient. The other members of the Target Group incorporated in Hong Kong and BVI are investment holding companies only and have not had any operation since their incorporation. Legal opinion on such members is not considered of such significance to be a condition precedent to the Share Transfer Agreement. Smooth Way has the right to waive in writing the conditions (b), (f), (g), (h) and (i) mentioned above. The technical assessment report mentioned in condition (b) above is expected to be required for ascertaining the market value of the Target Mine — First Portion. However, if the market value of the Target Mine — First Portion can be determined by an independent qualified valuer to the satisfaction of Smooth Way without such technical assessment report, Smooth Way may waive such condition. If the conditions mentioned above have not been fulfilled in full (or, where applicable, waived by Smooth Way in writing) on or before the Long Stop Date, the Share Transfer Agreement shall lapse and be of no further effect and none of the parties shall have any claims against or liability to the other parties (other than in respect of any antecedent breaches) under the Share Transfer Agreement. As at the Latest Practicable Date, except condition (b) which has been fulfilled as the Company has been provided with the technical report set out in Appendix VII to this circular, none of the conditions mentioned above was fulfilled or waived, the obtaining of the Mining Licence of the Target Mine is not made as a condition precedent to the Share Transfer Agreement given that the application for the Mining Licence is subject to regulatory procedure for which a definite timeframe is not provided. However, it has been agreed that the Tranche 2 Bonds in the principal amount of HK$400 million will only be issued to the Vendor (or such person(s) as nominated by the Vendor) on the fifth Business Day following the date of receipt of the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine. Smooth Way is only required to pay the balance of the Consideration in the sum of HK$400 million only after the Mining Licence has been obtained. It is a commercial decision that the Acquisition is not made conductible upon the obtaining of the Mining Licence of the Target Mine at Completion. The Directors consider that in the event where (1) further exploration of the Target Mine proves up a higher quantity of indicated Mineral Resources and/or (2) the Mining Licence is obtained, the consideration of the Target Mine will increase due to the inherent de-risking. Accordingly, the Directors consider that it is in the interest of the Company to secure the Share Transfer Agreement now to avoid a possible higher Consideration for the said reasons. Taking into account of the above, the Directors consider that it is in the interest of the Company not to make the Acquisition conditional upon the obtaining of the Mining Licence of the Target Mine. The Company will issue further announcement to update the Shareholders the status of obtaining of the Mining Licence of the Target Mine as and when appropriate. – 16 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Completion Completion of the Acquisition shall take place on the fifth Business Day after the fulfillment (or waiver) of the last of the conditions precedent referred to under the paragraph headed “Conditions precedent” above (other than conditions (g) and (h)) or such other date as the parties to the Share Transfer Agreement shall agree in writing. CALL OPTION Upon Completion, among other persons, Smooth Way, the Target Company and the Vendor will enter into the Shareholders’ Agreement, pursuant to which, the Vendor, in consideration of HK$1, will irrevocably grant to Smooth Way a call option (“Call Option”) to require the Vendor to sell to Smooth Way all those issued shares held by the Vendor in (and, where applicable, the shareholder’s loans advanced by the Vendor (or its associates) to) the Target Company as at the date of the exercise of the Call Option (“Call Option Shares”) at the Call Option Price (as defined below), subject to the terms and conditions of the Shareholders’ Agreement. The exercise of the Call Option is at the sole discretion of Smooth Way. The price of all the Call Option Shares (“Call Option Price”) shall be HK$960.78 million or if the Call Option is exercised in respect of only part of the Call Option Shares, the Call Option Price for such part shall be adjusted on a pro-rata basis. The Call Option may be exercised by Smooth Way in whole or in part from time to time during the period commencing on the Completion Date and expiring on the second year of the Completion Date (both dates inclusive), provided that the exercise of the Call Option and/or the completion of the purchase of the Call Option Shares shall be subject to the approval by the independent shareholders of the Company and in compliance with the relevant Listing Rules (or such listing rules to which the Company is subject) at the material time. The Company will issue a separate announcement and fully comply with the applicable requirements under the Listing Rules as and when appropriate if Smooth Way exercises the Call Option. FIRST RIGHT OF REFUSAL It will also be provided in that Shareholders’ Agreement that in the event that the Vendor wishes to transfer to an independent third party any or all of its right, benefit, title and/or interest to of and/or in the Carve-out Mine, the Vendor shall first offer the interest in the Carve-out Mine to Smooth Way at the same price and terms. Within a period of one month from the date of Smooth Way’s receipt of the offer notice of the Vendor, Smooth Way shall be entitled (but not obliged) to accept the offer made by the Vendor. If, at the end of the said one-month period, Smooth Way shall not have accepted the offer, all pre-emptive rights interest in the Carve-out Mine offered for sale shall lapse. In such event, the Vendor may transfer any or all of the interest in the Carve-out Mine to such third party purchaser in one or more transactions on terms no more favourable than as set forth in the offer notice. – 17 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD REORGANISATION Pursuant to the Reorganisation which has been or will be carried out for the purpose of the transactions contemplated under the Share Transfer Agreement: (i) the entirety of the Shareholder Loans (which was in the sum of about HK$31,434,000 as at 30 June 2007) will be waived, capitalised by way of the Loan Capitalisation such that immediately before the Completion, the number of shares of Hong Kong FSMI in issue will be 70 million; (ii) all the issued Shares in Hong Kong FSMI will be held by the Target Company by way of allotment and issue of new shares in Hong Kong FSMI to the Target Company or (as the case may be) transferred by the Vendor to the Target Company; (iii) the Target Group will make application or take preliminary steps to make application for the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine for Mineral Resources of no less than 16 million tonnes; and all the above steps under the Reorganisation shall be consummated on or before the Completion. The corporate structure before and after the Reorganisation and at Completion are set out below: At the time of signing the Share Transfer Agreement and before the Reorganisation The Vendor 100% 100% Target Company Hong Kong FSMI 100% Qinghai Senyuan Target Mine (Note) Carve-out Mine – 18 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD After completion of the Reorganisation The Vendor 100% Target Company 100% Hong Kong FSMI 100% Qinghai Senyuan Target Mine (Note) Carve-out Mine At Completion The Vendor Smooth Way 49% 51% Target Company 100% Hong Kong FSMI 100% PRC Entities other than Qinghai Senyuan Qinghai Senyuan Target Mine (Note) Note: It refers to the exploration rights of the Target Mine. – 19 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD As at the Latest Practicable Date, the geological exploration required for obtaining the Mining Licence of the Target Mine has been substantially completed and the associated exploration report (which is prepared for application for the Mining Licence of the Target Mine) has also been completed. A project feasibility study and an integrated mine utilization plan required for the application for the Mining License of the Target Mine are underway. Application for the Mining License of the Target Mine is expected to be made in the fourth quarter of 2007. A technical report by an independent qualified party has also been prepared. INFORMATION ON THE GROUP The Group is principally engaged in the design, manufacture and sale of a wide range of carpets under its own brand name and the trading of carpets of various brand names. The Group has a principal subsidiary in Huizhou, the PRC. The Board does not have any present intention to change its principal business to mining and intends to continue conducting its carpet business. Under the Share Transfer Agreement, upon Completion, the Company is required to appoint two persons nominated by the Vendor as Directors (subject to such persons not being disqualified under any laws or the Listing Rules from assuming the office of Director). There are currently eleven Directors in the Company. The Company plans to recruit an expert in the mining industry and/or an individual with relevant qualifications and experience in mining to oversee the Group’s investment in the Target Group. INFORMATION ON THE VENDOR The Vendor is a seasoned entrepreneur with broad experience in investment and business management, such as investment in natural resources and forestry projects in China. Between 1985 and 1992, she invested in the Dong Hu Hotel in Haikou, Hainan and participated actively in its operation and management. During the same period, the Vendor was also involved in investments in golf courses and resorts. Since 2001, the Vendor has been a shareholder of Crystal Health Club Company Limited in Hong Kong, which established Qinghai Senyuan, a wholly foreign owned enterprise in the PRC, in 2004. Qinghai Senyuan holds the exploration rights of the Existing LRM Mine (as constituted by the Target Mine and the Carve-out Mine). In 2005, the Vendor set up Hong Kong FSMI, which is an investment holding company incorporated in Hong Kong on 26 September 2005 whose entire issued share capital is ultimately beneficially owned by the Vendor before Completion. Hong Kong FSMI became the sole investor of Qinghai Senyuan in early 2007, when Crystal Health Club Company Limited transferred the entire registered capital of Qinghai Senyuan to Hong Kong FSMI. Qinghai Senyuan obtained the first Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine (as constituted by the Target Mine and the Carve-out Mine) on 25 November 2004. It obtained the current Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine on 31 December 2006 and such licence will expire on 25 November 2008. Pursuant to the current Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine, Qinghai Senyuan is the holder of the exploration rights of the Existing LRM Mine. – 20 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Based on the above, the Vendor, via her 100% interest in Hong Kong FSMI, which holds 100% interest in Qinghai Senyuan, is the ultimate holder of the exploration rights of the Target Mine as conferred by the current Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine. In 2006, the Vendor established Champion Forest Source Holdings Company Limited in Hong Kong, engaging in technologies relating to environmental and ecological system development. The Vendor is the Chairman of Champion Forest Source Holdings Company Limited, Hong Kong FSMI and Qinghai Senyuan. Due diligence work performed by the Company In order to ascertain the ultimate beneficial ownership of the Exploration Licence of the Target Mine, the Company has performed and arranged for the performance of the following due diligence work: (a) review of the copy corporate documents of the PRC Entities and the Existing LRM Mine (as constituted by the Target Mine and the Carve-out Mine) and the Exploration Licence held by Qinghai Senyuan in respect of the Existing LRM Mine, as provided by the Vendor; (b) conducting company search with the Hong Kong Companies Registry in respect of Hong Kong FSMI (being the registered holder of the entire registered capital in Qinghai Senyuan); and (c) reviewing a preliminary legal opinion from a PRC legal adviser on 27 June 2007, who mentioned that they reviewed the Exploration Licence held by Qinghai Senyuan in respect of the Existing LRM Mine, and that according to their telephone enquiry with an officer of the Ministry of Land and Resources, Qinghai Senyuan obtained the exploration right of the Existing LRM Mine. In addition, the Company has engaged Jingtian & Gongcheng as the Company’s PRC legal advisers to perform the due diligence over the PRC Entities and the Target Mine, and to issue the legal opinion as mentioned in condition precedent (a) set out in the paragraph headed “Conditions precedent” above. INFORMATION ON THE PRC ENTITIES Qinghai Senyuan is a wholly foreign owned enterprise established in the PRC on 8 April 2004 and is wholly owned by Hong Kong FSMI. As set out in the paragraph headed “Reorganisation” above, following the completion of the Reorganisation, the Target Company will hold 100% in Hong Kong FSMI which wholly owns Qinghai Senyuan. The current and on-going operation of Qinghai Senyuan principally includes the exploration of the Existing LRM Mine including surveying and diamond drilling; chemical assaying of the samples obtained from the Target Mine; metallurgical testing of the samples obtained from the Target Mine; feasibility study for the development of the Target Mine; and preparatory work for the application of the Mining Licence. At present and as set out above, Qinghai Senyuan is the holder of the Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine (i.e. which covers both the Carve-out Mine and the Target Mine). The Exploration Licence confers Qinghai Senyuan the rights to, among other things, (1) carry out exploration (such as diamond drilling) of the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine; (2) facilitate the construction of wiring at the Target Mine and neighboring areas for communication purpose and facilitate the supply of water and electricity to the – 21 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Target Mine; (3) access to the Target Mine and neighboring areas; (4) use the land on a temporary basis in accordance with the exploration work being carried out at the Target Mine; (5) be entitled to priority in exploring new type(s) of mineral resources (if any) discovered at the Target Mine; and (6) be entitled to priority in obtaining the mining right at the Target Mine. Whilst the Exploration Licence confers such rights to Qinghai Senyuan, under the relevant PRC laws, the ownership as to the Target Mine still vests with the PRC government but not Qinghai Senyuan, but this would not affect the rights of exploration as conferred to Qinghai Senyuan under the Exploration Licence. It is provided in the Share Transfer Agreement that all such rights and interests to and in the exploration in respect of the Carve-out Mine held by Qinghai Senyuan will, at nil consideration, be transferred and/or exclusively licensed to the Vendor or such entity controlled by the Vendor. According to the PRC legal opinion issued by Jingtian & Gongcheng, Qinghai Senyuan has obtained full legal and beneficial title in respect of the exploration of the Target Mine, and is the legally interested party in the exploration of the Target Mine. Thus, Qinghai Senyuan, after complying with the rules and regulations in China and having registered in the relevant governmental authorities, has the right to transfer and assign part of its exploration rights in the Target Mine. The PRC Entity to be set up will be owned by Hong Kong FSMI in Inner Mongolia for the mining of the Mineral Resources from the Target Mine and for the mineral dressing operation, and in Yumen (Gansu) for the processing of the mineral concentrates obtained from the mineral dressing processes. As at the Latest Practicable Date, an application for establishment of PRC Entity is being made. Such PRC Entity, after establishment, will make application for the Mining Licence of the Target Mine. The Mining Licence of the Target Mine, if granted, will confer such PRC Entity the right to (1) carry out mining activities in the Target Mine for the duration as stipulated in the Mining Licence; (2) sell the Mineral Resources extracted from the Target Mine; and (3) construct the necessary facilities and to apply in accordance with the PRC land administration laws and regulations for the land use right at the Target Mine for the purpose of such mining activities. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON MEMBERS OF THE TARGET GROUP Immediately upon Completion of the Acquisition, the Target Company will be owned as to 51% by Smooth Way and as to 49% by the Vendor, Hong Kong FSMI and Qinghai Senyuan will become wholly-owned subsidiaries of the Target Company pursuant to the Reorganisation. According to the accountants’ report on the Target Group as set out in Appendix IIA to this Circular, the Target Group had no turnover for the period from 8 April 2004 (being the date of incorporation of one of its subsidiaries Qinghai Senyuan) to 31 December 2004 and for the years ended 31 December 2005 and 2006 and for the six months period ended 30 June 2007. No turnover was recorded by the Target Group as the Target Group did not commence commercial production during the periods. – 22 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD The Target Group recorded net loss before taxation and after taxation of approximately HK$1,149,000 for the period from 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 and HK$1,702,000 for the year ended 31 December 2005 and HK$9,780,000 for the year ended 31 December 2006 and HK$5,991,000 for the six months period ended 30 June 2007. The combined losses for the periods were mainly due to the general and administrative expenses. As at 31 December 2004 and 2005, the Target Group had combined net assets of HK$348,000 and HK$518,000 respectively. As at 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007, the Target Group had combined net liabilities of HK$9,077,000 and HK$18,750,000 respectively. As at 30 June 2007, the Target Group had capital commitments of HK$3,065,000. As set out in the paragraph headed “Emphasis of matter” in the accountants’ report on the Target Group contained in Appendix IIA to this circular (i.e. page 139 of this circular), as at 30 June 2007, the Target Group had deficit in equity of approximately HK$18,750,000 and the Target Group also incurred a loss attributable to equity holder of the Company of approximately HK$5,991,000 for the period then ended. In addition, in preparing the financial information (“Relevant Financial Information”) in the accountants’ report on the Target Group contained in Appendix IIA to this circular, the director of Target Company has given consideration to the future liquidity of the Target Group in light of its deficit in equity as at 30 June 2007 and loss attributable to the equity holder of Target Company for the period ended 30 June 2007 mentioned above. The Relevant Financial Information has been prepared on a going concern basis on the assumption that the Target Group and Target Company will continue to operate as a going concern. The going concern basis has been adopted on the basis that the shareholder of Target Company has agreed to provide additional share capital of HK$50,000,000 and the shareholder’s loan of HK$31,464,000 will be capitalised and transferred to equity of Target Company before Completion. The above matters indicate the existence of a material uncertainty which may cast significant doubt about the Target Group’s ability to continue as a going concern. Given that it is common that companies engaged in exploration and exploitation of natural resources incur loss and have deficit in equity at exploration stage and the Target Group was engaged in the exploration of the Existing LRM Mine during the relevant financial period, the Directors are of the view that the risks of going concern and substantial capital requirement are generic risks relating to companies in the exploration and mining industry, instead of risks facing only the Target Group. The Board has considered the generic risks relating to companies in the exploration and mining industry when the Board proposed to diversify the Group’s business into exploration and mining business; the Board is of the view that the matters highlighted by the Company’s auditors in the accountants’ report on the Target Group contained in Appendix IIA to this circular as mentioned above do not have a material adverse impact on the Board’s evaluation of the Acquisition. – 23 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Set out below are the financial information of the individual companies comprising the Target Group (excluding the PRC Entities (other than Qinghai Senyuan) and intra group balances): From 8 April 2004 (date of incorporation of Qinghai Senyuan) to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 For the year ended 31 December 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 For the six months ended 30 June 2007 HK$’000 Target Company Revenue Net loss before taxation Net loss after taxation Net liabilities — — — — — 5 5 (5) — 4 4 (9) — — — (9) Hong Kong FSMI Revenue Net loss before taxation Net loss after taxation Net liabilities — — — — — 227 227 (227) — 7,105 7,105 (7,331) — 4,563 4,563 (11,893) Qinghai Senyuen Revenue Net loss before taxation Net loss after taxation Net assets/(liabilities) — 1,149 1,149 348 — 2,670 2,670 (1,737) — 1,428 1,428 (6,848) — 1,471 1,471 750 Upon Completion, the Target Company will become a non wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company and its combined financial results will be consolidated with those of the Group. INFORMATION ON THE TARGET MINE The Target Mine is located in Inner Mongolia, the PRC. A technical report in respect of the Target Mine is set out in Appendix VII to this Circular. As set out in the technical report, the indicated Mineral Resources of the Target Mine — First Portion (an area of approximately 0.7 square km and within the Target Mine) amounted to 16.2 million tonnes at 19.5% total iron (TFe), 3.86% titanium (TiO2) and 0.03% vanadium (V2O5). At present, the Exploration Licence in respect of the Existing LRM Mine (which confers the right to conduct exploration work for the Mineral Resources in the areas of the Target Mine and the Carve-out Mine) has already been obtained and is held by Qinghai Senyuan. The rights conferred by the Exploration Licence are set out in the paragraphs headed “Introduction” and “Information on the PRC Entities” above. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Mining Licence of the Target Mine has yet to be obtained. The Target Mine and the Carve-out Mine form the Existing LRM Mine. The location and boundaries of the Carve-out Mine and the Target Mine are determined by reference to the co-ordinates of such mines. – 24 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Appendix IV to this circular is the valuation report of the Target Mine — First Portion prepared by LCH, in which it is set out, among other things, that the value the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 would be approximately RMB2,255 million. The Target Mine is evaluated on the basis of continued use and as part of a going concern business of Qinghai Senyuan. The continued use premise assumes that the Target Mine will be used for the purpose for which it was conceived or is currently carried out. Please refer to pages 187 to 188 for the assumptions adopted in the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion, and page 209 for the conclusion made by LCH. Appendix VII to this circular is the technical report of the Target Mine prepared by WGM, in which it is set out, among other things, the Target Mine — First Portion (an area of approximately 0.7 square km and within the Target Mine) has an estimated indicated Mineral Resources of not less than 16.2 million tonnes at 19.5% TFe and 3.86% TiO2 and 0.03% V2O5 respectively. The technical report also concludes that with continued on-going exploration by diamond drilling, the potential for increasing resources and reserves in the proposed pit area and in the remaining portion of the Target Mine (i.e. the portion other than the Target Mine — First Portion) is considered to be good. The technical report has been prepared by WGM to comply with the guidelines of Canadian Securities Administrators National Instrument 43-101 that governs all public disclosure of scientific and technical information concerning mineral projects based on information prepared by a qualified person. Please refer to pages 288 to 289 for the design assumptions and pages 309 to 311 for the conclusions and recommendations made by WGM. Both the valuation report prepared by LCH and the technical report prepared by WGM cover the Target Mine only and the Carve-out Mine is excluded. Based on the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion prepared by LCH, the Directors consider that the Consideration for the Acquisition (totalling HK$1,000 million), representing 51% interest of the whole Target Mine is fair and reasonable. Further, given the current amount of mineral resources and the potential for increasing resources and reserves (as per the technical report on the Target Mine prepared by WGM), the Directors consider that the Acquisition would be beneficial to the Group. . REASONS FOR THE ACQUISITION As set out in the Company’s annual report for the year ended 31 December 2006, the Group continued to focus on the carpet manufacturing and trading business and to take productive steps to improve profitability and market share. On the other hand, the Group has been looking into the opportunity of other business and exploring more investment to offer sustainable growth to its business. In March 2007, the Group acquired a carpet trading subsidiary to strengthen the base of its core business, details of which were set out to the Company’s announcement and circular dated 14 December 2006 and 2 January 2007 respectively. In addition, in the extraordinary general meeting of the Company held on 15 June 2007, the Shareholders had approved the investment in Hebei Da Sheng Warranty Company Limited, a company incorporated in Zhangjiakou, Hebei Province, PRC which engages in logistic, investment and project guarantee business, to diversify the Group’s business. Please refer to the Company’s announcement and circular dated 29 March 2007 and 28 May 2007 respectively for further details in this regard. – 25 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD The Directors consider that the Group may broaden its source of income by diversifying into the exploration and mining of natural resources. The purpose of the Acquisition is to explore the opportunities for deriving from the sales of the Mineral Resources to be extracted from the Target Mine when the Mining Licence is obtained. It is currently expected that the Target Group will generate revenue in 2009, if the Mining Licence is obtained. The prices of metals such as iron, titanium and vanadium have been rising over the past years. The Directors believe that the demand for metals such as iron, titanium and vanadium will be considerable given the fact that the economy of the PRC will grow rapidly, and therefore the national consumption of such metals will rise in the near future. The Directors therefore believe that the Acquisition enables the Group to diversify into the iron, titanium and vanadium mining business which has good future prospect. Based on the technical report prepared by WGM and contained in Appendix VII to this circular, the indicated Mineral Resources of the Target Mine—First Portion amounted to 16.2 million tonnes at 19.5% TFe, 3.86% TiO 2 and 0.03% V 2O 5 respectively, which represents an estimate of proven exploitable reserves at the Target Mine—First Portion. The technical report also concludes that with continued on-going exploration by diamond drilling, the potential for increasing resources and reserves in the proposed pit area and in the remaining portion of the Target Mine (i.e. the portion other than the Target Mine - First Portion) is considered to be good. Given the current amount of mineral resources and the potential for increasing the mineral resources and reserves estimates, the Directors consider that the Acquisition would be beneficial to the Group. As per the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion prepared by LCH and contained in Appendix IV to this circular, the value of the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 was approximately RMB2,255 million. As such, the Directors consider that the Consideration for the Acquisition (totalling HK$1,000 million), representing 51% interest of the whole Target Mine is fair and reasonable. Shareholders’ attention is drawn to the fact that discounted cash flow method has been used in the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion as set out in Appendix IV to this circular and is accordingly a deemed profit forecast under Rule 14.61 of the Listing Rules. The Directors consider that they have made due and careful enquiry in determining the value of the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 as set out in Appendix IV to this circular. Please also refer to Part A of Appendix V to this circular in which Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited, the financial adviser appointed by the Company, has opined that the forecasts upon which the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion set out in Appendix IV to this circular has been made, have been made after due and careful enquiry by the Directors. The Enlarged Group’s total assets and total liabilities will increase significantly after the Acquisition. In addition, it is expected that the Acquisition will increase the Group’s profits in the future due to the earnings of the Enlarged Group will be improved in long run when the Target Mine is under the production stage, however, the possible risk factors may be considered in the paragraph headed “Risk factors” below. For the reasons set out in the sub-paragraph headed “Consideration payable upon Completion” under the paragraph headed “Share Transfer Agreement” above, the Acquisition is structured into two stages that Completion will take place before the Mining Licence of the Target Mine is obtained. The Directors, including the independent non-executive Directors, consider that the terms of the Acquisition (including the Consideration and the payment methods thereof) are fair and reasonable and in the interest of the Company and the Shareholders as a whole. – 26 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD FINANCIAL EFFECTS OF THE ACQUISITION Upon completion, the Target Company will become a non-wholly owned subsidiary of the Company and its consolidated financial results will be consolidated with those of the Group. Set out below is a summary of the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Group (1) before Completion, (2) at Completion but the Mining Licence has yet to obtain and, (3) at Completion and upon obtaining the Mining Licence, prepared on the bases set out on pages 170 to 172 of this circular and details of which are set out in Appendix III to this circular: The Group as at 30 June 2007 (Before Completion) (Unaudited) (HK$’000) Pro forma of the Enlarged Group (At Completion but the Mining Licence has yet to obtain) (Unaudited) (HK$’000) Pro forma of the Enlarged Group (At Completion and upon obtaining the Mining Licence) (Unaudited) (HK$’000) Total assets Total liabilities Total net assets Net current assets Gearing ratio (total liabilities/total assets) 211,164 60,524 150,640 61,952 0.29 996,237 292,538 703,699 101,200 0.29 2,751,111 538,325 2,212,786 101,200 0.20 Loss for the year ended 31 December 2006 (46,157) (55,937) (55,937) There is no variation to the remuneration payable to and benefits in kind receivable by the directors of Smooth Way as a consequence of the Acquisition. NON-CASH PORTION OF THE CONSIDERATION CONSIDERATION SHARES The Issue Price of the Consideration Shares of HK$0.5 per Consideration Share was determined after arm’s length negotiations between the parties with reference to the recent market price of the Shares and the net asset value per Share as at 31 December 2006 of HK$0.11, which represents (i) a premium of approximately 354.55% to the net asset value per share as at 31 December 2006 of HK$0.11; (ii) a discount of approximately 41.18% to the closing price of HK$0.85 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange on 6 July 2007, the last trading day immediately prior to the date of the Share Transfer Agreement; (iii) a discount of approximately 41.18% to the average of the closing prices of HK$0.85 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange for the last five trading days immediately prior to the date of the Share Transfer Agreement; (iv) a discount of approximately 40.19% to the average of the closing prices of HK$0.836 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange for the last ten trading days immediately prior to the date of the Share Transfer Agreement; and (v) a discount of approximately 21.88% to the closing price of HK$0.64 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange as at the Latest Practicable Date. – 27 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD As set out above, the Board has considered the net asset value per Share as at 31 December 2006 of HK$0.11 in determining the Issue Price of the Consideration Shares. The Issue Price of the Consideration Shares of HK$0.5 per Consideration Share represents a premium of about 354.55% over the net asset value per Share as at 31 December 2006. Taking into account the fact that the Group made losses for the previous two financial years ended 31 December 2006, the parties to the Share Transfer Agreement consider that it is more appropriate to use the net asset value per Share of the Company as at 31 December 2006 as the pricing benchmark for the Issue Price of the Consideration Shares. Based on the above, the Board considers the Issue Price of the Consideration Shares is fair and reasonable and in the interests of the Shareholders. Given the aforesaid massive premium of the Issue Price over the net asset value per Share as at 31 December 2006 and from the arm’s length commercial negotiations between the parties to the Share Transfer Agreement, the Board considers a discount of around 40% of the Issue Price from the market price of the Shares are fair and reasonable and in the interest of the Shareholders. The Consideration Shares represents approximately 28.34% of the existing issued share capital of the Company and approximately 22.08% of the issued share capital of the Company as enlarged by the issue of the Consideration Shares. Based on the market value per Share as of 6 July 2007 (i.e. the closing price of HK$0.85 per Share), the aggregate value of the Consideration Shares is HK$229,500,000. The Consideration Shares will be issued under a specific mandate proposed to be obtained at the EGM. An application has been made to the Stock Exchange for the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Consideration Shares. Please refer to page 31 of this circular for, inter alia, the shareholding structure, of the Company immediately after the issue of the Consideration Shares. CONVERTIBLE BONDS The principal terms of the Convertible Bonds are as follows: Principal amount HK$765 million in aggregate, as to the Tranche 1 Bonds of HK$365 million and as to the Tranche 2 Bonds of HK$400 million. Form and denomination The Convertible Bonds will be issued in registered form and in the denomination of HK$600,000 each. Maturity Date The respective Business Day falling on the fifth anniversary from the issue date of each of the Tranche 1 Bonds and Tranche 2 Bonds. – 28 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Interest The Bonds shall accrue no interest. Transferability The Convertible Bonds will be transferable provided that (1) any transfer of the Convertible Bonds shall be in the principal amount of HK$600,000 (or such lesser amount as may represent the entire principal amount thereof); and (2) if the transfer is made to a connected person of the Company (other than the associates (with the same meaning as defined under the Listing Rules) of the holder of the Convertible Bonds (including the Vendor)), such transfer shall comply with the requirements under the Listing Rules and/or the requirements imposed by the Stock Exchange (if any). Conversion The Tranche 1 Bonds are convertible in whole or in part into new Shares at any time from the period commencing from the Completion and expiring on the fifth anniversary of such date of commencement up to 4:00 p.m.; while Tranche 2 Bonds are convertible in whole or in part into new Shares at any time from the period commencing from the fifth Business Day following the date of receipt of the Mining Licence in respect of the Target Mine and expiring on the fifth anniversary of such date of commencement up to 4:00 p.m., provided that no Conversion Bonds may be converted, to the extent that following such exercise, a holder of the Conversion Bonds and parties acting in concert with it, taken together, will directly or indirectly, control or be interested in 25% or more of the entire issued Shares. The Convertible Bonds are convertible at the Conversion Price, subject to adjustment for, among other matters, subdivision or consolidation of Shares, bonus issues, and rights issue. Any conversion shall be made in amounts of not less than a whole multiple of HK$600,000 (save that if at any time the outstanding principal amount of the Convertible Bond held by a holder of the Convertible Bond is less than HK$600,000, or if a holder of the Convertible Bond intends to exercise the conversion rights attached to the entire principal amount of all the Convertible Bonds held by him) and no fraction of a Share shall be issued on conversion. Save for the redemption of the Convertible Bonds upon the reduction of the Consideration set out in the paragraph headed “Adjustment to the Consideration” above, any Convertible Bond which remains outstanding by 4:00 p.m. (Hong Kong time) on the Maturity Date shall be converted automatically into the Conversion Shares. However, there will not be any automatic conversion of the Convertible Bonds at Maturity if such conversion will result in a holder of the Convertible Bonds and parties acting in concert with it, taken together, will directly or indirectly, control or be interested in 25% or more of the entire issued Shares. If at Maturity, a holder of the Convertible Bonds and parties acting in concert with it, directly or indirectly, control or are interested in 25% or more of the entire issued Shares, which result in no automatic conversion of the Convertible Bonds at Maturity as mentioned above, the Company may consider liaising with the holders of the outstanding Convertible Bonds to extend the maturity date of the Convertible Bonds, or the Company (or its subsidiaries) may consider purchasing the Convertible Bonds. Should the maturity date of the Convertible Bonds be extended, it will constitute a change in material terms of the Convertible Bonds and the Company will seek Shareholders’ approval (or as the case may be, independent Shareholders’ approval) of such alteration at general meeting in accordance with the requirements under the Listing Rules and comply with the applicable requirements of the Listing Rules (including but not limited to Chapters 14 and 14A of the Listing Rules). – 29 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Conversion Price The Convertible Bonds shall be converted at the Conversion Price of HK$0.6 per Conversion Share. The Conversion Price of HK$0.6 represents (i) a premium of approximately 445.45% to the net asset value per Share as at 31 December 2006 of HK$0.11; (ii) a discount of approximately 29.41% to the closing price of HK$0.85 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange on 6 July 2007, the last trading day immediately prior to the date of the Share Transfer Agreement; (iii) a discount of approximately 29.41% to the average of the closing prices of HK$0.85 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange for the last five trading days immediately prior to the date of the Share Transfer Agreement; and (iv) a discount of approximately 28.23% to the average of the closing prices of HK$0.836 per Share as quoted on the Stock Exchange for the last ten trading days immediately prior to the date of the Share Transfer Agreement. Conversion Price is generally at discount to the market price and the Board does not consider discount of 28% to 29% as high discount, taking into account the net asset value per Share as at 31 December 2006 of HK$0.11. Moratorium on Conversion Shares The Convertible Shares may not be assigned or transferred in whole or in part to a connected person of the Company (other than the associates (with the same meaning as defined under the Listing Rules) of the holder of the Convertible Bonds (including the Vendor)) unless such transfer complies with the requirements under the Listing Rules and/or the requirements imposed by the Stock Exchange (if any). Purchase The Company or any of its subsidiaries may at any time and from time to time purchase the Convertible Bonds that remain outstanding from the holders of such Convertible Bonds at any price as to be agreed between the Company or such subsidiary and the relevant holder of the Convertible Bonds. There is no minimum for each purchase. If the Company purchases the Convertible Bonds (which may be an exercise of a right, but not obligation, of the Company to purchase the Convertible Bonds), the Company will comply with the applicable requirements under the Listing Rules (including but not limited to Rule 13.09, Chapters 14 and 14A of the Listing Rules). Cancellation Immediately upon redemption by the Company or purchase by the Company or any of its subsidiaries, the Convertible Bonds so redeemed or purchased shall forthwith be cancelled. Any Convertible Bond so cancelled shall not be re-issued or re-sold. Adjustment to Conversion Price The Conversion Price is subject to adjustments upon the occurrence of, among other matters, subdivision or consolidation of Shares, capitalisation issues and rights issues. – 30 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Ranking The Conversion Shares shall rank in all respects pari passu with all Shares in issue as at the date of allotment. Listing The Convertible Bonds will not be listed on the Stock Exchange or any other stock exchange. An application has been made to the Stock Exchange for the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Conversion Shares. Due to the significant dilutive nature of the Conversion Shares, the Company would adopt the following additional disclosure measures if the transaction contemplated under the Share Transfer Agreement is approved by the Shareholders: (i) the Company will make a monthly announcement (“Monthly Announcement”) on the website of the Stock Exchange. Such announcement will be made on or before the fifth business day following the end of each calendar month and will include the following details in a table form; (a) whether there is any conversion of the Convertible Bonds during the relevant month and if so, details of the conversion(s), including the conversion date, number of new Shares issued and conversion price for each conversion. If there is no conversion during the relevant month, a negative statement to that effect; (b) the number of outstanding Convertible Bonds after the conversion, if any; (c) the total number of Shares issued pursuant to other transactions including Shares issued pursuant to exercise of options under any share option scheme(s) of the Company; and (d) the total issued share capital of the Company as at the commencement and the last day of the relevant months. (ii) in addition to the Monthly Announcement, if the cumulative amount of the new Shares converted from the Convertible Bonds reaches 5% of the issued share capital of the Company as disclosed in the last Monthly Announcement or any subsequent announcement made by the Company in respect of the Convertible Bonds (as the case may be) (and thereafter in a multiple of such 5% threshold), the Company will make an announcement on the website of the Stock Exchange including details as stated in (i) (a)-(d) above for the period commencing from the date of the last Monthly Announcement or any subsequent announcement made by the Company in respect of the Convertible Bonds (as the case may be) up to the date on which the total amount of Shares issued pursuant to the conversion amounted to 5% of the issued share capital of the Company as disclosed in the last Monthly Announcement or any subsequent announcement made by the Company in respect of the Convertible Bonds (as the case may be); and (iii) in respect of conversion of the Convertible Bonds, the Company will make an announcement in the event any such conversion will result in an increase of its shareholding in the Company by 5%. Shareholding chart of the Company The following chart sets out the percentage shareholding in the Company, (i) as at the date of signing of the Share Transfer Agreement, (ii) as at the Latest Practicable Date; (iii) after issue of the Consideration Shares but before the issue of the Conversion Shares under the Convertible Bonds; (iv) after issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares under the Tranche 1 Bonds (assuming – 31 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD the Tranche 1 Bonds are converted in full) but before issue of the Conversion Shares under the Tranche 2 Bonds; and (v) after issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares under the Tranche 1 Bonds and the Tranche 2 Bonds (assuming all the Convertible Bonds are converted in full), assuming that there is no other change in the share capital of the Company from the date of signing of the Share Transfer Agreement to the Completion Date: After issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares under After issue of the Tranche 1 the Consideration Bonds Shares and After issue of (assuming the the Conversion the Consideration Tranche 1 Bonds Shares under Shares but are converted the Tranche 1 As at before in full) but Bonds and the date of the issue of before the issue of the Tranche 2 signing of As at the Conversion the Conversion Bonds (assuming the Share the Latest Shares under Shares under all the Convertible Transfer Practicable the Convertible the Tranche 2 Bonds are Agreement Date Bonds Bonds converted in full) L & L Holdings Limited (Note 1) 120,000,000 Shares (14.67%) 120,000,000 Shares (12.60%) 120,000,000 Shares (9.81%) 120,000,000 Shares (6.55%) 120,000,000 Shares (4.80%) The Vendor (and/or its nominees) 0 Share (0%) 0 Share (0%) 270,000,000 Shares (22.08%) 878,333,333 Shares (47.97%) (Note 2) 1,545,000,000 Shares (61.86%) (Note 2) Public 697,720,000 Shares (85.33%) 832,720,000 Shares (87.40%) 832,720,000 Shares (68.11%) 832,720,000 Shares (45.48%) 832,720,000 Shares (33.34%) Total: 817,720,000 Shares 952,720,000 Shares 1,222,720,000 Shares 1,831,053,333 Shares 2,497,720,000 Shares Notes: 1. L & L Holdings Limited is an investment holding company incorporated in the Republic of the Marshall Islands, the entire issued share capital of which is wholly and beneficially owned by Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, the chief executive officer and executive Director. 2. The CB Instrument provides that no Conversion Bonds may be converted, to the extent that following such exercise, a holder of the Conversion Bonds (including the Vendor) and parties acting in concert with it, taken together, will directly or indirectly, control or be interested in 25% or more of the entire issued Shares. As set out in the above table, the maximum number of the Conversion Shares (assuming the conversion rights attached to the Convertible Bonds are exercised in full) is 1,275,000,000 Conversion Shares, which represents (1) approximately 133.83% of the existing issued share capital of the Company; (2) approximately 104.28% of the issued share capital of the Company as enlarged by the issue of the Consideration Shares; and (3) approximately 51.05% of the issued share capital of the Company as enlarged by the issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares. – 32 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Taking into account the restriction set out in note 2 to the above table, the Acquisition, which involves the issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares, will not result in change of control (as defined in the Code on Takeovers and Mergers) of the Company. RISK FACTORS Possible risk factors which are faced by the Group are as follows: Significant and continuous capital investment The Target Mine requires significant and continuous capital investment; the Target Mine exploration and production may not be completed as planned; may exceed the original budgets and may not achieve the intended economic results or commercial viability. Actual capital expenditures for the Target Mine may significantly exceed the Group’s working capital or budgets because of various factors beyond the Group’s control, which in turn may affect the Group’s financial condition. Mining Licence of the Target Mine Qinghai Senyuan, a member of the Target Group, is the holder of the Exploration Licence of the Existing LRM Mine, which confers to Qinghai Senyuan the right to, inter alia, carry out exploration of the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine. The Target Group is conducting feasibility studies and other preparation work for obtaining the Mining Licence of the Target Mine for the purpose of carrying out mining of the Mineral Resources at the Target Mine. The obtaining of the Mining Licence of the Target Mine is not a condition precedent to which the Acquisition is subject. At Completion, the Mining Licence of the Target Mine may not have been obtained. There is no guarantee that the Mining Licence of the Target Mine will be granted. If the Target Group fails to obtain the Mining Licence of the Target Mine as planned, the Company may not recover fully the funds and resources it has spent, and the future development of the Group may be adversely affected. As the steps (if any) to be taken in the case that the Mining Licence of the Target Mine cannot be obtained largely depend on the surrounding circumstances then prevailing, the Company does not have any detailed plan at this stage, but would assure that all steps taken will be in the best interest of the Company and the Shareholders as a whole, and in compliance with the applicable laws, regulations and the Listing Rules. Policies and regulations Exploration and mining of the mineral resources in the PRC are subject to extensive governmental regulations, policies and controls. Whilst the exploitation and beneficiation of iron ore is one of the items listed in the Catalogue of “Encouraged Foreign Investment Industries” as promulgated by Decree No. 24 of the National Development and Reform Commission and the Ministry of Commerce of the PRC, there can be no assurance that the relevant government will not change the relevant laws and regulations or impose additional or more stringent laws or regulations in future. Failure to comply with the relevant laws and regulations in the exploration and mining projects may adversely affect the future development of the Group. – 33 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Environmental protection policies The mining and exploration business is subject to environmental protection law and regulations in the PRC. If the Group fails to comply with existing or future environmental laws and regulations, the Group may be required to take remedial measures, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, operations, financial condition and results of operations. LISTING RULES REQUIREMENTS The Acquisition constitutes a very substantial acquisition for the Company under Chapter 14 of the Listing Rules and is therefore subject to the reporting, announcement and Shareholders’ approval requirements under Chapter 14 of the Listing Rules. The Company has appointed Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited as its financial adviser to advise the Company on the Acquisition. FINANCIAL ASSISTANCE FOR FUNDING THE EXPLOITATION OF THE TARGET MINE Pursuant to the Shareholders’ Agreement (to be entered into upon Completion), if the Target Company requires additional funding and, subject always to the applicable Listing Rules being complied with, the Company shall raise funds required by the Target Company (or, as the case may be, Hong Kong FSMI) and provide such funds to the Target Company (or, as the case may be, Hong Kong FSMI) in the form of shareholder’s loans. The above constitutes financial assistance under Rule 14A.13(2)(a) of the Listing Rules and accordingly is a continuing connected transaction of the Company. However, as at the Latest Practicable Date, the Group cannot quantify the possible amount of capital funding on the Target Mine required to be provided by the Company, given that the feasibility study on the Target Mine is still ongoing and the total amount of investment required may vary from what is currently estimated. Please refer to the paragraph headed “Risk Factor(s)” above. The Company will comply with the relevant requirements under the Listing Rules when the above financial assistance arises. PROPOSED GRANT OF GENERAL MANDATE TO ALLOT AND ISSUE SHARES Pursuant to an ordinary resolution passed by the Shareholders at the AGM, the Directors were granted a general mandate to allot, issue and deal with up to a maximum of 162,690,000 Shares, representing 20% of the aggregate nominal amount of 813,450,000 issued as at the date of the AGM. As at the Latest Practicable Date, such mandate has been largely utilised in relation to the placing of 135,000,000 Shares as announced on 20 July 2007 by the Company. The Board will seek the approval of the Independent Shareholders for the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate at the EGM. Assuming no Shares are issued or repurchased prior to the EGM, the Company had an aggregate of 952,720,000 Shares in issue as at the Latest Practicable Date, upon the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate, the Directors shall be granted a general mandate to allot, issue and deal with up to 190,544,000 Shares. – 34 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD The Refreshed Issue Mandate will expire at the earliest of (a) the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company; (b) the expiration of the period within which the next annual general meeting of the Company is required by its articles of association, the Companies Law, Cap.22 (Law 3 of 1961, as consolidated and revised of the Cayman Islands) or any other applicable law of the Cayman Islands to be held; and (c) the passing of an ordinary resolution by the Shareholders in general meeting revoking or varying the authority given to the Directors. The refreshment is conditional upon the approval by the Independent Shareholders by way of ordinary resolutions at the EGM. The votes will be taken by way of poll. Pursuant to Rule 13.36(4)(a) of the Listing Rules, any controlling Shareholders and their associates or, where there are no controlling Shareholders, directors (excluding independent non-executive Directors) and the chief executive of the Company and their respective associates shall abstain from voting in favour of the Refreshed Issue Mandate. As at the Latest Practicable Date, there was no controlling Shareholder and aside from (1) Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, an executive Director and the chief executive officer of the Company who wholly and beneficially owns L & L Holdings Limited which holds 120,000,000 Shares (representing approximately 12.60% of the existing issued share capital of the Company), (2) Mr. Law Fei Shing, an executive Director, who holds 3,000,000 Shares (representing 0.31% of the existing issued share capital of the Company), and (3) Dr. Ma Chung Wo Cameron, a non-executive Director, who holds 500,000 Shares (representing 0.05% of the existing issued share capital of the Company), none of the Directors, chief executives and/or their respective associates was interested in any Shares. Accordingly, L & L Holdings Limited, Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, Mr. Law Fei Shing, Dr. Ma Chung Wo Cameron, and any Director (excluding independent non-executive Directors) and the chief executive of the Company who shall hold Shares as at the date of the EGM and their respective associates are required to abstain from voting in favour of the relevant resolutions proposed in connection with the Refreshed Issue Mandate at the EGM. L & L Holdings Limited, Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, Mr. Law Fei Shing, Dr. Ma Chung Wo Cameron and their respective associates had no intention to vote against the resolutions to approve the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate as at the Latest Practicable Date. In compliance with Rules 13.39(6) and 13.39(7) of the Listing Rules, an Independent Board Committee has been established to make recommendations to the Shareholders and Veda Capital has been appointed as the independent financial adviser to advise the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders in respect of the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate. EXTENSION MANDATE In addition, an ordinary resolution regarding the Extension Mandate will be proposed at the EGM providing that the nominal value of any shares of the Company repurchased by the Company pursuant to or in accordance with the authority granted and approved by the shareholders of the Company at the AGM will be added to the total nominal value of shares of the Company which may be allotted and issued under the Issue Mandate. Since the extension mandate granted at the AGM extends the power of the Directors to issue shares of the Company under the mandate to allot and issue shares granted at the AGM only, a fresh Extension Mandate is necessary to allow the Directors to issue further shares under the Issue Mandate upon repurchase of shares of the Company. – 35 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD REASONS FOR THE REFRESHED ISSUE MANDATE On 8 July 2007, the Company entered into the conditional Share Transfer Agreement in relation to the Acquisition, which offers sustainable growth to the Group’s business and broaden its source of income by diversifying into the exploration and mining of natural resources. On 18 July 2007, the Company entered into a placing agreement in respect of the issue of 135,000,000 Shares under the Existing General Mandate approved by the Shareholders at the AGM, to raise approximately HK$90.7 million for part of the payment of the Consideration (“Placing”). Since the AGM, no fund raising activity has been carried out by the Company aside from the Placing. Thus, the Board proposes to seek the approval from the Independent Shareholders at the EGM for the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate such that the Company will have greater financial flexibility in raising additional capital for the development of the newly acquired business. The Board believes that fund raising exercise pursuant to a general mandate provides the Company with a simpler and less lead time process than other types of fund raising exercises and to avoid the uncertainties in such circumstances that specific mandate may not be obtained in a timely manner. In appropriate circumstances, the Board will also consider other financing methods such as debt financing or internal cash resources to fund its future business development. The Directors therefore consider the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate is beneficial to the Company and the Independent Shareholders as a whole. FUND RAISING ACTIVITIES The Group has conducted the following fund raising activities in the past 12 months from the Latest Practicable Date: Intended use of Net amount proceeds as Description Announcement raised announced Actual use of proceeds Placing of new shares under general mandate granted on 8 June 2006 5 March 2007 Approximately Approximately HK$1 million for remaining HK$26.0 million HK$18 million balance of acquisition of the for new investment Logistic and Financial opportunity, as Management System from to approximately CMST. HK$3.2 million to repay accrued HK$9.3 million has been paid expenses and as to as partial consideration of approximately Acquisition approximately HK$4.8 million Approximately HK$8 million for operation for repayment of accrued expenses of expenses and operation the Group expenses (as to (1) payment of Directors’ fees and salary of HK$4,100,000; (2) settlement of professional fees of HK$3,900,000; As at the Latest Practicable Date, the remaining balance of the proceeds of HK$7.7 million has been maintained into the bank – 36 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD Description Announcement Net amount raised Intended use of proceeds as announced Actual use of proceeds Placing of new shares 11 June 2007 under refreshment of general mandate granted on 14 May 2007 Approximately Approximately HK$51 HK$10 million has been paid as HK$66.8 million million for major partial payment of capital transaction of injection in Hebei Da Sheng investment into joint Warranty Company Limited venture company in Hebei Da Sheng HK$4.2 million has been Warranty Company used as general working Limited details of capital of the Group which are set out in Company’s As at the Latest Practicable announcement and Date, the remaining balance circular dated of the proceeds of HK$52.6 29 March 2007 and million has been maintained 28 May 2007 into the bank in which respectively) and HK$41 million of the as to approximately balance of capital injection in HK$15.8 million for Hebei Da Sheng Warranty general working Company Limited capital of the Group will be paid. Placing of new shares under the mandate granted at the AGM Approximately All of the net HK$90.7 million proceeds for the part payment of the Consideration 20 July 2007 – 37 – The entire amount of net proceeds have been used to settle the cash portion of the Consideration. LETTER FROM THE BOARD REFRESHMENT OF THE SCHEME MANDATE LIMIT The Board also proposes to seek the approval of the Shareholders to refresh the Scheme Mandate Limit at the EGM. The Scheme Mandate Limit approved to be reset at the extraordinary general meeting of the Company held on 10 March 2006 enables the Directors to grant options to eligible person(s) under the Share Option Scheme to subscribe for up to 52,520,000 Shares, representing 10% of the then issued share capital of the Company as at the date of the extraordinary general meeting of the Company held on 10 March 2006. Up to the Latest Practicable Date, all the options entitling the holders to subscribe for 52,520,000 Shares have been granted and exercised under the Share Option Scheme. These options were granted on 7 March 2006, 2 May 2006 and 27 November 2006 and are in accordance with the terms and restrictions of the Share Option Scheme. All these options were granted to eligible participants under the Share Option Scheme. The Directors confirm that the grant of the above options was in line with the rules of the Share Option Scheme and the relevant requirements of the Listing Rules. As at the Latest Practicable Date, apart from the Share Option Scheme, the Company has no other share option scheme. In order to provide the Company with greater flexibility in granting options to eligible person(s) under the Share Option Scheme, the Board decides to seek the approval of the Shareholder to refresh the Scheme Mandate Limit so that the total number of Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all options to be granted under the Share Option Scheme and any other share option schemes of the Company shall be re-set at 10% of the Shares in issue as at the date of passing the relevant resolution at the EGM. As at the Latest Practicable Date, the Company had 952,720,000 Shares in issue and assuming no Shares are issued or repurchased prior to the EGM, the Board will be allowed to grant options to subscribe for up to 95,272,000 Shares (“Available Limit”) if the proposed refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit is approved at the EGM. Pursuant to the Listing Rules, the maximum number of Shares which may be issued upon exercise of all outstanding options granted and yet to be exercised under the Share Option Scheme and any other share option schemes of the Company must not in aggregate exceed 30% of the Shares in issue from time to time (“30% Overall Limit”). On the basis of 952,720,000 Shares in issue as at the Latest Practicable Date, the 30% Overall Limit represents a total of 285,816,000 Shares. There was no outstanding options granted and yet to be exercised as at the Latest Practicable Date, accordingly, the Available Limit does not exceed the 30% Overall Limit as at the Latest Practicable Date. The refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit is conditional upon: (a) the Shareholders approving the proposed refreshment at the EGM; and (b) the Listing Committee of the Stock Exchange granting the listing of and permission to deal in the Shares which may be allotted and issued upon the exercise of options to be granted under the Share Option Scheme or any other schemes. – 38 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD An ordinary resolution will be proposed at the EGM for the approval of refreshing the Scheme Mandate Limit. No Shareholder is required to abstain from voting for this ordinary resolution. Application has been made to the Listing Committee of the Stock Exchange for the granting of the listing of, and permission to deal in, the Shares to be issued pursuant to the exercise of options to be granted under the Share Option Scheme. EGM The EGM will be held at Suites 5303-5304, 53rd Floor, Central Plaza, 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong on 31 October 2007 at 10:30 a.m. to consider and, if thought fit, approve, among other matters, the Acquisition, the Share Transfer Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder, the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate and the proposed refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit. A notice convening the EGM is set out on pages 340 to 343 of this circular. Whether or not you are able to attend the EGM, you are requested to complete the accompanying form of proxy in accordance with the instructions printed thereon and return the same to the Company’s share registrar in Hong Kong, Tricor Tengis Limited at 26th Floor, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong as soon as possible and in any event not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for the holding of the EGM or any adjournment thereof. Completion and return of the form of proxy shall not preclude you from attending and voting at the EGM if you so wish. To the best knowledge of the Directors, none of the Vendor and her associates holds any Shares as at the Latest Practicable Date. On such basis, no Shareholder is required to abstain from voting on the Acquisition, the Share Transfer Agreement and the transactions contemplated thereunder. No Shareholder is required to abstain from voting on the proposed refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit. Pursuant to Rule 13.36(4) of the Listing Rules, all Directors (excluding the independent nonexecutive Directors) and the chief executive and their respective associates are required to abstain from voting in favour of the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate. PROCEDURE TO DEMAND A POLL AT GENERAL MEETING Pursuant to articles 72 and 73 of the articles of association of the Company, a resolution put to vote of the meeting shall be decided on a show of hands unless a poll is (before or on the declaration of the result of the show of hands or on the withdrawal of any demand for a poll) demanded: (i) by the chairman of the meeting; or (ii) by at least three Shareholders present in person (or, in the case of a Shareholder being a corporation, by its duly authorized representative) or by proxy for the time being entitled to vote at the general meeting; or (iii) by a Shareholder or Shareholders present in person (or, in the case of a Shareholder being a corporation, by its duly authorized representative) or by proxy and representing not less than one-tenth of the total voting rights of all the Shareholders having the right to vote at the meeting; or – 39 – LETTER FROM THE BOARD (iv) by a Shareholder or Shareholders present in person (or, in the case of a Shareholder being a corporation, by its duly authorized representative) or by proxy and holding Shares conferring a right to vote at the meeting being Shares on which an aggregate sum has been paid up equal to not less than one-tenth of the total sum paid up on all the Shares conferring that right; or (v) if required by the Designated Stock Exchange (defined as “a stock exchange in respect of which Shares are listed or quoted and where such stock exchange deems such listing or quotation to be the primary listing or quotation of the Shares” under the articles of association of the Company), by any Director or Directors who, individually or collectively, hold proxies in respect of Shares representing 5% or more of the total voting rights at such meeting. Unless a poll be so demanded and not withdrawn, a declaration by the chairman of the meeting that a resolution has on a show of hands been carried or carried unanimously, or by a particular majority, or lost, and an entry to that effect made in the book containing the minutes of the proceedings of the Company shall be conclusive evidence of the fact without proof of the number or proportion of the votes recorded in favour or against such resolution. RECOMMENDATION The Directors consider that the terms of the Share Transfer Agreement, the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate and the proposed refreshment of the Scheme Mandate Limit are fair and reasonable to the Company and in the interests of the Shareholders as a whole. Accordingly, the Directors recommend the Shareholders and the Independent Shareholders (as the case may be) to vote in favour of the relevant resolutions at the EGM. Your attention is drawn to the letter of recommendation from the Independent Board Committee set out on page 41 of this circular and the letter of advice from Veda Capital set out on pages 42 to 46 of this circular, which contains, among other matters, its advice to the Independent Board Committee in relation to the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the principal factors considered by it in arriving at its recommendation. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION Your attention is drawn to the information set out in the appendices to this circular. Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of the Board Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Law Fei Shing Executive Director – 40 – LETTER FROM THE INDEPENDENT BOARD COMMITTEE AURORA GLOBAL INVESTMENT HOLDINGS LIMITED ρˀଈҙ༅ઁٖτࠉʔ̇* (Incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) (Stock code: 353) 15 October 2007 To the Independent Shareholders Dear Sir or Madam, REFRESHMENT OF GENERAL MANDATE TO ALLOT AND ISSUE SHARES We have been appointed as members of the Independent Board Committee to advise the Independent Shareholders in connection with the granting of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate, details of which are set out in the circular of the Company dated 15 October 2007 (“Circular”), of which this letter forms part. Terms defined in the Circular shall have the same meanings when used herein unless the context otherwise requires. Having considered the advice of Veda Capital in relation thereto as set out in the Circular, we are of the view that the granting of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate is in the interests of the Company and the Independent Shareholders as a whole and the terms of the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate are fair and reasonable so far as the Independent Shareholders are concerned. Accordingly, we recommend the Independent Shareholders to vote in favour of the resolutions to be proposed at the EGM to approve the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and the Extension Mandate. Yours faithfully Lum Pak Sum Independent non-executive Director Wan Hon Keung Independent non-executive Director * for identification purpose only – 41 – Sun Tak Keung Independent non-executive Director LETTER FROM VEDA CAPITAL The following is the full text of the letter from Veda Capital setting out the advice to the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders for inclusion in this circular. Veda Capital Limited Suite 809, 8th Floor, Shui On Centre, 8 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong 15 October 2007 To the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Dear Sirs and Madams, REFRESHMENT OF GENERAL MANDATE TO ALLOT AND ISSUE SHARES INTRODUCTION We refer to the circular dated 15 October 2007 issued by the Company to the Shareholders of which this letter forms part (the “Circular”) and our appointment as the independent financial adviser to advise the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders in respect of the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate, details of which are set out in the letter from the Board contained in the Circular (the “Board Letter”). Capitalised terms used in this letter, unless the context otherwise requires, shall have the same meanings ascribed to them in the Circular. Pursuant to Rule 13.36(4)(a) of the Listing Rules, the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate is subject to the approval of the Independent Shareholders by way of poll at the EGM. The controlling Shareholders and their associates or, where there are no controlling Shareholders, Directors (excluding the independent non-executive Directors) and the chief executive of the Company and their respective associates shall abstain from voting in favour of the relevant resolutions at the EGM. As at the Latest Practicable Date, there was no controlling Shareholder and aside from Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, being the executive Director and the chief executive officer of the Company who wholly and beneficially owns L & L Holdings Limited which holds 120,000,000 Shares (representing approximately 12.60% of the existing issued share capital of the Company), Mr. Law Fei Shing, being the executive Director, who holds 3,000,000 Shares (representing 0.31% of the existing issued share capital of the Company), and Dr. Ma Chung Wo Cameron, the non-executive Director, who holds 500,000 Shares (representing 0.05% of the existing issued share capital of the Company), none of the Directors, chief executive of the Company and/or their respective associates was interested in any Shares. Accordingly, L & L Holdings Limited, Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, Mr. Law Fei Shing, Dr. Ma Chung Wo, Cameron and any Director (excluding the Independent non-executive Directors) and the chief executive of the Company who shall hold Shares as at the date of the EGM and their respective associates are required to abstain from voting in favour of the relevant resolutions proposed in connection with the grant of Refreshed Issue Mandate at the EGM. As at the Latest Practicable Date, – 42 – LETTER FROM VEDA CAPITAL L & L Holdings Limited, Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, Mr. Law Fei Shing, Dr. Ma Chung Wo, Cameron and their respective associates had no intention to vote against the resolution to approve the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate. The Independent Board Committee, comprising all the independent non-executive Directors, namely Mr. Lum Pak Sum, Mr. Wan Hon Keung and Mr. Sun Tak Keung, has been established to advise whether the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate is in the interests of the Company and the Independent Shareholders as a whole. BASIS OF OUR ADVICE In formulating our opinion, we have relied on the information, facts and representations contained or referred to in the Circular and the information, facts and representations provided by, and the opinions expressed by the Directors, the Company and its management. We have assumed that all statements, information, facts, opinions and representations made to us or referred to in the Circular were true, accurate and complete at the time they were made and continued to be true, accurate and complete as at the date of the Circular. We have relied on such information and opinions and have not, however, conducted any independent investigation into the business, financial conditions and affairs or the future prospects of the Group. We have no reason to doubt the truth, accuracy and completeness of the statements, information, facts, opinions and representations provided to us by the Directors, the Company and its management. The Directors have confirmed to us that no material facts have been omitted from the information supplied and opinions expressed. We consider that we have been provided with sufficient information to reach an informed view to provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. All the Directors jointly and severally accept full responsibility for the accuracy of the information contained in the Circular and confirm, having made all reasonable enquiries, that, to the best of their knowledge, opinions expressed in the Circular have been arrived at after due and careful consideration and that there are no other facts not contained in the Circular the omission of which would make any statement in the Circular misleading. PRINCIPAL FACTORS AND REASONS CONSIDERED In arriving at our opinion in respect of the proposed grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate, we have taken the following principal factors and reasons into consideration: Background The Group is principally engaged in the design, manufacture and sale of a wide range of carpets under its own brand name and the trading of carpets of various brand names. At the AGM, the Directors were granted the Existing General Mandate to allot, issue and deal with up to 162,690,000 new Shares, representing 20% of the aggregate nominal amount of the issued share capital of the Company then in issue. Subsequent to the AGM, and as at the Latest Practicable Date, the Existing General Mandate has been largely utilized in relation to the placing of 135,000,000 Shares, details of which were disclosed in the announcement of the Company dated 20 July 2007 as being part of the Consideration in relation to the Acquisition. – 43 – LETTER FROM VEDA CAPITAL To maintain the financial flexibility necessary for the Group’s future business development, the Directors therefore propose to seek the approval of the Independent Shareholders at the EGM for the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate. The Company had an aggregate of 952,720,000 Shares in issue as at the Latest Practicable Date. Subject to the passing of the ordinary resolutions for the approval of the Refreshed Issue Mandate and assuming that no Shares are issued and/or repurchased by the Company between the Latest Practicable Date and the date of the EGM, the Company would be allowed under the Refreshed Issue Mandate to allot and issue up to 190,544,000 Shares. Reasons for the Refreshed Issue Mandate With reference to the announcement of the Company dated 20 July 2007, the Company has entered into a Share Transfer Agreement in relation to the acquisition of the Target Company which engaged in the exploration and mining of natural resources. As disclosed in the Company’s annual report for the year ended 31 December 2006, the Group continued to focus on the carpet manufacturing and trading business and to take productive steps to improve profitability and market share. On the other hand, the Group has been looking into the opportunity of other business and exploring more investment to offer sustainable growth to its business. Thus, the Directors consider the Acquisition will enable the Group to diversify into the mining business. In view of the newly acquired business opportunity, the Refreshed Issue Mandate would offer the Group greater flexibility to enhance its business development as well as being able to capture investment opportunities which may arise at any time and require prompt investment decision by the Group. Given that the Existing General Mandate which was approved in the AGM has been largely utilized, the Directors consider that the Refreshed Issue Mandate could give the Company the flexibility and ability to capture any capital raising or investment or business opportunity as and when it arises. Such ability is crucial in a competitive and rapidly changing capital market and investment environment. In light of the above, we are of the opinion that the Refreshed Issue Mandate would provide the Company with the necessary flexibility essential for fulfilling any possible funding needs for future business development and/or investment decisions in a timely manner. As such, we are of the view that the granting of the Refreshed Issue Mandate will be in the interest of the Company and the Independent Shareholders as a whole. Fund Raising Activities As stated in the letter from the Board in this circular, in the past 12 months from the Latest Practicable Date, the Company has raised an aggregate of approximately HK$183.5 million by placing of new Shares under the general mandates granted on 8 June 2006, 14 May 2007 and at the AGM respectively, details of which are set out in the announcements of the Company dated 5 March 2007, 11 June 2007 and 20 July 2007 respectively. In view of the net proceeds of the placing of new Shares have been and will be utilized on their intended use as announced, we consider that it is reasonable for the Directors to propose the granting of the Refreshed Issue Mandate in the EGM in order to give the Company greater flexibility to finance its newly acquired mining business development and other investments as and when such opportunities arise. – 44 – LETTER FROM VEDA CAPITAL Other financing alternative As debt financing may incur interest burden to the Group, equity financing such as issuance of new Shares for cash or equity swaps may be an appropriate mean to fund such investments and/or acquisitions and provide additional working capital for the future development and expansion of the Group, given the Group’s financial position, capital structure, cost of funding and the then financial market condition. Other financing methods such as debt financing or internal cash resources to fund future business development of the Company shall be taken into consideration in appropriate circumstances. We consider that the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate will provide the Company with an additional alternative and it is reasonable for the Company to have the flexibility in deciding the financing methods for its future development, including equity issuance. As such, we are of the view that the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate will be in the interests of the Company and the Independent Shareholders as a whole. Potential dilution to shareholdings of the Independent Shareholders Set out below is a table showing the shareholdings of the Company as at the Latest Practicable Date and; for illustrative purpose, the potential dilution effect on the shareholdings upon full utilization of the Refreshed Issue Mandate, assuming no Shares are issued or repurchased during the period between the Latest Practicable Date and the date of the EGM: As at the Latest Practicable Date No. of Shares % Upon full utilization of the Refreshed Issue Mandate No. of Shares % L & L Holdings Limited (Note 1) Mr. Law Fei Shing (Note 2) Dr. Ma Chung Wo, Cameron (Note 3) Independent Shareholders Shares to be issued under the Refreshed Issue Mandate 120,000,000 3,000,000 500,000 829,220,000 12.60 0.31 0.05 87.04 120,000,000 3,000,000 500,000 829,220,000 10.50 0.26 0.04 72.53 — — 190,544,000 16.67 Total: 952,720,000 100.00 1,143,264,000 100.00 Notes: 1. L & L Holdings Limited is an investment holding company incorporated in the Republic of the Marshall Islands, the entire issued share capital of which is wholly and beneficially owned by Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, the chief executive officer of the Company and executive Director. 2. Mr. Law Fei Shing is an executive Director. 3. Dr. Ma Chung Wo, Cameron is a non-executive Director. – 45 – LETTER FROM VEDA CAPITAL As illustrated in the table above, the existing aggregate shareholding of the Independent Shareholders will decrease from approximately 87.04% as at the Latest Practicable Date to approximately 72.53% upon full utilisation of the Refreshed Issue Mandate. Taking into account the benefits of the Refreshed Issue Mandate as discussed above and the fact that the shareholdings of all Shareholders will be diluted proportionately, we consider such dilution or potential dilution of shareholding to be acceptable. RECOMMENDATION Having considered the factors and reasons as stated above, we are of the view that the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate is in the interests of the Company and Independent Shareholders as a whole, and is fair and reasonable. Accordingly, we recommend the Independent Shareholders and advise the Independent Board Committee to recommend the Independent Shareholders to vote in favour of the ordinary resolutions in relation to the grant of the Refreshed Issue Mandate to be proposed at the EGM. Independent Shareholders are however advised to take note of the possible dilution effect on their shareholding interests in the Company when and if the Refreshed Issue Mandate is utilised. Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of Veda Capital Limited Hans Wong Julisa Fong Managing Director Executive Director – 46 – APPENDIX I 1. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP SUMMARY OF FINANCIAL INFORMATION A summary of the published results and the assets and liabilities of the Group for the last three financial years, as extracted from the audited financial statements, is set out below. RESULTS Year ended 31 December 2006 2005 2004 HK’000 HK’000 HK’000 Revenue Cost of sales 26,523 (29,240) 40,982 (34,715) 19,560 (23,100) Gross profit/(loss) Other operating income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses (2,717) 7,476 (1,865) (38,299) (10,603) 6,267 765 (3,190) (24,466) (68,820) (3,540) 177 (800) (21,156) (49,184) Operating loss Finance costs (46,008) (149) (89,444) (1,686) (74,503) (3,290) Loss before income tax Taxation Credit (46,157) — (91,130) — (77,793) 84 Loss for the year (46,157) (91,130) (77,709) Attributable to: Equity holders of the Company Minority interest (46,167) 10 (91,136) 6 (77,486) (223) (46,157) (91,130) (77,709) ASSETS AND LIABILITIES 2006 HK$’000 As at 31 December 2005 HK$’000 2004 HK$’000 100,517 37,716 110,602 24,710 175,495 95,426 Net Assets Add: minority interests 62,801 217 85,892 227 80,069 233 Shareholder’s funds 63,018 86,119 80,302 Total Assets Total Liabilities – 47 – APPENDIX I 2. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP REPORT OF THE AUDITORS FOR THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF THE GROUP FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2006 The following are the financial statements of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2006 as extracted from the annual report of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2006 (“2006 Annual Report”). The page references in this report are the same as those in the 2006 Annual Report. INDEPENDENT AUDITORS’ REPORT To the members of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) We have audited the consolidated financial statements of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (the “Company”) set out on pages 31 to 86, which comprise the consolidated and Company balance sheets as at 31 December 2006, and the consolidated income statement, the consolidated statement of changes in equity and the consolidated cash flow statement for the year then ended, and a summary of significant accounting policies and other explanatory notes. Directors’ responsibility for the financial statements The directors of the Company are responsible for the preparation and the true and fair presentation of these financial statements in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants and the disclosure requirements of the Hong Kong Companies Ordinance. This responsibility includes designing, implementing and maintaining internal control relevant to the preparation and the true and fair presentation of financial statements that are free from material misstatement, whether due to fraud or error; selecting and applying appropriate accounting policies; and making accounting estimates that are reasonable in the circumstances. Auditors’ responsibility Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audit and to report our opinion solely to you, as a body, and for no other purpose. We do not assume responsibility towards or accept liability to any other person for the contents of this report. We conducted our audit in accordance with Hong Kong Standards on Auditing issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants. Those standards require that we comply with ethical requirements and plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance as to whether the financial statements are free from material misstatement. – 48 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP An audit involves performing procedures to obtain audit evidence about the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. The procedures selected depend on the auditors’ judgement, including the assessment of the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to fraud or error. In making those risk assessments, the auditors consider internal control relevant to the entity’s preparation and true and fair presentation of the financial statements in order to design audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the entity’s internal control. An audit also includes evaluating the appropriateness of accounting policies used and the reasonableness of accounting estimates made by the directors, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that the audit evidence we have obtained is sufficient and appropriate to provide a basis for our audit opinion. Opinion In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Company and of the Group as at 31 December 2006 and of the Group’s loss and cash flows for the year then ended in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards and have been properly prepared in accordance with the disclosure requirements of the Hong Kong Companies Ordinance. Grant Thornton Certified Public Accountants 13th Floor, Gloucester Tower The Landmark 15 Queen’s Road Central Hong Kong 27 April 2007 – 49 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT For the year ended 31 December 2006 Notes Revenue Cost of sales 5 Gross (loss)/profit Other revenue and income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses 5 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 26,523 (29,240) 40,982 (34,715) (2,717) 7,476 (1,865) (38,299) (10,603) 6,267 765 (3,190) (24,466) (68,820) (89,444) (1,686) Operating loss Finance costs 7 (46,008) (149) Loss before income tax Income tax expense 8 9 (46,157) — (91,130) — (46,157) (91,130) (46,167) 10 (91,136) 6 (46,157) (91,130) — Basic (8.7) (30.0) — Diluted N/A N/A Loss for the year Attributable to: Equity holders of the Company Minority interests 11 Loss for the year Loss per share (HK cents) 12 – 50 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET As at 31 December 2006 Notes 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 15(a) 16 34 18 73,952 4,912 3,750 — 74,497 4,831 4,075 — 82,614 83,403 4,033 4,504 8,590 — 776 5,683 5,712 6,704 2,031 7,069 17,903 27,199 9,723 25,611 1,143 76 5 9,032 10,547 — 76 2,395 36,558 22,050 (18,655) 5,149 63,959 88,552 234 924 304 2,356 1,158 2,660 62,801 85,892 ASSETS AND LIABILITIES Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Prepaid lease payments Deposits Goodwill Current assets Inventories Trade and bills receivables Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Pledged time deposits Cash at banks and in hand Current liabilities Trade payables Deposits received, other payables and accruals Amounts due to directors Finance lease payable Bank borrowings 19 20 26 21(a) 22 23 24 25 26 Net current (liabilities)/assets Total assets less current liabilities Non-current liabilities Finance lease payable Amounts due to minority shareholders 25 27 Net assets – 51 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET (Continued) As at 31 December 2006 Notes 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 28 29(a) 5,519 57,499 5,252 80,867 Minority interests 63,018 (217) 86,119 (227) Total equity 62,801 85,892 EQUITY Equity attributable to equity holders of the Company Share capital Reserves – 52 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP BALANCE SHEET As at 31 December 2006 Notes 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 15(b) 17 34 261 61,186 3,750 339 76,432 1,000 65,197 77,771 48 9 36 6,313 57 6,349 2,167 100 1,288 — 2,267 1,288 Net current (liabilities)/assets (2,210) 5,061 Net assets 62,987 82,832 5,519 57,468 5,252 77,580 62,987 82,832 ASSETS AND LIABILITIES Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Interests in subsidiaries Deposits Current assets Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents Current liabilities Other payables and accruals Amount due to a director 21(b) 23 24 EQUITY Share capital Reserves 28 29(b) Total equity – 53 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY For the year ended 31 December 2006 Equity attributable to equity holders of the Company At 1 January 2005 Disposal of subsidiaries Currency translation Net income/(expense) recognised directly in equity Net loss for the year Total recognised income and expense for the year Issue of convertible note (note 28(d)) Conversion of convertible note (note 28(d)) Issue of shares Capital reorganisation (note 28(b)) At 31 December 2005 and 1 January 2006 Currency translation Disposal of property, plant and equipment Net income/(expense) recognised directly in equity Net loss for the year Total recognised income and expense for the year Share options granted (note 30) Share options cancelled (note 30) Exercise of share options and issue of shares (note 28(f)) At 31 December 2006 Statutory Assets Capital reserve revaluation Exchange reserves fund reserve reserve HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 Share capital HK$’000 Share premium HK$’000 134,000 — — — — — — — — 35 (35 ) — 9,735 — — — — — — — — (35 ) — — — — — — 2,750 6,112 Convertible note equity reserve HK$’000 Share option Accumulated reserve losses Total HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 Minority interests HK$’000 Total equity HK$’000 (2,045 ) 4 2,141 — — — — — — (61,423 ) — — 80,302 (31 ) 2,141 (233 ) — — 80,069 (31 ) 2,141 — — 2,145 — — — — — — (91,136 ) 2,110 (91,136 ) — 6 2,110 (91,130 ) (35 ) — 2,145 — — (91,136 ) (89,026 ) 6 (89,020 ) — — — — 4,708 — — 4,708 — 4,708 30,250 55,731 — — — — — — — — (4,708 ) — — — — — 28,292 61,843 — — 28,292 61,843 — 137,610 — — — — — — — — — 5,252 — 85,981 — 137,610 — — — 9,735 — 100 2,833 — — — — — — — — (9 ) — — — — — — — — — — — (9 ) — 2,833 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — (9 ) — — 2,833 — — — — — — 11,190 (413 ) 267 14,065 — — — — — (4,867 ) 5,519 100,046 137,610 — 9,726 2,933 — 5,910 (137,610 ) – 54 – (152,559 ) — — 86,119 2,833 (227 ) — 85,892 2,833 (9 ) — (9 ) — (46,167 ) 2,824 (46,167 ) — 10 2,824 (46,157 ) (46,167 ) — — (43,343 ) 11,190 (413 ) 10 — — (43,333 ) 11,190 (413 ) 9,465 — 9,465 63,018 (217 ) 62,801 — (198,726 ) APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT For the year ended 31 December 2006 Notes Cash flows from operating activities Loss before income tax Adjustments for : Depreciation Amortisation of prepaid lease payments Bad debts written off Impairment of goodwill Provision for impairment of trade receivable Provision for salary provision written back Write back of other payable Gain on disposal of subsidiaries Gain on deemed disposal of a subsidiary Loss on disposals of property, plant and equipment Interest income Interest expenses Share-based compensation 30(a) & (b) 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 (46,157) (91,130) 7,447 112 65 — 314 — — — — 6,380 107 48,022 35,750 — (62) (2,230) (10,634) (2,067) 2 (85) 149 10,777 22 (87) 1,686 — Operating loss before working capital changes Decrease/(Increase) in inventories Decrease/(Increase) in trade and bills receivables Increase in prepayments, deposits and other receivables Increase/(Decrease) in trade payables Increase/(Decrease) in deposits received, other payables and accruals Increase in amounts due to directors (27,376) 1,680 (14,243) (4,136) 843 (2,058) (1,870) 516 (8,128) (562) 14,911 1,143 (1,767) — Cash used in operations Interest paid Hong Kong profits tax paid (10,153) (149) — (30,894) (1,686) (74) Net cash used in operating activities (10,302) (32,654) – 55 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT (Continued) For the year ended 31 December 2006 Notes Cash flow from investing activities Deposits paid Purchases of property, plant and equipment Proceeds from disposals of property, plant and equipment Disposal of subsidiaries (net of cash and cash equivalents) Deemed disposal of subsidiaries (net of cash and cash equivalents) Interest received 34 15(a) Net cash used in investing activities 2006 HK$’000 (2,750) (943) 153 — (44) — 85 (4) 87 — — — — 28(f) Net cash generated from financing activities Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January Effect on foreign exchange rate changes Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December – 56 – 21(a) (4,075) (1,003) 5 (3,603) Cash flow from financing activities Addition of new other loans Addition of new finance lease Proceeds from issue of convertible note Proceeds from issuance of share capital Proceeds from issue of shares upon exercise of share options (Decrease)/Increase in trust receipt loans Repayment of bank loans Repayment of other loans Capital element of finance lease payments Decrease/(Increase) in pledged time deposits (Decrease)/Increase in amount due to minority shareholders 2005 HK$’000 (4,886) 18,010 380 33,000 46,843 9,465 (2,257) — — (70) 2,031 — 101 (3,900) (48,097) (139) (1,031) (1,432) 1,923 7,737 47,090 (6,168) 9,550 6,931 8 (2,653) 34 771 6,931 APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS For the year ended 31 December 2006 1. GENERAL INFORMATION The Company was incorporated in the Cayman Islands as an exempted company with limited liability under the Companies Law (Revised) of the Cayman Islands. The address of its registered office is Century Yard, Cricket Squares, Hutchins Drive, P.O. Box 2681, Grand Cayman KY1-1111, Cayman Islands, Bristish West Indies and its principal place of business is Suites 5303-4, 53rd floor, Central Plaza, 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong. The Company’s shares are listed on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the “Stock Exchange”). Pursuant to a special resolution passed on 10 March 2006 at an extraordinary general meeting, the Company’s name was changed from Orient Industries Holdings Limited to Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited. The principal activity of the Company is investment holding. Details of principal activities of its principal subsidiaries (together with the Company referred to as the “Group”) are set out in note 17(a) to the financial statements. The financial statements on pages 31 to 86 have been prepared in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards (“HKFRSs”) which collective term includes all applicable individual Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards, Hong Kong Accounting Standards and Interpretations issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (“HKICPA”). The financial statements also include the applicable disclosure requirements of the Hong Kong Companies Ordinance and the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on the Stock Exchange. The financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2006 were approved for issue by the board of directors on 27 April 2007. 2. ADOPTION OF NEW OR AMENDED HKFRSS (a) New or amended HKFRSs effective on 1 January 2006 From 1 January 2006, the Group has adopted the new or amended HKFRSs which are first effective on 1 January 2006 and relevant to the Group. The adoption of these new and amended HKFRSs did not result in any significant changes in the Group’s and the Company’s accounting policies. – 57 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) New or amended HKFRSs that have been issued but are not yet effective The Group has not early adopted the following HKFRSs that have been issued but are not yet effective. The directors of the Company anticipate that the adoption of such HKFRSs will not result in material financial impact on the Group’s financial statements. Amendment to HKAS 1 HKFRS 7 HKFRS 8 HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 7 HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 8 HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 9 HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 10 HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 11 HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 3. “Presentation of Financial Statements” - Capital Disclosures 1 “Financial Instruments: Disclosures” 1 “Operating Segments” 8 “Applying the Restatement Approach under HKAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies” 2 “Scope of HKFRS 2” 3 “Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives” 4 “Interim Financial Reporting and Impairment” 5 “Group and Treasury Share Transactions” 6 “Service Concession Arrangements” 7 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 March 2006 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 May 2006 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 June 2006 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 November 2006 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 March 2007 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2008 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2009 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (a) Basis of preparation The significant accounting policies that have been used in the preparation of these financial statements are summarised below. These policies have been consistently applied to all the years presented unless otherwise stated. The financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost convention except for the revaluation of property, plant and equipment which are stated at fair values. The measurement bases are fully described in the accounting policies below. The financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis notwithstanding that the Group had net current liabilities of approximately HK$18,655,000 at 31 December 2006 and had made operating losses in each of the last 3 years. In order to turn around the Group’s loss-making situation, improve its financial position and ensure it has sufficient funds to meet its current commitments, the directors intend to take and/or have carried out the following : i) the directors will take action to tighten cost controls over the staff costs, overheads and various general and administrative expenses; – 58 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) ii) on 5 March 2007, the Company entered into a placement agreement (“the Placement Agreement”) with Enlighten Securities Limited (the “Placing Agent”) pursuant to which an aggregate of 87,000,000 new ordinary shares (the “Placing Share”) of HK$0.01 each were to be placed by the Placing Agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis, at the price of HK$0.308 per Placing Share with six independent investors. The gross proceeds from the placement of approximately HK$26,796,000 have been received on 16 March 2007; iii) subsequent to 31 December 2006, the exercise of 19,820,000 share options of the Company resulted in an increase in cash of approximately HK$7,547,000. Details are set out in note 30 to the financial statements; and iv) on 16 April 2007, the Group entered into a loan agreement with a registered money lender in Hong Kong for a loan of approximately HK$30,000,000 for the investment in a PRC company as set out in note 37(c). The loan will be repayable at the end of twelve months from the date of drawdown. In the opinion of the directors, in light of the measures taken to-date, the Group will have sufficient working capital to meet its current and future requirements. Accordingly, the directors are satisfied that the Group will be able to continue as a going concern and that it is appropriate to prepare the financial statements on a going concern basis, notwithstanding the Group’s tight financial and cash position as at 31 December 2006. Should the Group be unable to continue in business as a going concern, adjustments would have to be made to reduce the value of assets to their recoverable amounts, to provide for any further liabilities which might arise, and to reclassify non-current assets and liabilities as current assets and liabilities. It should be noted that accounting estimates and assumptions are used in preparation of the financial statements. Although these estimates are based on management’s best knowledge and judgement of current events and actions, actual results may ultimately differ from those estimates. The areas involving a higher degree of judgement or complexity, or areas where assumptions and estimates are significant to the financial statements, are disclosed in note 4. (b) Basis of consolidation The consolidated financial statements incorporate the financial statements of the Group made up to 31 December each year. (c) Subsidiaries Subsidiaries are entities (including special purpose entities) over which the Group has the power to control the financial and operating policies so as to obtain benefits from their activities. The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are considered when assessing whether the Group controls another entity. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Group. They are excluded from consolidation from the date that control ceases. – 59 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Inter-group transactions, balances and unrealised gains on transactions between group companies are eliminated in preparing the consolidated financial statements. Unrealised losses are also eliminated unless the transaction provides evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. In the Company’s balance sheet, subsidiaries are carried at cost less impairment loss. The results of the subsidiaries are accounted for by the Company on the basis of dividends received and receivable at the balance sheet date. Minority interest represents the portion of the profit or loss and net assets of a subsidiary attributable to equity interests that are not owned by the Group and are not the Group’s financial liabilities. Minority interests are presented in the consolidated balance sheet within equity, separately from the equity attributable to the equity holders of the Company. Profit or loss attributable to the minority interests are presented separately in the consolidated income statement as an allocation of the Group’s results. Where losses applicable to the minority exceeds the minority interests in the subsidiary’s equity, the excess and further losses applicable to the minority are allocated against the minority interest to the extent that the minority has a binding obligation and is able to make an additional investment to cover the losses. Otherwise, the losses are charged against the Group’s interests. If the subsidiary subsequently reports profits, such profits are allocated to the minority interest only after the minority’s share of losses previously absorbed by the Group has been recovered. (d) Foreign currency translation The financial statements are presented in Hong Kong Dollars (HK$), which is also the functional currency of the Company. In the individual financial statements of the consolidated entities, foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency of the individual entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. At balance sheet date, monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the foreign exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet date. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the balance sheet date retranslation of monetary assets and liabilities are recognised in the consolidated income statement. Non-monetary items carried at fair value that are denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated at the rates prevailing on the date when the fair value was determined and are reported as part of the fair value gain or loss. Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are not retranslated. In the consolidated financial statements, all individual financial statements of foreign operations, originally presented in a currency different from the Group’s presentation currency, have been converted into Hong Kong dollars. Assets and liabilities have been translated into Hong Kong dollars at the closing rates at the balance sheet date. Income and expenses have been converted into the Group’s presentation currency at the average rates over the reporting period. Any differences arising from this procedure have been dealt with separately in the exchange reserve in equity. – 60 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Other exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign entities and of borrowings are taken to shareholders’ equity. When a foreign operation is sold, such exchange differences are recognised in the consolidated income statement as part of the gain or loss on sale. (e) Revenue recognition Revenue is recognised when it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Group and when the revenue can be measured reliably, on the following bases: (i) sale of goods are recognised upon transfer of the significant risks and rewards of ownership to the buyers, provided that the Group maintains neither managerial involvement to the degree usually associated with ownership, nor effective control over the goods sold; (ii) interest income is recognised on a time proportion basis using the effective interest rate method; and (iii) rental and sub-leasing rental income are recognised on a time proportion basis in accordance with the terms and conditions of the tenancy agreement. (f) Borrowing costs All borrowing costs are expensed as incurred. (g) Goodwill Goodwill arising on acquisition of subsidiaries for which the acquisition date represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the Group’s interest in the fair value of identifiable assets and liabilities of the acquired subsidiary at the date of acquisition. The Group has discontinued amortisation from 1 January 2005 onwards and goodwill is tested annually for impairment and carried at cost less accumulated impairment losses. Gains and losses on the disposal of subsidiaries include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to the subsidiaries sold. (h) Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are recognised at revalued amount, based on their fair value at the date of valuation less any subsequent accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. Fair value is determined based on directors’ estimates and in appraisals by external professional valuers at least once every three years, unless market-based factors indicate a risk of impairment. Any accumulated depreciation at the date of revaluation is restated proportionately with the change in the gross carrying amount of the asset so that the carrying amount of the asset revaluation equals it revalued amount. – 61 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Any revaluation surplus arising on revaluation of property, plant and equipment is credited to the “assets revaluation reserve” in equity, unless the carrying amount of that asset has previously suffered a revaluation decrease or impairment loss as described in note 3(i). To the extent that any decrease has previously been recognised in consolidated income statement, a revaluation increase is credited to consolidated income statement with the remaining part of the increase dealt with in the asset revaluation reserve. A decrease in net carrying amount of property, plant and equipment arising from revaluations or impairment testing is charged against any revaluation surplus in the asset revaluation reserve relating to the asset and any remaining decrease recognised in consolidated income statement. Depreciation is calculated using the straight-line method to allocate the revalued amounts of the property, plant and equipment to their residual values over their estimated useful lives, as follows : Buildings The shorter of the lease terms and/or 50 years Plant and machinery 15 years Leasehold improvements, furniture, office equipment and motor vehicles 4 to 10 years The assets’ useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. The gain or loss arising on retirement or disposal is determined as the difference between the sales proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset and is recognised in consolidated income statement. Any revaluation surplus remaining in equity is transferred to retained earnings on the disposal of revalued assets. Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognised as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. All other costs, such as repairs and maintenance are charged to the consolidated income statement during the financial period in which they are incurred. (i) Impairment testing of assets Goodwill, property, plant and equipment, prepaid lease payments, and interests in subsidiaries are subject to impairment testing. Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually, irrespective of whether there is any indication that they are impaired. All other assets are tested for impairment whenever there are indications that the asset’s carrying amount may not be recoverable. – 62 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) An impairment loss is recognised as an expense immediately for the amount by which the asset’s carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount unless the relevant asset is carried at a revalued amount under the Group’s accounting policy, in which case the impairment loss is treated as a revaluation decrease according to that policy (refer to Note 3(h) for details). The recoverable amount is the higher of fair value, reflecting market conditions less costs to sell, and value in use. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessment of time value of money and the risk specific to the asset. For the purposes of assessing impairment, where an asset does not generate cash inflows largely independent from those from other assets, the recoverable amount is determined from the smallest group of assets that generate cash inflows independently (i.e. a cash-generating unit). As a result, some assets are tested individually for impairment and some are tested at cash-generating unit level. Goodwill in particular is allocated to those cash-generating units that are expected to benefit from synergies of the related business combination and represent the lowest level within the Group at which the goodwill is monitored for internal management purpose. An impairment loss recognised for cash-generating units, to which goodwill has been allocated, are credited initially to the carrying amount of goodwill. Any remaining impairment loss is charged pro rata to the other assets in the cash generating unit, except that the carrying value of an asset will not be reduced below its individual fair value less cost to sell, or value in use, if determinable. An impairment loss on goodwill is not reversed in subsequent periods. In respect of other assets, an impairment loss is reversed if there has been a favourable change in the estimates used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount and only to the extent that the asset’s carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation or amortisation, if no impairment loss had been recognised. (j) Leases An arrangement, comprising a transaction or a series of transactions, is or contains a lease if the Group determines that the arrangement conveys a right to use a specific asset or assets for an agreed period of time in return for a payment or a series of payments. Such a determination is made based on an evaluation of the substance of the arrangement and is regardless of whether the arrangement takes the legal form of a lease. (a) Assets acquired under a finance lease Where the Group acquires the use of assets under finance leases, the amounts representing the fair value of the leased asset, or, if lower, the present value of the minimum lease payments, of such assets is included in property, plant and equipment and the corresponding liabilities, net of finance charges, are recorded as obligation under finance leases. Subsequent accounting for assets held under finance lease agreement corresponds to those applied to comparable acquired assets. The corresponding finance lease liability is reduced by lease payments less finance charges, which are expensed to finance costs. – 63 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Finance charges implicit in the lease payments are charged to profit or loss over the period of the leases so as to produce an approximately constant periodic rate of charge on the remaining balance of the obligations for each accounting period. Contingent rentals are charged to profit or loss in the accounting period in which they are incurred. (b) Operating leases charges as the lessee (i) Where the Group has the use of assets held under operating leases, payments made under the leases are charged to the consolidated income statement on a straight line basis over the lease terms except where an alternative basis is more representative of the pattern of benefits to be derived from the leased assets. Lease incentives received are recognised in the consolidated income statement as an integral part of the aggregate net lease payments made. Contingent rentals are charged to the consolidated income statement in the accounting period in which they are incurred. (ii) Prepaid lease payments are up-front payments to acquire the land use rights/leasehold land. The payments are stated at cost less accumulated amortisation and accumulated impairment losses. Amortisation is calculated on a straight line basis over the lease term. (c) Assets leased out under operating leases as the lessor Assets leased out under operating leases are measured and presented according to the nature of the assets. Initial direct costs incurred in negotiating and arranging an operating lease are added to the carrying amount of the leased asset and recognised as an expense over the lease term on the same basis as the rental income. Rental income receivable from operating leases is recognised in profit or loss on a straightline basis over the periods covered by the lease term, except where an alternative basis is more representative of the pattern of benefits to be derived from the use of the leased asset. Lease incentives granted are recognised in profit or loss as an integral part of the aggregate net lease payments receivable. Contingent rentals are recognised as income in the accounting period in which they are earned. (k) Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined using the first-in, first-out method, and in the case of work in progress and finished goods, comprises direct materials, direct labour and an appropriate proportion of overheads based on a normal level of operating activities. Net realisable value is based on the estimated selling prices in the ordinary course of business less any applicable selling expenses. – 64 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (l) Financial assets All financial assets are recognised when, and only when, the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. When financial assets are recognised initially, they are measured at fair value, plus, in the case of investments not at fair value through profit or loss, directly attributable transaction costs. Derecognition of financial assets occurs when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments expire or are transferred and substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership have been transferred. At each balance sheet date, financial assets are reviewed to assess whether there is objective evidence of impairment. If any such evidence exists, impairment loss is determined and recognised based on the classification of the financial asset. Account and other receivables, and cash and cash equivalents are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They are recognised initially at fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method, less any provision for impairment losses. Amortised cost is calculated taking into account any discount or premium on acquisition and includes fees that are an integral part of the effective interest rate and transaction cost. A provision for impairment of receivables is established when there is objective evidence that the Group will not be able to collect all amounts due according to the original terms of the receivables. The amount of the write-down is determined as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of expected cash flows, discounted at the original effective rate of interest. The amount of loss is recognised in profit or loss of the period in which the impairment occurs. If, in subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss decreases and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed to the extent that it does not result in the carrying amount of the financial asset exceeding what the amortised cost would have been had the impairment not been recognised at the date the impairment is reversed. The amount of the reversal is recognised in profit or loss of the period in which the reversal occurs. (m) Accounting for income taxes Income tax comprises current tax and deferred tax Current income tax assets and/or liabilities comprise those obligations to, or claims from, tax authorities relating to the current or prior reporting period, that are unpaid at the balance sheet date. They are calculated according to the tax rates and tax laws applicable to the periods to which they relate, based on the taxable profit for the year. All changes to current tax assets or liabilities are recognised as a component of tax expense in the consolidated income statement. – 65 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Deferred tax is calculated using the liability method on temporary differences at the balance sheet date between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the financial statements and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences. Deferred tax assets are recognised for all deductible temporary differences, tax losses available to be carried forward as well as other unused tax credits, to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences, unused tax losses and unused tax credits can be utilised. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary difference arises from goodwill or from initial recognition (other than in a business combination) of assets and liabilities in a transaction that affects neither taxable nor accounting profit or loss. Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries, except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary differences and it is probable that the temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future. Deferred tax is calculated, without discounting, at tax rates that are expected to apply in the period the liability is settled or the asset realised, provided they are enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date. Changes in deferred tax assets or liabilities are recognised in the consolidated income statement, or in equity if they relate to items that are charged or credited directly to equity. (n) Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents include cash at bank and in hand less bank overdrafts which are repayable on demand and form an integral part of the Group’s cash management. (o) Share capital Ordinary shares are classified as equity. Share capital is determined using the nominal value of shares that have been issued. Any transaction costs associated with the issuing of shares are deducted from the share premium (net of any related income tax benefit) to the extent they are incremental costs directly attributable to the equity transaction. (p) Financial liabilities The Group’s financial liabilities include trade and other payables, and accruals, amounts due to directors and minority shareholders, bank borrowings and finance lease payable. They are included in balance sheet line items as “amounts due to minority shareholders” under non-current liabilities or “trade payables”, “other payables and accruals”, “amounts due to directors” and “bank borrowings” under current liabilities or “finance lease payable” under current or non-current liabilities. – 66 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Financial liabilities are recognised when the Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. All interest related charges are recognised as an expense in finance costs in the consolidated income statement. A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires. Where an existing financial liability is replaced by another from the same lender on substantially different terms, or the terms of an existing liability are substantially modified, such an exchange or modification is treated as a derecognition of the original liability and the recognition of a new liability, and the difference in the respective carrying amount is recognised in the consolidated income statement. (a) Borrowings Borrowings are recognised initially at fair value, net of transaction costs incurred. Borrowings are subsequently stated at amortised cost; any difference between the proceeds (net of transaction costs) and the redemption value is recognised in the consolidated income statement over the period of the borrowings using the effective interest rate method. Borrowings are classified as current liabilities unless the Group has an unconditional right to defer settlement of the liability for at least 12 months after the balance sheet date. (b) Trade and other payables and accruals Trade and other payables and accruals are recognised initially at their fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the effective interest rate method. (c) Convertible note Convertible note issued by the Company that contain both financial liability and equity components are classified separately into respective liability and equity components on initial recognition. On initial recognition, the fair value of the liability component is determined using the prevailing market interest rate for similar non-convertible debts. The difference between the proceeds of the issue of the convertible note and the fair value assigned to the liability component, representing the call option for conversion of the note into equity, is included in equity as convertible bond equity reserve. The liability component is subsequently carried at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. The equity component will remain in equity until conversion or redemption of the note. When the note is converted, the convertible note equity reserve and the carrying value of the liability component at the time of conversion, is transferred to share capital and share premium as consideration for the shares issued. If the bond is redeemed, the convertible note equity reserve is released directly to retained profits. – 67 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (d) Finance lease liabilities Finance lease liabilities are measured at initial value less the capital element of lease repayments (see Note 3(j)). (q) Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Provisions are recognised when the Group has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event, and it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made. Where the time value of money is material, provisions are stated at the present value of the expenditure expected to settle the obligation. All provisions are reviewed at each balance sheet date and adjusted to reflect the current best estimate. Where it is not probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required, or the amount cannot be estimated reliably, the obligation is disclosed as a contingent liability, unless the probability of outflow of economic benefits is remote. Possible obligations, whose existence will only be confirmed by the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more future events are also disclosed as contingent liabilities unless the probability of outflow of economic benefits is remote. Contingent liabilities are recognised in the course of the allocation of purchase price to the assets and liabilities acquired in a business combination. They are initially measured at fair value at the date of acquisition and subsequently measured at the higher of the amount that would be recognised in a comparable provision as described above and the amount initially recognised less any accumulated amortisation, if appropriate. (r) Retirement benefits costs and short term employee benefits Retirement benefits to employees are provided through a defined contribution plans (a) Defined contribution plans The Group operates a defined contribution Mandatory Provident Fund retirement benefits scheme (the “MPF Scheme”) under the Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance, for all of its employees in Hong Kong. Contributions are made based on a percentage of the employees’ basic salaries and are charged to the consolidated income statement as they become payable in accordance with the rules of the MPF Scheme. The assets of the MPF Scheme are held separately from those of the Group in an independently administered fund. The Group’s employer contributions vest fully with the employees when contributed into the MPF Scheme. – 68 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The employees of the Group’s subsidiaries which operate in the People’s Republic of China, excluding Hong Kong and Macau, (the “PRC”) are required to participate in the retirement benefits scheme (the “RB Scheme”) operated by the respective local municipal government in the PRC. These subsidiaries are required to contribute a certain percentage of their payroll costs to the RB Scheme to fund the benefits. The only obligation of the Group with respect to the RB Scheme is to pay the ongoing required contributions under the RB Scheme. Contributions under the RB Scheme are charged to the consolidated income statement as they become payable in accordance with the rules of the RB Scheme. (b) Short-term employee benefits Employee entitlements to annual leave are recognised when they are accrued to employees. A provision is made for the estimated liability for annual leave as a result of services rendered by employees up to the balance sheet date. Employee entitlements to sick leave and maternity leave are not recognised until the time of leave. (s) Share-based compensation (i) The Group operates equity-settled share-based compensation plans for remuneration of its employees. All employee services received in exchange for the grant of any share-based compensation are measured at their fair values. These are indirectly determined by reference to the share options awarded. Their value is appraised at the grant date and excludes the impact of any non-market vesting conditions (for example, profitability and sales growth targets). (ii) For other goods or services received by the Group in exchange for the grant of any sharebased compensation, they are directly measured at the fair value of the goods or services received. All share-based compensation is ultimately recognised as an expense in consolidated income statement/recognised as an expense in full at the grant date when the share options granted vest immediately, with a corresponding increase in equity (share option reserve). If vesting periods or other vesting conditions apply, the expense is recognised over the vesting period, based on the best available estimate of the number of share options expected to vest. Non-market vesting conditions are included in assumptions about the number of options that are expected to become exercisable. Estimates are subsequently revised, if there is any indication that the number of share options expected to vest differs from previous estimates. No adjustment to expense recognised in prior periods is made if fewer share options ultimately are exercised than originally vested. At the time when the share options are exercised, the amount previously recognised in share option reserve will be transferred to share premium. When the share options are forfeited or are still not exercised at the expiry date, the amount previously recognised in share option reserve will be transferred to retained profits. – 69 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (t) Segment reporting In accordance with the Group’s internal financial reporting the Group has determined that business segments be presented as the primary reporting format and geographical segments as the secondary reporting format. Segment revenue, expenses, results, assets and liabilities include items directly attributable to a segment as well as those that can be allocated on a reasonable basis to that segment. Segment revenue, expenses, assets and liabilities are determined before intra-group balances and intra-group transactions are eliminated as part of the combination process, except to the extent that such intragroup balances and transactions are between group enterprises within a single segment. Inter-segment pricing is based on similar terms as those available to other external parties. Capital expenditure is the total cost incurred during the year to acquire segment assets that are expected to be used for more than one year. Unallocated item mainly comprise financial and corporate assets, interest-bearing loans, borrowings, corporate and financing expenses and minority interests. In respect of geographical segment reporting, revenue is based on the country in which the customer is located and total assets and capital expenditure are where the assets are located. (u) Related parties Parties are considered to be related to the Group if: (i) directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, the Group: — — — controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with, the entity; has an interest in the entity that gives it significant influence over the entity; has joint control over the entity; (ii) the party is an associate of the Group; (iii) the party is a joint venture in which the Group is a venturer; (iv) the party is a member of the key management personnel of the Group or its parent; (v) the party is a close member of the family or any individual referred to in (i) or (iv); (vi) the party is an entity that is controlled, jointly-controlled or significantly influenced by or for which significant voting power in such entity resides with, directly or indirectly, any individual referred to in (iv) or (v); or (vii) the party is a post-employment benefit plan for the benefit of employees of the Group, or of any entity that is a related party of the Group. – 70 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 4. CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS Estimates and judgements are continually evaluated and are based on historical experience and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. The Group makes estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates will, by definition, seldom equal the related actual results. The estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year are discussed below: (i) Depreciation The Group depreciates its property, plant and equipment on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives of 4 to 50 years. The estimated useful lives reflect the directors’ estimate of the period that the Group will derive future economic benefits from the use of the Group’s property, plant and equipment. (ii) Fair value of property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are stated at fair value based on director’s estimates and valuations performed by independent professional valuers. In determining the fair value, the directors and the valuers have used a method of valuation which involves certain estimates. The directors have exercised their judgement as to the estimates used, the appropriateness of method of valuation used and that the assumptions used therein are reflective of current market conditions. (iii) Impairment of receivables The Group’s management reviews receivables on a regular basis to determine if any provision for impairment is necessary. This estimate is based on the credit history of its customers, past settlement and industry practice and current market conditions. Management reassesses the impairment of receivables at the balance sheet date. (iv) Net realisable value of inventories Net realisable value of inventories is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less estimated costs of completion and selling expenses. These estimates are based on the current market condition and the historical experience of selling goods of similar nature. It could change significantly as a result of changes in market conditions. Management reassesses the estimations at the balance sheet date. – 71 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 5. REVENUE, OTHER REVENUE AND INCOME Revenue, which is also the Group’s turnover, represents total invoiced value of goods sold after allowances for returns and trade discounts. An analysis of the Group’s revenue, other revenue and income is as follows: 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 26,523 40,982 85 1,312 1,079 5,000 87 544 134 — 7,476 765 Revenue Sale of goods Other revenue and income Interest income Rental and sub-leasing rental income Sundry income Write back of deposit received (note (a)) Note: (a) On 30 May 2006, the Company and GP Capital Limited entered into a subscription agreement (“Subscription Agreement”) for the placing of the Company’s convertible notes in an aggregate principal amount of HK$40 million (“Convertible Notes”). On 9 June 2006, the Company and GP Capital Limited entered into an agreement to extend the date of closing of the placing of Convertible Notes from 10 June 2006 to not later than 30 June 2006. In consideration of the Company agreeing to extend the closing date, GP Capital Limited agreed to place a non-refundable amount of HK$10,000,000 with the Company which upon completion of the placing of the Convertible Notes would be used as part of the subscription monies for the Convertible Notes. However, the Group only received an initial deposit of HK$5,000,000 prior to the expiry of the extended closing date. On 30 June 2006, the Company was provided with two cheques by GP Capital Limited in the amount of HK$5,000,000 and HK$30,000,000 respectively (the “Cheques”) for the purpose of settling the remaining subscription monies pursuant to the Subscription Agreement. However, the Cheques were not honoured by the GP Capital Limited’s bank. In view of this, on 27 September 2006, the Company notified GP Capital Limited of the termination of the Subscription Agreement. A legal proceeding was brought by the Group and based on the court order issued on 12 February 2007, GP Capital Limited is required to honour the Cheques. In the opinion of the directors, after consulting with their legal advisor, the Subscription Agreement has expired and the deposit received of HK$5,000,000 is non-refundable and, accordingly, this amount has been credited as income to the consolidated income statement for the year. – 72 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 6. SEGMENT INFORMATION The Group’s operating businesses are structured and managed separately according to the nature of their operations and the products they provide. Each of the Group’s business segments represents a strategic business unit that offers products which are subject to risks and returns that are different from those of the other business segments. Summary of details of the business segments are as follows: (i) the manufacturing of carpets segment represents the manufacturing and sale of carpets; and (ii) the trading of carpets segment represents the trading of carpets of other renowned brand names. In determining the Group’s geographical segments, revenues are attributable to the segments based on the location of customers, and assets are attributable to the segments based on the location of the assets. There was no intersegment sale and transfer during the year (2005: Nil). (a) Primary reporting format - business segments Manufacturing of carpets 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 Segment revenue: Sales to external customers Segment results Unallocated other operating income Impairment of goodwill Gain on disposal of subsidiaries Gain on deemed disposal of a subsidiary Other unallocated expense Finance costs Trading of carpets Consolidated 2006 2005 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 8,825 8,179 17,698 32,803 26,523 40,982 (17,618) (54,994) (5,506) (9,960) (23,124) (64,954) 5,059 55 — (35,750) — — — (35,750) — 3,838 — 6,796 — 10,634 — — — 2,067 — 2,067 (27,943) (149) (1,496) (1,686) Loss before income tax Income tax (46,157) — (91,130) — Loss for the year (46,157) (91,130) – 73 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Manufacturing of carpets 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 Trading of carpets Consolidated 2006 2005 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 Segment assets Unallocated assets 79,535 — 83,740 — 7,098 — 10,123 — 86,633 13,884 93,863 16,739 Total assets 79,535 83,740 7,098 10,123 100,517 110,602 Segment liabilities Unallocated liabilities 18,445 8,211 14,987 12,247 33,432 20,458 — — — — 4,284 4,252 Total liabilities 18,445 8,211 14,987 12,247 37,716 24,710 112 107 — — 112 107 6,152 5,952 312 323 6,464 6,275 — — — — 983 105 6,152 5,952 312 323 7,447 6,380 56 242 17 36 73 278 — — — — 3,945 725 56 242 17 36 4,018 1,003 Bad debts written off — 47,950 65 72 65 48,022 Provision for impairment of trade receivables — — 314 — 314 — Impairment of goodwill — 35,750 — — — 35,750 Amortisation of prepaid lease payments Depreciation Unallocated depreciation Capital expenditure — addition of property, plant and equipment Unallocated capital expenditure Addition of property, plant and equipment Non cash expenses – 74 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) Secondary reporting format — geographic segments Hong Kong Macau PRC Overseas Consolidated 2006 2005 2006 2005 2006 2005 2006 2005 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 7. Segment revenue Sales to external customers 12,471 24,231 866 778 9,386 11,541 3,800 4,432 26,523 40,982 Segment assets 20,982 26,862 — — 79,535 83,740 — — 100,517 110,602 Capital expenditure Addition of property, plant and equipment 3,962 761 — — 56 242 — — 4,018 1,003 FINANCE COSTS 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 111 275 Interest charged on: Bank loans and overdrafts wholly repayable within five years Finance lease 23 6 Other loans 15 1,405 149 1,686 – 75 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 8. LOSS BEFORE INCOME TAX Loss before income tax is arrived at after charging and crediting the following: 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 19,878 25,824 7,371 6,374 76 6 7,447 6,380 Charging: Cost of inventories recognised as expense Depreciation (note (a)) — owned assets — leased fixed assets Amortisation of prepaid lease payments 112 107 3,093 2,589 534 311 2 22 Impairment of goodwill ** — 35,750 Bad debts written off (note (b)) ** 65 48,022 1,020 — 9,757 — Operating lease charges on land and buildings Auditors’ remuneration Loss on disposals of property, plant and equipment ** Fair value of options granted to a third party for consultancy services rendered (note 30(a)) Fair value of options granted to directors and employees included in staff cost (note 13) Provision for impairment of trade receivables ** Outgoings in respect of leasing properties 314 — 1,096 60 8,938 — Under-provision of value added tax and the corresponding penalty arising in previous years (note 23(a)) ** Exchange difference, net Staff cost, including directors’ emoluments (note 13) — 239 24,243 10,262 Crediting: Exchange difference, net Gain on disposal of subsidiaries ** 4 — — 10,634 Gain on deemed disposal of subsidiaries ** — 2,067 Write back of other payables ** — 2,230 Write back of provision for salary provision ** — 62 Notes: ** Included in “Other operating expenses” on the face of the consolidated income statement. (a) Depreciation expenses of HK$5,538,000 (2005: HK$5,384,000) has been expensed in cost of inventories sold and HK$1,909,000 (2005: HK$996,000 ) in administrative expenses. (b) Included in the bad debts written off was an amount of HK$47,950,000 due from a debtor which was overdue for over two years as at 31 December 2005. – 76 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 9. INCOME TAX EXPENSE 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 — — Current tax — Hong Kong No provision for Hong Kong profits tax is required since the Group did not have any assessable profit for the year (2005: Nil). Reconciliation between income tax expense and the accounting loss at applicable tax rates: 2006 HK$’000 Loss before income tax (46,157) (91,130) Tax at the applicable rates Tax effect of non-taxable income Tax effect of non-deductible expenses Tax effect of unrecognised temporary differences Tax effect of tax losses not recognised (10,808) (1,406) 6,922 331 4,961 (16,117) (1,495) 15,326 242 2,044 Income tax expense 10. 2005 HK$’000 — — DIVIDENDS No dividend has been paid or declared by the Company for the year ended 31 December 2006 (2005: Nil). 11. LOSS ATTRIBUTABLE TO EQUITY HOLDERS OF THE COMPANY Of the consolidated loss attributable to equity holders of the Company of HK$46,167,000 (2005: HK$91,136,000), a loss of HK$40,087,000 (2005: HK$54,155,000) has been dealt with in the financial statements of the Company. 12. LOSS PER SHARE The calculation of basic loss per share is based on the loss attributable to the equity holders of the Company of approximately HK$46,167,000 (2005: HK$91,136,000) and on the weighted average of ordinary shares of 528,332,055 (2005: 303,888,493) in issue. No diluted loss per share is presented for the year ended 31 December 2006 as the outstanding share options were anti-dilutive. No diluted loss per share for the year ended 31 December 2005 has been presented as there was no dilutive potential shares. – 77 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 13. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT EXPENSE (INCLUDING DIRECTORS’ EMOLUMENTS) Wages, salaries and allowances Fair value of share options granted to directors and employees (note (a)) Pension costs - defined contribution plans 2006 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 14,186 10,035 9,757 300 — 227 24,243 10,262 Note: (a) 14. Fair value of share options granted to directors and employees of approximately HK$10,170,000 was charged to the income statement during the year at the date of grant (note 30(a)). An amount of approximately HK$413,000 was credited to the income statement on cancellation of share options when the corresponding staff left the Group (note 30 (b)). DIRECTORS’ REMUNERATION AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT’S EMOLUMENTS (a) Directors’ emolument Fees HK$’000 Salaries, allowances and benefits in kind* HK$’000 Contribution to retirement Quarter benefit expenses scheme HK$’000 HK$’000 Total HK$’000 2006 Executive directors Mr. Pang Man Kin, Nixon Mr. Tsao Ke Wen, Calvin Mr. Lam Shu Chung Mr. Law Fei Shing Mr. So Chi Keung — — — — — 2,325 1,177 1,465 1,605 1,090 600 605 — — — 12 12 12 12 11 2,937 1,794 1,477 1,617 1,101 Non-executive director Dr. Ma Chung Wo Cameron — 86 — — 86 Independent non-executive directors Mr. Poon Chiu # Mr. Lum Pak Sum Mr. Li Chak Hung # 60 60 66 86 86 86 — — — — — — 146 146 152 186 8,006 1,205 59 9,456 * This includes the fair value of share options granted during the year attributable to the directors. # Resigned on 4 April 2007. – 78 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Notes Contribution Quarter to retirement expenses benefit scheme HK$’000 HK$’000 Fees HK$’000 Salaries and allowances HK$’000 201 183 600 480 181 325 329 — — — 5 5 12 12 4 531 517 612 492 185 Total HK$’000 2005 Executive directors Mr. Pang Man Kin, Nixon Mr. Tsao Ke Wen, Calvin Mr. Lam Shu Chung Mr. Law Fei Shing Mr. So Chi Keung (ii) — — — — — Non-executive director Dr. Ma Chung Wo Cameron (iii) — — — — — Independent non-executive directors Mr. Poon Chiu Mr. Lum Pak Sum Mr. Li Chak Hung Mr. Yu Tak Shing, Eric Mr. Lee Siu Leung Mr. Ha Chun, Michael (iii) (iv) (iv) (v) (vi) (vii) 30 18 19 50 52 30 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 30 18 19 50 52 30 199 1,645 654 38 2,536 Notes: (i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) (vi) (vii) (i) (i) appointed on 16 August 2005 appointed on 31 March 2005 appointed on 30 June 2005 appointed on 16 September 2005 appointed on 31 March and resigned on 16 September 2005 resigned on 6 June 2005 resigned on 31 March 2005 During the year, 22,500,000 share options were granted to the directors of the Company to subscribe for ordinary shares of the Company (2005: Nil). During the year, no emoluments were paid by the Group to the directors of the Company as an inducement to join or upon joining the Group, or as compensation for loss of office (2005: Nil). There was no arrangement under which a director waived or agreed to waive any remuneration during the year. – 79 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) Five highest paid individuals The five highest paid individuals during the year included five directors (2005: three), details of whose remuneration are set out in note 14(a) above. Details of the emoluments of the remaining two individuals in the year ended 31 December 2005, which fell within the salary band of Nil HK$1,000,000, are as follows: 2005 HK$’000 Basic salaries, housing benefits, other allowances and benefits in kind Retirement benefits scheme contributions 1,080 24 1,104 15. PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT (a) Group Buildings HK$’000 Plant and machinery HK$’000 Leasehold improvements, furniture, office equipment and motor vehicles HK$’000 Total HK$’000 At 1 January 2005 Valuation Accumulated depreciation 21,497 (457) 61,167 (7,067) 4,127 (1,409) 86,791 (8,933) Net book amount 21,040 54,100 2,718 77,858 Year ended 31 December 2005 Opening net book amount Additions Disposals Exchange differences Depreciation 21,040 — — 607 (471) 54,100 — — 1,561 (5,482) 2,718 1,003 (175) 23 (427) 77,858 1,003 (175) 2,191 (6,380) Closing net book amount 21,176 50,179 3,142 74,497 At 31 December 2005 Valuation Accumulated depreciation 22,118 (942) 62,931 (12,752) 4,976 (1,834) 90,025 (15,528) Net book amount 21,176 50,179 3,142 74,497 – 80 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Leasehold improvements, furniture, office Plant and equipment and Buildings machinery motor vehicles Total HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 21,176 50,179 3,142 74,497 — — 4,018 4,018 Year ended 31 December 2006 Opening net book amount Additions Disposals — — 847 2,035 (490) (5,538) (1,419) (7,447) 21,533 46,676 5,743 73,952 Valuation 23,002 65,141 9,073 97,216 Accumulated depreciation (1,469) (18,465) (3,330) (23,264) Net book amount 21,533 46,676 5,743 73,952 Exchange differences Depreciation Closing net book amount (16) 18 (16) 2,900 At 31 December 2006 The Group’s property, plant and equipment were carried at fair value and were revalued at 31 December 2006. Valuations were made on the basis of the depreciated replacement cost method determined by B.I. Appraisals Limited, an independent firm of chartered surveyors. Property, plant and equipment for the Group includes an amount of HK$380,000 in respect of assets held under a finance lease (2005: HK$380,000) and the related accumulated depreciation amounts is approximately HK$82,000 (2005: HK$6,000). The Group paid a deposit of HK$3,075,000 for additions of leasehold improvements, furniture and office equipment during the year ended 31 December 2005 which was classified as ‘deposits paid’. During the year, the consideration was fully paid by the Group and the deposit paid in last year was transferred to property, plant and equipment. – 81 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) Company Leasehold improvements, furniture, office equipment and motor vehicles HK$’000 At 1 January 2005 Valuation Accumulated depreciation 447 (18) Net book amount 429 Year ended 31 December 2005 Opening net book amount Additions Disposals Depreciation 429 9 (12) (87) Closing net book amount 339 At 31 December 2005 Valuation Accumulated depreciation 444 (105) Net book amount 339 Year ended 31 December 2006 Opening net book amount Additions Disposals Depreciation 339 3 (8) (73) Closing net book amount 261 At 31 December 2006 Valuation Accumulated depreciation 438 (177) Net book amount 261 – 82 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 16. PREPAID LEASE PAYMENTS - GROUP The Group’s interests in leasehold land and land use rights represent prepaid operating lease payments and their net carrying value are analysed as follows: 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 Outside Hong Kong, held on leases of between 10 to 50 years 4,912 4,831 Opening net carrying amount 4,831 4,798 Exchange differences Annual charges of prepaid operating lease payment Closing net carrying amount 17. 193 140 (112) (107) 4,912 4,831 INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES - COMPANY Notes 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 Investments — Unlisted shares, at cost (a) 76,432 76,432 — Arising from share-based compensation (b) 5,754 — 82,186 76,432 Due from subsidiaries (c) 149,183 139,059 Provision for impairment losses – 83 – 231,369 215,491 (170,183) (139,059) 61,186 76,432 APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Notes: (a) Particulars of the principal subsidiaries as at 31 December 2006 are as follows: Percentage Name Place of Paid-up of equity incorporation/ share/registered attributable to activities and place Principal establishment capital the Company of operation British Virgin Ordinary 100% Islands US$100 British Virgin Ordinary Islands US$1 PRC US$4,940,000 Directly held Jackley China Limited Aurora International Enterprises Limited Investment holding Hong Kong 100% Investment holding Hong Kong Indirectly held Hui Zhou Orient Carpet Manufacturing 100% Co., Ltd. (“HZOCM”) # Orient Finance (Hong Kong) Limited * of carpets PRC Hong Kong Ordinary 100% HK$10,000 Orient Carpet Manufacturing Manufacture and sale Hong Kong (Hong Kong) Limited * Ordinary Provision of finance Hong Kong 100% HK$10,000 Investment holding and trading of carpets Hong Kong International Carpet Hong Kong Co. Limited (“ICC”) * Aurora Logistic Capital Ordinary 51% HK$2,000,000 Hong Kong Ordinary HK$1 Hong Kong 100% Assurance Limited Aurora Logistic Software Investment holding Hong Kong Hong Kong Ordinary HK$1 100% Management Limited Wise Mount Management Limited Trading of carpets Logistic Hong Kong Hong Kong Ordinary HK$1 100% Investment holding Hong Kong Wellspark Holdings Limited Hong Kong Ordinary HK$1 100% Investment holding Hong Kong * Subsidiaries audited by Grant Thornton Hong Kong # Wholly foreign owned enterprise – 84 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The above table lists the subsidiaries of the Company which, in the opinion of the directors, principally affected the results for the year or formed a substantial portion of the net assets of the Group. To give details of other subsidiaries would, in the opinion of the directors, result in particulars of excessive length. (b) The amount represents share-based compensation expenses arising from grant of share options of the Company to employees of subsidiaries in exchange for their services offered to these subsidiaries. (c) The amounts due are unsecured, interest-free and not repayable in the next twelve months from the balance sheet date. 18. GOODWILL — GROUP The net carrying amount of goodwill is analysed as follows: 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 At 1 January Gross carrying amount Accumulated impairment 71,500 71,500 (71,500) (35,750) Net carrying amount — 35,750 Net carrying amount at 1 January — 35,750 Impairment losses — (35,750) Net carrying amount at 31 December — — At 31 December Gross carrying amount Accumulated impairment 71,500 71,500 (71,500) (71,500) Net carrying amount — — The balance of the Group’s goodwill carried forward to 2005 of HK$35,750,000 was wholly attributable to HZOCM, which carries out all of the Group’s carpet manufacturing operations. Based on the comparison of the fair value less costs to sell (being the recoverable amount) and the carrying value of the cash-generating units, the directors concluded the goodwill relating to the HZOCM carpet manufacturing operations had been fully impaired in the year ended 31 December 2005. Accordingly, an impairment charge of HK$35,750,000 was charged to the consolidated income statement in 2005. – 85 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 19. INVENTORIES — GROUP Raw materials Work in progress Finished goods 20. 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 1,773 2,170 — 61 2,260 3,452 4,033 5,683 TRADE AND BILLS RECEIVABLES — GROUP The Group normally allows credit terms ranging from 30 to 120 days to established customers. An aging analysis of the trade and bills receivables, net of provision, as at the balance sheet date, based on the date of recognition of the sale, is as follows: 1-90 days 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 3,567 3,340 91-120 days 153 80 121-365 days 471 2,292 2,050 1,423 6,241 7,135 (1,737) (1,423) 4,504 5,712 Over 1 year Less: Provision for impairment of trade receivables Trade receivables — net – 86 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 21. CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS (a) Group Cash and cash equivalents include the following components: Cash at banks and in hand Bank overdrafts (note 26) 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 776 7,069 (5) Cash and cash equivalents 771 (138) 6,931 Included in cash at banks and in hand of the Group is HK$344,000 (2005: HK$201,000) of bank balances denominated in Renminbi (“RMB”) placed with banks in the PRC. RMB is not a freely convertible currency. (b) Company Cash at banks and in hand 22. 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 9 6,313 TRADE PAYABLES — GROUP An aging analysis of the trade payables as at the balance sheet date, based on the receipt of goods purchased, is as follows: 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 1-90 days 5,926 5,977 91-120 days 2,603 986 121-365 days 967 500 Over 1 year 227 1,569 9,723 9,032 – 87 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 23. DEPOSITS RECEIVED, OTHER PAYABLES AND ACCRUALS Group Note Deposits received Company 2006 2005 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 5,429 2,263 — — 20,182 8,284 2,167 1,288 25,611 10,547 2,167 1,288 Other payables and accruals (a) Note: (a) Included in the balance was installation cost and interest payable to ૯Γജጙۺஉτࠉʔ̇ജ ጙin relation to a litigation case of a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company namely HZOCM who had been made a defendant of a proceeding in the PRC. The proceedings were brought byജጙ against HZOCM at the Peoples Court of the Hui Yang District, Hui Zhou City, Guangdong Province in respect of installation cost due and interest payable. The amount claimed under this set of proceedings was HK$1,520,000 and interest payable of HK$1,288,000. The amount and the corresponding interest was fully provided in the Group’s financial statements as at 31 December 2006. The balance also included value added tax and the corresponding penalty payable estimated and billed by the local tax authority during the year of approximately HK$8,938,000 (note 8). At 31 December 2005, an amount due to a former-director of the Company of HK$58,000 was included in other payables and accruals of the Group and the Company. The amount due was fully settled during the year ended 31 December 2006. 24. AMOUNTS DUE TO DIRECTORS The amounts due are unsecured, interest-free and repayable on demand. – 88 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 25. FINANCE LEASE PAYABLE — GROUP The analysis of the total future minimum lease payments under a finance lease and their present values are as follows: Present value Minimum of minimum lease payments lease payments 2006 2005 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year 101 101 76 76 In the second year 101 101 76 76 208 301 158 228 410 503 310 380 on finance lease payments (100) (123) Total net finance lease payable 310 380 (76) (76) 234 304 Amounts payable: In the third to fifth years, inclusive Total minimum finance lease payments Future finance charges Less: Portion classified as current liabilities Non-current portion included under non-current liabilities The Group entered into a finance lease for a motor vehicle with a lease period of 5 years. The lease does not have an option to renew or any contingent rental provisions. Under the lease term, the legal title of the leased asset will be transferred to the Group at nil consideration on expiry of the lease period. – 89 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 26. BANK BORROWINGS — GROUP An analysis of bank borrowings which were repayable within one year was as follows: Bank overdrafts, unsecured (note 21(a)) Trust receipt loans, secured (note (a) (a) 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 5 138 — 2,257 5 2,395 At 31 December 2005, these borrowings bore interest at variable rate of 7.405% per annum and were secured by the followings: 27. (i) Pledge of time deposits of HK$2,031,000; and (ii) Personal guarantees executed by a related party and by the minority shareholders of ICC. AMOUNTS DUE TO MINORITY SHAREHOLDERS The amounts due are unsecured, interest free and would not be repayable within the next twelve months from the balance sheet date. – 90 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 28. SHARE CAPITAL 2006 Authorised: At 1 January, ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each (2005: HK$0.1 each) Capital reorganisation Notes Number of shares ’000 (b) HK$’000 Number of shares ’000 HK$’000 20,000,000 — 200,000 — 2,000,000 18,000,000 200,000 — 20,000,000 200,000 20,000,000 200,000 525,200 — — 5,252 — — 1,340,000 50,000 (1,251,000) 134,000 5,000 (137,610) 525,200 5,252 139,000 1,390 (c) (d) (e) — — — — — — 69,500 275,000 41,700 695 2,750 417 (f) 26,700 267 — — 551,900 5,519 525,200 5,252 At 31 December ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each (2005: HK$0.01 each) Issued and fully paid: At 1 January, ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each (2005: HK$0.1 each) Shares issued on 18 January 2005 Capital reorganisation (a) (b) Ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each after the capital reorganisation Shares issued on 14 April 2005 Shares issued on 10 August 2005 Shares issued on 3 November 2005 Exercise of share options and issue of shares At 31 December ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each (2005: HK$0.01 each) 2005 Notes: (a) On 18 January 2005, the Company issued 50,000,000 new ordinary shares at HK$0.30 per share to Shenzhen Hao Sheng He Industrial Company Limited to complete the balance of the consideration of the conditional share acquisition agreement (to acquire 49% additional equity interest in a subsidiary of the Company, HZOCM) entered into on 15 September 2003. These issued shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. – 91 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) Pursuant to a special resolution passed on 31 December 2004, the capital reorganisation was approved in the following manner (i) the nominal value of the issued shares was reduced from HK$0.10 each to HK$0.001 each by the cancellation of HK$0.099 paid up on each issued share; (ii) every authorised but unissued share was subdivided into 100 reduced shares; and (iii) every 10 reduced shares was consolidated into one new shares (“New Share”). As a result, an amount of approximately HK$137,610,000 standing to the credit of the issued share capital of the Company was cancelled and credited to capital reserve account of the Company, from which distribution shall be at the discretion of the Directors. The capital reorganisation was completed on 10 March 2005. (c) On 22 February 2005, the Company proposed to raise approximately HK$13,900,000 before expenses, by issuing 69,500,000 offer shares at the price of HK$0.2 per offer share by way of an open offer, payable in full on application, on the basis of one offer share for every two New Shares. The open offer was fully allotted by the shareholders and the underwriter in April 2005. These issued New Shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. (d) In June 2005, the Company completed a subscription agreement for the issue of convertible note in an aggregate principal of HK$33,000,000 to the subscriber. The subscriber has the right to convert the whole integral multiple of HK$1,000,000 of the principal amount of the convertible note into New Shares at any times before the maturity date falling on the second anniversary of the date of issue of the convertible note at the initial conversion price of HK$0.12 per share. On 9 August 2005, the Company received a conversion notice from L & L Holdings Limited (“L & L”) in respect of the convertible note in an aggregate principal amount of HK$33,000,000, pursuant to which L & L exercised the conversion rights in full attaching to the convertible note at the conversion price of HK$0.12 per share, resulting in the issue of 275,000,000 New Shares by the Company to L & L. These issued New Shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. (e) In October 2005, Prime Orient International Limited (“POIL”) entered into the placing and subscription agreement pursuant to which a placing agent agreed with POIL to place up to 41,700,000 shares at the placing price of HK$0.79 per placing share on behalf of POIL to not less than six individual investors who were third parties independent of the Company and its connected persons on a best effort basis. Immediately after the completion of the aforesaid placing, the Company issued 41,700,000 New Shares at HK$0.79 per share to POIL on 3 November 2005. These issued New Shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. (f) During the year, subscription rights attached to the 26,700,000 share options of the Company (note 30(c)) were exercised at subscription prices of HK$0.365 and HK$0.35 per share. As a result of the subscription, the Company allotted, issued and fully paid 26,700,000 New Shares of HK$0.01 each. These issued New Shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. A share premium of approximately HK$9,198,000 was arose from the issue and allotment of shares. In addition an amount of approximately HK$4,867,000 was transferred from share option reserve to share premium. – 92 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 29. RESERVE (a) Group The amounts of the Group’s reserves and the movements therein for the current and the prior years are presented in the consolidated statement of changes in equity of the financial statements. The share premium account of the Company includes i) the difference between the then combined net asset value of the subsidiaries acquired pursuant to the Group reorganisation in 2001, over the nominal value of the share capital of the Company issued in exchange therefore; ii) the premium arising from the capitalisation issue in the previous year (note 28(b)); iii) issue of shares of the Company at a premium net of the transaction costs associated with the issue of shares; and iv) amount transferred from other equity reserves upon exercise of share option and conversion of convertible note. The capital reserves of the Group arose from the capital reorganisation as set out in note 28(b) above. – 93 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) Company Share Capital Convertible Share note equity option Accumulated premium reserves reserve reserve losses Total HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 — 3,057 — — 55,731 — — — — 55,731 — — 4,708 — — 4,708 30,250 — (4,708) — — (25,542) Capital reorganisation — 137,610 — — — 137,610 Net loss for the year — — — — (54,155) (54,155) 85,981 140,667 — — (149,068) 77,580 — — — 11,190 — — — (413) 14,065 — — (4,867) — — — — (40,087) (40,087) 100,046 140,667 — 5,910 (189,155) 57,468 At 1 January 2005 (94,913) (91,856) Premium on shares issued during the year Issue of convertible note (note 28(d)) Conversion of convertible note (note 28(d)) At 31 December 2005 and 1 January 2006 Share options granted (note 30(a)) — 11,190 Share options cancelled (noted 30(b)) — (413) Exercise of share options and issue of shares (note 28(f)) Net loss for the year At 31 December 2006 — 9,198 Details of the share premium account and capital reserves of the Company are set out in note 29(a) above. – 94 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 30. SHARE-BASED COMPENSATION The Company operates a share option scheme (the “Scheme”) for the purpose of providing incentives and rewards to eligible participants who contribute to the success of the Group’s operations. Eligible participants of the Scheme include the Company’s directors, independent non-executive directors, other employees of the Group, suppliers of goods or services to the Group, customers of the Group, any person or entity that provides research, development or other technological support to the Group and any minority shareholder in the Company’s subsidiaries. The Scheme was adopted on 6 June 2002 and, unless otherwise cancelled or amended, will remain in force for 10 years from that date. The maximum number of unexercised share options currently permitted to be granted under the Scheme is an amount equivalent, upon their exercise, to 10% of the shares of the Company in issue at any time. Pursuant to the extraordinary general meeting passed on 10 March 2006, the general scheme limit of the Company’s share option scheme has been reset to 52,520,000 shares, representing 10% of the Company’s issued share capital on the date of meeting, with the passing of ordinary resolution, which allowing the Company to grant further options carrying the rights to subscribe for a maximum of 52,520,000 shares. The maximum number of shares issuable under share options to each eligible participant in the Scheme within any 12-month period, is limited to 1%, of the shares of the Company in issue at any time. Any further grant of share options in excess of this limit is subject to shareholders’ approval in a general meeting. Share options granted to a director, chief executive or substantial shareholder of the Company, or to any of their associates, are subject to approval in advance by the independent non-executive directors , in addition, any share options granted to a substantial shareholder or an independent non-executive director of the Company, or to any of their associates, in excess of 0.1% of the shares of the Company in issue at any time or with an aggregate value (based on the price of the Company’s shares at the date of the grant) in excess of HK$5 million, within any 12-month period, are subject to shareholders’ approval in advance in a general meeting. The offer of a grant of share options may be accepted within 28 days from the date of the offer, upon payment of a nominal consideration of HK$1 in total by the grantee. The exercise period of the share options granted is determinable by the directors, and commences after a certain vesting period and ends on a date which is not later than 10 years from the date of the offer of the share options or the expiry date of the Scheme, if earlier. The exercise price of the share options is determinable by the directors, but may not be less than the higher of: i) the Stock Exchange closing price of the Company’s shares on the date of the offer of the share options; ii) the average Stock Exchange closing price of the Company’s shares for the five trading days immediately preceding the date of the offer; and iii) the nominal value of the shares. – 95 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Share options do not confer rights on the holders to dividends or to vote at shareholders’ meetings. The movement of the share options granted by the Company under the Scheme are as follows: 2006 2005 Number Number — — — on 7 March 2006 32,000,000 — — on 2 May 2006 14,200,000 — 8,720,000 — At 1 January Granted (note (a)) — on 27 November 2007 54,920,000 — Cancelled (note (b)) (2,400,000) — Exercised (note (c)) (26,700,000) — 25,820,000 — At 31 December Notes: (a) Share options granted vest immediately. The fair value of the 54,920,000 share options at the date of grant was approximately HK$11,190,000 in aggregate which has been recognised as to HK$10,170,000 as employee benefits expenses and other administrative expenses of HK$1,020,000 in the consolidated income statement for the year ended 31 December 2006. The corresponding amount of HK$11,190,000 has been credited to share option reserve. No liabilities were recognised due to these equity settled share-based payment transactions. The fair values of share options granted to employees of HK$10,170,000 during the year were determined by an independent valuer using the Black-Scholes Model (the “Model”). Details of the inputs to the Model are as follows: Share options Expected volatility (%) Risk-free interest rate (%) Dividend yield (%) – 96 – Share options Share options granted on granted on granted on 7 March 2006 2 May 2006 27 November at exercise at exercise 2006 at exercise price of price of price of HK$0.35 HK$0.365 HK$0.54 79% 94% 108% 4.207% 4.216% 3.657% 0.00% 0.00% 0.00% APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Expected volatility at the date of grant was generated from Bloomberg based on the Company’s 90 days historical share prices before the respective date of valuation. The fair value of share options granted to a third party of HK$1,020,000 for consultancy services rendered during the year was determined based on the invoiced amount of service provided. (b) During the year, 2,400,000 share options were cancelled when the employees left the Group and the corresponding amount of approximately HK$413,000 was credited to the income statement and debited to the share option reserve. (c) In respect of the share options exercised in the current financial year, the weighted average share price of the Company at the dates of exercise ranged from HK$0.50 to HK$0.61 per share. The share options exercised during the year resulted in the issue of 26,700,000 ordinary shares of the Company (note 28(f)). At the balance sheet date, the Group has the following outstanding share options and exercise prices: 2006 Number 2005 Weighted Weighted average average exercise exercise price price per share Number HK$ per share HK$ Exercise period: 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 10,900,000 0.350 — N/A 6,200,000 0.365 — N/A to 9 March 2011 8,720,000 0.540 — N/A At 31 December 2006 25,820,000 0.418 — N/A 2 May 2006 to 9 March 2011 27 November 2006 The exercise in full of these remaining share options would under the present capital structure of the Company result in the issue of 25,820,000 additional ordinary shares of the Company including share capital of approximately HK$258,000 and share premium of approximately HK$10,529,000. Subsequent to the balance sheet date, 19,820,000 share options were exercised resulting in a gross proceeds of HK$7,547,000. Subsequent to the balance sheet date and up to the date of these financial statements, no share option had been granted. – 97 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 31. DEFERRED TAX At the balance sheet date, unrecognised deferred tax assets are follows: Group Tax losses Company 2006 2005 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 36,880 29,554 — — Deferred tax asset has not been recongnised in respect of the above tax losses carried forward because it is not probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the Group and the Company can utilise the benefits. The unrecognised tax losses may be carried forward indefinitely except for the losses of HK$31,735,000 (2005: HK$20,051,000) which will expire as follows: 32. 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 2006 — 664 2007 2,397 2,397 2008 1,206 1,206 2009 9,667 9,667 2010 6,117 6,117 2011 12,348 — 31,735 20,051 OPERATING LEASE COMMITMENTS At 31 December 2006, the Group had total future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating lease falling due as follows: Within one year In the second to fifth years, inclusive – 98 – 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 3,474 4,044 521 2,468 3,995 6,512 APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The Group leases certain leasehold land and buildings under operating leases. The leases run for an initial period of two to three years, with an option to renew the lease and renegotiate the terms at expiry date or at dates as mutually agreed between the Group and respective landlords/lessors. None of the leases include contingent rentals. The Company did not have any significant lease commitments at 31 December 2006 (2005: Nil). 33. OPERATING SUB-LEASE ARRANGEMENTS At 31 December 2006, the Group had total future minimum lease receipts under non-cancellable operating sub-lease falling due as follows: 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 822 364 — 152 822 516 Within one year In the second to fifth years, inclusive The Group sub-leases its property under operating lease arrangements which run for an initial period of one to two years, with an option to renew the lease terms at the expiry date or at dates as mutually agreed between the Group and the respective tenants. The terms of the leases generally also require the tenants to pay security deposits. The Company did not have any significant lease arrangements at 31 December 2006 (2005: Nil). 34. COMMITMENTS (a) On 3 December 2005, the Group entered into an acquisition agreement with China National Materials Storage and Transportation Guangzhou Corp (the “vendor”) to purchase the Logistic and Financial Management System at a total consideration RMB6,000,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$5,769,000) which was satisfied (i) as to RMB3,500,000 (approximately HK$3,365,000) by issuing of 10,516,827 shares of the Company, and (ii) as to RMB2,500,000 (approximately HK$2,404,000) for cash. On 24 November 2006, the Group and the vendor have entered into a revised acquisition agreement which amended the consideration from HK$6,000,000 to HK$3,000,000. The consideration would be settled in cash based on the revised terms. A refundable deposit of HK$1,000,000 was paid by the Group in 2005 and an additional deposit of HK$1,000,000 was paid by the Group during the year. The amounts paid were included in balance sheet as “deposits” under non-current assets as at 31 December 2006. As at 31 December 2006, capital commitment arising from this acquisition was approximately HK$1,000,000 in cash. – 99 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (b) On 8 December 2006, the Group entered into an acquisition agreement to acquire 70% equity interests in Win Alliance Development Limited, which carries out the businesses of manufacturing and trading of carpets and trading of commodities such as seamless steel pipes and steel, at a total consideration HK$14,000,000. The consideration shall be satisfied (i) as to HK$ 9,000,000 by issuing of 18,000,000 ordinary shares of the Company, and (ii) as to HK$ 5,000,000 for cash. A refundable deposit of HK$1,750,000 was paid by the Group on 13 December 2006 and which was included in the consolidated balance sheet as “deposits” under non-current assets. As at 31 December 2006, capital commitment arising from this acquisition was HK$3,250,000 in cash and issue of 18,000,000 consideration shares of the Company. The transaction was completed on 2 March 2007. 35. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS Apart from the balances and transactions with related parties disclosed elsewhere in the financial statements, the Group had the following transactions with its related parties during the year: (a) A wholly-owned subsidiary entered into a sub-letting agreement with Orient Securities Limited, a company in which a director of the Company had beneficial interest, to sublet part of office at 8/F Luk Kwok Centre, 69 Gloucester Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong at monthly rental HK$30,338, totalling to HK$364,056 for the year (2005: HK$364,056). (b) Compensation of key management personnel Included in staff costs are key management personnel compensation (including directors’ emoluments) and comprises the following categories: Short term employee benefits Contribution to retirement benefit scheme Share-based payment – 100 – 2006 2005 HK$’000 HK$’000 5,520 2,498 59 38 5,129 — 10,708 2,536 APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 36. RISK MANAGEMENT OBJECTIVES AND POLICIES The Group is exposed to a variety of financial risks which results from both its operating and investing activities. The Group does not have written risk management policies and guidelines. However, the board of directors meets periodically to analyse and formulate strategies to manage the Group’s exposure to market risks, including changes in interest rates and currency exchange rates. Generally, the Group introduces conservative strategies on its risk management. The Group’s exposure to market risk is kept to minimum. The Group has not used any derivatives or other instruments for hedging purposes. The Group does not issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. (a) Credit risk All the Group’s cash and cash equivalents are deposited with major banks located in Hong Kong and the PRC. The carrying amounts of trade and bills receivables and other receivables represent the Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk in relation to its financial assets. These financial assets are actively monitored to avoid significant concentrations of credit risk. No other financial assets carry a significant exposure to credit risk. (b) Foreign currency risk The sales and purchases of the Group are predominantly in United States Dollar, RMB and Hong Kong Dollar. The Group does not hedge its foreign currency risks, as the management does not expect any significant movements in the exchange rate between United States Dollar, RMB and Hong Kong Dollar. (c) Interest rate risk The Group has no significant interest bearing assets. The Group’s interest rate risk arises from long term borrowings. The interest rates and terms of repayment are disclosed in notes 25 and 26. (d) Fair values The fair values of the Group’s current financial assets and liabilities are not materially different from their carrying amount because of the immediate or short term maturity. The fair values of noncurrent liabilities were not disclosed because their carrying value is not materially different from their fair value. – 101 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 37. POST BALANCE SHEET EVENTS The Group had the following significant post balance sheet events: (a) On 30 January 2007, the Company entered into a non-legally binding memorandum of understanding (“MOU”), pursuant to which the Company has agreed, subject to the entering into of a formal subscription agreement, which is expected to be within two months from the date of signing of the MOU, to issue to the investor the convertible notes, which are proposed to be in maximum aggregate principal amount of US$10,000,000. No formal contract has been signed up to the date of these financial statements. (b) On 5 March 2007, the Company entered into a placement agreement as set out in note 3(a)(ii) to the financial statements. (c) On 27 March 2007, the Group entered into an agreement regarding an investment into a ChineseForeign Equity Joint Venture Company, Hebei Da Sheng Warranty Company Limited (“Da Sheng”), where the Group would inject US$6,375,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$ 51,000,000) as capital. The contribution by the Group to the registered capital shall be made in the following manner: (i) US$3,125,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$25,000,000) within three mounts after the date of signing the agreement that is 26 June 2007; and (ii) US$ 3,250,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$26,000,000) by the end of two years from the date of issuance of business license of Da Sheng.that is 25 September 2008. – 102 – APPENDIX I 3. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP INTERIM REPORT OF THE COMPANY FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2007 The following are the unaudited consolidated results of the Group as extracted from the interim report of the Group for the six months ended 30 June 2007. CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT For the period ended 30 June 2007 Notes Revenue Cost of sales 3 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 17,458 (23,445) 11,002 (12,520) Gross loss Other revenue and income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses (5,987) 1,040 (1,367) (16,674) (930) (1,518) 849 (1,009) (21,854) (8,670) Operating loss Finance costs 6 (23,918) (20) (32,202) (89) Loss before income tax Income tax expense 5 7 (23,938) — (32,291) — Loss for the period (23,938) (32,291) Attributable to: Equity holders of the Company Minority interests (23,938) — (32,301) 10 (23,938) (32,291) (3.8) (6.2) N/A N/A Loss per share attributable to equity holders of the Company — Basic, HK cents 9 — Diluted, HK cents – 103 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET As at 30 June 2007 Notes ASSETS AND LIABILITIES Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Prepaid lease payments Deposits Current assets Inventories Trade and bills receivables Prepayments, deposits and other receivables Cash at bank and in hand Current liabilities Trade payables Deposits received, other payables and accruals Amounts due to directors Finance lease payable Bank borrowings Tax payable 10 11 Net current assets/(liabilities) Total assets less current liabilities Non-current liabilities Finance lease payable Amounts due to minority shareholders Net assets EQUITY Equity attributable to equity holders of the Company Share capital Reserves 13 Minority interests 30 June 2007 (Unaudited) HK$’000 31 December 2006 (Audited) HK$’000 74,664 4,855 18,355 73,952 4,912 3,750 97,874 82,614 4,611 9,374 9,709 89,596 4,033 4,504 8,590 776 113,290 17,903 15,847 34,161 1,100 87 — 143 9,723 25,611 1,143 76 5 — 51,338 36,558 61,952 (18,655) 159,826 63,959 176 9,010 234 924 150,640 62,801 8,135 142,722 5,519 57,499 150,857 63,018 (217) Total equity 150,640 – 104 – (217) 62,801 APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY For the period ended 30 June 2007 Minority Interest Total equity Total HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 Equity attributable to equity holders of the Company Share capital HK$’000 Capital reserves HK$’000 Share premium HK$’000 Assets revaluation reserve HK$’000 Exchange reserve HK$’000 5,252 137,610 85,981 9,735 100 — (152,559) 86,119 (227) 85,892 — — — — — — — — — — 8,016 — — (32,301) 8,016 (32,301) — 10 8,016 (32,291) At 30 June 2006 (Unaudited) 5,252 137,610 85,981 9,735 100 8,016 (184,860) 61,834 (217) 61,617 At 1 January 2007 (Audited) 5,519 137,610 100,046 9,726 2,933 5,910 (198,726) 63,018 (217) 62,801 2,400 — 100,896 — — — — 103,296 — 103,296 216 — — — 12,824 — — — — — (4,559) — — (23,938) 8,481 (23,938) — — 8,481 (23,938) 8,135 137,610 213,766 9,726 2,933 1,351 (222,664) 150,857 (217) 150,640 At 1 January 2006 (Audited) Equity-settled share option arrangement Net loss for the period Issue of shares (note 13) Exercise of share options and issue of shares (note 13(d)) Net loss for the Period At 30 June 2007 (Unaudited) – 105 – Share option Accumulated reserve losses HK$’000 HK$’000 APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT For the period ended 30 June 2007 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Net cash outflow from operating activities (9,461) (942) Net cash outflow from investing activities (4,032) (761) Net cash inflow/(outflow) from financing activities Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents 102,318 (612) 88,825 (2,315) Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January 771 6,931 Cash and cash equivalents at 30 June 89,596 4,616 – 106 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS For the period ended 30 June 2007 1. BASIS OF PREPARATION These unaudited condensed consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the applicable disclosure requirements of Appendix 16 to the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the “Listing Rules”) and the Hong Kong Accounting Standard (“HKAS”) 34 “Interim Financial Reporting” issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (“HKICPA”). The interim financial report contains the condensed financial statements and selected explanatory notes. The notes include an explanation of events and transactions that are significant to an understanding of the changes in financial position performance of the Group since the 2006 annual financial statement. The condensed consolidated financial statements and notes thereon do not include all of the information required for full set of financial statements prepared in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Report Standards (HKFRSs), which term collectively includes HKASs and Interpretations (“INTs”). The preparation of the interim financial report in conformity with HKAS 34 requires management to make judgments, estimates and assumptions that affect the application of policies and reported amounts of assets and liabilities, income and expenses on a year to date basis. Actual results may differ from these estimates. The interim financial report is unaudited, but have been reviewed by the Audit Committee of the Company. 2. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING POLICIES The condensed financial statements have been prepared on the historical cost basis except for the revaluation of certain property, plant and equipment and certain financial assets and liabilities, which are measured at fair value. The accounting and basis of preparation adopted in these condensed consolidated financial statements are consistent with those followed in the preparation of the Group’s financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2006, except in relation to the following amendments to and interpretation of HKFRSs issued by HKICPA that affect the Group and are adopted for the first time for the current period’s financial statements: Amendment to HKAS 1 “Presentation of Financial Statements” — Capital Disclosures (1) HKFRS 7 “Financial Instruments: Disclosures” (1) HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 7 “Applying the Restatement Approach under HKAS 29 Financial Reporting in Hyperinflationary Economies” (2) HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 8 “Scope of HKFRS 2” (3) HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 9 “Reassessment of Embedded Derivatives” (4) HK(IFRIC) Interpretation 10 “Interim Financial Reporting and Impairment” (5) – 107 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (1) Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007 (2) Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 March 2006 (3) Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 May 2006 (4) Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 June 2006 (5) Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 November 2006 The adoption of the above HKFRSs did not result in material impact on the accounting policies of the Group’s condensed consolidated financial statements. The Group has not early adopted certain accounting Standards or Interpretations that have been issued but not yet effective. The adoption of such Standards and Interpretations will not result in substantial changes to the Group’s accounting policies. 3. REVENUE Revenue, which is also the Group’s turnover represents the net invoiced value of goods sold, after allowances for returns and trade discounts during the Period. All significant transactions among the companies comprising the Group have been eliminated on consolidation. 4. SEGMENT INFORMATION Segment information is presented by way of two segment formats: (i) on a primary segment reporting basis, by business segment; and (ii) on a secondary segment reporting basis, by geographical segment. The Group’s operating business are structured and managed separately, according to the nature of their operations and the products they provide. Each of the Group’s business segments represents a strategic business unit that offers products which are subject to risks and returns that are different from those of other business segments. Summary details of the business segments are as follows: (a) the manufacture of carpets segment represents the manufacture and sale of carpets under the Group’s own brand name; and (b) the trading of carpets segment represents the trading of carpets of other renowned brand names. (c) the trading of other goods segment represents the trading of other goods from imports and exports. – 108 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) In determining the Group’s geographical segments, revenue and results are attributed to the segments based on the location of the customers. (a) Business segments The following table presents revenue and results for the Group’s business segments. Manufacturing of carpets six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 (b) Trading of carpets six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Trading of other goods six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Consolidated six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Segment revenue: Sales to external customers 4,904 4,501 9,482 6,501 3,072 — 17,458 11,002 Segment results (3,281) (11,675) (8,429) (5,737) (356) — (12,066) (17,412) Unallocated other operating income Share-base payment Unallocated expenses Finance costs 215 — (12,067) (20) 18 (8,016) (6,792) (89) Loss before income tax Income tax (23,938) — (32,291) — Loss for the period (23,938) (32,291) Geographical segments The following table presents revenue and results for the Group’s geographical segments. Hong Kong six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Segment revenue: Sales to external customers Segment results The People’s Republic of China (the “PRC”) six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Overseas six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Consolidated six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 8,863 4,541 5,704 4,649 2,891 1,812 17,458 11,002 (20,657) (20,616) (3,281) (11,675) — — (23,938) (32,291) – 109 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 5. LOSS BEFORE INCOME TAX The Group’s loss before income tax is arrived at after charging: Six months ended 30 June Cost of inventories sold Fair value of options granted 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 20,061 10,190 — 8,016 Depreciation 4,093 3,596 Impairment loss of goodwill 1,081 — 57 55 8,348 5,407 Amortisation of prepaid lease payments Staff costs (including directors’ emoluments) 6. 2007 FINANCE COSTS Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Interest charged on: Bank loans and overdrafts wholly repayable within five years 7. — 63 Finance leases 20 11 Other loans — 15 20 89 INCOME TAX EXPENSE No provision for Hong Kong profits tax is required since the Group did not have any assessable profit for the Period (2006: Nil). 8. DIVIDENDS The Directors do not recommend the payment of any interim dividend in respect of the Period (2006: Nil). – 110 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 9. LOSS PER SHARE The calculation of basic loss per share is based on the loss attributable to equity holders of the Company of HK$23,938,000 (2006: HK$32,301,000) and on the weighted average number of ordinary shares of 634,056,851 (six months ended 30 June 2006: 525,200,000) in issue during the Period. Dilutive loss per share for the Period was not presented because the exercise of the Company’s share options will reduce loss per share which is anti-dilutive. 10. TRADE AND BILL RECEIVABLES The Group normally allows credit terms ranging from 30 to 120 days to established customers. An aging analysis of the trade receivables, net of provisions, as at the balance sheet date, based on the date of recognition of the sales, is as follows: 30 June 31 December 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Audited) HK$’000 HK$’000 1-90 days 3,804 3,567 91-120 days 2,308 153 121-365 days 2,294 471 Over 1 year 2,705 2,050 11,111 6,241 (1,737) (1,737) 9,374 4,504 Less: Provision for impairment of trade receivables Trade receivables — net – 111 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 11. TRADE PAYABLES The Group normally obtains credit terms ranging from 30 to 120 days from its suppliers. An aging analysis of the trade payables as at the balance sheet date, based on the receipt of goods purchased, is as follows: 30 June 12. 31 December 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Audited) HK$’000 HK$’000 1-90 days 7,973 5,926 91-120 days 3,157 2,603 121-365 days 2,042 967 Over 1 year 2,675 227 15,847 9,723 ACQUISITION OF SUBSIDIARIES During the six months ended 30 June 2007, the Group acquired 100% interest in Go On Foundate Company Limited (“Go On”) and 70% interest in Win Alliance Development Limited (“Win Alliance”). The acquisition has been accounted for using business combination method of accounting. On 8 December 2006, Wise Mount Management Limited (“Wise Mount”), a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, and Ms Sheng De Cruz Li entered into conditional sales and purchase agreement pursuant to which Wise Mount agreed to acquire the equity interests of Win Alliance which represented 70% of the registered share capital of Win Alliance. Win Alliance is principally manufacturing and trading of carpets and trading of other commodities such as seamless steel pipes and steel. (Please also refer the Company’s announcement and circular dated 14 December 2006 and 2 January 2007 for further details.) – 112 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The fair value of the identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities of subsidiaries acquired by the Group and dealt with in the interim condensed consolidated financial statements at the dates of acquisition are as follows: Win Alliance Go On (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Net assets acquired: Property, plant and equipment 1,892 284 18,355 — Trade receivables 2,499 — Prepayments, deposits and other receivables 1,633 — Deposits Cash and bank balances 1 Trade payables (2,274) — — Other payables and accruals (78) — Finance lease payable — (298) (16) (313) (143) — Due to the directors Tax payable Minority interests Goodwill arising on acquisition 21,869 (327) (8,623) — 754 327 14,000 — Cash 5,000 — Shares allotment (Note 13(a)) 9,000 — 14,000 — Fair value of net assets at dates of acquisition Satisfied or represented by: – 113 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) An analysis of the net outflow of cash and cash equivalents in respect of the acquisition of subsidiaries are as follows: Win Alliance Go On (Unaudited) (Unaudited) HK$’000 HK$’000 1 — Cash and bank balances acquired and net inflow of cash and cash equivalents in respect of the consolidation of subsidiary in the condensed consolidated balance sheet Less: Cash consideration (5,000) — (4,999) — Net outflow of cash and cash equivalents in respect of the acquisition of subsidiary in the consolidated cash flow statements Note: Since the date of the acquisitions, Win Alliance and Go On have recorded a loss of HK$382,000 and HK$43,000 to the Group’s loss distributable to equity shareholders of the Company respectively and Win Alliance has contributed a revenue of HK$2,398,000 for the four months ended 30 June 2007. – 114 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 13. SHARE CAPITAL 30 June 2007 31 December 2006 Number Number of shares Notes of shares ’000 HK$’000 ’000 HK$’000 20,000,000 200,000 20,000,000 200,000 551,900 5,519 525,200 5,252 (a) 18,000 180 — — (b) 87,000 870 — — (c) 135,000 1,350 — — 21,550 216 26,700 267 813,450 8,135 551,900 5,519 Authorised: Ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each Issued and fully paid: At 1 January, ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each Shares issued on 16 February 2007 Shares issued on 16 March 2007 Shares issued on 25 June 2007 Exercise of share options and issue of shares (d) At 30 June/31 December ordinary shares of HK$0.01 each Notes: (a) On 16 February 2007, the Company issued 18,000,000 new ordinary shares at HK$0.50 per share to Ms Sheng De Cruz Li to complete the balance of the consideration of the conditional sale and purchase agreement (to acquire 70% equity interest in Win Alliance Development Limited) entered into on 8 December 2006. These issued shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. (b) In March 2007, the Company entered into placement agreement between Enlighten Securities Limited as placing agent, pursuant to which an aggregate of 87,000,000 new ordinary shares were placed by the placing agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis at the price of HK$0.308 per placing share with six independent investors. Immediately after the completion of the aforesaid placing, the Company issued 87,000,000 new Shares at HK$0.308 per share to six independent investors on 16 March 2007. These issued new shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. – 115 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (c) In June 2007, the Company entered into placement agreement between Enlighten Securities Limited as placing agent, pursuant to which an aggregate of 135,000,000 new ordinary shares were placed by the placing agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis at the price of HK$0.50 per placing share with six independent investors. Immediately after the completion of the aforesaid placing, the Company issued 135,000,000 new Shares at HK$0.50 per share to six independent investors on 25 June 2007. These issued new shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. (d) During the Period, subscription rights attached to the 10,900,000 share options, 6,200,000 share options and 4,450,000 share options of the Company were exercised at subscription prices of HK$0.35, HK$0.365 and HK$0.54 per share respectively. As a result of the subscription, the Company allotted, issued and fully paid 21,550,000 new Shares of HK$0.01 each. These issued new Shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. 14. SHARE BASED COMPENSATION The Company operates a share option scheme (the “Scheme”) for the purpose of providing incentives and rewards to eligible participants who contribute to the success of the Group’s operations. Eligible participants of the Scheme include the Company’s directors, independent non-executive directors, other employees of the Group, suppliers of goods or services to the Group, customers of the Group, any person or entity that provides research, development or other technological support to the Group and any minority shareholder in the Company’s subsidiaries. The Scheme was adopted on 6 June 2002 and, unless otherwise cancelled or amended, will remain in force for 10 years from that date. The maximum number of unexercised share options currently permitted to be granted under the Scheme is an amount equivalent, upon their exercise, to 10% of the shares of the Company in issue at any time. Pursuant to the extraordinary general meeting passed on 10 March 2006, the general scheme limit of the Company’s share option scheme has been reset to 52,520,000 shares, representing 10% of the Company’s issued share capital on the date of meeting, with the passing of ordinary resolution, which allowing the Company to grant further options carrying the rights to subscribe for a maximum of 52,520,000 shares. The maximum number of shares issuable under share options to each eligible participant in the Scheme within any 12-month period, is limited to 1%, of the shares of the Company in issue at any time. Any further grant of share options in excess of this limit is subject to shareholders’ approval in a general meeting. Share options granted to a director, chief executive or substantial shareholder of the Company, or to any of their associates, are subject to approval in advance by the independent non-executive directors, in addition, any share options granted to a substantial shareholder or an independent non-executive director of the Company, or to any of their associates, in excess of 0.1% of the shares of the Company in issue at any time or with an aggregate value (based on the price of the Company’s shares at the date of the grant) in excess of HK$5 million, within any 12-month period, are subject to shareholders’ approval in advance in a general meeting. – 116 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The offer of a grant of share options may be accepted within 28 days from the date of the offer, upon payment of a nominal consideration of HK$1 in total by the grantee. The exercise period of the share options granted is determinable by the directors, and commences after a certain vesting period and ends on a date which is not later than 10 years from the date of the offer of the share options or the expiry date of the Scheme, if earlier. The exercise price of the share options is determinable by the directors, but may not be less than the higher of: (i) the Stock Exchange closing price of the Company’s shares on the date of the offer of the share options; (ii) the average Stock Exchange closing price of the Company’s shares for the five trading days immediately preceding the date of the offer; and (iii) the nominal value of the shares. Share options do not confer rights on the holders to dividends or to vote at shareholders’ meetings. – 117 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Details of the outstanding share options under the Scheme during the period for the six months ended 30 June 2007 were as follow: Participants Date of grant Number of share options outstanding at 1 January 2007 (’000) Directors Mr. Pang Man Kin, Nixon 7 March 2006 5,000 0.350 Mr. Tsao Ke Wen, Calvin 7 March 2006 500 0.350 Mr. Law Fei Shing 7 March 2006 3,000 0.350 Dr. Ma Chung Wo, Cameron 7 March 2006 500 0.350 Directors of subsidiaries In aggregate 7 March 2006 1,500 0.350 27 November 2006 8,720 0.540 7 March 2006 400 0.350 2 May 2006 3,200 0.365 2 May 2006 3,000 0.365 Other employees In aggregate Exercise price per share HK$ Exercise period 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 Number of Number of share share options options exercised balance during as at the period 30 June 2007 (’000) (’000) Closing price immediately before the date on which the options were granted HK$ 5,000 — 0.350 500 — 0.350 3,000 — 0.350 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 500 — 0.350 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 27 November 2006 to 9 March 2011 1,500 — 0.350 4,450 4,270 0.540 10 March 2006 to 9 March 2011 2 May 2006 to 9 March 2011 400 — 0.350 3,200 — 0.365 3,000 — 0.365 21,550 4,270 Third parties Total 25,820 2 May 2006 to 9 March 2011 Note: All of above share options can be exercised immediately upon acceptance of the offer by the grantee and there were no vesting conditions/period. – 118 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 15. OPERATING LEASE COMMITMENTS At 30 June 2007, the Group had total future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating lease falling due as follows: 30 June Within one year In the second to fifth years, inclusive 16. 31 December 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Audited) HK$’000 HK$’000 1,833 3,474 194 521 2,027 3,995 OPERATING SUB-LEASE ARRANGEMENTS At 30 June 2007, the Group had total future minimum lease receipts under non-cancellable operating sublease falling due as follows: 30 June 31 December 2007 2006 (Unaudited) (Audited) HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year — 822 In the second to fifth years, inclusive — — — 822 – 119 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP NOTES TO THE CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) 17. COMMITMENTS On 27 March 2007, the Group entered into an agreement regarding an investment into a Chinese Foreign Equity Joint Venture Company, Hebei Da Sheng Warranty Company Limited (“Da Sheng”), where the Group would inject US$6,375,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$51,000,000) as capital. The contribution by the Group to the registered capital shall be made in the following manner: (i) US$3,125,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$25,000,000) within three months after the date of signing the agreement, that is 26 June 2007, in which HK$10,000,000 has been injected into Da Sheng, the balance of HK$15,000,000 will be injected; and (ii) US$3,250,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$26,000,000) by the end of two years from the date of issuance of business license of Da Sheng, that is September 2008. 18. POST BALANCE SHEET EVENT (a) On 8 July 2007, the Group entered into the conditional Share Transfer Agreement with Ms Leung Lai Ching, Margaret as the Vendor. Under the Share Transfer Agreement, the wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, Smooth Way International Limited (“Smooth Way”) has agreed to acquire 51% of the entire issued share capital of Kanson Development Limited at completion from the Vendor at the consideration totaling HK$1,000 million in value (Please also refer the Company’s announcement dated 20 July 2007 for further details). (b) On 18 July 2007, the Company entered into a placement agreement between Guotai Junan Securities (Hong Kong) Limited as placing agent, pursuant to which an aggregate of 135,000,000 new ordinary shares were placed by the placing agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis at the price of HK$0.69 per share to six independent investors on 2 August 2007. These issued new shares rank pari passu with other shares in issue in all respects. (Please also refer the Company’s announcement dated 20 July 2007 for further details). – 120 – APPENDIX I 4. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP MANAGEMENT DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2004 The Group’s turnover for the year ended 31 December 2004 was approximately HK$19.6 million, which represented a decrease of 84.6% compared to the previous year. The administrative expenses for the year ended 31 December 2004 were approximately HK$21.2 million, which represented a decrease of 12.3% compared to the expenses incurred last year. The consolidated loss for the year ended 31 December 2004 was approximately HK$77.5 million (2003: HK$31.9 million). Dividend The Directors do not recommend the payment of any dividend for the year ended 31 December 2004 (2003: Nil). Business Review During the year ended 31 December 2004, carpet manufacturing and distribution were the core business. However due to the keen competition in the whole carpet industry in the PRC, the Group recorded a significant decrease in the profits margin and the turnover. Therefore, sales and marketing offices in Beijing, Guangzhou, Fuzhou and branch office in Shanghai were closed. The Hong Kong construction and property markets have sloped down for several years and thus the demand of carpets has subsequently dropped. However, a strong growth and recovery in the property market this year and hotel hospitality upgrade programs led to the increase of demand of carpets in local Hong Kong market. Sales to United States of America were stable, but the profit margin decreased due to the price increase of raw materials which could not be wholly absorbed by the customers. In response to the current competitive environment, the sales and marketing network has been expanded by linking up additional distributors and dealers with the sales efforts into other markets and developing an OEM arrangement with leading rug retailers. Carpet Manufacturing Acquisition On 22 July 2004 the Company, through its indirectly wholly-owned subsidiary, has acquired the remaining 49% minority equity interest in Hui Zhou Orient Carpet Manufacturing Co., Ltd. (“HZOCM”) (formerly known as Hui Yang Xie Kai Cheng Carpet Company Limited) from Shenzhen Hao Sheng He Industrial Company Limited for a total consideration of HK$62 million. HK$47 million was already settled last year in the forms of inventory and trade receivables of the Group. The balance of the consideration of HK$15 million was settled by issuance of 50 million shares of the Company at HK$0.30 per share on 18 January 2005. – 121 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP DNTC Acquisition On 10 September 2004 Orient Carpet Trading Limited, an indirectly wholly-owned subsidiary, entered into the sale and purchase agreement with Mr. Choi Hok Ya and Mr. Ng Yau Wah to purchase 1,020,000 shares of DNTC Investment Limited (now known as International Carpet Co., Limited (“ICC”)), a company incorporated in Hong Kong with the entire issued share capital beneficially owned by Mr. Choi Hok Ya and Mr. Ng Yau Wah, representing 51% of the issued share capital of ICC for a consideration of HK$9,500,000. The consideration of HK$9,500,000 was arrived at arm’s length negotiation between the parties. The Directors believe that the value of ICC lies in its comprehensive range of products and services as well as its experienced marketing team. It specialises in the supply, design, installation, trading and contracting of carpet products. ICC distributes a range of international branded carpet products such as hand-tufted carpets, woven axminster and carpets of Brintons Carpet. Having considered the current operating environment which is highly competitive in terms of pricing and the services and the merits of ICC as described above, the directors consider that ICC’s established sales network and marketing team will assist in boosting the sales of broadloom carpets and carpet tiles manufactured by the Group and strengthening the Group’s marketing position in Hong Kong and the PRC. Capital Reorganisation Pursuant to the special resolution passed at the extraordinary general meeting held on 31 December 2004 that the issued share capital of the Company be reduced by canceling paid-up capital to the extent of HK$0.099 on each existing share of HK$0.10 of the Company in issue as at the effective date of capital reduction on 10 March 2005, so that each such share shall be treated as one fully paid up share of HK$0.001 each. Subject to and forthwith upon the capital reduction and subdivision taking effect, every ten (10) reduced shares be consolidated into one new share with effective on 11 March 2005. Future Plan and Prospects Looking forward, the market demand for carpet products will have stable growth due to the recovery of the property market. However the impact of continuous and frequent increase in raw material cost such as polypropylene and nylon due to unstable oil prices would substantially lower profit margin. To help offset the margin pressure, a higher sales turnover would have to be achieved. The Group will continue to adhere to the strategy of maintaining balanced exposure to both the core carpet business and the new business. The Board will seek any possible ways to raise funds to improve the current tight financial position and to seek new investment. With the new management team embracing experience and knowledge of manufacturing, trading and financing, we strongly believe that we have the necessary skills and expertise to enable us to explore potential investment opportunities that would offer higher returns to shareholders and enhance the group’s growth. – 122 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Liquidity and Financial Resources As at 31 December 2004, the Group had interest-bearing bank borrowings of approximately HK$10 million (2003: HK$40 million) which are repayable within one year, are interest-bearing at the prevailing interest rates and denominated in Hong Kong dollars. The Group’s bank borrowings were secured by (i) corporate guarantees given by the Company and certain subsidiaries of the Group, (ii) pledge of HK$4.3 million fixed deposits of related parties, and HK$1 million fixed deposits of a subsidiary, (iii) personal guarantees executed by a related party and two shareholders of the Company, who also are directors of a subsidiary. As a significant portion of the Group’s sales and purchases were denominated in Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi, the directors considered the Group has no significant exposure to foreign exchange fluctuations in view of the stability of the exchange rates of Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi. The Directors also consider that there will be sufficient cash resources denominated in Hong Kong dollars for the repayment of its bank borrowings. During the year ended 31 December 2004, the Group did not use any hedging instrument. Current and Gearing Ratio As at 31 December 2004, the Group had total assets of approximately HK$175 million (2003: HK$221 million), total liabilities of HK$95 million (2003: HK$76 million), indicating a gearing ratio 0.54 (2003: 0.34) on the basis of total liabilities over total assets. The current ratio of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2004 was 0.74 (2003: 0.78). Contingent Liabilities As at 31 December 2004, the Group did not have any significant contingent liabilities except as described below: 1. A wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, HZOCM has been made defendant of proceeding in the PRC. The proceedings brought by ૯Γജጙۺஉτࠉʔ̇against HZOCM at the People’s Court of the Hui Yang District, Hui Zhou City, Guangdong Province in respect of installation cost due and interest payable. The amount claimed under this set of proceedings were HK$1,420,560 (RMB1,520,000) and interest payable HK$2,077,456 (RMB2,222,878). Freezing orders have been obtained by the plaintiff for this set of proceedings and are in place against certain plant and machinery of HZOCM. The proceedings were adjourned for hearing on a day to be fixed in due course. 2. The Company had provided corporate guarantees to banks for banking facilities provided to certain subsidiaries of approximately HK$20,133,000 (2003: HK$59,710,000). These banking facilities had been utilised to the extent of approximately HK$8,930,000 (2003: HK$39,264,000) as at 31 December 2004. – 123 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Number and Remuneration of Employees The Group had a total of approximately 136 employees in Hong Kong and the PRC as at 31 December 2004. The Group paid remuneration to its staff at competitive levels and in line with industry practice. In addition, the Company has adopted a share option scheme of which the Board may, at its discretion, grant options to employees of the Group. The Company has granted no share options during the year ended 31 December 2004. FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2005 Financial Summary The Group’s turnover for the year ended 31 December 2005 was approximately HK$41.0 million, which represented an increase of 110% compared to the previous year. The administrative expenses for the year ended 31 December 2005 were approximately HK$24.5 million, which represented an increase of 15.6% compared to the expenses incurred last year. The consolidated loss attributable to equity holders of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2005 was increased to approximately HK$91.1 million, as compared to HK$77.4 million in the previous corresponding year. Business Review During the year ended 31 December 2005, carpet manufacturing and trading were the core business. The Group benefited from the revival of the construction and property development markets in Hong Kong and Macau, and the continued growth in the same sector in the PRC. The Company is also witnessing early encouraging results in its efforts to develop distribution channels in the international markets. These resulted in a 110% increase in turnover over the previous corresponding year. However, profit margins continued to be depressed in the intensely competitive environment which the Group operates under. The prices of raw material increased in tandem with the increase in crude oil prices globally. Unfortunately, these additional costs could not be fully passed on to end customers due to the very keen pricing competition in the markets the Group operates in. This is further exacerbated by a one time write off on a substantial overseas receivable of HK$47.9 million and impairment loss of goodwill of approximately HK$35.7 million. Excluding these non recurring events the Group would have registered a very much dramatic decrease in its consolidated losses attributable to the equity holders of the Company from HK$77.4 million for the previous corresponding year to HK$7.5 million for the financial year ended 31 December 2005. The Company intends to continue its efforts to improve the turnover and profitability of its core business. In addition, the management team shall seek to identify opportunities that will help the Group diversify its reliance on the contributions from its carpet business which is expected to remain robust but fiercely competitive. – 124 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Logistic and Financial Management System Acquisition On 3 December 2005 the Company, through its indirectly wholly-owned subsidiary, Aurora Logistic Software Development Limited, entered into a conditional acquisition agreement (the “Acquisition Agreement”) to acquire the Logistic and Financial Management System from China National Materials Storage and Transportation Guangzhou Corp. for a total consideration of RMB6,000,000. The consideration for the sale and purchase of the Logistic and Financial Management System shall be satisfied by paying cash of RMB2,500,000 (approximately HK$2,404,000) and issuing 10,615,827 shares of the Company for the remaining RMB3,500,000 (approximately HK$3,365,000). Upon completion, the Company believes the acquisition will help reduce the lead time and costs involved in the sale and trading of carpets in the areas of storage, transport, distribution, import and export. The Company is cautiously optimistic of the potential of the logistics software market in the PRC, and that this acquisition, whilst complementary, will also help the Group diversify its sources of revenue. Future Plan and Prospects The growth of the construction and property development market in the PRC is expected to contribute to as well as benefit from the continued national GDP growth. Economists estimate that the “2008 Olympic Games” in Beijing alone would benefit PRC’s GDP by an additional one per cent. With this as the backdrop, the Company intends to capitalise on the spill over effect to the carpet industry, whilst trying at the same time to strike an equilibrium against the decreasing profit margin trend. Having undergone three major capital raising exercises in 2005 which raised net proceeds of approximately HK$78.4 million, the Group is now in a much improved financial position. It is the management’s intention to leverage on this financial strength to explore new potential investment opportunities in view of the very competitive market environment which its carpet business operate within. With the view of enhancing the group’s growth and offering higher returns to shareholders, the Group will continue to be prudent in its approach, and will strive to maintain a balanced exposure to both the core carpet business and any new investment opportunities Strengthening The Capital Base An open offer to raise funds by issuing 69,500,000 offer shares at the price of HK$0.20 per offer share on the basis of one offer share for every two new shares held on 10 March 2005 was completed on 14 April 2005. Net proceeds from the open offer was approximately HK$13 million, of which approximately HK$9.1 million was applied to repay outstanding indebtedness and the remaining balance of approximately HK$3.9 million used as general working capital of the Group. – 125 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Raising Further Capital On 20 October 2005, Prime Orient International Limited (“POIL”) entered into the placing and subscription Agreement pursuant to which a placing agent agreed with POIL to place up to 41,700,000 shares at the placing price of HK$0.79 per placing share on behalf of POIL to not less than six individual investors who were third parties independent of the Company and its connected persons on a best effort basis. Immediately after the completion of the aforesaid placing, the Company issued 41,700,000 new ordinary shares at HK$0.79 per share to POIL on 3 November 2005. POIL is wholly and beneficially owned by Mr. Lam Shu Chung, a substantial shareholder and executive director of the Company. The aforesaid placing broadened the capital and shareholder base of the Company, and the subscription raised net proceeds of approximately HL$32.4 million for repayment of the Group’s indebtedness, working capital and future business development requirements of the Group. As at 31 December 2005, the Group had interest-bearing bank borrowings of approximately HK$2 million (2004: HK$10 million) which are repayable within one year, are interest-bearing at the prevailing interest rates and denominated in Hong Kong dollars. The Group’s bank borrowings were secured by (i) a pledge of HK$2 million fixed deposits of a subsidiary, and (ii) personal guarantee executed by a director of the subsidiary. As a significant portion of the Group’s sales and purchases were denominated in Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi, the directors considered the Group has no significant exposure to foreign exchange fluctuations in view of the stability of the exchange rates of Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi. During the year under review, the Group did not use any hedging instrument. Current and Gearing Ratio As at 31 December 2005, the Group has total assets of approximately HK$110 million (2004: HK$175 million), total liabilities of HK$25 million (2004: HK$95 million), indicating a gearing ratio 0.23 (2004: 0.54) on the basis of total liabilities over total assets. The current ratio of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2005 was 1.23 (2004: 0.74). Contingent Liabilities As at 31 December 2005, the Company Group did not have any significant contingent liabilities except as described below: A wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company namely HZOCM has been made a defendant of a proceeding in the PRC. The proceedings were brought by ૯Γജጙۺஉτࠉʔ̇qagainst HZOCM at the Peoples Court of the Hui Yang District, Hui Zhou City, Guangdong Province in respect of installation cost due and interest payable. The amount claimed under this set of proceedings was HK$1,461,000 (RMB1,520,000) and interest payable of HK$2,137,000 (RMB2,223,000). HK$1,461,000 was provided in the Group’s financial statements. No provision was made on the interest payable of HK$2,137,000 as in the option of the directors, this probably will not require an outflow of resources of the Group. The proceedings were adjourned for hearing on a day to be fixed. – 126 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Employee Information As at 31 December 2005, the Group employed a total of 141 (2004: 136) full-time employees, mostly at the Group’s subsidiary factories for manufacturing carpets. The Group’s emolument policies are formulated on the performance of individual employees and are reviewed annually in line with industry practice. The Group also provides provident fund schemes (as the case may be) to its employees depending on the location of such employees. Shares Option Scheme The Company adopted a share option scheme (the “Share Option Scheme”) pursuant to an ordinary resolution passed by the shareholders of the Company on 6 June 2002. The purpose of the Share Option Scheme is to provide incentives or rewards to participants for their contributions to the Group and/or to enable the Group to recruit and retain high-caliber employees and attract human resources that are valuable to the Group. The shareholders of the Company have approved the refreshment of the general scheme limit on the grant of options under the Share Option Scheme on the extraordinary general meeting held on 10 March 2006. The general scheme limit has been reset to 52,520,000 shares, allowing the Company to grant further options carrying the rights to subscribe for a maximum of 52,520,000 shares. The Company did not grant any share options during the year ended 31 December 2005. Change of Auditor Grant Thornton Certified Public Accountants was appointed as the auditors of the Company and of its subsidiaries with effect from 16 September 2005 to fill the vacancy left by RSM Nelson Wheeler, which was not reappointed at the Company’s annual general meeting on 30 June 2006, and to hold office until the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company. Dividend The Directors do not recommend the payment of any dividend for the year ended 31 December 2005 (2004: Nil). – 127 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP FOR THE YEAR ENDED 31 DECEMBER 2006 BUSINESS REVIEW During the year ended 31 December 2006, carpet manufacturing and trading were the core business of the Group. However the Group reported a decrease in turnover and a net loss. The turnover of the Group was substantially decreased mainly due to the kin market competition in Hong Kong and PRC. Profit margins continued to be depressed in the intensely competitive environment which the Group operates under. The prices of raw material increased in tandem with the increase in crude oil prices globally and the appreciation of Renminbi. Unfortunately, these additional costs could not be fully passed on to end customers due to the very keen pricing competition in the markets of the Group operates in. In addition, the Group provided additional provision for VAT and corresponding penalties payable of the amount HK$8.9 million arising in previous year from 1998 to 2003. The Group continued to focus on the existing business carpet manufacturing and distribution to take productive approach to improve profitability and market share. In addition the Group had acquired a carpet trading subsidiary in March 2007 to strengthen the base of core business. On the other hand, the Group is looking into the opportunity of Logistic business as well as exploring more investment to offer sustainable growth the new business. LOGISTIC AND FINANCIAL MANAGEMENT SYSTEM On 3 December 2005, the Group entered into an acquisition agreement with China National Materials Storage and Transportation Guangzhou Corp (the “vendor”) to purchase the Logistic and Financial Management System at a total consideration RMB6,000,000 (equivalent to approximately HK$5,769,000) which was satisfied (i) as to RMB3,500,000 (approximately HK$3,365,000) by issuing of 10,516,827 shares of the Company, and (ii) to RMB2,500,000 (approximately HK$2,404,000) for cash. On 24 November 2006, the Group and the vendor have entered into a revised acquisition agreement which amended the consideration from HK$6,000,000 to HK$3,000,000. The consideration should be settled in cash based on the revised terms. INVESTMENT INTO HEBEI DA SHENG WARRANTY COMPANY According to the Company’s announcement dated 29 March 2007, the Board announced that on 27 March 2007, Aurora Logistic Capital Assurance Limited (“Aurora Logistic”), a whollyowned subsidiary of the Company, entered into an agreement with Liaohai International Investments Limited (“Liaohai”) and Hebei Da Sheng Warranty Company (“Da Sheng”), a company incorporated in Zhangjiakou, Hebei Province, PRC in connection with the investment into Da Sheng which engages in logistic, investment and project guarantee business. Pursuant to the Agreement, Aurora Logistic shall contribute US$6,375,000 (equivalent to approximately RMB51,000,000) to acquire 51% of the equity interests of Da Sheng. – 128 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Da Sheng, when it commences its business, will be principally engaged in logistic, investment and project guarantee business in Zhangjiakou, Hebei Province, PRC. Da Sheng will provide commodity based financing to the enterprises so that enterprises can obtain additional credit limit from the financial institutions. In principle, Da Sheng will act as the guarantor of the enterprise to guarantee the enterprise’s repayment obligations to the financial institutions thereby allowing the enterprise to obtain additional credit limit. Da Sheng will receive a guarantee fee from the enterprise based on a certain percentage of the loan advanced by the financial institution to the enterprise. Da Sheng will also require the enterprise to provide commodity collateral to Da Sheng. Accordingly, Da Sheng can assist medium to large enterprises to obtain loans from financial institutions for developing mineral processing operations by providing guarantees to such financial institutions. The Group’s investment in Da Sheng can diversify the Group’s business and since Da Sheng will base on a leveraged operation with a guarantee/lending multiplier, a stable profit and steady cash flow and return on investment will be expected during the initial year of operation. As a result, the steady growth of profit and development of Da Sheng will contribute financially to the Group in future. Strategic Cooperation Agreement According to the Company’s announcement dated 27 November 2006, the Board also announced that on 24 November, 2006, the Company entered into a legally binding strategic cooperation agreement with CMST (the “Strategic Cooperation Agreement”). Under the Strategic Cooperation Agreement, CMST will mainly be responsible for the custody and storage of pledged assets and providing control and management services in respect of the pledged assets in Mainland China. The Group will, through its subsidiary (“Guarantee Company”), be responsible for providing guarantee services to customers, liaising and/or introducing mortgagees or financial institutions to potential customers in Mainland China. CMST will also assist the Group to develop a logistic finance/banking business by utilizing its existing excellent business networks with major banks and/or financial institutions in Mainland China. For each of the transactions conducted through the cooperation between the Company and CMST, the relevant parties (i.e. the Guarantee Company, CMST, the bank or financial institution and the customer) will sign an agreement whereby CMST will charge the Guarantee Company a custodian and management service fee based on the guarantee amount and the Guarantee Company will charge the customer (i.e. the borrowing enterprise), a guarantee fee. Acquistion of a 70% Equity Interest in Win Alliance Development Limited On 8 December 2006, Wise Mount Management Limited (“Wise Mount”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company entered into an agreement with a third party to, pursuant to which, the Vendor has conditionally agreed to sell and Wise Mount has agreed to purchase 700,000 shares in Win Alliance Development Limited (“Win Alliance”), representing 70% of the entire issued share capital of Win Alliance, for an aggregate consideration of HK$14,000,000. Please refer the Company’s announcement and circular dated 14 December 2006 and 2 January 2007 respectively for more details. – 129 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP The Acquisition was completed on 2 March 2007. The Board believed that the Acquisition will enable the Group to expand its existing core business of manufacturing and trading of carpets and may also provide the Group with valuable customer base, which is principally engaged in trading of seamless steel pipes and steel, for developing its logistic financial business in PRC. Future Plan and Prospects The principal business of the Group is engaged in the design, manufacture and sale of a wide range of carpets under its own brand name and the trading of carpets of various brand names. By acquiring 70% of the entire issued share capital of Win Alliance, which will enable the Group to expand its existing core business of manufacturing and trading of carpets. The Group also intends to diversify its bisiness by acquiring 51% of Da Sheng, a company incorporated in Zhangjiakou, Hebei Province, PRC. The principal business of Da Sheng will be to support the enterprises by acting as the guarantor of the enterprise and to secure bank finance by providing guarantees to the financial institutions to secure the credit facilities to these enterprises thereby allowing the enterprise to obtain additional credit limit. Da Sheng will receive an all-in-fee from the enterprise based on a certain percentage of the loan advanced by the financial institution to the enterprise. Da Sheng will also require the enterprise to provide commodity as collateral to Da Sheng. If the completion is taken place, it is expected that both the assets and liabilities of the Group will increase. In addition this project will contribute a steady return to the Group in the future. Raising Further Capital On 5 March 2007, the Company entered into the Placing Agreement with the Placing Agent pursuant to which an aggregate of 87,000,000 new shares were placed by the Placing Agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis, at the price of HK$0.308 per Placing Share with six independent investors who were third parties independent of the Company and its connected persons. Immediately after the completion of the aforesaid placing, the Company issued 87,000,000 new ordinary shares at HK$0.308 per share to the six independent investors on 16 March 2007. The aforesaid placing broadened the capital and shareholder base of the Company, and the net proceeds of the Placing of approximately HK$26 million will be applied as to approximately HK$18 million for working capital and the balance to new investment opportunities. Financial Summary The Group’s turnover for the year ended 31 December 2006 was approximately HK$26.5million, which represented a decrease of 35% compared to the previous year. The administrative expenses for the year ended 31 December 2006 were approximately HK$38.3 million, which represented an increase of 56% compared to the expenses incurred last year. The consolidated loss attributable to equity holders of the Company for the year ended 31 December 2006 was decreased to approximately HK$46.2 million, as compared to HK$91.1 million in the previous year. – 130 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP As a significant portion of the Group’s sales and purchases were denominated in Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi, the Directors considered the Group has no significant exposure to foreign exchange fluctuations in view of the stability of the exchange rates of Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi. During the year ended 31 December 2006, the Group did not use any hedging instrument. Current and Gearing Ratio As at 31 December 2006, the Group had total assets of approximately HK$101 million (2005: HK$110 million), total liabilities of HK$38 million (2005: HK$25 million), indicating a gearing ratio 0.37 (2005: 0.23) on the basis of total liabilities over total assets. The current ratio of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2006 was 0.49 (2005: 1.23). Charges on Assets As at 31 December 2006, the Group had not interest-bearing bank borrowings and no assets were pledged (2005: HK$2 million). At 31 December 2005, the Group’s bank borrowings were secured by time deposit of HK$2,031,000. Contingent Liabilities As at 31 December 2006, the Group did not have any contingent liabilities. Employee Information As at 31 December 2006, the Group employed approximately 139 full-time employees (2005: 141), mostly at the Group’s subsidiary factories for manufacturing carpets. The Group’s emolument policies are formulated on the performance of individual employees and are reviewed annually in line with industry practice. The Group also provides provident fund schemes (as the case may be) to its employees depending on the location of such employees. Dividend The Directors do not recommend the payment of any dividend for the year ended 31 December 2006 (2005: Nil). – 131 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP FOR THE SIX MONTHS ENDED 30 JUNE 2007 Business review and outlook For the six months period ended 30 June 2007, the Group’s turnover and net loss were approximately HK$17 million (2006: HK$11 million) and HK$23.94 million (2006: HK$32.29 million) respectively. The turnover of the Group was substantially increased by approximately 58.7% as compared to the corresponding period of last year and this increase was mainly due to acquire a subsidiary of trading of other goods and improved by Hong Kong economic growth. The Group continued to focus on the existing business CARPET MANUFACTURING AND DISTRIBUTION to take productive approach to review and strengthen for its future growth and improve profitability. In the meantime, the Group invested LOGISTIC AND FINANCE BUSINESS in Da Sheng which will board the source of the income and contribute steady profit in the future. Carpet Manufacturing and Distribution For the six months period ended 30 June 2007, the Group’s turnover was HK$14 million, compared with approximately HK$11 million for the same period last year, an increase of about 27.3% and the loss of the segment is HK$11.7 million as compared with HK$17.4 million for the same period last year. For the first half of 2007, the Group continued to engage in the manufacturing and distribution of carpets. During the Period, although the Group benefited from the revival of the construction and property development markets in Hong Kong and Macau’s booming casino and resort markets, and the continued growth in the same sector in PRC, the Group still recorded a net loss of its business due to the intensive competition of the carpet industry. Furthermore, the prices of raw material increased in tandem with the increase in crude oil prices globally and these additional costs could not be fully passed on to end customers due to the very keen pricing competition in the markets the Group operates in. The Group will enhance product development and technology innovation and raising product value with the aim of increasing the profit margin of products and exercised tight control of incremental selling expenses. Moreover, the Group will try to reduce the effect brought by the floatation of oil price by reinforcing procurement management. Trading of Other Goods In March 2007, the Group acquired 70% interest of Win Alliance Development Limited which enable the Group to expand the trading of seamless steel and other goods business to diversify the Group’s source of income. For the six months period ended 30 June 2007, the turnover of the segment was HK$3 million (2006: Nil) and the loss of the segment is HK$356,000 (2006: Nil). The Group will try to improve the gross profit of trading and further explore the customer base to contribute a profit in the future. – 132 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Logistic and Financial Business In July 2007, the Group acquired 51% interest of Hebei Da Sheng Warranty Company Limited (“Da Sheng”), The principal business of Da Sheng is to support the enterprises by acting as guarantor of the enterprise and to secure bank finance by providing guarantees to the financial institutional to secure the credit facilities to these enterprises thereby allowing the enterprise to obtain additional credit limit. At the beginning of the operation, Da Sheng incurs administrative expenses and does not offer a very exciting profit profile. Nevertheless, the management of Da Sheng will dedicate more resources to attract more prospective target customers and will work diligently to achieve the goal in order to generate a profit to the Group in the coming future. Liquidity and financial resources Based on the unaudited management account for the six months ended 30 June 2007, the Group’s total current assets were HK$113 million and its total current liabilities were HK$51 million. As at 30 June 2007, the Group cash and bank balances were amounted to HK$89 million (31 December 2006: HK$776,000). The Group recorded the net current assets was HK$62 million. Current and gearing ratio As at 30 June 2007, the Group had total assets of HK$211 million (31 December 2006: HK$ 100.5 million), total liabilities of HK$60 million (31 December 2006: HK$37.7 million), indicating a gearing ratio of 0.28 (31 December 2006: 0.37) on the basis of total liabilities over total assets. The current ratio of the Group for the Period was 2.21 (31 December 2006: 0.49). Number and remuneration of employees The Group total number of employees was approximately 141 employees (2006: 140) in Hong Kong and PRC for the period ended 30 June 2007. The Group recognized the importance of maintaining good working relationships with its employees and accordingly, strives to maintain remunerations at competitive levels and in line with industry practice. The Company adopted a share option scheme (the “Share Option Scheme”) pursuant to an ordinary resolution passed by the shareholders of the Company on 6 June 2002. The purpose of the Share Option Scheme is to provide incentives or rewards to participants for their contributions to the Group and to enable the Group to recruit and retain high-caliber employees and attract human resources that are valuable to the Group. Foreign currency exposure The Group did not have any significant exposure to and did not hedge against risks associated with foreign currency fluctuation. – 133 – APPENDIX I FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP Contingent liabilities As at 30 June 2007, the Group did not have any significant contingent liabilities. 5. INDEBTEDNESS, LIQUIDITY AND FINANCIAL RESOURCES At the close of business on 31 August 2007 (being the latest practicable date for the purpose of this indebtedness statement prior to the printing of this circular), the Enlarged Group had unsecured loans of approximately HK$3.6 million and obligation under finance lease of HK$249,080. As at 31 August 2007, the Enlarged Group does not have any mortgages, charges, contingent liabilities or guarantees. Save as aforesaid or as otherwise disclosed herein, and apart from intra-group liabilities, the Enlarged Group did not have outstanding at the close of business on 31 August 2007 any loan capital issued and outstanding or agreed to be issued, bank overdrafts, loans or other similar indebtedness, liabilities under acceptances or acceptable credits, debentures, mortgages, charges, hire purchases commitments, guarantees or other material contingent liabilities. The Group’s monetary assets, liabilities and transactions are mainly denominated in Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi. As Hong Kong dollars is pegged to United States dollars, and there is no significant fluctuation in the exchange rate between Hong Kong dollars and Renminbi, the Group believes that its risk of exposure to exchange rate is not high. 6. EMPLOYEES As at 31 August 2007, the Group had approximately 145 full-time employees in Hong Kong and the PRC. The remuneration committee and the management review the remuneration policy regularly on the basis of performance and experience of the employees as well as the prevailing industry practice. The Group also provides various training courses on relevant business or skills for the management and staff at all levels. Pension contributions are made by the Group for its PRC employees in accordance with the relevant PRC laws. Insurance and mandatory provident fund schemes are also effected for its Hong Kong staff. The Company operates a the Share Option Scheme whereby the Board may at their absolute discretion, grant options to employees and executive Directors of the Company and any of its subsidiaries to subscribe for shares in the Company. The subscription price, exercisable period and the maximum number of options to be granted are determined in accordance with the prescribed terms of the Share Option Scheme. – 134 – APPENDIX I 7. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP WORKING CAPITAL With regard to the capital investment to bring the Target Mine to commercial production, the Company intends to finance the same by the Company’s internal resources, bank borrowings, and if considered appropriate, proceeds from any future fund raising activity of the Company. The Company has appointed Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited as its financial advisor to advise the Company on the fund raising, which is intended to be finalized subsequent to the completion of the mine feasibility study. The capital investment shall be significantly contingent on the results of those fund raising activities, after the completion of the mine feasibility study. The Directors have also included a paragraph about the significant and continuous capital investment required by the Target Mine under the paragraph headed “Risk factor(s)” in the letter from the Board in this circular. The estimated funds required of the Group for the two years following the issue of this circular is RMB1,080,000,000, in order to bring the Mineral Resources of the Target Mine into commercial production, which includes the funds required to obtain the Mining Licence and to conduct a drilling program to further exploit the proven reserves of the Target Mine. As it will typically take 12 months to 18 months to establish the mining operation upon obtaining of the Mining Licence, the Target Mine is not expected to generate any revenue for at least the next 12 months from the date of this circular. Other than the above, the Directors are of the opinion that, taking into account the internal resources available to the Group, the Enlarged Group will have sufficient working capital to continue to operate in next 24 months from the date of this circular in the absence of unforeseen circumstances. – 135 – APPENDIX I 8. FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE GROUP MATERIAL ADVERSE CHANGE The Directors are not aware of any material adverse change in the financial or trading position of the Group since 31 December 2006, being the date of which the latest audited financial statements of the Group were made up. 9. BUSINESS PROSPECTS Trend of business of the Group The principal business of the Group is the design, manufacture and sale of a wide range of carpets under its own brand name and the trading of carpets of various brand names since 31 December 2006, being the date of which the latest audited financial statements of the Group were made up. In March 2007, the Group acquired 70% of entire issued share capital of Win Alliance, which will enable the Group to expand its existing core business of manufacturing of trading of carpets. In addition, the Group acquired 51% of entire issued share capital of Da Sheng, a company incorporated in Zhangjiakou, Hebei Province, the PRC in July 2007. The principal business of Da Sheng will be to support enterprises (not connected or otherwise related to the Group) by acting as their guarantor so as to secure credit facilities from financial institutions by providing guarantees to the financial institutions and thereby allowing those enterprises to obtain additional credit limit. Da Sheng will receive an all-in-fee from those enterprises based on a certain percentage of the loan advanced by the financial institutions to those enterprises. Da Sheng will also require those enterprises to provide commodity as collateral to Da Sheng. If the business is commenced, it is expected that Da Sheng will contribute a steady return to and will diversify the sources of income of the Group in the future in terms of the said all-in-fee. Trading and financial prospects of the Enlarged Group The Directors consider that the Group may broaden its source of income by diversifying into the exploration and mining of natural resources. The Directors believe that the demand for metals such as iron, titanium and vanadium will be considerable given the fact that the economy of the PRC will grow rapidly, and therefore the national consumption of such metals will rise in the near future. Further, the prices of such metals have been rising over the past years. Since the Target Mine contains substantial reserves of the said metals, the Directors believe that the Acquisition will bring satisfactory returns to the Group. – 136 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP The following is the text of a report on the Target Company, prepared for the sole purpose of inclusion in this circular, received from the independent reporting accountants, Grant Thornton. The Directors Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Suites 5303-04, 53/F Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road Wanchai Hong Kong Dear Sirs, We set out below our report on the combined financial information of Kanson Development Limited (the “Target Company”) and its subsidiaries (hereinafter collectively referred to as the “Target Group”) including the balance sheets of the Target Group as at 31 December 2004, 2005 and 2006 and 30 June 2007, income statements, cash flow statements and statements of changes in equity for the period from 8 April 2004 (being the date of incorporation of one of its subsidiaries, Qinghai Forest Source Mining Industry Development Company Limited (ࣵڇᘊพೕτࠉʔ̇) (“Qinghai Senyuan”) to 31 December 2004, each of the two years ended 31 December 2005 and 2006 and the six months ended 30 June 2007 (the “Relevant Periods”) and notes thereto, together with the unaudited combined financial information of the Target Group including the income statement, cash flow statement and statement of changes in equity for the six months ended 30 June 2006 (the “30 June 2006 Corresponding Information”), prepared for inclusion in the circular (the “Circular”) dated 15 October 2007 issued by Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (the “Company”) in connection with the very substantial acquisition: acquisition of interests in a company involving issue of consideration shares and convertible bonds (the “Acquisition”) . The Target Company was incorporated in the British Virgin Islands with limited liability on 12 July 2005 with an authorised share capital of US$50,000 divided into 50,000 ordinary shares of US$1 each. The registered office of the Target Company is at P.O. Box 3444, Road Town, Tortola, British Virgin Islands and its principal place of business is located at Units 3-4, 15th Floor, Goldfield Industrial Centre, 1 Sui Wo Road, Fotan, Shatin, New Territories, Hong Kong. Pursuant to a reorganisation (the “Reorganisation”) as detailed in subsection headed “Reorganisation” in Letter from the Board of the Circular, the Target Company became the holding company of the subsidiaries now comprising the Target Group at the completion of the Reorganisation. – 137 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP The principal activity of the Target Company is investment holding. As at the date of this report, the Target Company has the following subsidiaries: Name of subsidiaries Nominal value of issued and fully paid ordinary/ registered capital Date and place of incorporation/ establishment Principal place of operation Attributable interest held by the Target Company Principal activities Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited ࠗಋᘊพઁٖ τࠉʔ̇ (“Hong Kong FSMI”) HK$20,000,000 26 September 2005, Hong Kong Hong Kong 100% Investment holding Qinghai Senyuan# HK$18,312,000 8 April 2004, The People’s Republic of China (the “PRC”) The PRC 100%* Exploration of mine * equity interest indirectly held by the Target Company # The unoffical English translation is for identification purpose only No audited financial statements have been prepared for the Target Company since its date of incorporation as there are no statutory audit requirements. No audit has been performed on the management accounts of Hong Kong FSMI as it was newly incorporated on 26 September 2005. The financial statements of Qinghai Senyuan were prepared in accordance with the relevant accounting rules and regulations applicable to enterprises in the PRC. Qinghai Senyuan has adopted 31 December as its financial year-end date. The financial statements of Qinghai Senyuan for the years ended 31 December 2005 and 2006 were audited by ڌړࣵڇผ߮ԑ৻ֺτࠉʔ̇ (“Qinghai Baoxin Certified Public Accountant Co., Ltd”) (for identification purpose only), a firm of certified public accountants registered in the PRC. No audited financial statements have been prepared for the periods from 8 April 2004 (date of establishment) to 31 December 2006 and for the six months ended 30 June 2007. For the purpose of this report, the director of the Target Company has prepared the combined financial statements (the “Underlying Financial Statements”) of the Target Group for the Relevant Periods in accordance with Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards (“HKFRS”). We have, for the purpose of this report, carried out appropriate audit procedures in respect of the Underlying Financial Statements of the Target Company for the Relevant Periods, in accordance with Hong Kong Standards on Auditing issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (the “HKICPA”). – 138 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP The financial information and the notes thereto for the Relevant Periods (the “Financial Information”) as set out in this report has been prepared by the director of the Target Company based on the Underlying Financial Statements and in accordance with HKFRSs. For the purpose of this report, we have examined the Financial Information of the Target Group and carried out such additional procedures as are necessary in accordance with Auditing Guideline 3.340 “Prospectuses and the Reporting Accountant” issued by the HKICPA. The director of the Target Company is responsible for the preparation of the Underlying Financial Statements and the Financial Information which gives a true and fair view. The directors of the Company are responsible for the contents of the Circular in which this report is included. In preparing the Financial Information which gives a true and fair view, it is fundamental that appropriate accounting policies are selected and applied consistently. It is our responsibility to form an independent opinion, based on our examination, on the Financial Information and to report our opinion to you. In our opinion, the Financial Information, for the purpose of this report, gives a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Target Group and the Target Company as at 31 December 2004, 2005 and 2006 and 30 June 2007 and of the combined results and combined cash flows of the Target Group for each of the Relevant Periods. For the purpose of this report, we have reviewed the 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information, which are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in Hong Kong and for which the director of the Target Company is responsible, in accordance with Statement of Auditing Standard 700 “Engagements to review interim financial reports” issued by the HKICPA. Our review consisted principally of making enquiries of management and applying analytical procedures to the 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information and based thereon assessing whether the accounting policies and presentation have been consistently applied unless otherwise disclosed. A review excludes audit procedures such as tests of controls and verification of assets, liabilities and transactions. It is substantially less in scope than an audit and therefore provides a lower level of assurance than an audit. Accordingly we do not express an audit opinion on the 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information. For the purpose of this report and on the basis of our review of the 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information, which does not constitute an audit, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to the unaudited 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information. Emphasis of matter — fundamental uncertainty relating to going concern basis Without qualifying our opinion, we draw attention to note 2 in Section II to Underlying Financial Statements which discloses that as at 30 June 2007, the Target Group had deficit in equity of approximately HK$18,750,000 (30 June 2006: HK$2,053,000) and the Target Group also incurred a loss attributable to equity holder of the Company of approximately HK$5,991,000 (30 June 2006: HK$2,976,000) for the six months then ended. These conditions, along with other matters as disclosed in note 2 in Section II to the Financial Information, indicate the existence of a material uncertainty which may cast significant doubt about the Target Group’s ability to continue as a going concern. – 139 – APPENDIX IIA I. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP FINANCIAL INFORMATION COMBINED INCOME STATEMENTS Notes Revenue 4 Bank interest income Administrative expenses Loss before income tax Income tax expense Loss for the period/year 5 6 From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 Year ended 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (unaudited) — — — — — 1 (1,150) 1 (1,703) 13 (9,793) 5 (5,996) 12 (2,988) (1,149) — (1,702) — (9,780) — (5,991) — (2,976) — (1,149) (1,702) (9,780) (5,991) (2,976) – 140 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP COMBINED BALANCE SHEETS Notes 2004 HK$’000 As at 31 December As at 30 June 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 ASSETS AND LIABILITIES Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Intangible assets – “exploration and evaluation assets” 9 1,442 1,188 1,709 1,923 10 1,579 2,536 8,505 12,243 3,021 3,724 10,214 14,166 122 20 22 247 544 229 797 222 142 269 773 1,019 1,096 1,719 1,308 2,167 4,103 15,961 2,471 31,464 2,815 3,475 20,064 33,935 Net current liabilities (2,673) (3,206) (19,291) (32,916) Net assets/(liabilities) 348 518 (9,077) (18,750) 1,512 (1,164) 3,351 (2,833) 3,501 (12,578) — (18,750) 348 518 (9,077) (18,750) Current assets Deposits, prepayments and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents Current liabilities Other payables and accruals Amounts due to a shareholder EQUITY Equity attributable to the equity holder of the Target Company Share capital Reserves 12 13 14 15 16 Total equity – 141 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP BALANCE SHEET Notes 2004 HK$’000 As at 31 December As at 30 June 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 ASSETS AND LIABILITIES Non-current assets Interests in a subsidiary 11 — — — 20,000 Current liabilities Amounts due to a shareholder 14 — 5 9 20,009 Net current liabilities — (5) (9) (20,009) Net liabilities — (5) (9) (9) — — — (5) — (9) — (9) — (5) (9) (9) EQUITY Share capital Accumulated losses 15 16 Total equity – 142 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP COMBINED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN EQUITY The Target Group Share capital HK$’000 Exchange reserve HK$’000 Accumulated losses HK$’000 Total HK$’000 At 8 April 2004 Currency translation — — — (15) — — — (15) Net expenses recognised directly in equity Loss for the period — — (15) — — (1,149) (15) (1,149) Total recognised income and expenses for the period Capital injection to Qinghai Senyuan — 1,512 (15) — (1,149) — (1,164) 1,512 At 31 December 2004 and at 1 January 2005 Currency translation 1,512 — (15) 33 (1,149) — 348 33 — — 33 — — (1,702) 33 (1,702) Total recognised income and expenses for the year Capital injection to Qinghai Senyuan — 1,839 33 — (1,702) — (1,669) 1,839 At 31 December 2005 and at 1 January 2006 Currency translation 3,351 — 18 35 (2,851) — 518 35 — — 35 — — (9,780) 35 (9,780) — 150 35 — (9,780) — (9,745) 150 3,501 — 53 (181) (12,631) — (9,077) (181) — — (181) — — (5,991) (181) (5,991) — 800 (181) — (5,991) — (6,172) 800 (4,301) — — (4,301) — (128) (18,622) (18,750) Net income recognised directly in equity Loss for the year Net income recognised directly in equity Loss for the year Total recognised income and expenses for the year Capital injection to Qinghai Senyuan At 31 December 2006 and at 1 January 2007 Currency translation Net expenses recognised directly in equity Loss for the period Total recognised income and expenses for the period Capital injection to Qinghai Senyuan Elimination of share capital of Hong Kong FSMI and Qinghai Senyuan upon Reorganisation At 30 June 2007 – 143 – APPENDIX IIA ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP COMBINED CASH FLOW STATEMENTS From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 Notes HK$’000 Cash flows from operating activities Loss before income tax Adjustments for: Interest income Depreciation of property, plant and equipment 9 Year ended 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) (1,149) (1,702) (9,780) (5,991) (2,976) (1) (1) (13) (5) (12) 188 338 522 319 236 (962) (1,365) (9,271) (5,677) (2,752) Operating loss before working capital changes (Increase)/Decrease in deposits, prepayments and other receivables Increase/(Decrease) in other payables and accruals Increase in amounts due to a shareholder (122) 100 (522) (253) (442) 1,096 1,719 212 448 2,795 13,794 (1,632) 15,503 402 3,989 Cash generated from/(used in) operations and net cash generated from/ (used in) operating activities 1,731 (605) 6,796 7,941 1,197 Cash flows from investing activities Purchase of property, plant and equipment Expenditure in exploration and evaluation costs Investment in subsidiaries Interest received (1,630) (42) (996) (533) (870) (1,579) — 1 (911) — 1 (5,867) — 13 (3,738) (4,301) 5 (462) — 12 Net cash used in investing activities (3,208) (952) (6,850) (8,567) (1,320) Cash flows from financing activities Capital injection to Qinghai Senyuan 1,512 1,839 150 800 150 Net cash generated from financing activities 1,512 1,839 150 800 150 Net increase in cash and cash equivalents 35 282 96 174 27 Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of the year/period — 20 247 229 247 Effect of foreign exchange rate changes (15) (55) (114) (181) (114) Cash and cash equivalents at end of the year/period 20 247 229 222 160 20 247 229 222 160 Analysis of the balances of cash and cash equivalents, representing Bank balances and cash at end of the year/period 12 – 144 – APPENDIX IIA II ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP NOTES TO THE COMBINED FINANCIAL INFORMATION AND THE 30 JUNE 2006 CORRESPONDING INFORMATION 1. BASIS OF PRESENTATION The Financial Information and the 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information set out in this report have been prepared in accordance with all applicable HKFRSs, which include all applicable individual Hong Kong Financial Reporting Standards, Hong Kong Accounting Standards and Interpretations issued by the HKICPA and have been consistently applied throughout the Relevant Periods. The Target Group is regarded as a continuing entity resulting from the Reorganisation since all companies within the Target Group were under common control before and immediately after the Reorganisation. Consequently, immediately after the Reorganisation, there was a continuation of the risks and benefits to the ultimate shareholder that existed prior to the Reorganisation. The Reorganisation has been accounted for as a reorganisation under common control in a manner similar to pooling of interests. Accordingly, the combined financial information has been prepared on the basis of merger accounting. The Financial Information and the 30 June 2006 Corresponding Information also comply with the applicable disclosure requirements of the Hong Kong Companies Ordinance and the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited. 2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES Adoption of new and amended HKFRSs The Target Group has not early adopted the following HKFRSs that have been issued but are not yet effective. The director of the Target Company is currently assessing the impact of these HKFRSs but are not yet in a position to state whether they would have material financial impact on the Target Group’s financial statements. HK(IFRIC) Int 11 Group and Treasury Share Transactions 1 HK(IFRIC) Int 12 Service Concession Arrangements 2 HKFRS 8 Operating Segments 3 HKAS 23 (Revised) Borrowing Costs 3 1 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 March 2007 2 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2008 3 Effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2009 Basis of preparation of Financial Information The Financial Information has been prepared on the basis of merger accounting in accordance with the Accounting Guideline No.5 “Merger Accounting for Common Control Combination” issued by the HKICPA, under which Target Company is considered as the holding company of the Target Group during the Relevant Periods. The results and cash flows of the Target Group for the Relevant Periods include the results and cash flows of the Target Company and its subsidiaries from 8 April 2004, being the date of incorporation of Qinghai Senyuan, or since the Target Company and Hong Kong FSMI respective dates of incorporation/ establishment whichever is shorter, as if current group structure had been in existence throughout the Relevant Periods. The combined balance sheets as at respective balance sheet dates of the Relevant Periods is a combination of the balance sheets of the Target Company and its subsidiaries at each balance sheet date as if the current group structure had been in existence at these dates. – 145 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) Basis of preparation of Financial Information (Continued) The Financial Information has been prepared in accordance with the significant accounting policies set out below. The Financial Information is prepared under the historical cost convention except for the revaluation of certain financial assets and liabilities. The measurement bases are fully described in the accounting policies below. It should be noted that accounting estimates and assumptions are used in preparation of the Financial Information. Although these estimates are based on management’s best knowledge of current events and actions, actual results may ultimately differ from those estimates. The areas involving higher degree of judgement or complexity, or areas where assumptions and estimates are significant to the Financial Information are disclosed in note 3. In preparing the Financial Information, the director of the Target Company has given consideration to the future liquidity of the Target Group in light of its deficit in equity of approximately HK$18,750,000 as at 30 June 2007 and loss of approximately HK$5,991,000 attributable to the equity holder of the Target Company for the six months ended 30 June 2007. Notwithstanding this, the Financial Information has been prepared on a going concern basis on the assumption that the Target Group and the Target Company will continue to operate as a going concern. The going concern basis has been adopted on the basis that the shareholder of the Target Company has agreed to provide additional share capital of HK$50,000,000 and the shareholder’s loan of HK$31,464,000 will be capitalised and transferred to equity of Target Company before the Acquisition. Should the Target Group and the Target Company be unable to continue in business as a going concern, adjustments would have to be made to reduce the value of assets to their recoverable amount, to provide for any further liabilities which might arise, and to reclassify non-current assets as current assets. These adjustments have not been reflected in the Financial Information. (a) Basis of combination and subsidiaries Subsidiaries are all entities (including special purpose entities) over which the Target Company has the power to control the financial and operating policies so as to obtain benefits from their activities. The existence and effect of potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are considered when assessing whether the Target Company controls another entity. Subsidiaries are fully consolidated from the date on which control is transferred to the Target Company. They are excluded from consolidation from the date that control ceases. The Financial Information incorporates the financial statements of the Target Company and its subsidiaries after elimination of intercompany transactions. As explained above, the Financial Information has been accounted for using the merger method of accounting. – 146 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) Basis of preparation of Financial Information (Continued) (a) Basis of combination and subsidiaries (Continued) The net assets of the combining entities are combined using the existing book values from the controlling parties’ perspective. No amount is recognised as consideration for goodwill or excess of acquirer’s interest in the net fair value of acquiree’s identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities over cost at the time of common control combination. The combined income statements includes the results of each of the combining entities from the date of incorporation/establishment or since the date when the combining entities first came under the common control, where this is a shorter period, regardless of the date of the common control combination. All significant intragroup transactions, balances and unrealised gains on transactions have been eliminated on combination. Unrealised losses are also eliminated unless the transactions provide evidence of an impairment of the asset transferred. In the Target Company’s balance sheet, subsidiaries are carried at cost less impairment loss. The results of the subsidiaries are accounted for by Target Company on the basis of dividends received and receivables at the balance sheet date. (b) Foreign currency translation The functional currency of the Target Group is Renminbi (“RMB”). In the opinion of the director of the Target Company, the presentation of the Financial Information of the Target Group in Hong Kong Dollars (HK$) provides more relevant information about the Acquisition. Accordingly, in the Financial Information, the financial statements of the Target Group originally presented in a currency different from the Target Group’s presentation currency, have been converted into HK$. In the individual financial statements of the combined entities, foreign currency transactions are translated into the functional currency of the individual entity using the exchange rates prevailing at the dates of the transactions. At each balance sheet date, monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are translated at the foreign exchange rates ruling at the balance sheet dates. Foreign exchange gains and losses resulting from the settlement of such transactions and from the balance sheet dates retranslation of monetary assets and liabilities are recognised in the combined income statements. Non-monetary items carried at fair value that are denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated at the rates prevailing on the date when the fair value was determined and are reported as part of the fair value gain or loss. Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are not retranslated. – 147 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (b) Foreign currency translation (Continued) In the combined financial statements, all individual financial statements of foreign operations, originally presented in a currency different from the Target Group’s presentation currency, have been converted into HK$. Assets and liabilities have been translated into HK$ at the closing rates at the balance sheet dates. Income and expenses have been converted into the HK$ at the exchange rates ruling at the transaction dates, or at the average rates over the reporting period provided that the exchange rates do not fluctuate significantly. Any differences arising from this procedure have been dealt with separately in the exchange reserve in equity. Other exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign entities are taken to shareholders’ equity. When a foreign operation is sold, such exchange differences are recognised in the income statement as part of the gain or loss on sale. (c) Revenue recognition Provided it is probable that the economic benefits will flow to the Target Group and the revenue can be measured reliably, revenue is recognised as follows: Interest income is recognised on a time-proportion basis using the effective interest method. (d) Property, plant and equipment Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses. The cost of an item of property, plant and equipment comprises its purchase price and any directly attributable costs of bringing the asset to the working condition and location for its intended use. Subsequent costs are included in the asset’s carrying amount or recognised as a separate asset, as appropriate, only when it is probable that future economic benefits associated with the item will flow to the Target Group and the cost of the item can be measured reliably. All other costs, such as repairs and maintenance are charged to the combined income statements during the financial period in which they are incurred. – 148 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (d) Property, plant and equipment (Continued) Depreciation is provided to write off the cost less their estimated residual values over their estimated useful lives, using the straight-line method, at the following rates per annum: Motor vehicles 20 % Furniture, fixtures and office equipment 20%-25% The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date. The gain or loss arising on retirement or disposal is determined as the difference between the sales proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset and is recognised in the combined income statements. (e) Impairment of assets Property, plant and equipment and interests in a subsidiary are subject to impairment testing. All these assets are tested for impairment whenever there are indications that the asset may be impaired. An impairment loss is recognised as an expense immediately for the amount by which the asset’s carrying amount exceeds its recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of fair value, reflecting market conditions less costs to sell, and value in use. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a pre-tax discount rate that reflects current market assessment of time value of money and the risk specific to the asset. For the purposes of assessing impairment, where an asset does not generate cash inflows largely independent from those from other assets, the recoverable amount is determined for the smallest group of assets that generate cash inflows independently (i.e. a cash-generating unit). As a result, some assets are tested individually for impairment and some are tested at cash-generating unit level. An impairment loss is reversed if there has been a favourable change in the estimates used to determine the asset’s recoverable amount and only to the extent that the asset’s carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation or amortisation, if no impairment loss had been recognised. – 149 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (f) Leases An arrangement, comprising a transaction or a series of transactions, is or contains a lease if the Target Group determines that the arrangement conveys a right to use a specific asset or assets for an agreed period of time in return for a payment or a series of payments. Such a determination is made based on an evaluation of the substance of the arrangement and is regardless of whether the arrangement takes the legal form of a lease. Operating lease as the lessee Where the Target Group has the right to use the assets held under operating leases, payments made under the leases are charged to the combined income statement on a straight line basis over the lease terms except where an alternative basis is more representative of the pattern of benefits to be derived from the leased assets. Lease incentives received are recognised in the combined income statements as an integral part of the aggregate net lease payments made. Contingent rental are charged to the combined income statement in the accounting period in which they are incurred. (g) Financial assets The Target Group’s accounting policies for financial assets other than interest in subsidiaries are set out below. Recognition and measurement The Target Group financial assets include deposits, prepayments and other receivables. These are classified into loans and receivables. Management determines the classification of its financial assets at initial recognition depending on the purpose for which the financial assets were acquired and where allowed and appropriate, re-evaluates this designation at every reporting date. All financial assets are recognised when, and only when, the Target Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. When financial assets are recognised initially, they are measured at fair value plus directly attributable transaction costs. Loans and receivables are non-derivative financial assets with fixed or determinable payments that are not quoted in an active market. They are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method, less any impairment losses. Amortised cost is calculated taking into account any discount or premium on acquisition and includes fees that are an integral part of the effective interest rate and transaction cost. Derecognition Derecognition of financial assets occurs when the rights to receive cash flows from the investments expire or are transferred and substantially all of the risks and rewards of ownership have been transferred. At each balance sheet date, financial assets are reviewed to assess whether there is objective evidence of impairment. If any such evidence exists, impairment loss is determined and recognised based on the classification of the financial asset. – 150 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (g) Financial assets (Continued) Impairment of financial assets At each balance sheet date, financial assets are reviewed to determine whether there is any objective evidence of impairment. If any such evidence exists, the impairment loss is measured and recognised as follows: If there is objective evidence that an impairment loss on loans and receivables has been incurred, the amount of the loss is measured as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the present value of estimated future cash flows (excluding future credit losses that have not been incurred) discounted at the financial asset’s original effective interest rate (i.e. the effective interest rate computed at initial recognition). The amount of the loss is recognised in the combined income statements of the period in which the impairment occurs. If, in subsequent period, the amount of the impairment loss decreases and the decrease can be related objectively to an event occurring after the impairment was recognised, the previously recognised impairment loss is reversed to the extent that it does not result in a carrying amount of the financial asset exceeding what the amortised cost would have been had the impairment not been recognised at the date the impairment is reversed. The amount of the reversal is recognised in the combined income statements in the period in which the reversal occurs. (h) Accounting for income taxes Income tax comprises current tax and deferred tax. Current income tax assets and/or liabilities comprise those obligations to, or claims from, fiscal authorities relating to the current or prior reporting period, that are unpaid at the balance sheet dates. They are calculated according to the tax rates and tax laws applicable to the fiscal periods to which they relate, based on the taxable profit for the year/period. All changes to current tax assets or liabilities are recognised as a component of tax expense in the combined income statement. Deferred tax is calculated using the liability method on temporary differences at the balance sheet dates between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the combined financial statements and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax liabilities are generally recognised for all taxable temporary differences. Deferred tax assets are recognised for all deductible temporary differences, tax losses available to be carried forward as well as other unused tax credits, to the extent that it is probable that taxable profit will be available against which the deductible temporary differences, unused tax losses and unused tax credits can be utilised. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary differences arises from initial recognition of assets and liabilities in a transaction that affects neither taxable nor accounting profit or loss. – 151 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (h) Accounting for income taxes (Continued) Deferred tax is calculated, without discounting, at tax rates that are expected to apply in the period the liability is settled or the asset realised, provided they are enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date. Changes in deferred tax assets or liabilities are recognised in the combined income statements or in equity if they relate to items that are charged or credited directly to equity. The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available to allow all or part of the asset to be recovered. (i) Cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents include cash at bank and in hand. (j) Share capital Ordinary shares are classified as equity. Share capital is determined using the nominal value of shares that have been issued. (k) Retirement benefit costs and short term employee benefits Retirement benefits to employee are provided through defined contribution plans. Defined contribution plan The Target Group operates a defined contribution Mandatory Provident Fund retirement benefits scheme (the “MPF Scheme”) under the Mandatory Provident Fund Schemes Ordinance, for those employees who are eligible to participate in the MPF Scheme. Contributions are made based on a percentage of the employees’ basic salaries and are charged to the combined income statement as they become payable in accordance with the rules of the MPF Scheme. The assets of the MPF Scheme are held separately from those of the Target Group in an independently administered fund. The Target Group’s employer contributions vest fully with the employees when contributed into MPF scheme. The employees of the Target Group’s subsidiary which operates in the PRC, except Hong Kong are required to participate in the retirement benefits scheme (the “RB Scheme”) operated by the respective local municipal government in the PRC. The subsidiary is required to contribute a certain percentage of their payroll costs to the RB Scheme to fund the benefits. The only obligation of the Target Group with respect to the RB Scheme is to pay the ongoing required contributions under the RB Scheme. Contributions under the RB Scheme are charged to the combined income statements as they become payable in accordance with the rules of the RB Scheme. – 152 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (k) Retirement benefit costs and short term employee benefits (Continued) Short-term employee benefits Employee entitlements to annual leave are recognised when they are accrued to employees. A provision is made for the estimated liability for annual leave as a result of services rendered by employees up to the balance sheet dates. Non-accumulating compensated absences such as sick leave and maternity leave are not recognised until the time of leave. (l) Financial liabilities The Target Group’s financial liabilities include other payables and accruals, and amounts due to a shareholder. Financial liabilities are recognised when the Target Group becomes a party to the contractual provisions of the instrument. All interest related charges are recognised as an expense in finance costs in the combined income statement. A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires. Where an existing financial liability is replaced by another from the same lender on substantially different terms, or the terms of an existing liability are substantially modified, such an exchange or modification is treated as a derecognition of the original liability and the recognition of a new liability, and the difference in the respective carrying amount is recognised in the combined income statements. Other payables and accruals and amounts due to a shareholder are recognised initially at their fair value and subsequently measured at amortised cost, using the effective interest method. (m) Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets Provisions are recognised when the Target Group has a present obligation (legal or constructive) as a result of a past event, and it is probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required to settle the obligation and a reliable estimate can be made. Where the time value of money is material, provisions are stated at the present value of the expenditure expected to settle the obligation. All provisions are reviewed at each balance sheet date and adjusted to reflect the current best estimate. – 153 – APPENDIX IIA 2. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (Continued) (m) Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets (Continued) Where it is not probable that an outflow of economic benefits will be required, or the amount cannot be estimated reliably, the obligation is disclosed as a contingent liability, unless the probability of outflow of economic benefits is remote. Possible obligations, whose existence will only be confirmed by the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more future events are also disclosed as contingent liabilities unless the probability of outflow of economic benefits is remote. (n) Intangible assets – exploration and evaluation assets Exploration and evaluation assets are stated at cost less impairment losses. Exploration and evaluation assets include topographical and geological survey drilling, exploratory drilling, sampling and trenching and expenditure incurred for the technical feasibility studies and incurred to secure further mineralisation in the mine ore. Expenditure incurred prior to obtaining the exploration and evaluation rights to explore an area is written off as incurred. Once the technical feasibility and commercial viability of extracting the mineral resource had been determined and that the project reaches development phase, exploration and evaluation costs capitalised are amortised. If exploration property is abandoned during the evaluation stage, the total expenditure thereon will be written off. (o) Related parties A party is considered to be related to the Target Group if: (i) directly, or indirectly through one or more intermediaries, the party (i) controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with, the Target Group; (ii) has an interest in the Target Group that gives it significant influence over the Target Group; or (iii) has joint control over the Target Group; (ii) the party is an associate; (iii) the party is a jointly-controlled entity; (iv) the party is a member of the key management personnel of the Target Group; (v) the party is a close member of the family or any individual referred to in (i) or (iv); (vi) the party is an entity that is controlled, jointly controlled or significantly influenced by or for which significant voting power in such entity resides with, directly or indirectly, any individual referred to in (iv) or (v); or (vii) the party is a post-employment benefit plan for the benefit of employees of the Target Group, or of any entity that is a related party of the Target Group. – 154 – APPENDIX IIA 3. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS Estimates and judgements are continually evaluated and are based on historical experience and other factors, including expectations of future events that are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances. The Target Group makes estimates and assumptions concerning the future. The resulting accounting estimates will, by definition, seldom equal the related actual results. The estimates and assumptions that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year/period are discussed below: (i) Depreciation The Target Group depreciates its property, plant and equipment on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. The estimate useful lives reflect the director’s estimate of the period that the Target Group will derive future economic benefits from the use of the Target Group’s property, plant and equipment. (ii) Impairment of receivables Allowances for impairment of receivables are determined by management based on the repayment history of its debtors and the current market condition. It could change significantly as a result of changes in the financial position of the debtors. Management would re-assess the amount of impairment allowances of receivables, if any, at each balance sheet date. (iii) Impairment of intangible assets — “exploration and evaluation assets” The carrying value of exploration and evaluation assets is reviewed for impairment when events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying value may not be recoverable. The Target Group considers no fact and circumstance occurred which would suggest that the carry amount of the exploration and evaluation assets may exceed its recoverable amount. 4. REVENUE The Target Group did not generate any revenue during the Relevant Periods and the six months ended 30 June 2006. 5. LOSS BEFORE INCOME TAX From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 Loss before income tax is arrived at after charging: Auditors’ remuneration Depreciation Minimum lease payments under operating leases in respect of rented premises Staff cost including director’s emoluments (note 7) Year ended 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (unaudited) — 188 3 338 8 522 — 319 — 236 150 450 2,451 1,365 931 105 366 3,067 1,780 1,062 – 155 – APPENDIX IIA 6. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP INCOME TAX EXPENSE No income tax has been provided as the Target Group had no estimated assessable profits arising in or derived from Hong Kong and in other jurisdiction during the Relevant Periods. Reconciliation between income tax expense and accounting loss at applicable tax rates is as follows: From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 Loss before income tax Year ended 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (unaudited) (1,149) (1,702) (9,780) (5,991) (2,976) (201) (298) (1,712) (1,048) (521) Hong Kong profits tax rate of 17.5% Effect of different tax rates of subsidiaries operating in (178) (228) (414) (222) (181) Tax effect of non-deductible expenses other jurisdictions 15 47 1,254 803 322 Tax effect of non-taxable revenue — — (2) (1) (2) not recognised 364 479 874 468 382 Income tax expense — — — — — Deferred tax assets on pre-commencement expenses No deferred tax asset has been recognised due to the uncertainty of future taxable profit. 7. EMPLOYEE BENEFIT EXPENSE (INCLUDING DIRECTOR’S EMOLUMENTS) From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 Salaries and allowances Retirement benefits scheme contributions Year ended 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (unaudited) 105 366 3,030 1,740 1,060 — — 37 40 2 105 366 3,067 1,780 1,062 – 156 – APPENDIX IIA 8. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP DIRECTOR’S REMUNERATION AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT’S EMOLUMENTS (a) Director’s emoluments From 8 April 2004 to 31 December Year ended 31 December Six months ended 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 (unaudited) Fees — — — — — — — 988 528 460 — — — — — — — 988 528 460 Basic salaries, housing and other allowances and benefits in kind — Leung Lai Ching, Margaret Contributions to pension scheme — Leung Lai Ching, Margaret Leung Lai Ching, Margaret was appointed on 8 August 2005. During the Relevant Periods and the six months ended 30 June 2006, no emoluments were paid by the Target Group to the director of Target Company as an inducement to join or upon joining the Target Group, or as compensation for loss of office. No director of the Target Company waived any emoluments paid by the companies now comprising the Target Group during the Relevant Periods and for the six months ended 30 June 2006. – 157 – APPENDIX IIA 8. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP DIRECTOR’S REMUNERATION AND SENIOR MANAGEMENT’S EMOLUMENTS (Continued) (b) Five highest paid individuals The five individuals whose emoluments were the highest in the Target Group for the Relevant Periods and for the six months ended 30 June 2006 included one director whose emoluments are reflected in the analysis presented above. The emoluments payable to the remaining four individuals during the Relevant Periods and the six months ended 30 June 2006, which fell within the salary band of Nil – HK$1,000,000 are as follows: From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 Salaries and allowance Retirement benefits scheme contributions Year ended 31 December 2005 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 Six months ended 30 June 2007 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (unaudited) 53 267 1,245 612 445 — — 21 18 1 53 267 1,266 630 446 During the Relevant Periods and the six months ended 30 June 2006, no emoluments were paid by the Target Group to the five highest paid individuals, including the director, as an inducement to join or upon joining the Target Group or as compensation for loss of office. – 158 – APPENDIX IIA 9. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT Motor vehicles HK$’000 Furniture, fixtures and office equipment HK$’000 Total HK$’000 Period ended 31 December 2004 Additions Depreciation — — 1,630 (188) 1,630 (188) Closing net book amount — 1,442 1,442 At 31 December 2004 Cost Accumulated depreciation — — 1,630 (188) 1,630 (188) Net book amount — 1,442 1,442 Year ended 31 December 2005 Opening net book amount Additions Depreciation Exchange differences — — — — 1,442 42 (338) 42 1,442 42 (338) 42 Closing net book amount — 1,188 1,188 At 31 December 2005 Cost Accumulated depreciation — — 1,720 (532) 1,720 (532) Net book amount — 1,188 1,188 Year ended 31 December 2006 Opening net book amount Additions Depreciation Exchange differences — 314 (57) — 1,188 682 (465) 47 1,188 996 (522) 47 Closing net book amount 257 1,452 1,709 At 31 December 2006 Cost Accumulated depreciation 314 (57) 2,470 (1,018) 2,784 (1,075) Net book amount 257 1,452 1,709 Six months ended 30 June 2007 Opening net book amount Additions Depreciation 257 506 (57) 1,452 27 (262) 1,709 533 (319) Closing net book amount 706 1,217 1,923 At 30 June 2007 Cost Accumulated depreciation 820 (114) 2,497 (1,280) 3,317 (1,394) 706 1,217 1,923 Net book amount – 159 – APPENDIX IIA 10. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP INTANGIBLE ASSETS — “EXPLORATION AND EVALUATION ASSETS” As at 31 December Exploration right As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 1,121 1,154 1,200 1,200 — — — 1,690 458 1,382 6,856 7,469 — — 449 1,884 1,579 2,536 8,505 12,243 Technical feasibility studies Exploratory drilling Sampling No impairment was made during the Relevant Periods. 11. INTERESTS IN SUBSIDIARIES As at 31 December As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 — — — 20,000 Unlisted shares, at cost Particulars of the subsidiaries of the Target Company at 30 June 2007 are as follows: Percentage of Name of subsidiaries Hong Kong Forest Source Place of Issued and fully incorporation and paid/registered operation share capital Hong Kong Mining Industry Ordinary registered and issued capital held by the Principal Target Company activities Directly Indirectly 100% — Investment holding — 100% Exploration of mine HK$20,000,000 Holding Company Limited ࠗಋᘊพઁٖ τࠉʔ̇ (“Hong Kong FSMI”) Qinghai Forest Source Mining Industry PRC Registered HK$18,312,549 Development Company Limited ࣵڇᘊพೕτࠉʔ̇ (“Qinghai Senyuan”) – 160 – APPENDIX IIA 12. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS As at 31 December 2004, 2005 and 2006 and as at 30 June 2007, included in cash at banks and in hand of the Target Group are HK$4,000, HK$241,000, HK$2,000 and HK$61,000 of bank balances denominated in RMB placed with banks in the PRC. RMB is not freely convertible into foreign currencies. 13. OTHER PAYABLES AND ACCRUALS As at 31 December Other payables 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 1,096 1,128 2,973 1,510 — 180 1,130 961 1,096 1,308 4,103 2,471 Accruals 14. As at 30 June 2004 AMOUNTS DUE TO A SHAREHOLDER The amounts due are unsecured, interest-free and repayable on demand. 15. SHARE CAPITAL Target Group As at 31 December As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 1,512 3,351 3,501 — Hong Kong FSMI — — — — Target Company — — — — 1,512 3,351 3,501 — Qinghai Senyuan As at 31 December 2004, the share capital of the Target Group represented the capital of Qinghai Senyuan. Hong Kong FSMI and Target Company were not yet incorporated as at 31 December 2004. As at 31 December 2005, the share capital represented the aggregate capital of Qinghai Senyuan of HK$3,351,000, Hong Kong FSMI of HK$1 and the Target Company of HK$8. As at 31 December 2006, the share capital represented the aggregate capital of Qinghai Senyuan of HK$3,501,000, Hong Kong FSMI of HK$1 and the Target Company of HK$8. As at 30 June 2007, as Hong Kong FSMI and Qinghai Senyuan had become the subsidiaries of the Target Company upon Reorganisation, their share capital was eliminated when drawing up the combined accounts. – 161 – APPENDIX IIA 15. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP SHARE CAPITAL (Continued) Target Company As at 31 December As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 — 390 390 390 HK$ HK$ HK$ HK$ — HK$8 HK$8 HK$8 Authorised: 50,000 ordinary shares of US$1 each Issued and fully paid : 1 ordinary share of US$1.00 16. RESERVES Target Group The Target Group’s reserves and the movements therein for the Relevant Periods are presented in the combined statement of changes in equity in Section I of the Financial Information. Target Company Total HK$’000 At date of incorporation — Loss and total recognised expense for the period (5) At 31 December 2005 and at 1 January 2006 (5) Loss and total recognised expense for the year (4) At 31 December 2006 and at 1 January 2007 (9) Loss and total recognised expense for the period — At 30 June 2007 (9) – 162 – APPENDIX IIA 17. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP OPERATING LEASE COMMITMENTS Target Group At the respective balance sheet dates, the total future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases are payable by the Target Group as follows: As at 31 December As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 Within one year 214 1,534 3,607 2,677 In the second to fifth years 846 2,519 1,336 428 1,060 4,053 4,943 3,105 The Target Group leases a number of properties under operating leases. The leases run for an initial period of 1 to 5 years, with an option to renew the lease and renegotiated the terms at the expiry date or at dates as mutually agreed between the Target Group and respective landlords. None of the leases include contingent rentals. Target Company Target Company did not have any significant operating lease commitments at the respective balance sheet dates. 18. CAPITAL COMMITMENTS Target Group Capital commitments of the Target Group in relation to technical feasibility studies, exploratory drilling and sampling are as follows: As at 31 December As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 — — — 3,065 Intangible assets Contracted but not provided for Target Company Target Company did not have any significant capital commitments at the respective balance sheet dates. – 163 – APPENDIX IIA 19. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS Key management personnel compensation: Included in staff costs are key management personnel compensation. The key management personnel is the director of the Target Company, the details of remuneration paid to the director is set out in note 8. 20. SEGMENT INFORMATION No separate analysis of segment information by business or geographical segments is presented as the Target Group’s sole business is the exploration of mine. The Target Group’s results, assets and liabilities and capital expenditure are principally attributable to a single geographical region, which is the PRC. 21. RISK MANAGEMENT OBJECTIVES AND POLICIES The Target Group is exposed to a variety of financial risks which results from both its operating and investing activities. The Target Group does not have written risk management policies and guidelines. However, the director analyses and formulates strategies periodically to manage the Target Group’s exposure to market risks, including changes in interest rates and currency exchange rates. Generally, the Target Group introduces conservative strategies on its risk management. The Target Group’s exposure to market risk is kept to minimum. The Target Group has not used any derivatives or other instruments for hedging purposes. The Target Group does not issue derivative financial instruments for trading purposes. The most significant financial risks to which the Target Group is exposed to are described below. (a) Foreign currency risk Subsidiaries of the Target Company have foreign currency transactions, which expose the Target Group to foreign currency risk. The Target Group does not hedge its foreign currency risks, as the management does not expect any significant movements in the exchange rate between RMB and HK$. (b) Credit risk All the Target Group’s cash and cash equivalents are deposited with major banks located in Hong Kong and the PRC. The carrying amounts of deposits, prepayments and other receivables represent the Target Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk in relation to its financial assets. These financial assets are actively monitored to avoid significant concentrations of credit risk. No other financial assets carry a significant exposure to credit risk. (c) Interest rate risk The Target Group has no significant interest bearing assets and liabilities. – 164 – APPENDIX IIA 21. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP RISK MANAGEMENT OBJECTIVES AND POLICIES (Continued) (d) Liquidity risk As mentioned in Section II note 2, the Target Group had taken measures to improve its working capital. Provided that the shareholder of the Target Company has agreed to provide additional share capital of HK$50,000,000 and the shareholder’s loan of HK$31,464,000 will be capitalised and transferred to equity of the Target Group before the Acquisition, the director of the Target Company is satisfied that the Target Group will be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due in the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the financial statements have been prepared on a going concern basis. (e) Fair value The fair values of the Target Group’s current financial assets and liabilities are not materially different from their carrying amounts because of the immediate or short term maturity. (f) Summary of financial assets and liabilities by category The carrying amounts of the Target Group’s financial assets and liabilities as recognised at the balance sheet dates of the Relevant Periods under review may also be categorised as follows. See notes 2(g) and 2(l) for explanations about how the category of financial instruments affects their subsequent measurement. Financial assets As at 31 December As at 30 June 2004 2005 2006 2007 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 — Other receivables 12 12 33 201 Cash and cash equivalents 20 247 229 222 32 259 262 423 1,096 1,128 2,973 1,510 1,719 2,167 15,961 31,464 2,815 3,295 18,934 32,974 Current assets Loans and receivables Financial liabilities Current liabilities Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost — Other payables — Amounts due to a shareholder – 165 – APPENDIX IIA 22. ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON THE TARGET GROUP CAPITAL MANAGEMENT The Target Group’s objectives when managing capital are: (a) To safeguard the Target Group’s ability to continue as a going concern, so that it continues to provide returns and benefits for stakeholders; (b) To support the Target Group’s stability and growth; and (c) To provide capital for the purpose of strengthening the Target Group’s risk management capability. The Target Group actively and regularly reviews and manages its capital structure to ensure optimal capital structure and shareholder returns, taking into consideration the future capital requirements of the Target Group and capital efficiency, prevailing and projected profitability, projected operating cash flows, projected capital expenditures and projected strategic investment opportunities. The Target Group currently does not adopt any formal dividend policy. Management regards total equity as capital, for capital management purpose. 23. POST BALANCE SHEET EVENTS On 8 July 2007, Smooth Way International Limited, which is a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, entered into a conditional share transfer agreement with Leung Lai Ching, Margaret. Details of the conditional share transfer agreement are set out in Letter from the Board of this Circular. 24. SUBSEQUENT FINANCIAL STATEMENTS No audited financial statements have been prepared for the Target Group in respect of any period subsequent to 30 June 2007. Yours faithfully, Grant Thornton Certified Public Accountants Hong Kong – 166 – APPENDIX IIB FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE TARGET GROUP MANAGEMENT DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS ON THE TARGET GROUP Financial summary As set out in the audited financial statement of the Target Group for the period/year ended 31 December 2004, 2005, 2006 and the six months ended 30 June 2007. From 8 April 2004 to 31 December 2004 HK$’000 Revenue Loss for the period/year — (1,149) Year 2005 HK$’000 — (1,702) Year 2006 HK$’000 — (9,780) Six months ended 2007 HK$’000 — (5,991) The Target Group did not have any revenue in the relevant period. Therefore the Target Group did not have any profit and had only incurred a loss due to administrative expenses and professional fee during the relevant period. Amount due to a shareholder As at 31 December 2004, 31 December 2005, 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007, amount due to a shareholder is unsecured, interest free and has no fixed terms of repayment. Treasury policies As at 31 December 2004, 31 December 2005, 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007, there was no other borrowing from bank or financial institution during the period. Liquidity and financial resources Net Assets/Liabilities Set out below is a summary of the audited accountant report of the Target Group as at 31 December 2004, 2005 and 2006 and 30 June 2007 which prepared on the bases set out on pages 140 to 141 of this circular and details of which are set out in Appendix IIA to this circular: Total assets Total liabilities Net assets/(liabilities) Amount due to a shareholder Gearing ratio As at 31 December 2004 HK$’000 2005 HK$’000 3,163 2,815 348 1,719 0.89 3,993 3,475 518 2,167 0.87 The gearing ratio is the basis of total liabilities over total assets. – 167 – 2006 HK$’000 10,987 20,064 (9,077) 15,961 1.83 As at 30 June 2007 HK$’000 15,185 33,935 (18,750) 31,464 2.23 APPENDIX IIB FINANCIAL INFORMATION ON THE TARGET GROUP Liquidity The Target Group had total cash and bank balances of approximately HK$20,000, HK$247,000, HK$229,000, and HK$222,000 as at 31 December 2004, 31 December 2005, 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007. The current ratio was approximately 0.05, 0.08, 0.04, and 0.03. Contingent liabilities As at 31 December 2004, 31 December 2005, 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007, the Target Group did not have any contingent liabilities. Charges on assets As at 31 December 2004, 31 December 2005, 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007, the Target Group had no interest-bearing borrowings and no assets were pledged. Foreign exchange exposure The Target Group does not hedge its foreign currency risks, as the management does not expect any significant movements in exchange rate between, United States Dollar, RMB and HK$, During the relevant periods under review, The Target Group did not use any hedging instrument. Employee As at 31 December 2004, 31 December 2005, 31 December 2006 and 30 June 2007, the Target Group had employed around 7, 7, 16, and 17 full time staffs in Hong Kong and the PRC respectively. – 168 – APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP 1. INTRODUCTION The following is the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group prepared in accordance with the Listing Rules for the purpose of illustrating the effect of the Acquisition on the financial position of the Group as at 30 June 2007 and the results and cash flows of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2006. As it is prepared for illustrative purpose only, and because of its nature, it may not give a true picture of the financial position, results and cash flows of the Enlarged Group following completion of the Acquisition. The unaudited pro forma consolidated balance sheet of the Enlarged Group is prepared based on the unaudited consolidated balance sheet of the Group as at 30 June 2007 extracted from the published interim report of the Group as of 30 June 2007 as set out in Appendix I to this circular and the audited combined balance sheet of the Target Group as at 30 June 2007 as extracted from the accountants’ report set out in Appendix IIA to this circular as if the Acquisition had been completed on 30 June 2007. The unaudited pro forma consolidated income statement and cash flow statement of the Enlarged Group are prepared based on the audited consolidated income statement and cash flow statement of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2006 extracted from the published annual report of the Group as of 31 December 2006 as set out in Appendix I to this circular and the audited combined income statement and cash flow statement of the Target Group for the year ended 31 December 2006 as extracted from the accountants’ report set out in Appendix IIA to this circular as if the Acquisition had been completed on 1 January 2006. The unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group is presented in two stages. The first stage assumes that the Acquisition has been completed but the mining license has not yet been obtained by the Target Group whilst the second stage assumes that the Acquisition has been completed and the mining license has been obtained by the Target Group. – 169 – APPENDIX III 2. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET OF THE ENLARGED GROUP The Group as at 30 June 2007 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Target Group as at 30 June 2007 HK$’000 (Audited) Notes Pro forma adjustments Pro forma relating to the Enlarged Acquisition Group (at (at completion) completion) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Pro forma adjustments Pro forma relating to the Enlarged Acquisition (at Group (at completion completion and upon and upon obtaining obtaining the the mining mining license) license) Notes HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) 76,587 4,855 18,355 729,188 — 76,587 4,855 18,355 — 2,484,062 ASSETS AND LIABILITIES Non-current assets Property, plant and equipment Prepaid lease payments Deposits Goodwill Intangible assets — “Mining rights” Intangible assets — “Exploration and evaluation assets” Current assets Inventories Trade and bills receivables Deposits, prepayments and other receivables Cash and cash equivalents Current liabilities Trade payables Deposits received, other payables and accruals Amounts due to directors Finance lease payable Amount due to a shareholder Tax payable 74,664 4,855 18,355 — — 1,923 — — — — — 12,243 12,243 12,243 97,874 14,166 841,228 2,596,102 4,611 9,374 — — 4,611 9,374 4,611 9,374 9,709 89,596 797 222 10,506 130,518 10,506 130,518 113,290 1,019 155,009 155,009 15,847 — 15,847 15,847 34,161 1,100 87 — 143 2,471 — — 31,464 — 36,632 1,100 87 — 143 36,632 1,100 87 — 143 51,338 33,935 53,809 53,809 (3a) (4) (6) – 170 – 729,188 40,700 (31,464) (3b) (3b) (729,188) 2,484,062 APPENDIX III 2. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET OF THE ENLARGED GROUP (Continued) Pro forma adjustments Pro forma relating to the Enlarged Acquisition Group (at (at completion) completion) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Pro forma adjustments Pro forma relating to the Enlarged Acquisition (at Group (at completion completion and upon and upon obtaining obtaining the the mining mining license) license) Notes HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) The Group as at 30 June 2007 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Target Group as at 30 June 2007 HK$’000 (Audited) Net current assets/(liabilities) 61,952 (32,916) 101,200 101,200 Total assets less current liabilities 159,826 (18,750) 942,428 2,697,302 176 — 176 176 9,010 — — — 9,186 — 238,729 484,516 Net assets/(liabilities) 150,640 (18,750) 703,699 2,212,786 EQUITY Equity attributable to equity holders of the Company Share capital Reserves 8,135 142,722 — (18,750) 4,050 537,029 12,185 661,001 291,897 12,185 952,898 Minority interests 150,857 (217) (18,750) — (3a) & (10) 30,730 673,186 30,513 (3b) & (10) 1,217,190 965,083 1,247,703 Total equity 150,640 (18,750) Non-current liabilities Finance lease payable Amounts due to minority shareholders Convertible bonds Notes (7a) (8) (9a) 229,543 9,010 229,543 703,699 – 171 – (7b) (9b) 245,787 9,010 475,330 2,212,786 APPENDIX III 3. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED INCOME STATEMENT OF THE ENLARGED GROUP The Group Target Group year ended year ended 31 December 31 December 2006 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (Audited) (Audited) Notes Pro forma Pro forma adjustments Enlarged Group relating to the year ended 31 Acquisition December 2006 (at completion) (at completion) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Pro forma Pro forma adjustments Enlarged Group relating to the year ended 31 Acquisition December 2006 (at completion (at completion and upon and upon obtaining the obtaining the mining license) mining license) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Revenue Cost of sales 26,523 (29,240 ) — — 26,523 (29,240 ) 26,523 (29,240 ) Gross loss Other revenue and income Selling and distribution expenses Administrative expenses Other operating expenses (2,717 ) 7,476 (1,865 ) (38,299 ) (10,603 ) — 13 — (9,793 ) — (2,717 ) 7,489 (1,865 ) (48,092 ) (10,603 ) (2,717 ) 7,489 (1,865 ) (48,092 ) (10,603 ) Operating loss Finance costs (46,008 ) (149 ) (9,780 ) — (55,788 ) (149 ) (55,788 ) (149 ) Loss before income tax Income tax expense (46,157 ) — (9,780 ) — (55,937 ) — (55,937 ) — Loss for the year (46,157 ) (9,780 ) (55,937 ) (55,937 ) Attributable to : Equity holders of the Company Minority interests (46,167 ) 10 (9,780 ) — (51,155 ) (4,782 ) (51,155 ) (4,782 ) Loss for the year (46,157 ) (9,780 ) (55,937 ) (55,937 ) (11) (11) – 172 – 4,792 (4,792 ) APPENDIX III 4. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT OF THE ENLARGED GROUP The Group Target Group year ended year ended 31 December 31 December 2006 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (Audited) (Audited) Cash flows from operating activities Loss before income tax Adjustments for: Depreciation of property, plant and equipment Amortisation of prepaid lease payments Bad debts written off Provision from impairment of trade receivable Loss on disposals of property, plant and equipment Interest income Interest expenses Share-based compensation Pro forma Pro forma adjustments Enlarged Group relating to the year ended 31 Acquisition December 2006 (at completion) (at completion) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Pro forma Pro forma adjustments Enlarged Group relating to the year ended 31 Acquisition December 2006 (at completion (at completion and upon and upon obtaining the obtaining the mining license) mining license) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) (46,157 ) (9,780 ) (55,937 ) (55,937 ) 7,447 112 65 522 — — 7,969 112 65 7,969 112 65 314 — 314 314 2 (85 ) 149 10,777 — (13 ) — — 2 (98 ) 149 10,777 2 (98 ) 149 10,777 (27,376 ) 1,680 843 (9,271 ) — — (36,647 ) 1,680 843 (36,647 ) 1,680 843 (1,870 ) 516 (522 ) — (2,392 ) 516 (2,392 ) 516 14,911 1,143 — 2,795 — 13,794 17,706 1,143 13,794 17,706 1,143 13,794 Cash (used in)/generated from operations Interest paid (10,153 ) (149 ) 6,796 — (3,357 ) (149 ) (3,357 ) (149 ) Net cash (used in)/generated from operating activities (10,302 ) 6,796 (3,506 ) (3,506 ) Operating loss before working capital changes Decrease in inventories Decrease in trade and bills receivables Increase in deposits, prepayments, and other receivables Increase in trade payables Increase in deposit received, other payables and accruals Increase in amounts due to directors Increase in amount due to a shareholder – 173 – APPENDIX III 4. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP UNAUDITED PRO FORMA CONSOLIDATED CASH FLOW STATEMENT OF THE ENLARGED GROUP (Continued) The Group Target Group year ended year ended 31 December 31 December 2006 2006 HK$’000 HK$’000 (Audited) (Audited) Cash flows from investing activities Deposit paid Purchases of property, plant and equipment Proceeds from disposals of property, plant and equipment Exploration and evaluation costs Interest received Acquisition of subsidiaries Proceeds from issuance shares Notes Pro forma Pro forma adjustments Enlarged Group relating to the year ended 31 Acquisition December 2006 (at completion) (at completion) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) Pro forma Pro forma adjustments Enlarged Group relating to the year ended 31 Acquisition December 2006 (at completion (at completion and upon and upon obtaining the obtaining the mining license) mining license) HK$’000 HK$’000 (Unaudited) (2,750 ) (943 ) — (996 ) (2,750 ) (1,939 ) (2,750 ) (1,939 ) 5 — 85 — — — (5,867 ) 13 — — 5 (5,867 ) 98 (99,753 ) 90,700 5 (5,867 ) 98 (99,753 ) 90,700 (3,603 ) (6,850 ) (19,506 ) (19,506 ) 9,465 (2,257 ) (70 ) 2,031 — — — — 9,465 (2,257 ) (70 ) 2,031 9,465 (2,257 ) (70 ) 2,031 (1,432 ) — (1,432 ) (1,432 ) — — 150 — 150 50,000 150 50,000 7,737 150 57,887 57,887 (6,168 ) 96 34,875 34,875 6,931 8 247 (114 ) 6,931 (106 ) 6,931 (106 ) Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December 771 229 (41,700 ) (41,700 ) Analysis of balances of cash and cash equivalents Cash and bank balances 771 229 (41,700 ) (41,700 ) Net cash used in investing activities Cash flows from financing activities Proceeds from issue of shares upon exercise of share options Decrease in trust receipt loans Capital element of finance lease payments Decrease in pledged time deposits Decrease in amount due to minority shareholders Capital injection by the equity holder of a subsidiary Capital contribution Net cash generated from financing activities Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year Effect of foreign exchange rate changes (5) (5) (5) (5) – 174 – (99,753 ) 90,700 50,000 (247 ) APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP Notes to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group (1) On 8 July 2007, Smooth Way International Limited, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, entered into an agreement with the Vendor to acquire 51% of the entire share capital of the Target Company. The fair value of total consideration for the acquisition is HK$1,298,856,000 as at 30 June 2007 which is to be satisfied in the following manners: HK$’000 Issue of Consideration Shares (including a premium of HK$207,900,000) 210,600* Issue of Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds) 450,572# Cash 100,000 Cost of investments at Completion of the Acquisition 761,172 Issue of Convertible Bonds (Tranche 2 Bonds) 537,684# Cost of investments at Completion of the Acquisition and upon obtaining mining license 1,298,856 Upon Completion of the Acquisition, the Target Company is considered by the directors of the Company as a subsidiary of the Company as the Target Company will be controlled by the Group after completion. The consolidated balance sheet of the Target Group will be consolidated with that of the Group from the date on which control is transferred to the Group. The Tranche 2 Bonds will be issued by the Company when the mining license is to be obtained by the Target Group. * The fair value of the Consideration Share is equal to the published price of the Consideration Shares on 29 June 2007 (the closest trading day to 30 June 2007) times the number of shares in issue. # The valuation of the Convertible Bonds was carried out by LCH (Asia-Pacific) Surveyors Limited, an independent firm of chartered surveyors. The basis of the valuation is detailed in Note 7. (2) A shareholder of Target Company has agreed to inject capital of HK$50,000,000 to the Target Company before the completion date of the Acquisition. In the meantime, the shareholder’s loan of HK$31,464,000, immediately before completion of the Acquisition, will be capitalised and transferred to share capital of the Target Company. Consequently, total net identifiable assets of the Target Group are as follows: HK$’000 Net liabilities as at 30 June 2007 (as extracted in Appendix IIA) HK$’000 (18,750) Capital injection 50,000 Capitalisation of shareholder’s loan 31,464 Additional net identifiable assets for Acquisition 81,464 Total net identifiable assets for Acquisition 62,714 – 175 – APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP Notes to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group (3a) The adjustment is to reflect the effect of the Acquisition, before the mining license is obtained, on the consolidated balance sheet of the Group as if the Acquisition had taken place on 30 June 2007. Details of net identifiable assets to be acquired and the goodwill arising on the Acquisition are as follows: HK$’000 Cost of investments at Completion of the Acquisition (Note 1) 761,172 Less: Fair value of net identifiable assets to be acquired — as shown below (31,984) Goodwill 729,188 The identifiable assets and liabilities arising from the Acquisition are as follows: Acquiree’s Property, plant and equipment Intangible assets - “exploration and evaluation assets” Fair value carrying amount HK$’000 HK$’000 1,923 1,923 12,243 12,243 Deposits, prepayments and other receivables 797 797 Cash and cash equivalents 222 222 Other payables and accruals (2,471) (2,471) Amount due to a shareholder (31,464) (31,464) Net liabilities as at 30 June 2007 (as extracted from Appendix IIA) (18,750) (18,750) Additional net identifiable assets for Acquisition (Note 2) 81,464 Total net identifiable assets for Acquisition 62,714 Minority interest (49%) (30,730) Net identifiable assets to be acquired 31,984 It is assumed that the fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities of the Target Group as at 30 June 2007 is the carrying amounts as recorded in the books of the Target Group as extracted from the accountants’ report of the Target Group as set out in Appendix IIA to this circular, plus the additional net identifiable assets for Acquisition. As the mining license has not yet been obtained, it is assumed that surplus of consideration over the fair value of net identifiable assets is goodwill. On Completion, the fair value of the consideration and the net identifiable assets and liabilities of the Target Group will have to be assessed. As a result of the assessment, the amount of goodwill may be different from that estimated based on the basis stated above for the purpose of preparation of the unaudited pro forma financial information. Accordingly, the actual goodwill at the date of completion may be different from that presented above. – 176 – APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP Notes to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group (Continued) (3b) The calculation is to reflect the effect of the Acquisition, after the mining license is obtained, on the consolidated balance sheet of the Group as if the Acquisition had taken place, and the feasibility study of the underlying mine has been completed on 30 June 2007. Details of net identifiable assets to be acquired and goodwill arising on the Acquisition are as follows: HK$’000 Cost of investments at Completion of the Acquisition and upon obtaining mining license (Note 1) 1,298,856 Less: Fair value of net identifiable assets to be acquired — as shown below (1,298,856) Goodwill — The identifiable assets and liabilities arising from the Acquisition are as follows: Acquiree’s Property, plant and equipment Fair value carry amount HK$’000 HK$’000 1,923 1,923 12,243 12,243 Deposits, prepayments and other receivables 797 797 Cash and cash equivalents 222 222 Intangible assets — “exploration and evaluation assets” Other payables and accruals (2,471) (2,471) Amount due to a shareholder (31,464) (31,464) Net liabilities as at 30 June 2007 (as extracted from Appendix IIA) (18,750) (18,750) Additional net identifiable assets for Acquisition (Note 2) Intangible assets — “Mining rights” (balancing figure) Total net identifiable assets for Acquisition Minority interest (49%) 81,464 2,484,062 2,546,776 (1,247,920) Net identifiable assets to be required 1,298,856 It is assumed that the fair value of the identifiable assets and liabilities of the Target Group as at 30 June 2007 is the carrying amounts as recorded in the books of the Target Group as extracted from the accountants’ report of the Target Group as set out in Appendix IIA to this Circular, plus the mining rights and the additional net identifiable assets for Acquisition. – 177 – APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP Notes to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group (Continued) (3b) (Continued) The fair value of the mining rights is assessed assuming the feasibility study of the underlying mine has been completed and the mining license has been obtained by the Target Group as at 30 June 2007. For details of the status when the mining license is obtained, please refer to paragraph headed “Status when the Mining License is obtained” in the Letter from the Board of this Circular. Based on the assumption that the cost of investments equal to the fair value of net identifiable assets to be acquired and there is no goodwill arising from the Acquisition, the fair value of the mining rights will be equal to HK$2,484,062,000. On Completion, the fair value of the consideration and the net identifiable assets and liabilities of the Target Group will have to be assessed. As a result of the assessment, the amount of goodwill may be different from that estimated based on the basis stated above for the purpose of preparation of the unaudited pro forma financial information. Accordingly, the actual goodwill at the date of completion may be different from that presented above. The adjustments are to reflect the effect of the Acquisition on the consolidation balance sheet of the Group as if the Acquisition had taken place and the mining license had been obtained and the feasibility study of the underlying mine has been completed on 30 June 2007. Intangible assets — “Mining Balance at Completion Minority rights” Goodwill interest HK$’000 HK$’000 HK$’000 — 729,188 30,513 Transfer to intangible assets from goodwill when the mining license is obtained (as the balance is regarded as a part of the fair value of the mining rights) 729,188 (729,188) — Shortfall between HK$2,484,062,000 (being the fair value of the intangible assets - “Mining rights”) and HK$729,188,000 (being the amount transferred from goodwill as shown above) 1,754,874 — — — — 1,217,190 2,484,062 — 1,247,703 Shortfall between the balance of HK$30,730,000 (minority interest of the Target Group as at the Completion (Note 3a)) and the balance of HK$1,247,920,000 (being minority interest of the Target Group as at the Completion and upon obtaining the mining licence (Note 3b)) Balance at Completion and upon obtaining the mining license – 178 – APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP Notes to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group (Continued) (4) The adjustment is to reflect the effect on cash and cash equivalents at banks and in hands arising from the Acquisition on the consolidated balance sheet of the Group as if the Acquisition had taken place on 30 June 2007 and is detailed as follows: HK$’000 Cash consideration to be paid to the vendor (Note 1) Cash injection to the Target Group (Note 2) Net proceeds from placing of new shares (100,000) 50,000 90,700 40,700 Based on the unaudited consolidated balance sheet of the Group as at 30 June 2007, the Group did not have adequate cash to settle the above cash consideration of HK$100,000,000. Pursuant to an announcement issued by the Company dated 20 July 2007 regarding the placing agreement to place for 135,000,000 shares at HK$0.69 per share, net proceeds of approximately HK$90,700,000 has been raised. This can be used to settle part of the cash consideration of HK$100,000,000. (5) The adjustment is to reflect the effect on cash flows arising from the Acquisition on the consolidated cash flow statement of the Group as if the Acquisition had taken place on 1 January 2006 and is detailed as follows: HK$’000 Cash consideration to be paid to the vendor (Note 1) (100,000) Cash and cash equivalents in the Target Group as at 1 January 2006 (as extracted in Appendix IIA) Net cash outflow on acquisition (6) 247 (99,753) Cash injection to the Target Group (Note 2) 50,000 Net proceeds from placing of new shares (Note 4) 90,700 The adjustment is to reflect the capitalisation of the shareholder’s loan of HK$31,464,000, immediately before completion of the Acquisition, by the shareholder of the Target Group (Note 2). (7) This adjustment relates to the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds and Tranche 2 Bonds) (Note 1) issued for the purpose of the Acquisition. In accordance with Hong Kong Accounting Standards 32, Financial Instruments: Presentation, the Convertible Bonds are accounted for by two elements, equity component and liability component. The valuation of the Convertible Bonds was carried out by LCH (Asia-Pacific) Surveyors Limited, an independent firm of chartered surveyors. The major assumption adopted in the valuation is the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 2 Bonds) is to be granted three months after the issuing date of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds). The fair value of the liability component of the Convertible Bonds is estimated using the discounted cash flow approach at the prevailing market rate of approximately 9.72%. The fair value of the equity component of the Convertible Bonds is estimated using the Binomial Option Pricing Model. – 179 – APPENDIX III UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP Notes to unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group (Continued) (7) (8) (Continued) (a) At Completion of the Acquisition, an amount of HK$229,543,000 is credited as the liability component of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds). The amount of HK$221,029,000, representing the difference between HK$450,572,000, being the fair value of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds)(Note 1), and the liability component of HK$229,543,000, is recorded as the fair value of the equity component of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds). (b) At Completion of the Acquisition and upon obtaining mining license, an amount of HK$245,787,000 is credited as the liability component of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 2 Bonds). The amount of HK$291,897,000, representing the difference between HK$537,684,000, being the fair value of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 2 Bonds)(Note 1), and the liability component of HK$245,787,000, is recorded as the fair value of the equity component of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 2 Bonds). The adjustment is to reflect the effect of the placing of shares (Note 4) and the issue of Consideration Shares by the Company. HK$’000 Share capital Placing of shares (being 135,000,000 shares of HK$0.01 each) Issue of Consideration Shares (being 270,000,000 shares of HK$0.01 each) 1,350 2,700 4,050 Premium on share issues Placing of shares Issue of Consideration Shares 89,350 207,900 297,250 (9a) The adjustments are to reflect the following transactions arising upon Completion of the Acquisition. HK$’000 Premium on the share issues (Note 1 and Note 8) Reserves of the Target Group as at 30 June 2007 (as extracted from Appendix IIA) Equity component on Convertible Bonds (Tranche 1 Bonds) (Note 7a) 297,250 18,750 221,029 Adjustment at Completion of the Acquisition 537,029 (9b) This represents the adjustment of the equity component of the Convertible Bonds (Tranche 2 Bonds) (Note 7b). (10) The adjustment is to reflect the effect on minority interest arising from the Completion of the Acquisition. The calculation of minority interest has been detailed in Note 3a and 3b above. (11) The adjustment is to reflect the share of loss to minority interest. – 180 – APPENDIX III 5. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP The following is the text of an accountants’ report dated 15 October 2007, prepared for the sole purpose of inclusion in this circular, received from the independent reporting accountants, Grant Thornton, Certified Public Accountants, Hong Kong, in respect of the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP 15 October 2007 The Directors Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Suites 5303-04, 53/F Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road Wanchai Hong Kong Dear Sirs Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited We report on the unaudited pro forma financial information of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries (hereinafter collectively referred to as the “Group”) and Kanson Development Limited (“Target Company”) and its subsidiaries (the “Target Group” and together with the Group hereinafter collectively referred to as the “Enlarged Group”), which has been prepared by the directors of the Company for illustrative purposes only, to provide information about how the acquisition of interests in a company involving issue of consideration shares and convertible bonds (the “Acquisition”) might have affected the financial information presented, for inclusion in Appendix III to the circular of the Company dated 15 October 2007 (the “Circular”). The basis of preparation of the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group is set out in the section headed “Unaudited Pro Forma Financial Information of the Enlarged Group” on page 169 Appendix III to the Circular. – 181 – APPENDIX III 5. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP (Continued) Respective Responsibilities of Directors of the Company and Reporting Accountants It is the responsibility solely of the directors of the Company to prepare the unaudited pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group in accordance with paragraph 4.29 of the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on the Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited (the “Listing Rules”) and with reference to Accounting Guideline 7 “Preparation of Pro Forma Financial Information for Inclusion in Investment Circulars” issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (the “HKICPA”). It is our responsibility to form an opinion, as required by paragraph 4.29 of the Listing Rules, on the unaudited pro forma financial information and to report our opinion to you. We do not accept any responsibility for any reports previously given by us on any financial information used in the compilation of the unaudited pro forma financial information beyond that owed to those to whom those reports were addressed by us at the dates of their issue. Basis of opinion We conducted our engagement in accordance with Hong Kong Standard on Investment Circular Reporting Engagements 300 “Accountants’ Reports on Pro Forma Financial Information in Investment Circulars” issued by the HKICPA. Our work consisted primarily of comparing the unadjusted financial information with source documents, considering the evidence supporting the adjustments and discussing the unaudited pro forma financial information with the directors of the Company. This engagement did not involve independent examination of any of the underlying financial information. We planned and performed our work so as to obtain the information and explanations we considered necessary in order to provide us with sufficient evidence to give reasonable assurance that the unaudited pro forma financial information has been properly compiled by the directors of the Company on the basis stated, that such basis is consistent with the accounting policies of the Group and that the adjustments are appropriate for the purposes of the unaudited pro forma financial information as disclosed pursuant to paragraph 4.29(1) of the Listing Rules. Our work did not constitute an audit or review made in accordance with Hong Kong Standards on Auditing or Hong Kong Standards on Review Engagements issued by the HKICPA, and accordingly, we did not express any such assurance on the unaudited pro forma financial information. – 182 – APPENDIX III 5. UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP ACCOUNTANTS’ REPORT ON UNAUDITED PRO FORMA FINANCIAL INFORMATION OF THE ENLARGED GROUP (Continued) Basis of opinion (Continued) The unaudited pro forma financial information is for illustrative purposes only, based on the judgements and assumptions of the directors of the Company, and because of its hypothetical nature, does not give any assurance or indication that any event will take place in the future and may not be indicative of — the financial position of the Enlarged Group as at 30 June 2007 or any future date; or — the results and cash flows of the Enlarged Group for the year ended 31 December 2006 or any future periods. Opinion In our opinion: a. the unaudited pro forma financial information has been properly compiled by the directors of the Company on the basis stated; b. such basis is consistent with the accounting policies of the Group; and c. the adjustments are appropriate for the purposes of the unaudited pro forma financial information as disclosed pursuant to paragraph 4.29(1) of the Listing Rules. Yours faithfully, Grant Thornton Certified Public Accountants Hong Kong – 183 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION The following is the text of the summary report in the valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 prepared by LCH for the purposes of inclusion in this circular. The readers are reminded that the following report has been prepared in accordance with general evaluation procedures and practice that entitle the valuer to make assumptions which may on further investigation, for instance by the readers’ legal representative, prove to be inaccurate. Any exception is clearly stated below. Headings are inserted for convenient reference only and have no effect in limiting or extending the language of the paragraphs to which they refer. It is emphasised that the findings and conclusion presented below are based on the documents and facts known to the valuer at the date of this report. If additional documents and facts are made available, the valuer reserves the right to amend this report and its conclusion. 17th Floor Champion Building Nos. 287-291 Des Voeux Road Central Hong Kong 15 October 2007 The Directors Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Suites 5303-4 on the 53rd Floor Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road Wanchai Hong Kong Dear Sirs, In accordance with the instruction given to us by the management of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (hereinafter referred to as the “Company”), we have conducted an agreed-upon procedures evaluation of a project to be comprised of a mining portion and a by-product processing portion (hereinafter referred to as the “Project” and to be defined later in this report) as at 31 August 2007 (hereinafter referred to as the “Relevant Date”) for the Company’s internal management reference purpose. The location at which the mining portion of the Project will be carried out is in ɻਝʑၬ̀ Ϭਂ؝ᔾᏜढ़࿏ɩɬ Xiaohongshan, Ejinaqi, Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region of the People’s Republic of China (hereinafter referred to as the “PRC” or “China”). Our findings and conclusion are documented in a narrative report (hereinafter referred to as the “Narrative Report”) and submitted to the Company at today’s date. – 184 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION At the request of the management of the Company, we prepared this summary report to summarise our findings and conclusion as documented in the Narrative Report for the purpose of inclusion in a circular at today’s date for the Company’s shareholders’ reference. Terms used herein without definition shall have the same meanings as in the Narrative Report, and the assumptions and caveats adopted in the Narrative Report also apply to this report. We understand that the management of the Company will use our work product as part of its business due diligence and we have not been engaged to make specific sale or purchase recommendations. We further understand that the management of the Company will not rely solely on our work, and that the use of our work product will not supplant other due diligence which the management of the Company should conduct in reaching its business decision with regards to the Project. Our findings and conclusion in this agreed-upon procedures evaluation are summarised as follows: INTRODUCTION On 20 July 2007, the management of the Company announced that Smooth Way International Limited (hereinafter referred to as the “Purchaser”), a company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands and a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, had entered into a conditional share transfer agreement with, among others, Ms. Leung Lai Ching, Margaret (hereinafter referred to as the “Vendor”) , pursuant to which the Purchaser has agreed to acquire 51% of the entire issued share capital of Kanson Development Limited (hereinafter referred to as the “Target Company”), a company incorporated in the British Virgin Islands and wholly-owned by the Vendor, at a consideration totaling HK$1,000 million in value. The Company, as the warrantor of the Purchaser, also entered into a Share Transfer Agreement, giving representations, warranties and undertakings jointly and severally with the Purchaser in favor of the Vendor. The Target Company is an investment holding company which shall hold 100% interest in Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited (hereinafter referred to as “Hong Kong FSMI”), an incorporation established in Hong Kong, immediately after the completion of the reorganisation involving the members of the group of companies consisting of the Target Company, Hong Kong FSMI and various PRC business entities and the businesses carried on by them or their predecessors. We were given to understand that the principal economic asset of Hong Kong FSMI is its 100% holding of ࣵڇᘊพೕτࠉʔ̇ Qinghai Forest Source Mining Industry Developing Company Limited (hereinafter referred to as “Qinghai Senyuan”), a wholly foreign owned enterprise established in the PRC on 9 April 2004. The registered address of Qinghai Senyuan is at ޘࣵڇϹྟ̟С༏ 53໔ (ࣁڇɣ෨10ᅢ) No. 53 Shengli Road, Xining City, Qinghai Province (10th Floor Qinglu Building). According to a ͬพؒɁᏪพਨ๑ Enterprise Legal Person Business License dated 16 August 2007, the operating term of Qinghai Senyuan is 20 years till 8 April 2024. Qinghai Senyuan is licensed to carry out§ᘊพଐؿۂೕ (ɺфઔ), ˱ɮ, ሻਕ, ޚᗐҌڸ(¨৻רtranslated as exploration (excluding mining), processing, selling and its related technical consultancy services of mineral products). Qinghai Senyuan is the holder of a Mineral Resource Exploration License (hereinafter referred to as the “Exploration Licence”) in respect of the Xiaohongshan (or known as Little Red Mountain in this report) Iron-Titanium-Vanadium Mine (hereinafter referred to as the “Existing LRM Mine”). – 185 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION We were further given to understand that a portion of the Existing LRM Mine of about 2 km (kilometers) times 1 km with an area of about 2 sq. km. (square kilometers) has been undergoing a detailed exploration program, and this parcel of land is referred to as the Target Mine in our report. OUR INSTRUCTIONS TO THIS ENGAGEMENT At the instruction of the management of the Company, we were retained to analyse and prepare an agreed-upon procedures project evaluation report to evaluate the financial net present value of the Project as proposed in a business plan titled “The Iron-Titanium-Vanadium-Ilmenite Mine in Xiaohongshan Business Plan” dated May 2007 and its supplementary information (collectively, hereinafter referred to as the “Business Plan”) provided by the Company’s financial advisor and the appointed personnel of the Vendor. As instructed, our work was based on the Business Plan and a technical report titled “An Independent Technical Assessment on the Little Red Mountain IronTitanium-Vanadium Deposit, Xiao Hong Shan, People’s Republic of China” prepared by a qualified technical consultant, Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited of Canada, in August 2007 (hereinafter referred to as the “Technical Report”) on the Target Mine. PROCEDURES TO EVALUATE In performing our work, we have adopted the following procedures which were agreed with the management of the Company before the engagement. They were: • To prepare and submit a list(s) of required documents and information regarding the Project during the course of evaluation. The completeness of our evaluation depends on the availability of the required information being supplied by the management of the Company or its appointed personnel. • To read and based on the content of the supplied Business Plan and Technical Report, such as mineral resources estimation, by-product information, market information, financial information, and its related materials such as exploration program, explanatory statements and relevant correspondence, to arrive at our conclusion. In the course of our evaluation, we will assume that the information provided in the materials are correct and we will only verify the information when and where possible. However, we will not ascertain the correctness of the information contained in the materials like an auditor in giving an audit opinion. • To hold discussions with relevant personnel in order to have a better understanding of the Project. • To conduct a limited scope of physical inspection to the Target Mine and to give us an understanding of the general environment of the Target Mine. The purpose of the inspection is not to have a full scope investigation on the quantity and the quality of the subjects as contained in the Business Plan and the Technical Report; rather, it is designed to give the valuer a better understanding of the subjects as contained in both documents. – 186 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION • To conduct appropriate research and technical consultation in order to obtain sufficient information to arrive at our conclusion. The extent of research and consultation is at our discretion. • To evaluate the financial net present value of the Project using the appropriate method(s). • To document our findings in our project evaluation report. THE BASIS OF EVALUATION AND ASSUMPTIONS The Project is evaluated on the basis of continued use and as part of a going concern business of a business enterprise (see Note) i.e. the legally interested party in the Project-Qinghai Senyuan. The continued use premise assumes that the Project will be used for the purpose for which it was conceived or is currently carried out. Our evaluation has been made on the assumption that, as at the Relevant Date, 1. the legally interested party in the Project has free and uninterrupted rights to use or assign the interests of the Project for the whole of the unexpired terms as granted and any premiums/ administrative costs payable have already been fully paid; 2. the legally interested party in the Project successfully completed the detailed exploration program (as described in this report) and obtained the expected result within the scheduled time frame; 3. the detailed exploration program and the subsequent mining operations in the Target Mine confirmed the quality and quantity expected in the Business Plan and the Technical Report; 4. the relevant Enterprise Legal Person Business License and/or business registration documents (including Tax Registration Certificate) are able to be renewed after their expiration from time to time in order to achieve the planned extraction phase; 5. the subsequent feasibility studies and governmental endorsement confirmed the quality and quantity discovered during the mine development stage under various reserve classification commonly adopt in the world or in China (the Solid Minerals Resource Classification (GB/ T17766-1999)); 6. the legally interested party in the Exploration Licence is able to obtain, upon completion of the exploration program and successfully achieved the expected result, the mining right of the Target Mine for a term of, say 13 years, from the relevant authorities in China; 7. all required licenses, certificates, consents, or other legislative or administrative authority from any local, provincial, or national government or private entity or organisation have been or can readily be obtained or renewed or replaced on which the evaluation contained in our report are based; Note: A business enterprise is defined as a commercial, industrial, service, or investment entity, or a combination thereof, pursuing an economic activity. – 187 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION 8. the legally interested party in the Project successfully raises fund to finance and to develop the Project as planned, and is able to transport and to sell the predicted by-products to its clientele at market price as projected; 9. the Project successfully yielded the economic benefits as projected in the Business Plan and the Technical Report; 10. the prospective earnings would provide a reasonable return to the legally interested party in the Project and that the legally interested party in the Project has adequate working capital to implement the scheduled exploration program, the mining operations and the operation of the four by-products processing plants from time to time; 11. the legally interested party in the Project has the rights to transport, produce and sell the extracted mineral ores and its by-products after processing to the market, both locally and internationally; 12. the legally interested party in the Project has adopted reasonable and necessary security measures and has considered several contingency plans against any disruption (such as fire, change of government policy, labour dispute, implementation of serious statutory mining safety measures, geologic formation structurally deformed, soil erosion and other types of unexpected accidence) to the scheduled exploration program and mining operations; and 13. the Project, as part of a going concern business of the legally interested party in the Project, can be freely disposed and transferred free of all encumbrances for its existing or approved uses in the market to both local and overseas purchasers without payment of any premium to the government. Should this not be the case, it will have an adverse impact to the reported findings and conclusion herein. – 188 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION INDUSTRY AND MARKET OVERVIEW (SEE NOTE) The Economic Outlook of China The GDP (Gross Domestic Product) growth of China for the last year was 10.7%. With the strong growth of China’s economy at a compound annual growth rate of approximately 10.16% from 1990 to 2006, it is expected that China’s economic growth would remain at 8.5% to 9% from 2008 to 2011. Economists further estimated that the 2008 Olympic Games in Beijing would benefit the nation’s GDP by additional one per cent. For Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, despite of the Macro Regulation and Control from the Chinese government, the growth rate of the GDP in 2005 was about 21.6% and the growth rate in 2006 was 18.0%. The following table listed out the development trend of GDP of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region in recent years (as at the end of each year). Year 2002 2003 2004 2005 2006 GDP Growth (%) 12.1 16.3 19.4 21.6 18 Source: From National Bureau of Statistics of China Mining Industry Mining is a very risky business and the initial work which needs to be carried out in order to find and prove up a deposit will, more often than not, prove it to be uneconomic rather than profitable to exploit. Exploration can be split into two separate parts — one is to find a new mine in the vicinity of an old one, the other is built from scratch by deciding what geological environments are most likely to contain the mineral which is being sought then to be followed by reading through literature to find where those environments are to be found and then sending out an exploration team to test the hypothesis. All mining activity takes place within the earth’s crust, about the top 7-35 km of the solid matter comprising the bulk of the planet. However, the distribution of metals within the crust is by no means uniform, as can be seen by the differences in the types of rock which it contains, be it limestone, granite, sandstone or basalt. Nevertheless, these different rock types are generally of uniform composition, at least locally, and further concentrations need to occur in order to produce concentrations of materials which can be mined and sold at a profit. Such concentrations decided whether a mineral deposit is economically worth to extract or not. There are some generally accepted background concentrations of the major metallic elements and the concentration factors required for economic viability identified by some industry practitioners such as Charles Kernot (1999). These concentration factors are only of importance for the metals because of the geological controls on their formation. Note: The information provided in this section relating to the minerals industry and market is derived in part or extracted or referred to from various official and unofficial sources. The official sources include various quasi-governmental or world organisation websites (such as gov.cn, National Bureau of Statistics of China and World Bank). The unofficial sources include information provided by the management of the Company, various websites (include steel35.com, asianmetal.cn, cnmn.com.cn, alibaba.com.cn, fenmoyejin.com, Bloomberg.com, en.wikipedia.org and Yahoo! Finance), newspapers, research reports and journals (such as U.S. Geological Survey) from various industry practitioners or analysts. We need to state that such official and unofficial information have not been prepared or independently verified by us, and may not be consistent with other information complied within or outside China. None of our staff involved in preparing this report make any representation as to the correctness or accuracy of such information and accordingly such information should not be unduly relied upon. The readers should conduct his/her due diligence with regard to the correctness and accuracy of such information for his/her own use. – 189 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Metal deposits are categorised both in terms of the metals which they contain and the controls on their origin which governs their three dimensional shape. The metals themselves are deemed to be either ferrous (containing iron) or non-ferrous. Non-ferrous metals are, in turn, subdivided into those which are precious, base or minor. The precious metals are essentially limited to gold, platinum and silver as these metals are relatively rare, but have great demand and widely traded. Since 1998, when the Chinese government issued the laws regulating exploration and mining rights, operating a mining business in China must first obtain those rights from the government with a price. The business was considered to be opened to foreign investors in 2003 when the Chinese government allowed the transfer of the mining rights to all kinds of entities. It is now easier and more secure than ever for these foreign mining companies to operate in China. Apart from the above, several measures have also been taken to encourage foreign investment and participation in developing China’s mining industry by the government. These measures include the privatisation of the mining sector, streamlining of permitting and approval processes, granting irrevocable exclusive mining rights to foreign entities and relaxing rules on repatriation of capital profit. These measures benefit not only the foreign investors but also the local miners in that the cost of mining can be reduced and thus more profit can be generated. According to the data released by the China National Bureau of Statistics, China’s total industrial iron and steel products have increased three-fold from 1995 to 2004. China’s crude steel output for year 2006 was 423 million tonnes, up by 19.7% from previous year. Steel use is expected to increase by 13% in 2007, then 10% in 2008 taking the total to 443 million tonnes which accounts for 35% of the world total. A continued and sustained growth in the China steel market is expected in the coming years. The research and development of the titanium industry had started 40 years ago. Now, China is ranked the 4th in the global titanium production market with an annual production of 1,015,000 tonnes in 2005. The output of titanium mill products in China is expected to reach 18,000 tonnes by 2007 with consumption at 20,500 tonnes. The titanium industry in China will continue to grow. THE PROJECT DESCRIPTION (SEE NOTE) A. Historical Background From the information made available to us, Qinghai Senyuan (or the legally interested party in the Project) holds the Exploration License No. 0100000410104 issued by the Ministry of Land Resources of the PRC. This license allows Qinghai Senyuan to explore from 31 December 2006 to 25 November 2008 in an approximately 15.47 sq. km. area lying in Ejinaqi. Under this license, an exploration area of about 15.47 sq. km. from longitude 97˚58’00”E to 98˚01’00”E and latitude 41˚25’00”N to 41˚27’00”N i.e. the Existing LRM Mine was granted to Qinghai Senyuan. Note: Sources from the Business Plan and the Technical Report. – 190 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION The Existing LRM Mine is located approximately 180 km north of Jiayugan City, just east of Gansu Province and situated at the western part of the Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region on a gentle, well rounded, low-hilly land forms, in the eastern end of the Beishan Mountain Range, on the western margin of the Bandanjilin Desert. Elevations ranged from 1,470 meters (m) to 1,580 m above sea level with the difference in elevation generally about 60 m. The Target Mine forms part of the Existing LRM Mine where detailed exploration has been concentrated. It has a rectangular area of 2 km by 1 km oriented NorthWest-SouthEast with the following corner coordinates: Latitudes Longitudes 41˚26’44"N 41˚26’14"N 41˚25’45"N 41˚26’15"N 97˚58’51"E 98˚00’07"E 97˚59’47"E 97˚58’31"E According to the Technical Report, we were further given to understand that extensive drilling program was conducted at the western part of the Target Mine, about an area of 0.7 sq. km., and this particular portion of land is referred to as the Target Mine — First Portion in our report. According to the information provided to us, prior geologic work in the region is summarised below: • 1966 to 1969 — The Geophysical Prospecting Group of the Ministry of Geology discovered two magnetic anomalies. The resulting 1:200,000 scale geologic map was completed by the Geological Survey Team of the Second Region Geology Department of Gansu province. • 1980 — A Level III aerial survey was carried out on the Xiaohongshan magnetic anomaly by the Geophysical Prospecting Team of the Geology Department of Gansu Province. This survey resulted in the decision to carry out additional exploration in the area. • 1986 — A 1:1,000,000 aerial magnetic survey by the Aerial Geophysical Prospecting Team of the Geology and Mineral Ministry further defined the magnetic anomalies. – 191 – APPENDIX IV • VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION 2004 — Qinghai Senyuan commissioned Qinghai Geology Survey of Nuclear Industry to conduct an initial exploration program. A preliminary geological map at 1:2,000 scale, trenches and shallow shafts and mapping of the iron deposits were completed. Qinghai Senyuan further commissioned the Fourth Geology and Mineral Survey Institute of Gansu Province to carry out a 1:2,000 scale topographic mapping of the 2 sq. km. area (i.e. the Target Mine) within the larger permit Target Mine, and to make an analysis of the previous detailed magnetic survey with particular attention to the buried or concealed magnetite anomalies to assist future drilling programs. A total of 37 magnetic anomalies were outlined by geophysical surveying, 18 of which are exposed magnetite orebodies, 6 are blind orebodies and the remaining 13 are caused by gabbros with magnetite mineralization. • 2005 to 2006 — In early November 2005, a contract was signed by Hong Kong FSMI with SINOREX Resource and Environment Engineering (Beijing) Co., Ltd. (hereinafter referred to as “SINOREX”) for SINOREX to carry out the first stage and second stage exploration programs, as mandated by the Chinese requirements. The following table outlines the exploration works that were completed during the first stage and second stage, starting with geological mapping, followed by trenching then by diamond drilling: Description Amount Geological mapping at 1:2,000 scale Geological profile mapping at 1:500 scale Geological profile mapping at 1:1,000 scale Trenching Diamond drilling Trench sampling Diamond drill core samples Hydrogeology drillhole monitoring Groundwater level monitoring Engineering, environmental and hydrogeological mapping Drill core logging Hydrogeological logging of drill core Standard assay sampling Complete assaying Surveying GPS Samples (individual) Polished and thin sections 2 km2 8 linear km 4 linear km 3,053.4 m3 7,510.24 m 2,614.6 m 6,921.33 m 26 dh 3 locations 2 km2 7,510.24 m (26 ddh) 11 ddh 31,617 samples 188 samples 105 stations 100 48 – 192 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION The diamond drilling at the Existing LRM Mine was carried out by SINOREX in two stages, the first stage during 2005 consisting of 13 drillholes (2,461.94 m) and the second stage also consisting of 13 drillholes (5,048.30 m) during 2006. All the diamond drilling has been concentrated in the Target Mine — First Portion on the west side of the Target Mine designated for the detailed exploration program. B. Existing State Qinghai Senyuan has been conducting a geological exploration program within the Target Mine, with the intention to obtain rights for the development of an Iron-Titanium-Vanadium mine. Though the previous drillings were concentrated on the west side of the Target Mine i.e. the Target Mine — First Portion, we were advised that additional exploration is being carried out in the remaining portion (east side) of the Target Mine. While the entire concession covers an area of 15.47 sq. km., the exploration and mining area staked out for the current state is set at the Target Mine. From the information provided, the exploration programs carried out have already determined the overall geometry of seven, separate lenticular ore bodies (located at the western end of the Target Mine) of titaniferous magnetite that contain recoverable amounts of iron, titanium, vanadium and phosphorous. The average grade of contained metal in ores is 19.5% iron, 3.86% titanium and 0.03% vanadium. After metallurgical dressing processes, the recovery rate of iron concentrate is 56-57%, of phosphate concentrate is 28-35% and of titanium concentrate is 43-48%. Geological investigation and metallurgical testing conducted on the Target Mine since 2004 by SINOREX and the Changsha Research Institute of Mining and Metallurgy confirmed that, the mineral ores at the Target Mine contains titaniferous magnetite which contains recoverable amounts of iron, titanium, vanadium and phosphorous. These test results were further verified by the qualified technical consultant we referred to in this report. According to the research conducted by SINOREX, the mineral resources of the seven identified orebodies within the Target Mine — First Portion are divided into three categories: category (331), category (332) and category (333). A total of approximately 30 million tonnes (including the inferred category) mineral resources has been estimated. After testing and sampling, results show that the Target Mine possess valuable minerals mainly iron, titanium and vanadium with good grindability. High quality saleable product can be produced commercially. Based on the Technical Report we referred to in this report, we were given to understand that the total indicated mineral resources was estimated at approximately 16.2 million tonnes for the three zones in the Target Mine — First Portion i.e. Zone 101, Zone 102 and Zone 103, and the total inferred mineral resources was estimated at approximately 260,000 tonnes for Zone 103 only. – 193 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION The qualified technical consultant in the Technical Report mentioned the estimation of the mineral resources of the Existing LRM Mine prepared by China ENFI Engineering Corporation (hereinafter referred to as “ENFI”) in its mine engineering report. It reported that ENFI estimated within the Target Mine — First Portion, has a total measured and indicated mineral resources of approximately 18.78 million tonnes and an inferred mineral resources of approximately 11.68 million tonnes. However, the Technical Report made no further comments on such estimation. The qualified technical consultant agreed with ENFI that additional drilling is required immediately to increase the mineral resources/reserve to produce a viable and profitable operation. It was reported that mine recoverable mineral reserves contained within the designed open pit by ENFI totaled 12 million tonnes @ 19.5% Fe (iron) and 4.2% TiO2 (titanium dioxide), and the mine life was estimated by the qualified technical consultant to be 5 years. However, the potential for increasing mineable reserves, and mine life, through revised pit optimization and additional drilling is considered by the qualified technical consultant to be highly probable. According to the advice given by the appointed personnel of the Vendor, a detailed feasibility study and a mine plan are in the process of preparation by ENFI, and it is expected that Qinghai Senyuan will receive all the necessary approvals from the authorities in late 2007. Qinghai Senyuan will then start to design and construct the mine. The Technical Report reported that a diamond drilling program began in early August this year with two rigs on the south side of the present design pit and a third rig on the untested magnetic anomalies to the east of the pit within the Target Mine. It is expected that the construction of the mine will be completed in 2009 and mining operations will start simultaneously and be normalised in 2010 onwards. A dressing plant will be built at a location very close to the mining site in order to carry on the dressing processes. The ore rock recovered from open pit mining will be delivered to the dressing plants and will undergo various dressing processes including magnetic separation and floatation for the extraction of the mineral concentrates. After a series of weak magnetic separations, iron concentrates of 56-57% grading will be extracted from the ores. The iron concentrates will be totally used to stock feed the direct reduction of iron concentrate plant. The remaining substance after the weak magnetic separations will go through a strong magnetic separation. After a phosphate flotation process, a phosphate concentrate of 28-35% grading will be formed. The remaining substance will go through a titanium flotation process and titanium concentrate of 43-48% grading will be formed. When the production is fully normalised in 2010, an amount of 156,000 tonnes of titanium concentrate and an amount of 124,800 tonnes of phosphate concentrate will be produced annually. The phosphate concentrate will be sold as end-products but the titanium concentrates will be used as input in the direct reduction of titanium concentrate process. A Direct Reduction of Iron Concentrate plant will be built in Qingshan, near Yumen, Gansu Province in 2008. In this plant, iron concentrate from the dressing plant will be fed in and go through a process of pelletisation. After cooling, crushing, grinding and magnetic separation, direct reduced iron powder will be produced. It will be sold as end product to the market. In 2010, an amount of 185,472 tonnes of direct reduced iron will be produced from the iron – 194 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION concentrates annually. The tailings from the production of direct reduced iron powder contain titanium and vanadium. With further processing of the tailings, vanadium pentoxide graded at 99% and titanium dioxide graded at 46% will be obtained. The vanadium pentoxide is sold as an end product called direct reduced vanadium. In 2010, an amount of 1,142 tonnes of direct reduced vanadium will be produced annually. A High-End DRI plant will be built in 2009 in the same area as the Direct Reduction of Iron Concentrate plant. Some of the direct reduced iron from the DRI plant will be further used to make High-End Direct Reduced Iron Powder (98% Fe). From 2010 onwards, there will be a production of 85,169 tonnes of high-end direct reduced iron powder each year. A Direct Reduction of Titanium Concentrate plant will be constructed within the same area for the production of high grade titanium oxide with grading of more than 90%. This plant contains a reduction plant and a corrosion plant. With a reducing temperature of 1100 degree Celsius and two and a half hours of reduction time, metallized pellets has been obtained. After further corrosion separation, high grade titanium oxide will be produced. In 2010, 74,412 tonnes of high grade titanium oxide will be produced. In the process of producing high grade titanium oxide, two substances: hematite and iron concentrate are formed too. Both substances will be sold into the market. In 2010, there will be 8,642 tonnes of hematite produced annually. Currently there is no water and power supply at the mining site in Xiaohongshan. A few essential infrastructures are to be constructed at the site including an access road from Yumen, water supply, power supply and communication systems. Together, the Target Mine — First Portion and the four by-product processing plants form the subject of the Project as part of a going concern business of the legally interests party in the Project. As at the Latest Practical Date of this circular, no detailed construction or development schedule of the Target Mine — First Portion or the named by-product processing plants were made available to us for inspection, thus, our work depends solely on the advices given by the management of the Company and the documents provided to us. C. Establishment of Titles Due to the purpose of this engagement, the management of the Company was requested to provide us the necessary documents to support that the legally interested party in the Project i.e. Qinghai Senyuan has free and uninterrupted rights to assign or to transfer the Project (a part of or the whole of) free of all encumbrances and any premiums/administrative costs payable have already been paid in full. We have been provided with various copies of title documents and a PRC legal opinion dated 15 October 2007 issued by Jingtian & Gongcheng (hereinafter referred to as the “Legal Opinion”) regarding the Target Mine — First Portion. According to the Legal Opinion, Qinghai Senyuan – 195 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION has obtained full legal and beneficial title in respect of the exploration of the Target Mine — First Portion, and is the legally interested party in the exploration of the Target Mine — First Portion. Thus, Qinghai Senyuan, after complying with the rules and regulations in China and having registered in the relevant governmental authorities, has the right to transfer and assign part of its exploration rights in the Target Mine. However, we have not inspected the original documents to verify ownership or to verify any amendment which may not appear on the copies handed to us. We have complied with the requirements as stated in Practice Note No. 12 of the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited and relied solely on the copy of the Legal Opinion with regard to the existing legally interested party in the Target Mine — First Portion. No responsibility and liability is assumed in relation to those opinions or copies of documents. Due to inherent defects in the land registration system of China, we are unable to inspect the original documents from the relevant land registration departments to verify the existing titles of or any material encumbrances that might be attached to the land related subjects in the Project. We are not in the legal profession, thus we are unable to ascertain the titles and to report any encumbrances that may be registered against the land related subjects in the Project. We further emphasised that we are unable to, or not in the position of, opining or commenting on the legal procedures and time to be required to achieve the final goal of the Project. No responsibility or liability is assumed. Having said that, we were given to understand that the management of the Company has obtained the Legal Opinion to satisfy them as to the legal status of it. D. Inspections and Investigations of the Target Mine We have, when and where possible, conducted a limited scope of inspections of the Target Mine in respect of which we have been provided with such information as we have requested for the purpose of our evaluation. With regard to the occupation status of the Target Mine, we have relied solely on the information provided by the management of the Company and its appointed personnel. No verification from our part is assumed. Due to the agreed-upon procedures basis, we were unable to inspect those parts which were covered, unexposed, inaccessible or not being arranged for inspection. We cannot express an opinion about or advice upon the condition of the Target Mine and our report should not be taken as making any implied representation or statement about the conditions of the Target Mine. We did not conduct any structural survey, drilling, sampling, investigation, test or examination, or any means of geological test or assay or engineering or survey in the Target Mine. No tests were carried out to any utilities (if any) and we are unable to identify those utilities covered, unexposed or inaccessible. It is emphasised that the inspection and the use of our report do not purport to be a conditional survey of the Target Mine. We have assumed that the Target Mine is free of rot and inherent danger or serious geologic formation structurally deformed and soil erosion. We were given to understand that the management of the Company has employed various technical consultants to advise them on this area. – 196 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION As agreed, the purpose of the inspection is not to have a full scope investigation on the quantity and the quality of the Target Mine; rather, it is designed to give us a better understanding of the Target Mine and its surrounding areas. No responsibility or liability is assumed. We have not carried out on-site measurements to verify the correctness of the dimensions, specifications and areas of the Target Mine, but have assumed that the figures shown on the documents and handed to us are correct. All dimensions, measurements and areas are approximations. Our engagement and the agreed procedures to work did not include an independent land survey to verify the legal boundaries and the exact location of the Target Mine. We need to state that we are not in the land survey profession in China, therefore, we are not in the position to verify or ascertain the correctness of the legal boundaries and location of the Target Mine that appeared on the documents handed to us. No responsibility from our part is assumed. FACTORS CONSIDERED IN THE EVALUATION Unless otherwise stated, the evaluation of the Project has taken account of all pertinent factors affecting the Project and its ability, if successful, to generate future investment returns as part of a going concern business of the legally interested party in the Project. The factors considered in the evaluation included, but were not limited to, the following: • the nature and the characteristics of the Project, including the historical background and the ground work for the Project; • the use of the Project as part of a going concern business of the legally interested party in the Project; • the initial life of the Project, as advised in the Business Plan, i.e. 13 years; • the cost and financial information as contained in the Business Plan; • technical evaluation of the mining portion of the Project; • business advices of the by-product processing portion of the Project; • projected future results in the Business Plan based on assumptions made by the appointed personnel from Hong Kong FSMI; • the nature of the exploration right and the mining right (if obtained) such as the remaining life and its characteristics; – 197 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION • the nature and the going concern business of Qinghai Senyuan in the Project; • the legally interested party in the Project is able to obtain a valid Mining License following the Exploration License and be part of the going concern business of the legally interested party in the Project; • the quality of the proposed mining facilities; • the capability of the legally interested party in the Project to raise fund to finance the exploration program, the construction of the mine and its subsequent operations; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to follow the planned development schedule in the Business Plan; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to maintain its proposed clientele as disclosed in the Business Plan; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to continue the proposed marketing strategy of its predicted by-products, if successful; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to construct and implement the scheduled production process to produce relevant by-products to attract customers as predicted; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to follow the government and industry management quality standards and to review/up-lift its standards to catch the industry need from time to time; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to protect its mining operations, if successful, against any disruption of the normal operation of the proposed mine; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to maintain a cost effective and stable supply chain of the materials to produce its predicted products; • the capability and determination of the legally interested party in the Project to maintain an experienced management team as part of its going concern business; • the economic and industry data affecting the Project and the mining industry in China; • the market-derived investment returns of similar business; and, • the risks facing the operations as proposed in the Business Plan. PROJECT COST Please refer to the Technical Report in Appendix VII in this circular with sections heading Capital Cost Summary and Operating Costs for the details. – 198 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION FINANCIAL EVALUATION Generally speaking, there are several conventional capital investment evaluation techniques, namely the Payback Period, the Rate of Return Method and the Discounted Cash Flows Method. The use of the Payback Period and the Rate of Return Method or the like is designed to serve the purpose of comparing between two or more capital investment projects simultaneously, and to help the investor(s) to examine a sound investment decision between the analysed projects by comparing the period to recover cost of investments or rate of return on capital employed. While the Discounted Cash Flows Method is designed to serve the purpose of evaluating the total sum of money to be received during the useful life of a project by investing certain amount of capital after considered the time value of money (see Note). The first step of the evaluation is to estimate the economic income projection. The projections of the future revenues used in this evaluation were prepared by the appointed personnel of Hong Kong FSMI and provided by the management of the Company, and they are responsible for the assumptions upon which the projections are based. Having discussed with the appointed personnel of Hong Kong FSMI, we understood that the assumptions they adopted reflected their judgment of their ability to market and to produce the predicted products through its marketing strategy and client networks. The projections used in our evaluation are based on the view of the management of Hong Kong FSMI and contained in the Business Plan. The management of Hong Kong FSMI confirmed to us that they have had due regard to published research data, current industry conditions and relevant experience, and they attested that the supplied data are accurate and reasonable. We were given to understand that it represented the most likely result to be made by Qinghai Senyuan in operating the Project, if successful. These data have been utilised without further verification. Payback Period Payback measures the number of years it is expected to take to recover the cost of the original investment. It is calculated by estimating the annual cash flows from the commencement of a project to the end of its useful life. Initially the outflow will be negative, but, within a year or two from the start of most projects, positive cash flows will occur. This is a simple method and usually used as a first screening method (quoted from Investment Appraisal by G. Mott for the readers’ easy reference). However, we have reservation to use this simple method for it ignores any cash received after the payback period which cash flows after the payback period are usually much larger than before. And, it makes no attempt to relate the cash earned on the investment to the amount actually invested. In other words, it failed to measure the total profitability over the whole life of the investment. Some analysts commented this method encouraging a short term view and discriminate against long term projects and growth projects, like this Project. This technique is only good to making comparison between two capital investment projects and to help to examine a sound investment decision between the two projects and, appropriate for entity where short term cash flows is more important than long term cash flows. Return on Capital Employed This method also known as the accounting rate of return. It is calculated by estimating average annual pre-tax profit as a percentage of the average capital employment i.e. the original investment. Analysts considered this method is good to measure a project if the entity is concerned with profits rather than liquidity over a period of time. However, like the previous method, it ignores the time value of money and takes no account of the timing of the profits for it take averaging over a period of time (quoted from Investment Appraisal of The CIMA for the readers’ easy reference). Note: The time value of money is based on the premise that one will prefer to receive a certain amount of money today than the same amount in the future, all else equal. – 199 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION We consider this method as irrelevant for the ratio in consideration is based on averaging profit over a period of time, not cash flows, which is hard to determine to the Project at present moment. Ipso facto, we have reservation to use the non-discounting but comparison evaluation techniques in appraising the Project for there did not have other capital investment project(s) for compare. We take the view that the comparison evaluation techniques, in this instance, can only be used when there are benchmarks to compare, say, statutory planned rate of return or payback period, and the evaluation is required for statutory purposes. However, to the best of our understanding, this evaluation is not intended to serve such statutory purposes nor there are reasonable, market-orientated benchmarks published by any recognised authorities in China for the investors to follow. Last but not the least, our instruction was to conduct a financial evaluation based on the materials provided in the Business Plan and to arrive at the financial net present value of the Project, if successful. Under such circumstance, we consider the use of the non-discounting comparison evaluation techniques in this engagement is irrelevant. Discounted Cash Flows Method (see Note) In considering the Discounted Cash Flow (“DCF”) Method as the most appropriate method to assess the profitability of the Project, we have used the Net Present Value Method. By using this method, the expected cash flows on the Project are set out year by year and brought to a present value by use of present value factors at the appropriate rate. In constructing the cumulative present value table, positive present values are netted off against deficit present values so as to arrive at the “net present value” or in short form, NPV. When this net figure is positive then the Project is said to be viable because the stream if inflows is sufficient to pay the interest at the specified rate. Conversely, when the net present value is negative then the Project is not viable. The NPV is the difference between the present values of project benefits and project costs. The financial NPV is computed using the following formula (for illustration purpose): NPV bi – ci ∑n i =0 (1 + r)i where bi = benefits in period i ci = costs in period i r = discount rate n = discounting period The decision criterion is, as said, simple — to accept a project with NPV greater than or equal to zero, and reject if otherwise. Note: Data from Bloomberg.com – 200 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION By constructing a cumulative present value table, a cash flows table is required. In preparing the cash flows table, this would necessitate the subtraction, from net income, the capital expenditures and net changes in working capital and the addition of depreciation in the computation of cash flows year by year. The use of the NPV Method and its related analysis reflect investment criteria and requires the valuer to make empirical and subjective assumptions. The next step is to estimate the appropriate present value factor i.e. discount rate. Discount rate equals cost of capital. The cost of capital represents investors’ expectations and for any given investment is a combination of three basic factors, namely the risk-free rate, the expected inflation and a premium for risk. There are many ways to estimate the discount rate such as the Build-up Model, the Capital Asset Pricing Model and the Arbitrage Pricing Model for equity investment and the Weighted Average of Cost of Capital for normal project investment. The use of the appropriate model in each analyse depends on numerous factors, in particular the future capital structure of the investment. There is no universal model that applies to all cases. In this engagement, we have considered the Weighted Average Cost of Capital (“WACC”). The WACC Model is an average representing the expected return on all of a company’s capital. Each source of capital, such as stocks, bonds, and other debt, is assigned a required rate of return, and then these required rates of return are weighted in proportion to the share each source of capital contributes to the company’s capital structure. The resulting rate is what the firm would use as a minimum for evaluating a capital project or investment (extracted from investorwords.com for readers’ easy understanding). The WACC is computed using the following formula (for illustration purpose): WACC = Pe x Re + P1 x R1 Where Pe = percentage of equity investment to total capital funds P1 = percentage of loaned funds Re = opportunity cost of capital of equity funds R1 = effective cost of loaned funds In estimating the appropriate WACC in this engagement, we have considered two available sources of WACC and choose the most appropriate source. Firstly, we noticed that there are a numbers of – 201 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION publicly traded companies in the Shenzhen Stock Exchange or Shanghai Stock Exchange in China that have approximately similar line of business as the Project. Examples of these companies are as follow: Name Market Capitalisation (RMB in Million) Weighting WACC Weighted WACC 4,679.74 0.01 13.50% 0.17% 26,049.92 27,908.67 21,933.08 12,495.97 13,133.70 4,882.68 0.07 0.08 0.06 0.03 0.04 0.01 10.36% 12.11% 12.68% 11.59% 11.54% 9.40% 0.74% 0.93% 0.77% 0.40% 0.42% 0.13% 31,710.90 0.09 11.79% 1.03% 5,065.69 0.01 12.02% 0.17% 5,258.43 0.01 12.63% 0.18% 14,918.40 21,025.20 1,726.72 0.04 0.06 0.00 12.83% 13.50% 12.62% 0.53% 0.78% 0.06% 15,262.92 0.04 13.79% 0.58% 30,157.99 0.08 12.13% 1.01% 13,180.16 0.04 9.79% 0.36% 53,046.50 0.15 9.40% 1.37% 38,844.38 0.11 11.47% 1.23% 22,158.43 0.06 10.11% 0.62% 363,439.48 1.0 Guizhou Yibai Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. Sichuan Hongda Co., Ltd. Huludao Zinc Industry Co., Ltd. Baoji Titanium Industry Co., Ltd. Xiamen Tungsten Co., Ltd. Zhuzhou Smelter Group Co., Ltd. Henan Yuguang Gold & Lead Co., Ltd. Yunnan Chihong Zinc & Germanium Co., Ltd. China Tungsten and Hightech Materials Co., Ltd. Tibet Mineral Development Co., Ltd. Shandong Gold-Mining Co., Ltd. Zhongjin Gold Co., Ltd. Qinghai Jinrui Mineral Development Co., Ltd. Inner Mongolia Baotou Steel Rare-Earth Hi-Tech Co., Ltd. Shenzhen Zhongjin Lingnan Nonfemet Company Limited Chengde Xinxin Vanadium and Titanium Co., Ltd. Maanshan Iron & Steel Company Limited Tangshan Iron and Steel Company Limited Jinan Iron and Steel Company Ltd. Total: Source: From Bloomberg.com at August 2007 * Due to rounding process, the figures in the table may not be added up to totals – 202 – 11.45% APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Secondly, we take the view that cost of capital in a capital investment project is forward looking, same as the capital investment project itself. Thus, we need to take into consideration of the capital structure of the project in the future to determine its required cost of capital i.e. discount rate. In this respect, we understand that it is the Company’s intention to acquire the interest of the Project soon, after that, the Project will form part of the going concern business of the Company, and that the capital structure of the Project will be tied up with the Company. We, then, used the WACC of the Company at 8.99 per cent. (or %) plus the difference between Hong Kong and mainland China (about 0.3 per cent. as quoted from damodaran.com) for discounting the Project’s estimated economic benefit because the Project and the Company will have the same systematic risk and the same debt capacity in the future. Moreover, an additional risk premium, say 6% was added to both scenarios to reflect the possible risk of this Project. For the estimation of the long-term growth rate, we have made reference to the Company, China’s economy and the iron, titanium and vanadium ores markets as a whole. Having considered the quantity and quality of available data, and each analysed method in providing a valid indication of discount rate, we have, therefore, assigned a discount rate of 16.4% (rounding) in the evaluation before inflation factor (2 per cent. per annum) adjustment. Thus, our financial evaluation of the Project, if successful, subject to the assumptions and financial parameters stated above became: WACC Net Present Value (RMB) Range 15.4% 16.4% 17.4% 2,379,000,000 2,255,000,000 2,139,000,000 Optimistic Expected Pessimistic We have conducted a sensitivity analysis to determine whether or not the Project will remain feasible if changes in the assumptions used in the calculations/projections were to take place. Three sensitivity analysis scenarios are used in the financial evaluation of the Project: Case I: Increase in projected costs by 10 per cent. till 2010 then constant. WACC 15.4% 16.4% 17.4% Net Present Value (RMB) Range 2,241,000,000 2,118,000,000 2,005,000,000 Optimistic Expected Pessimistic – 203 – APPENDIX IV Case II: VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Decrease in revenues by 10 per cent till 2010 then constant. WACC Net Present Value (RMB) Range 2,259,000,000 2,137,000,000 2,025,000,000 Optimistic Expected Pessimistic 15.4% 16.4% 17.4% Case III: Combination of Cases I and II. WACC Net Present Value (RMB) Range 2,121,000,000 2,001,000,000 1,891,000,000 Optimistic Expected Pessimistic 15.4% 16.4% 17.4% The summarised sensitivities analysis scenarios indicated that under a pessimistic scenario with a projected cost increase 10 per cent. and projected sales decrease 10 per cent. simultaneously, there would have a drop of NPV of RMB 364 million, about 16 per cent. dropped. The Project remains feasible at an internal rate of return of 16.4% per cent. Cost increased Revenue decrease Combined Variables Optimistic 10% 10% 10% both 2,241 2,259 2,121 Net Present Value RMB (million) Expected 2,118 2,137 2,001 Pessimistic 2,005 2,025 1,891 RISKS AND ISSUES FACING THE PROJECT A. Mineral Resources Classification Systems In establishing the level of economic viability, the terms Resources and Reserves are the key terms generally used. Definitions excerpted from the JORC Code adequately reflect the typical meanings of these two terms. Resource • Mineral Resources — A concentration or occurrence of material of intrinsic economic interest in or on the Earth’s crust in such form, quality and quantity that there are reasonable prospects for eventual economic extraction. The location, quantity, grade, geological characteristics and continuity of a Mineral Resource are known, estimated or interpreted from specific geological evidence and knowledge. Mineral Resources are sub-divided, in order of increasing geological confidence, into Inferred, Indicated and Measured categories. – 204 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Reserve • Ore Reserve — The economically mineable part of a Measured and/or Indicated Mineral Resource. It includes diluting materials and allowances for losses, which may occur when the material is mined. Appropriate assessments and studies have been carried out, and include consideration of and modification by realistically assumed mining, metallurgical, economic, marketing, legal, environmental, social and governmental factors. These assessments demonstrate at the time of the reporting that extraction could reasonably be justified. Ore Reserves are sub-divided in order of increasing confidence into Probable Ore Reserves and Proved Ore Reserves. In summary, resources are considered to be potentially economic to extract, although this has not been determined at the date of the estimate, and their estimation is based on geologic knowledge. Various degrees of geologic assurance are applied to resource estimates. Similarly, estimates of reserves are based on geologic knowledge. However, a number of additional criteria must be met, including the ability to extract economically as well as meeting legal, environmental, and a number of other factors. B. Exploration Standards Based on China’s technical standards, exploration is generally divided into four stages, as follows: • Reconnaissance — This level of work identifies areas of enhanced mineral potential on a regional scale based primarily on the results of a variety of tasks, including geological studies, regional geologic mapping, airborne and indirect methods, preliminary field inspection in addition to geologic inference and extrapolation. The objective is to identify mineralized areas worthy of further investigation towards deposit identification. Estimates of quantities should be made only if sufficient data are available and when an analogy with known deposit(s) of similar geologic character is possible, and then only on an order-of-magnitude basis. • Prospecting — This level of work comprises a systematic process of searching for a mineral deposit by narrowing down areas of promising enhanced mineral potential. The methods utilized are outcrop identification, geological mapping, and indirect methods such as geophysical and geochemical studies. Limited trenching, drilling, and sampling may be carried out. The objective is to identify a deposit that will be the target for further exploration. Estimates of quantities are inferred, based on interpretation of geological, geophysical, and geochemical results. – 205 – APPENDIX IV • VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION General Exploration — This level of work involves the initial delineation of an identified deposit. Methods used include surface mapping; widely spaced sampling, trenching, and drilling for preliminary evaluation of mineral quantity and quality (including mineralogical tests on a laboratory scale if required), and limited interpolation based on indirect methods of investigation. The objectives are to establish the primary geologic features of the deposit, give a reasonable indication of continuity, and provide an initial estimate of size, shape, structure, and grade. The degree of accuracy should be sufficient to allow a decision to be made as to whether a prefeasibility study and detailed exploration are warranted. • Detailed Exploration — This level of work involves a detailed three-dimensional delineation of a known deposit achieved through sampling, such as from outcrops, trenches, drill holes, shafts, and tunnels. Sampling grids are closely spaced such that size, shape, structure, grade, and other relevant characteristics of the deposit are estimated with a high degree of accuracy. Processing tests involving bulk samples may be required. A decision whether to conduct a feasibility study can be made from the information provided by detailed exploration. As advised, the existing exploration program is designed to meet the requirements of the Detailed Exploration stage. According to the Technical Report we referred to in this report, the project was classified by the qualified technical consultant as at Scoping Study or Preliminary Assessment level. C. Budgeted Tonnage The Technical Report stated three different sets of estimated tonnage on the mineral resources of the Target Mine — First Portion, namely from the qualified technical consultant, from the SINOREX and from the ENFI. The figures are summarised below for reader’s easy reference: Tonnes Measured (331) Indicated (332) Inferred (333) Total Technical Report SINOREX ENFI — 16,207,012 259,689 11,880,312 4,338,962 13,294,512 14,390,000 4,390,000 11,680,000 16,466,701 29,513,786 30,460,000 In the Technical Report, the qualified technical consultant explained the reason for the difference as “The WGM (qualified technical consultant) Indicated Mineral Resource estimate at 16.2 million tonnes @ 19.46% Fe and 3.86% TiO2 compares favourable with ENFI Measured and Indicated Mineral Resources of 18.78 million tonnes at 19.44% Fe and 3.87% TiO2. WGM mineral resources were estimated only for Zones I, II, and III. SINOREX estimated 1.7 Mt for Zones IV and V in classifications 331 and 332, equivalent to Measured and Indicated categories”. We made no comments on the difference between the measured and the indicated mineral resources. In the course of our work, we were advised to base on the estimated tonnage by ENFI to start our evaluation. – 206 – APPENDIX IV D. VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Environmental We were not aware of the content of any environmental audit or other environmental investigation or soil survey which may have been carried out in the Target Mine and which may draw attention to any contamination or the possibility of any such contamination as at the Latest Practical Date of this circular. In undertaking our work, we have been instructed to assume that no contaminative or potentially contaminative uses have ever been carried out in the Target Mine. We have not carried out any investigation into past or present uses, either of the Target Mine or of any neighbouring land, to establish whether there is any contamination or potential for contamination to the Target Mine from these uses or sites, and have therefore assumed that none exists. However, should it be established subsequently that contamination, seepage or pollution exists at the Target Mine or on any neighbouring land, or that the premises have been or are being put to a contaminative use, this might affect the conclusion now reported. For the detail of the environmental issue, please refer to the Technical Report in Appendix VII in this circular with section heading Environmental Assessment for the details. MATTERS THAT MIGHT AFFECT THE EVALUATION We noted that the progress of exploration of the mining portion of the Project was technically classified as at Scoping Study or Preliminary Assessment level in the Technical Report and the qualified technical consultant opined that this is equivalent to Detailed Exploration level in accordance with the China exploration standard. In the absence of any approved feasibility study report of the Target Mine — First Portion by the relevant governmental authorities or reserve estimation of the Target Mine — First Portion made by the qualified technical consultant as at the Latest Practical Date of this circular, our work is preliminary in nature and suitable only for making a reference as to whether the Business Plan, if successful, will yield the economic benefit to the legally interested party in the Project subject to the known facts and hypothesises as contained in the above documents. We need to state that this report is not a detailed evaluation of the feasibility of developing a mine and its subsequent four by-product processing plants as proposed in the Business Plan; rather, it is an objective evaluation of the financial net present value of the Project as proposed in the Business Plan and the Technical Report. No allowance has been made in the evaluation for any charges, mortgages, outstanding premium or amounts owing on the subjects as contained in the Project. In the course of evaluation, we have assumed that the Project is able to implement without any legal impediment (especially from the regulators). Should this not be the case, it will affect the reported conclusion significantly. The readers are reminded to have their own legal due diligence work on such issues. No responsibility or liability is assumed. As at the Latest Practical Date of this circular, we have not identify any adverse news against the Project which may affect our findings and conclusion in our report. Thus, we are not in the position to report and comment on its impact (if any) to the Project. However, should it be established subsequently that such news did exist as at the date of this report, we reserve the right to amend this report and conclusion reported herein. – 207 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION SOURCES OF INFORMATION AND ITS VERIFICATION For the purpose of our work, we were furnished with the Business Plan and the Technical Report and other documents related to the Project as part of a going concern business of Qinghai Senyuan. The projections of the future revenues and expenditures as part of a going concern business of Qinghai Senyuan were prepared by the appointed personnel of Hong Kong FSMI and they are responsible for the assumptions upon which the projections are based. Having discussed with the management of Hong Kong FSMI, we understood that the assumptions adopted by them reflect their judgment on the ability of the Project, if successful, as part of the going concern business of Qinghai Senyuan to derive economic income within a hypothetical and legally allowed operation term. The projections are based on their view of the most likely result to be arrived at on a going concern basis. These data have been utilised without further verification. We have had no reason to doubt the truth and accuracy of the information that we have been furnished. No responsibility is assumed for the accuracy of the provided information. For the purpose of this evaluation, we were furnished with various copies of the above named documents related to this report and these copies have been referenced without further verifying with the relevant bodies and/or authorities. We need to state that we are not attorney of laws by nature, therefore, we are not in the position to advise and comment on the legality and effectiveness of the documents provided by the management of Hong Kong FSMI via the Company. No responsibility is assumed. We have relied solely on the information provided by the management of Hong Kong FSMI via the Company or its appointed personnel without further verification and have fully accepted advice given to us on such matters as planning approvals or statutory notices, procedures to obtain necessary approvals, locations, titles, easements, tenure, occupation, clientele, products (type and class), site areas and all other relevant matters. Our procedures to evaluate did not include undertaking a feasibility study of the proposed expansion of the Project. Accordingly we do not express an opinion as to the merit or demerit of any future expansion (if any). Unless otherwise stated, we have not carried out an evaluation on a redevelopment basis on the Target Mine — First Portion and the study of possible alternative development options and the related economics do not come within the scope of our report. We are not contracted to conduct a due diligence to review the existing mining industry and the official policy on grating out mining right of mineral resources in China. In the course of our work, we have solely depended on the advice given by the management of Hong Kong FSMI via the Company. We are unable to accept any responsibility for the reliability of the advice. Also, we are not contracted to conduct a detailed geological study or pre-feasibility study or feasibility study or mining report, thus, the report is not a detailed evaluation of the feasibility of developing a mine in the Target Mine. In the course of our work, we have solely depended on the Technical Report and advice given by the management of Hong Kong FSMI via the Company. We are unable to accept any responsibility for the reliability of the advice. – 208 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Our engagement did not include an independent land or geological survey to verify the information provided. Since we are not the authorised person to conduct geological survey in China and the enormous resources required in conducting a detailed inspection and survey, we were further instructed to conduct our work based on the information given in the Business Plan and the Technical Report. We are unable to accept any responsibility for the reliability of the information given in these documents. Information furnished by others, upon which all or portions of our report are based, is believed to be reliable but has not been verified in all cases. Our procedures to evaluate or work do not constitute an audit, review, or compilation of the information provided. Thus, no warranty is made nor liability assumed for the accuracy of any data, advice, opinions, or estimates identified as being furnished by others which have been used in formulating our report. When we adopted the work products from other professions, external service/data providers and/or the management of Hong Kong FSMI in our evaluation, the assumptions and caveats adopted by them in arriving at their opinions also apply in our evaluation. The procedures we have taken do not require us to examine all the evidences, like an auditor, in reaching at our opinion. As we have not performed an audit, we are not expressing an audit opinion in our evaluation. We are unable to accept any responsibility for the information that has not been supplied to us by the management of Hong Kong FSMI via the Company. We have sought and received confirmation from the management of the Company that no material factors have been omitted from the information supplied. The report is based upon the assumption of full disclosure between the Company and us of material and latent facts that may affect the appraisal. No responsibility is assumed for withheld information (if any). Unless otherwise stated, the base currency of our report is Renminbi Yuan (“RMB”). CONCLUSION Based on the investigation, analysis, stated assumptions, limitations, reasoning and data outlined as above, and on the evaluation methods employed, it is our opinion that as of the Relevant Date the financial net present value of the Project (before taking into consideration any transaction costs), as part of a going concern business of Qinghai Senyuan, if successful, under the Business Plan, is reasonably stated by the amounts of RENMINBI TWO THOUSAND TWO HUNDRED AND FIFTY FIVE MILLION YUAN (RMB2,255,000,000). LIMITING CONDITIONS This report is provided strictly for the sole use of the Company. Neither the whole nor any part of this report or any reference made hereto may be included in any published documents, circular or statement, or published in any way, without our written approval of the form and context in which it may appear. Nevertheless, we consent to the publication of this report in this circular for the Company’s shareholders’ reference. Our findings and conclusion in this report are valid only for the stated purpose and only for the Relevant Date. We or our personnel shall not be required to give testimony or attendance in court or to any government agency by reason of this report, and we accept no responsibility whatsoever to any other person. – 209 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION No responsibility is taken for changes in market conditions and no obligation is assumed to revise this report to reflect events or change of government policy or financial condition or other conditions, which occur subsequent to the date hereof. Our maximum liability relating to services rendered under this engagement (regardless of form of action, whether in contract, negligence or otherwise) shall be limited to the charges paid to us for the portion of its services or work products giving rise to liability. In no event shall we be liable for consequential, special, incidental or punitive loss, damage or expense (including without limitation, lost profits, opportunity costs, etc.), even if it has been advised of their possible existence. The Company is required to indemnify and hold us and our personnel harmless from any claims, liabilities, costs and expenses (including, without limitation, attorney’s fees and the time of our personnel involved) brought against, paid or incurred by us at a time and in any way based on the information made available in connection with our report except to the extent that any such loses, expenses, damages or liabilities are ultimately determined to be the result of gross negligence of our engagement team in conducting its work. This provision shall survive even after the termination of this engagement for any reason. STATEMENTS This report is based on generally accepted procedures and practices that rely extensively on assumptions and considerations, not all of which can be easily quantified or ascertained exactly. While we have exercised our professional judgement in performing the report, the readers and the client are urged to consider carefully the nature of such assumptions which are disclosed in this report and should exercise caution in interpreting this report. The evaluation has been undertaken by valuer, acting as external valuer, qualified for the purpose of the evaluation. We retain a copy of our report together with the data from which it was prepared, and these data and documents will, according to the Laws of Hong Kong, keep for a period of 6 years from the date of our report and to be destroyed thereafter. We considered these records confidential, and we do not permit access to them by anyone, with the exception for law enforcement authorities or court order, without the Company’s authorisation and prior arrangement made with us. Moreover, we will add the Company’s information into our client list for our future reference. – 210 – APPENDIX IV VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION We hereby certify that the fee for this service is not contingent upon our conclusion and we have no present nor prospective interest in the Project, the Company and Qinghai Senyuan. Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of LCH (Asia-Pacific) Surveyors Limited Joseph Ho Chin Choi BSc PgD RPS (GP) Managing Director Contributing valuers in the report: Elsa Ng Hung Mui BSc MSc RPS(GP) Sam Lai Siu Nam BBA Vivian Ting Wai BSc MSc Notes: 1. Mr. Joseph Ho Chin Choi has been conducting asset valuations and advisory work in Hong Kong, Macau, Taiwan, mainland China, Japan, South East Asia, Australia, Scotland, Germany, Finland, Guyana, Canada and the United States of America for various purposes since 1988. He obtained the Examination Certificate of the Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice issued by the American Society of Appraisers in 1996. He has extensive experience in the valuation of various types of intangible assets and power plants, toll road, health products and foodstuffs, mineral extracting, agricultural property assets, financial services, luxurious consumer goods, pharmaceutical and biotechnology, electronic consumer products manufactory, telecommunication, media and information technology related businesses for the listed companies in Hong Kong, Taiwan, Singapore, Canada and the United States of America. At present, he is a valuer on the List of Property Valuers for Undertaking Valuation for Incorporation or Reference in Listing Particulars and Circulars and Valuations in Connection with Takeovers and Mergers published by the HKIS (Hong Kong Institute of Surveyors). Over the length of his professional experience, he has valued and managed the valuation of a number of mineral extracting industry related projects for merger and acquisition, fund raising, financial reporting and management reference purposes. He also prepared and signed technical review reports of mineral extraction industry for public documents purpose. 2. Ms Elsa Ng Hung Mui has been conducting valuation of real estate properties in Hong Kong since 1994 and has more than 8 years of experience in valuing properties in mainland China. She obtained a Master Degree of Science in Finance and involved in various financial assets valuations in the past years. At present, she is a valuer in the List of Property Valuers for Undertaking Valuation for Incorporation or Reference in Listing Particulars and Circulars and Valuations in Connection with Takeovers and Mergers published by the HKIS. Over the length of her professional experiences, she has valued and managed the valuation of a number of mineral extracting industry related projects for merger and acquisition, fund raising, financial reporting and management reference purposes. 3. Mr. Sam Lai Siu Nam has been conducting business enterprise, financial and intangible asset valuations in Hong Kong since 2006. He has experiences in valuing a wide variety of financial assets such as employee stock option, convertible bond, equity-linked note and financial guarantee contract and business enterprise such as mining, forestry, property development, toll road and commercial retail business for purposes like merger and acquisition, disposal and annual accounting. 4. Ms. Vivian Ting Wai specialises in financial analysis and valuation. She has been conducting business enterprise, financial and intangible asset valuations in Hong Kong since her graduation of Master of Science Degree in Financial Mathematics and Actuarial Science. She has experiences in valuing a wide variety of financial assets such as employee stock option, convertible bond, equity-linked note and various business enterprises. – 211 – APPENDIX V REPORTS ON FORECASTS UNDERLYING THE VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION Set out below are texts of the reports from Grant Thornton and Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited in connection with the cash flow forecasts underlying the asset valuation on the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 and prepared for the purpose of inclusion in this circular. (A) REPORT FROM GRANT THORNTON 15 October 2007 The Directors Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Suites 5303-04, 53/F Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road Wanchai Hong Kong Dear Sirs Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited We have examined the arithmetical accuracy of the calculations of the discounted cash flow forecast underlying the asset valuation on the mine site held by ࣵڇᘊพೕτࠉʔ̇ (“Qinghai Forest Source Mining Industry Development Company Limited”) as of 31 August 2007 (hereinafter referred to as the “Underlying Forecast”) as set out in Appendix IV “Valuation of the Target Mine — First Portion” to the circular of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (the “Company”) and its subsidiaries dated 15 October 2007 (the “Circular”). Responsibilities The directors of the Company (the “Directors”) are responsible for the preparation of the Underlying Forecast and the reasonableness and validity of the assumptions based on which the Underlying Forecast are prepared (the “Assumptions”). – 212 – APPENDIX V REPORTS ON FORECASTS UNDERLYING THE VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION It is our responsibility to form an opinion, based on our work on the arithmetical accuracy of the calculations of the Underlying Forecast and to report our opinion solely to you, as a body, solely for the purpose of reporting under paragraph 14.62 (2) of the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on the Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited and for no other purpose. We accept no responsibility to any other person in respect of, arising out of, or in connection with our work. Because the Underlying Forecast relates to cash flows, no accounting policies of the Company have been adopted in its preparation. The Assumptions include hypothetical assumptions about future events as detail in Appendix IV to the Circular and management actions that cannot be confirmed and verified in the same way as past results. These Assumptions may or may not occur. Even if the events and actions anticipated do occur, actual results are still likely to be different from the Underlying Forecast and the variation may be material. Accordingly, we have not reviewed, considered or concluded any work on the reasonableness and the validity of the Assumptions and do not express opinion whatsoever thereon. Basis of opinion We conducted our work in accordance with Hong Kong Standard on Assurance Engagements 3000 “Assurance Engagements Other Than Audits or Reviews of Historical Financial Information” issued by the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants. We have examined the arithmetical accuracy of the calculations of the Underlying Forecast. Our work has been undertaken solely to assist the Directors in evaluating whether the Underlying Forecast, so far as the arithmetical accuracy of the calculations are concerned, has been properly compiled in accordance with the Assumptions made by the Directors. Our work does not constitute any valuation on the mine site held by Qinghai Forest Source Mining Industry Development Company Limited. Opinion In our opinion, so far as the arithmetical accuracy of the calculations are concerned, the Underlying Forecast has been properly compiled in accordance with the Assumptions made by the Directors. Yours faithfully, Grant Thornton Certified Public Accountants Hong Kong – 213 – APPENDIX V (B) REPORTS ON FORECASTS UNDERLYING THE VALUATION OF THE TARGET MINE — FIRST PORTION REPORT FROM MACQUARIE (HONG KONG) LIMITED 15 October 2007 The Directors Aurora Global Investments Holding Limited Suites 5303-4, 53/F Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Dear Sirs, We refer to the valuation prepared by LCH (Asia Pacific) Surveyors Limited (“LCH”) in relation to the appraisal of the valuation of a business unit, which comprises the operation of the Xiaohongshan (Little Red Mountain) iron-titanium-vanadium mine and four various processing plants with eight products (the “Valuation”) as set out in Appendix IV to the circular of the Company dated 15 October 2007 (the “Circular”), of which this report forms part of. We have reviewed the forecasts upon which the Valuation has been made for which you as the directors of the Company are solely responsible and discussed with you and LCH the information and documents provided by you which formed part of the basis and assumptions upon which the forecasts have been prepared. We have also considered the letter from Grant Thornton dated 15 October 2007 addressed to yourselves as set out in Section (A) of Appendix V to the Circular regarding the accounting policies and calculations upon which the forecasts have been made. On the basis of the foregoing, we are of the opinion that the forecasts upon which the Valuation has been made, for which you as the directors of the Company are solely responsible, have been made after due and careful enquiry by you. Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited Willaim JE Managing Director, Corporate Finance Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited Xia SHEN Managing Director, Corporate Finance – 214 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION The following is the text of the letter, and valuation certificate on property interest of the Group as at 31 August 2007 prepared by LCH for the purpose of inclusion in this circular. The readers are reminded that the report which follows has been prepared in accordance with the guidelines set by the HKIS Valuation Standards on Properties, First Edition, 2005 (“HKIS Standards”) published by the Hong Kong Institute of Surveyors (the “HKIS”) and entitles the valuer to make assumptions which may on further investigation, for instance by the readers’ legal representative, prove to be inaccurate. Any exception is clearly stated below. Headings are inserted for convenient reference only and have no effect in limiting or extending the language of the paragraphs to which they refer. 17th Floor Champion Building 287-291 Des Voeux Road Central Hong Kong 15 October 2007 Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Suites 5303-04, 53rd Floor Central Plaza 18 Harbour Road Wanchai Hong Kong Dear Sirs, In accordance with your instructions to value a property held by Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (hereinafter referred to as the “Company”) and its subsidiaries (hereinafter together with the Company referred to as the “Group”) in Hui Zhou City (hereinafter referred to as the “Property”), Guangdong Province of the People’s Republic of China (hereinafter referred to as the “PRC” or “China”) for the Company’s internal management reference purpose, we confirm that we have made relevant enquiries and obtained such further information as we consider necessary to support our opinion of value of the Property as at 31 August 2007 (hereinafter referred to as the “Date of Valuation”). – 215 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION We understand that the use of our work product (regardless of form of presentation) would form part of the Company’s business due diligence to the Property and we have not been engaged to make specific sale or purchase recommendations. We further understand that the use of our work product will not supplant other due diligence which a rational investor should conduct in reaching business decisions regarding the Property. Our findings and conclusion in this valuation are documented in a valuation report and submitted to the Company at today’s date. At the request of the management of the Company, we prepared this summary report (including this letter and the valuation certificate) to summarise our findings and conclusion as documented in the valuation report for the purpose of inclusion in this circular at today’s date for the Company’s shareholders’ reference. Terms herein used without definition shall have the same meanings as in the valuation report, and the assumptions and caveats adopted in the valuation report also apply to this summary report. BASIS OF VALUATION AND ASSUMPTIONS According to the International Valuation Standards (hereinafter referred to as “IVS”), Eighth Edition, 2007 published by the International Valuation Standards Committee, which the HKIS Standards also follows, there are two valuation bases, namely market value basis and valuation bases other than market value. In this engagement, we are instructed to have our opinions of value of the Property on the market value basis. The term “Market Value” is defined as “the estimated amount for which a property should exchange on the date of valuation between a willing buyer and a willing seller in an arm’s-length transaction after proper marketing wherein the parties had each acted knowledgeably, prudently and without compulsion”. Our valuation has been made on the assumption, that 1. the legally interested party in the Property sells the Property in the market in its existing state without the benefit of a deferred terms contract, leaseback, joint venture, management agreement or any other similar arrangement which would serve to increase the value of the Property; 2. the legally interested party in the Property has free and uninterrupted rights to use or assign the property interests for the whole of the unexpired terms as granted and any premiums payable have already been fully paid; and 3. the Property can be freely disposed and transferred free of all encumbrances at the Date of Valuation for its existing or alternative uses in the market to both local and overseas purchasers without payment of any premium to the government. Should this not be the case, it will have adverse impact to the value as reported. – 216 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION There are three generally accepted approaches to value in arriving at the market value of a property on an absolute title basis, namely the Market Approach, the Cost Approach and the Income Approach. Having considered the general and inherent characteristics of the Property, we have adopted the depreciated replacement cost approach which is an application of the Cost Approach in valuing specialised properties like the Property. The use of this approach requires an estimate of the market value of the land use rights for its existing use, and an estimate of the new replacement cost of the buildings and other site works from which deductions are then made to allow for age, condition, and functional obsolescence taken into account of the site formation cost and those public utilities connection charges to the Property. The land use rights of the Property has been determined from market-based evidences by analysing similar sales or offerings of comparable properties. The valuation of the Property is on the assumption that the Property is subject to the test of adequate potential profitability of the business having due regard to the value of the total assets employed and the nature of the operation. By using this approach, the land should be assumed to have the benefit of planning permission for the replacement of the existing buildings and it is always necessary when valuing the land, to have regard to the manner in which the land is developed by the existing buildings and site works, and the extent to which these realise the full potential value of the land. When considering a notional replacement site, it should normally be regarded as having the same physical and location characteristics as the actual site, other than characteristics of the actual site which are not relevant, or are of no value, to the existing use. In considering the buildings, the gross replacement cost of the buildings should take into consideration everything which is necessary to complete the construction from a new green field site to provide buildings as they are, at the date of valuation, fit for and capable of being occupied and used for the current use. These costs to be estimated are not to erect buildings in the future but have the buildings available for occupation at the date of valuation, the work having commenced at the appropriate time. We need to state that our opinion of value of the Property is not necessarily intended to represent the amount that might be realised from disposition of land use rights or various buildings of the Property on piece meal basis in the open market. MATTERS THAT MIGHT AFFECT THE VALUE REPORTED No allowance has been made in our valuation for any charges, mortgages, outstanding premium or amounts owing on the Property. Unless otherwise stated, it is assumed that the Property is free from all encumbrances, restrictions, and outgoings of an onerous nature which could affect its value. As at the Latest Practicable Date of this circular, we are unable to identify any adverse news against the Property which may affect the reported value in our work product. Thus, we are not in the position to report and comment on its impact (if any) to the Property. However, should it be established subsequently that such news did exist at the Date of Valuation, we reserve the right to adjust the value reported herein. – 217 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION ESTABLISHMENT OF TITLES Due to the market value basis of valuation, the management of the Company provided us the necessary documents to support that the legally interested party in the Property, i.e. the Group has free and uninterrupted rights to assign, to mortgage or to let the Property (in this instance, an absolute title) free of all encumbrances and any premiums payable have already been paid in full or outstanding procedures have been completed. However, our procedures to value as agreed with the management of the Company did not require us to conduct legal due diligence on the legality and formality on the way that the legally interested party obtained the Property from the relevant authorities. For the sake of valuation, we have been provided with copies of the title documents regarding the Property. However, we have not inspected the original documents to verify ownership or to verify any amendment which may not appear on the copies handed to us. Due to inherent defects in the land registration system of China, we are unable to inspect the original documents from the relevant land registration departments to verify the existing titles of the property or any material encumbrances that might be attached to the property. We are not legal professional and are unable to ascertain the titles and to report on any encumbrances that may be registered against the property. No responsibility and liability is assumed. In our valuation, we have assumed that the legally interested party in the Property has obtained all the approval and/or endorsement from the relevant authorities, and that there would have no legal impediment (especially from the regulators) for the legally interested party to continue the ownership of the Property. Should this not be the case, it will affect our conclusion in this report significantly. The readers or party who has interest to the Property are reminded to have their own legal due diligence work on such issues. No responsibility or liability is assumed. INSPECTIONS AND INVESTIGATIONS OF THE PROPERTY IN ACCORDANCE WITH VS4 OF THE HKIS STANDARDS As part of the agreed-upon procedures, we made reference to our previous inspection records of the Property in respect of which we have been provided with such information as we have requested for the purpose of our valuation. We have not inspected those parts of the Property which were covered, unexposed or inaccessible and such parts have been assumed to be in reasonable condition. We cannot express an opinion about or advice upon the condition of the Property and our work product should not be taken as making any implied representation or statement about the condition of the Property. No structural survey, investigation or examination has been made, but in the course of our inspections, we did not note any serious defects in the Property inspected. We are not, however, able to report that the Property is free from rot, infestation or any other structural defects. No tests were carried out to the utilities (if any) and we are unable to identify those utilities covered, unexposed or inaccessible. – 218 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION Our valuation has been made on the assumption that no unauthorised alteration, extension or addition has been made in the Property, and that the inspection and the use of this report do not purport to be a building survey of the Property. We have assumed that the Property is free of rot and inherent danger or unsuitable materials and techniques. No allowance has been made in our valuation for any charges, mortgages or amounts owing on the Property. Unless otherwise stated, it is assumed that the Property is free from encumbrances, restrictions, and outgoings of an onerous nature which could affect its value. We have not carried out on-site measurements to verify the correctness of the areas of the Property, but have assumed that the areas shown on the documents and handed to us are correct. All dimensions, measurements and areas are approximations. Our engagement and the agreed procedures to value the Property did not include an independent land survey to verify the legal boundaries of the Property. We need to state that we are not in the land survey profession, therefore, we are not in the position to verify or ascertain the correctness of the legal boundaries of such Property that appeared on the documents handed to us. No responsibility from our part is assumed. The management of the Company or interested party in the Property should conduct their own legal boundaries due diligence work. We have not arranged for any investigation to be carried out to determine whether or not any deleterious or hazardous material has been used in the construction of the Property, or has since been incorporated, and we are therefore unable to report that the Property is free from risk in this respect. For the purpose of this valuation, we have assumed that such investigation would not disclose the presence of any such material to any significant extent. We are not aware of the content of any environmental audit or other environmental investigation or soil survey which may have been carried out on the Property and which may draw attention to any contamination or the possibility of any such contamination. In undertaking our work, we have been instructed to assume that no contaminative or potentially contaminative uses have ever been carried out in the Property. We have not carried out any investigation into past or present uses, either of the Property or of any neighbouring land, to establish whether there is any contamination or potential for contamination to the Property from these uses or sites, and have therefore assumed that none exists. However, should it be established subsequently that contamination, seepage or pollution exists at the Property or on any neighbouring land, or that the premises have been or are being put to a contaminative use, this might reduce the value now reported. SOURCES OF INFORMATION AND ITS VERIFICATION IN ACCORDANCE WITH VS5 OF THE HKIS STANDARDS We have relied solely on the information provided by the management of the Company or its appointed personnel without further verification and have fully accepted advice given to us on such matters as planning approvals or statutory notices, locations, titles, easements, tenure, occupation, site and floor areas and all other relevant matters. – 219 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION The scope of valuation has been determined by reference to the property list provided by the management of the Company. The management of the Company has confirmed to us that it has no property interests other than those specified on the list supplied to us. Unless otherwise stated, we have not carried out any valuation on a redevelopment basis and the study of possible alternative development options and the related economics do not come within the scope of our work product. Information furnished by others, upon which all or portions of our work product are based, is believed to be reliable but has not been verified in all cases. Our procedures to value or work do not constitute an audit, review, or compilation of the information provided. Thus, no warranty is made nor liability assumed for the accuracy of any data, advice, opinions, or estimates identified as being furnished by others which have been used in formulating our work product. When we adopted the work products from other professions, external data providers and the management of the Company in our valuation, the assumptions and caveats that adopted by them in arriving at their figures also applied in our valuation. The procedures we have taken do not provide all the evidence that would be required in an audit and, as we have not performed an audit, accordingly, we do not express an audit opinion. We are unable to accept any responsibility for the information that has not been supplied to us by the management of the Company or its appointed personnel. Also, we have sought and received confirmation from the management of the Company or its appointed personnel that no materials factors have been omitted from the information supplied. Our analysis and valuation are based upon full disclosure between us and the Company of material and latent facts that may affect the valuation. Unless otherwise stated, all monetary amounts are in Renminbi Yuan (“RMB”) LIMITING CONDITIONS OF THIS SUMMARY REPORT Our opinion of value of the Property in this summary report is valid only for the stated purpose and only for the Date of Valuation, and for the sole use of the named Company. We or our personnel shall not be required to give testimony or attendance in court or to any government agency by reason of this summary report, and the valuer accepts no responsibility whatsoever to any other person. No responsibility is taken for changes in market conditions and local government policy and no obligation is assumed to revise the attached valuation certificate to reflect events or conditions, which occur or make known to us subsequent to the date hereof. Neither the whole nor any part of this summary report or any reference made hereto may be included in any published documents, circular or statement, or published in any way, without our written approval of the form and context in which it may appear. Nonetheless, we consent to the publication of this summary report in a circular to the Company’s shareholders. – 220 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION Our maximum liability relating to services rendered under this engagement (regardless of form of action, whether in contract, negligence or otherwise) shall be limited to the charges paid to us for the portion of its services or work products giving rise to liability. In no event shall we be liable for consequential, special, incidental or punitive loss, damage or expense (including without limitation, lost profits, opportunity costs, etc.), even if it has been advised of their possible existence. The Company is required to indemnify and hold us and our personnel harmless from any claims, liabilities, costs and expenses (including, without limitation, attorney’s fees and the time of our personnel involved) brought against, paid or incurred by us at a time and in any way based on the information made available in connection with our report except to the extent that any such loses, expenses, damages or liabilities are ultimately determined to be the result of gross negligence of our engagement team in conducting its work. This provision shall survive even after the termination of this engagement for any reason. STATEMENTS The attached valuation certificate is prepared in line with the requirements contained in Chapter 5 and Practice Note No. 12 of the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited as well as the guidelines contained in the HKIS Standards. The valuation has been undertaken by valuers, acting as external valuers, qualified for the purpose of the valuation. We retain a copy of this summary report and the detailed valuation report together with the data from which it was prepared, and these data and documents will, according to the Laws of Hong Kong, keep for a period of 6 years from the date of this report and to be destroyed thereafter. We considered these records confidential, and we do not permit access to them by anyone, with the exception for law enforcement authorities or court order, without the Company’s authorisation and prior arrangement made with us. Moreover, we will add the Company’s information into our client list for our future reference. – 221 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION We hereby certify that the fee for this service is not contingent upon our conclusion of value and we have no present nor prospective interest in the Property, the Company, the Group or the value reported. The valuation certificate is attached. Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of LCH (Asia-Pacific) Surveyors Limited Elsa Ng Hung Mui B.Sc. M.Sc. RPS (GP) Associate Director Ms. Elsa Ng Hung Mui is a Registered Professional Surveyor who has been conducting valuation of real estate properties in Hong Kong since 1994 and has more than 8 years of experience in valuing properties in mainland China. She is a valuer on the List of Property Valuers for Undertaking Valuation for Incorporation or Reference in Listing Particulars and Circulars and Valuations in Connection with Takeovers and Mergers published by the HKIS. – 222 – APPENDIX VI PROPERTY VALUATION VALUATION CERTIFICATE Property Description and tenure A factory complex erected on a parcel of land located at Wei Bu Industrial District Qiu Chang Town Hui Yang District Hui Zhou City Guangdong Province The People’s Republic of China The property comprises a parcel of l a n d h av i n g a s i t e a r e a o f approximately 23,914 sq.m. There are 7 various buildings and structures having a total gross floor area of approximately 15,250.56 sq.m. erected thereon. The buildings and structures are single to 2-storey in height and were completed 1993 (see Note 2 below). Particulars of occupancy As confirmed by the Company, the property is currently occupied by the Group for production, warehouse and ancillary office purposes. Amount of valuation in existing state attributable to the Group as at 31 August 2007 RMB 27,500,000 (100% interest) The property is subject to a right to use the land for a term till 5 February 2046 for industrial purpose. Notes: 1. The right to possess the land is held by the State and the right to use the land has been granted by the State and transferred to య ή ̟ ʿ Δ ಇ ́ ଐ τ ࠉ ʔ ̇ Hui Zhou Orient Manufacturing Co., Ltd., an indirectly wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company via the following ways: (i) According to a real estate transfer agreement dated 22 December 2003 and made between ૯Γɻ࣏එ྆ʔ̇ Shenzhen China Nuclear Company Group and యඈԾௗṄΔಇτࠉʔ̇ Huiyang Xie Kai Cheng Carpet Co., Ltd (which was renewed to యή̟ʿΔಇ́ ଐτࠉʔ̇ Hui Zhou Orient Manufacturing Co., Ltd.), the Property was transferred to యඈԾௗṄΔಇτࠉʔ ̇ Huiyang Xie Kai Cheng Carpet Co., Ltd. at a consideration of HK$26,000,000. (ii) a State-owned Land Use Rights Certificate known as Hui Yang Guo Yang (2004) Di 0500030 Hao and issued by the People’s Government of Huiyang District of Hui Zhou City for a term till 5 February 2046. The land has a site area of approximately 23,914 sq. m. and is restricted for industrial purpose. – 223 – APPENDIX VI 2. PROPERTY VALUATION According to seven various Realty Title Certificates — Yue Fang Di Zheng Zi Di C1956101, C1956102, C1956103, C1956104, C1956274, C1956275, and C1956276 Hao issued by the People’s Government of Huiyang District of Hui Zhou City and all dated 27 January 2005, the legally interested party in the Property having a total gross floor area of approximately 15,250.56 sq. m. was యή̟ʿΔಇ́ଐτࠉʔ̇ Hui Zhou Orient Carpet Manufacturing Co., Ltd.. The area breakdowns for each of the buildings and structures covered by the Certificates are listed as below: Buildings/Structures (i) 3. a single storey warehouse Year Built Gross Floor Area (sq.m.) 1993 4,866.25 (ii) a single storey workshop 1993 2,388.15 (iii) a 2-storey carpet workshop 1993 7,161.30 (iv) a single storey boiler room 1993 477.96 (v) a single storey transformer room 1993 252.02 (vi) a single storey store room 1993 50.02 (vii) a single storey toilet 1993 54.86 యή̟ʿΔಇ́ଐτࠉʔ̇ Hui Zhou Orient Carpet Manufacturing Co., Ltd. is a wholly-owned foreign enterprise with a valid Business Enterprise License for operation from 11 June 1993 to 10 June 2008. – 224 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT The following is the text of the technical assessment report in respect of the Target Mine prepared by Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited, for the purpose of inclusion in this circular. AN INDEPENDENT TECHNICAL ASSESSMENT ON THE LITTLE RED MOUNTAIN IRON-TITANIUM-VANADIUM DEPOSIT, XIAO HONG SHAN, PEOPLE’S REPUBLIC OF CHINA FOR AURORA GLOBAL INVESTMENT HOLDINGS LIMITED prepared by Velasquez Spring, P.Eng. Senior Geologist and Robert S. Didur, P.Eng. Senior Associate Mining Engineer 15 October 2007 Toronto, Canada Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited Consulting Geologists and Engineers – 225 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 1. SUMMARY ......................................................................................................................... 231 2. INTRODUCTION, BACKGROUND AND SCOPE OF WORK ................................. 244 2.1 2.2 INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................... BACKGROUND AND SCOPE OF WORK ............................................................. 244 244 OBJECTIVES AND WORK PROGRAM ...................................................................... 245 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 3.7 3.8 PROGRAM OBJECTIVES ....................................................................................... PURPOSE OF THE REPORT ................................................................................... REPORTING STANDARD ....................................................................................... WORK PROGRAM ................................................................................................... PROJECT TEAM ....................................................................................................... STATEMENT OF WGM INDEPENDENCE ........................................................... WGM EXPERIENCE ................................................................................................ FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS .................................................................. 245 245 245 246 246 246 247 247 PROPERTY DESCRIPTION AND LOCATION .......................................................... 247 4.1 4.2 LOCATION ................................................................................................................ PROPERTY DESCRIPTION .................................................................................... 247 248 ACCESS, CLIMATE, LOCAL RESOURCES, INFRASTRUCTURE AND PHYSIOGRAPHY ........................................................ 250 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 ACCESS ..................................................................................................................... CLIMATE ................................................................................................................... LOCAL RESOURCES .............................................................................................. INFRASTRUCTURE ................................................................................................. PHYSIOGRAPHY ..................................................................................................... 250 250 250 251 251 GEOLOGICAL SETTING ............................................................................................... 252 6.1 6.2 6.3 INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................... REGIONAL GEOLOGY ........................................................................................... PROPERTY GEOLOGY ........................................................................................... 252 253 257 7. DEPOSIT TYPES ............................................................................................................... 260 8. MINERALIZATION .......................................................................................................... 260 3. 4. 5. 6. – 226 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 9. EXPLORATION ................................................................................................................. 262 10. DRILLING .......................................................................................................................... 263 11. SAMPLING METHOD AND APPROACH .................................................................... 264 12. SAMPLE PREPARATION, ANALYSES AND SECURITY ........................................ 264 13. DATA VERIFICATION ..................................................................................................... 265 13.1 GENERAL ................................................................................................................. 13.2 WGM SITE VISIT SAMPLING ............................................................................... 265 265 MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES ........................ 267 14.1 14.2 14.3 14.4 14.5 GENERAL ................................................................................................................. GENERAL MINERAL RESOURCE ESTIMATION PROCEDURES .................. DATABASE ................................................................................................................ GEOLOGICAL MODELLING PROCEDURES ..................................................... DATABASE PREPARATION, STATISTICAL ANALYSIS AND COMPOSITING ...................................................................... MINERAL RESOURCE BLOCK MODELLING ................................................... MINERAL RESOURCE CLASSIFICATION AND TABULATION ..................... SINOREX MINERAL RESOURCE ESTIMATE .................................................... ENFI MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES.......... 267 269 269 270 EXPLORATION POTENTIAL ........................................................................................ 285 15.1 MINERAL RESOURCE POTENTIAL .................................................................... 15.2 MINERAL RESERVE POTENTIAL........................................................................ 285 286 16. ADJACENT PROPERTIES .............................................................................................. 288 17. INTRODUCTION AND DESIGN ASSUMPTIONS ..................................................... 288 18. MINING ASSESSMENT ................................................................................................... 290 18.1 18.2 18.3 18.4 290 291 293 295 14. 14.6 14.7 14.8 14.9 15. INTRODUCTION AND MINE DESCRIPTION ..................................................... MINE DESIGN .......................................................................................................... FINAL PIT ................................................................................................................. MINE PRODUCTION ............................................................................................... – 227 – 274 275 280 281 283 APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT TABLE OF CONTENTS Page 19. MINERAL PROCESSING AND METALLURGICAL TESTING ............................. 295 19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 19.5 INITIAL BENCH SCALE TESTS ........................................................................... PILOT PLANT SCALE DRESSING TEST ............................................................. BULK SAMPLES ...................................................................................................... ADDITIONAL SAMPLES ........................................................................................ GRADE DISTRIBUTION OF BULK SAMPLE MATERIAL (FROM HKFSS DATA) ......................................................................................... 295 297 297 298 INFRASTRUCTURE ......................................................................................................... 300 20.1 20.2 20.3 20.4 20.5 20.6 20.7 INFRASTRUCTURE ISSUES .................................................................................. ROADS ....................................................................................................................... POWER ...................................................................................................................... WATER ....................................................................................................................... LAND ......................................................................................................................... MINE SITE LAYOUT ............................................................................................... METALLURGICAL PLANT SITE .......................................................................... 300 300 300 300 301 301 301 21. ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT (REF. ENFI) ...................................................... 301 22. CAPITAL COST SUMMARY .......................................................................................... 302 22.1 22.2 22.3 22.4 22.5 22.6 PRE-CONSTRUCTION ............................................................................................ INFRASTRUCTURE ................................................................................................. MINING ..................................................................................................................... ORE DRESSING PLANT ......................................................................................... METALLURGICAL PLANTS .................................................................................. TOTAL PROJECT CAPITAL.................................................................................... 302 302 302 303 303 304 OPERATING COSTS ........................................................................................................ 305 23.1 23.2 23.3 23.4 23.5 23.6 MINING ..................................................................................................................... ORE DRESSING PLANT ......................................................................................... MINE MANAGEMENT ............................................................................................ RESOURCES TAX .................................................................................................... CONCENTRATE TRANSPORT .............................................................................. METALLURGICAL PLANTS .................................................................................. 305 306 306 306 307 307 CONCLUSIONS AND RECOMMENDATIONS ........................................................... 309 APPENDIX 1: EXPLORATION PERMIT ......................................................................... APPENDIX 2: CERTIFICATE OF ANALYSIS ................................................................. 312 314 20. 23. 24. – 228 – 299 APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT TABLE OF CONTENTS Page CERTIFICATES ........................................................................................................................... 319 REFERENCES .............................................................................................................................. 329 LIST OF TABLES 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. Geological events history of China ..................................................................................... Characteristics of the orebodies .......................................................................................... Average chemical analysis for the different Existing LRM Mine ore types ..................... ALS analyses ........................................................................................................................ SGS analyses ........................................................................................................................ Existing LRM Mine Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources prepared by WGM (using a 15% TFe cutoff grade) ....................................................................................... Basic statistics of 6 ft composites ....................................................................................... Block model grid parameters ............................................................................................... Existing LRM Mine Indicated Resources (prepared by WGM at different cutoff grades) ............................................................... Existing LRM Mine Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources (prepared by WGM using a 15% TFe cutoff grade) ........................................................................................ Sinorex resource estimates .................................................................................................. Mineral resource summary .................................................................................................. Price RMB/t .......................................................................................................................... Concentrate forecast basis ................................................................................................... Mineral reserves and stripping results ................................................................................ Capital cost estimate ............................................................................................................ Opex (direct reduction of iron concentrate)........................................................................ Opex (direct reduction of titanium concentrate) ................................................................ 252 260 261 265 266 267 274 279 280 280 282 283 286 289 294 304 308 309 LIST OF FIGURES 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Location map ........................................................................................................................ Property concession map ..................................................................................................... Regional geology .................................................................................................................. Exploration drillholes and trenches geology map .............................................................. Cross section Line 15 ........................................................................................................... Drillhole and trench plan ..................................................................................................... 3-D Wireframes of the ore zones ......................................................................................... Normal Histogram for All Zone composites ...................................................................... Normal Histogram for Zone 101 composites ..................................................................... – 229 – 248 249 254 257 263 272 273 275 275 APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT TABLE OF CONTENTS LIST OF FIGURES Page 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. Normal Histogram for Zone 102 composites ..................................................................... Normal Histogram for Zone 103 composites ..................................................................... Normal probability plot for All Zone composites .............................................................. Normal probability plot for Zone 101 composites ............................................................. Normal probability plot for Zone 102 composites ............................................................. Normal probability plot for Zone 103 composites ............................................................. Block model — section line 15 ........................................................................................... Design pit overlain onto magnetic contour map ................................................................. Planned product line ............................................................................................................. Pit design .............................................................................................................................. Distribution of grade and weight ......................................................................................... – 230 – 276 276 277 277 278 278 281 281 289 293 299 APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited (“WGM”) was retained by Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (“Company”) to review the current engineering studies being carried out by China ENFI Engineering Corporation (“ENFI”) on the Xiao Hong Shan, Little Red Mountain, Iron, Titanium, Vanadium property (“Existing LRM Mine”) located in Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, People’s Republic of China. Aurora Global is a company listed on the Hong Kong Stock Exchange and is considering acquiring an interest in the Existing LRM Mine from Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited (“Hong Kong FSMI”). Aurora Global requires an independent technical assessment report on the Existing LRM Mine for inclusion in a circular to be issued by Aurora Global to fulfil some regulatory requirements in Hong Kong. Velasquez Spring, P.Eng., WGM Senior Geologist and qualified person (“QP”) conducted an initial site visit to Existing LRM Mine on October 14 and 15, 2005, and also visited the Chinese sample preparation and analytical laboratory in the city of Jiuguan PRC. A second visit by V. Spring to China between May 16 to 22, 2006 reviewed the exploration works being carried out by Sinorex Resource and Environment Engineering (Beijing) Co. Ltd. “Characterization samples” were collected by V. Spring on both visits and carried back to Canada and sent to an assay laboratory. During July 12 to 18, 2007, Robert Didur, P.Eng., WGM Senior Associate Mining Engineer, and V. Spring travelled to Beijing, PRC and held numerous meetings and discussions with ENFI and HKFS personnel to review the progress of the engineering studies being carried out by ENFI and to prepare an independent technical assessment report. The Little Red Mountain mineral concession is located 180 km north of the city of Jiayugan in central-western PRC between latitudes 41˚25’00"N and 41˚27’00"N, and longitudes 97˚58’00"E and 98˚01’00"E. The Existing LRM Mine comprises a single mineral exploration concession covering 15.47 km2 granted to QFS and valid until November 25, 2008. The Existing LRM Mine is readily accessible by vehicle some 150 km north on the paved highway from Jiayuguan then west for about 60 km. The city of Jiayuguan is an important steel producing commercial and industrial centre with a large workforce and all modern facilities, banking, communications, transport, medical and housing. The climate is a continental desert climate and is characteristically windy coming from the west throughout almost the entire year. The annual precipitation is less than 60 mm and the average annual temperature is approximately 6.8˚C. The project is located in the northern part of central-western China in the western district of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, is some 25 km from the border of Gansu Province. Topographically it is found in gentle, well rounded, low-hilly land forms, in the eastern end of the Beishan Mountain Range, on the western margin of the Bandanjilin Desert. The region is without any local resources and all goods, equipment, food and supplies must be brought into the project. No nearby power source is available and no water wells, or natural springs, occur in the concession area. – 231 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Initial exploration consisted of a magnetic survey of the area carried out from 1966 to 1967. In 1980, an aerial survey was carried out on the Xiaohong Mountain magnetic anomaly and concluded that the magnetic anomalies were caused by the gabbros, and magnetite mineralization. A total of 37 magnetic anomalies were outlined by a ground geophysical survey, 18 of which are exposed magnetite orebodies, 6 are blind orebodies and the remaining 13 are caused by gabbros with magnetite mineralization. Seven separate titaniferous magnetite deposits were detected requiring additional exploration. In 2004, a preliminary geological map, trenches and shallow shafts and mapping of the iron orebodies were completed, as well as a 1:2,000 scale topographic mapping of the 2 km2 Existing LRM Mine (within the larger permit exploration area). The Existing LRM Mine occurs within a sequence of early Proterozoic meta-sedimentary rocks located along the northern margin of the North China platform. In the northern part of the concession area, large areas of Jurassic, Cretaceous and Tertiary age rocks outcrop while in the southern part, a wide range of Quaternary age rocks outcrop. In general, the deposit is made up of two, broad, west to east geological belts: the middle belt, the Gong Po Quan-Hong Liu Da Quan and the southern belt the structural zone of the south hill to the Tianshan Mountain. Faulting in the region occurs mainly as thrust faults striking near E-W that were later crosscut by NE, NW and NS faults. Complex fold structures were caused by fault movements, accompanied by strong magmatic activity. The Existing LRM Mine has been subjected to frequent magmatic activity from early Paleozoic through to Cretaceous times but a late Paleozoic period experienced the most intense, wide spread, largest and different types of intrusives. The late Paleozoic has been divided into three periods (early, mid and late). The early Devonian intrusives are mainly plagioclase granites and quartz diorites in the form of stocks. The Carboniferous includes batholiths of granites and granodiorites and are mainly in the southern part of Existing LRM Mine while in Permian they are mainly ultramafic, gabbro diabase, biotiteplagioclase granites and diorite intrusives. The Permian age gabbro is the principal intrusive at Existing LRM Mine occurring in an E-W direction over 2 km and in a 1 km N-S direction. The vanadium-titanium-magnetite mineralized bodies occur within the gabbros. Most of the ore mineralization is fine-grained. Major fold structures were destroyed at Existing LRM Mine by the intrusion of the later Paleozoic gabbros. Faults and fracturing however are well developed. Apart from intrusive rocks two sedimentary lithological units are found at Existing LRM Mine, the sediments of the Gutongjing Group of the Great Wall System of middle Proterozoic age, and the unconsolidated sediments of the Quaternary. – 232 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) The Existing LRM Mine type of deposit is described as a late stage magmatic segregation from the parent gabbroic magma. The segregation, a vanadium bearing titaniferous magnetite, was at a later time, due to tectonic movements, injected along layers of the gabbro. A total of eight separate lenticular bodies of magnetite (numbered I to VIII make up the present mineral resource) occur within the gabbro, concentrated in the western end of the detailed study area. The bodies strike between 090˚ to 120˚ and dip south, or southwestward at angles of between 80˚ to 88˚. The magnetite bodies vary in width, both along strike and down dip, with bodies I to IV of relatively larger size. In general, according to Chinese classification, the magnetite bodies are described as medium scale and ranging from simple to complex in shape but with a good continuity of the bodies (i.e., few faults) and gradual changes in grades. Iron mineralization, a primary metal of interest occurs mainly in minerals of titaniferous magnetite, ilmenite, magnetite and some pyrrhotite occurring as disseminations and as discrete lenticular masses within the gabbro. The mineralization has been classified in three categories: 1) oxidized (down to depths of 1.7 and 12.9 m); 2) compound (10 to less than 30 m depth); and, 3) primary (below 30 m depth). The total iron content of the resource varies from 17.0% to 31.7% and is classified under the Chinese categories as a medium grade iron-ore deposit requiring mineral dressing for commercialisation. Secondary metals of interest are titanium and vanadium (intergrown with the iron) with the percentages of TiO2 and V2O5 in the iron ores levels of commercial interest as stipulated in People’s Republic of China. Also of interest is the P2O5 content of the ore. In early 2006, SINOREX Resource and Environment Engineering (Beijing) Co., Ltd. (“Sinorex”) was commissioned by Hong Kong FSMI to commence the first stage and second stage exploration programs, as mandated by the Chinese requirements. Detailed exploration during the first and second stage programs followed with drilling, trenching and sampling of the orebodies with the data points spaced at approximately 40 to 60 m. Drilling was concentrated in an area of about 0.7 km2 (i.e. Target Mine — First Portion) on the west side of the 2 km x 1 km area (i.e. Target Mine). Additional exploration will be required to evaluate the remaining portion (east side) of the 2 km2 area. The holes were drilled in a N28˚15’E direction, at angles near -50˚ along crosslines on a grid at a spacing of 100 m. The location of the drillhole collars were controlled by GPS readings. Surveying of the holes was by single shot down-the-hole readings, carried out at 50 m intervals. The core was photographed, then geologically logged and the Rock Quality Designations (“RQD”) determined and sawed in half at intervals of near 1.5 m. Each sample was separately bagged, labelled and sealed for shipment to the assay laboratory. Geological mapping was carried out in the trenches on one wall and on the bottom of the trench at a scale of 1:100. Trench samples, about 6 kg to 7 kg, were collected at intervals of approximately 1.5 m and all sample locations GPS controlled. – 233 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) WGM visited the No 4 Laboratory, Gansu Bureau of Geology and Mineral Resources where the complete sample preparation was reviewed; 5% of the total number of samples are repeated as a duplicate samples, however no blank, or standard samples are routinely entered into the sample flow. Various analytical methods are carried out to determine the metal contents. The comparison of the data derived from Chinese laboratories and from Canadian laboratories show good agreement. Future drilling programs should consider sample preparation on site to control Quality Assurance/Quality Control as required by NI 43-101 regulations. WGM’s field examination confirmed the geological setting of the diamond drillholes and trenches. The audit of selected drill core verified the reported mineralized intervals, the sample intervals, the core recovery and the reported RQD of the rocks. WGM feels confident that the geology as represented on the property geological map fairly represents the geology as observed. HKFS had engaged Golder Associates Consulting Ltd. (“Golder”) of Australia mid-way during the SINOREX drilling program to estimate the Mineral Resources from a block model developed from the drillholes completed at that time. Mineral Resource WGM prepared the following Mineral Resource estimates for the three main Existing LRM Mine zones based on 3D wireframes interpreted by Golder. The estimates were prepared from a block model using GEMCOM software and exclude all blocks grading less than 15% TFe. The estimates were prepared in accordance with the provisions of NI 43-101 guidelines and the Canadian Institute of Mining, Metallurgy and Petroleum (“CIM”) standards. Existing LRM Mine Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources prepared by WGM (using a 15% TFe cutoff grade) Tonnes %TFe %TiO2 %V2O5 6,821,539 7,326,882 2,058,591 20.13 19.34 17.68 4.03 3.84 3.40 0.04 0.03 0.03 16,207,012 19.46 3.86 0.03 Zone 103 259,689 17.69 3.25 0.02 Total Inferred 259,689 17.69 3.25 0.02 Zone Zone 101 Zone 102 Zone 103 Total Indicated Note: WGM has lowered the cutoff grade of the TFe from the 17% as stipulated in the China regulations for iron deposits to 15% because of the increased recoverable values in the ore from TiO2 and V2O5. – 234 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) SINOREX Mineral Resource estimated the Mineral Resource at Existing LRM Mine using China’s traditional “geometrical method”. According to the Chinese “Standards of Geological Exploration of Iron, Manganese and Chrome Mines”, the Mineral Resources are divided into three categories: category (331); category (332); and, category (333). The three categories approximate the CIM Mineral Resource categories of Measured (331), Indicated (332) and Inferred (333), however, WGM reports the following Mineral Resources for historical purposes only and because they are relevant, but has not attempted to rationalize them to conform with the guidelines published by the CIM standards. The author checked the methodology used for these Mineral Resources and has no reason to dispute them. The total SINOREX estimated Mineral Resource is 29,513,786 tonnes @ 19.64% TFe and 3.53% TiO2. The sum of the Chinese Mineral Resource estimate for categories 331 and 332 at a 17% TFe cutoff grade and the WGM block model Mineral Resource estimate at a 15% TFe cutoff grade give almost the same figures. However, the Chinese category 333 allows the mineral resource estimate to be projected downwards one quarter the length of the orebody, much of this tonnage would not be included in the WGM block model estimate. Nonetheless, WGM believes there is an excellent probability that with future exploration (diamond drilling) as recommended in this report that these additional Chinese mineral resources will be confirmed. The exploration programs carried out to-date within the 0.7 km2 area (i.e. Target Mine — First Portion) of the 2 km2 (i.e. Target Mine) detailed exploration area have determined the geological setting and the overall geometry of seven, separate, lenticular orebodies of titaniferous magnetite that contain recoverable amounts of iron, titanium vanadium and phosphorus. Based on WGM’s block model analysis and CIM standards, an Indicated Mineral Resource of 16.2 million tonnes at 19.5% TFe and 3.86% TiO2 and 0.03% V2O5 has been estimated for the Target Mine — First Portion. The remaining portion of the 2 km2 exploration area that has not yet been investigated by diamond drilling, and the untested covered magnetic anomalies outside of the detailed exploration area could contain similar titaniferous magnetite bodies that after confirmation drilling, could increase the total estimated mineral resource. The following Mineral Resource estimate was developed by ENFI using Datamine software from the same database used by WGM. Mineral Resource Summary Classification Millions Tonnes Total %Fe %TiO2 Measured Indicated Measured and Indicated 14.39 4.39 18.78 19.45 19.41 19.44 3.89 3.82 3.87 Inferred 11.68 19.75 3.21 – 235 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) WGM Indicated Mineral Resource estimate of 16.2 million tonnes @ 19.46% Fe and 3.86% TiO2 compares favourably with ENFI Measured and Indicated Mineral Resources of 18.78 million tonnes at 19.44% Fe and 3.87% TiO2. WGM mineral resources were estimated only for Zones I, II, and III. SINOREX estimated 1.7 Mt for Zones IV and V in classifications 331 and 332, equivalent to Measured and Indicated categories. ENFI developed the Mineral Reserves for the project using pit optimization software in Datamine. Optimization is based on Measured, Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources from the grade block model plus assumptions concerning product recovery, price, operating costs, pit slope, dilution and mining losses. Mineral Reserves reflect a final design pit that incorporates a haul road. Costs used for pit optimization comprise operating costs required for concentrate production and include mine and ore dressing cost centres. Revenue for the pit optimization process is limited to the value of concentrates produced. Value derived from downstream product upgrading is not included. Mineral Reserves Mine recoverable Mineral Reserves contained within the designed open pit total 12.0 million tonnes @ 19.5% Fe and 4.2% TiO2. WGM believe that ENFI have taken a conservative approach with respect to pit optimization parameters. Potential exists to increase mineable reserves through changes to optimization parameters including decreasing operating costs and increasing concentrate revenue. Depreciation charges should be removed from Management cost centre since depreciation is an Indirect cost and only direct costs should be used in pit optimization. Concentrate transportation and community costs should be added as these are costs directly related to production and delivery of concentrate to the downstream metallurgical plants. The net effect should be lower operating costs. ENFI has used significantly lower prices for concentrates as compared with the market prices from the last 6 to 18 months; recent prices would generate 36% to 59% higher concentrate revenue. ENFI recently conducted a sensitivity analysis on the effect of increasing market price on mineable reserves, results suggest that with a 20% price increase the mineable reserves are increased by 29% to 15.5 Mt. – 236 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Operation Plan Overview The proposed project is based on establishment of stand-alone northern operations including a 2.6 Mt/a Open Pit Mine and Ore Dressing Plant at Existing LRM Mine. Key support infrastructure required for the operation includes shops and personnel accommodation facilities. Development of a single infrastructure corridor between the northern and southern operation, includes a new Road, Power and Water supply. Planning has been on the basis of achieving potential ultimate capacity of 5.0 Mt/a mining and concentrating. Preliminary metallurgical planning has been based on developing sufficient Mineral Resources/ Reserves to support a 2.6 Mt/a mining and concentrating operation. The preliminary ore dressing flow sheet comprises: • Crushing and Grinding; • Weak Magnetic separation producing Iron Concentrate @ 56-57% Fe (contains 5% TiO2); • Strong Magnetic separation followed by Flotation producing: — Phosphate Concentrate @ 28-35% P2O5; and — Titanium Concentrate @ 43-48% TiO2. Annual Concentrate production forecast is based on 2.6 Mt/a ore mined and processed. Concentrate yield figures used by ENFI in their pit optimization assumptions are lower than the following which are based on the metallurgical tests conducted by Changsha Research Institute Mining and Metallurgy in October 2006. Magnetic Separation Flotation Flotation Iron Concentrate Titanium Concentrate Phosphorus Concentrate 12.6% 6.0% 4.8% Concentrate will be trucked approximately 150 km to the new metallurgical complex at Qing Shan (Yumen). Downstream metallurgical plants will be constructed to produce upgraded and increased value products including Direct Reduced Iron products (including high grade iron powder and associated titanium oxide and vanadium oxide) and Direct Reduced Titanium products (including high grade titanium oxide and iron concentrate). – 237 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Mining Plan Open pit mining has been selected on the basis of proximity to surface of the orebodies and their relatively simplicity. Open pit mining would utilize readily available equipment and operations would follow a standard drill, blast, load and haul methodology. Ore would be delivered to primary crushers (average 2 km one-way haul) and waste rock would be hauled to waste dumps (1.5 km average one-way haul). Pre-production stripping is estimated at 1.5 years to properly develop the mine for production. Mine equipment selected by ENFI reflects typical mining equipment that should be readily available in China and is based on the proposed annual production rate. The mine life based on the current mineable resources is 5 years. A larger pit/reserve will likely be required to support positive economics for a 2.6 Mt/a ore dressing plant and related downstream metallurgical plants. An optimized pit was developed by ENFI using NPV (net present value) software in Datamine utilizing Measured and Indicated Resources only followed by practical design to incorporate a final haul road. The revenue component of the block model was based on concentrate equivalent value assuming three concentrates: iron, titanium and phosphorus. Concentrate product prices used are 55% Fe conc. — RMB480/t conc., 47% TiO2 conc — RMB700/t conc., and 28% P2O5 conc — RMB280/t conc. Operating costs used for ENFI pit optimization were Mining — RMB6.5/tonne mined, Ore Dressing — RMB40.0/tonne, Management — RMB32.0/tonne, and Resource Tax — RMB5.6/ tonne A discount rate of 8% was applied and pit slope angles were set at 47 degrees, and the following criteria were used to establish the final pit design: • Bench height 12 m; • Bench face angle 60 degrees; • Final pit slope 47 degrees; • Haul road gradient 8%; • Haul road width 12 m; and • Dilution 3%; and Mining losses 3%. – 238 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Mining Plan (continued) Design criteria are considered by WGM to be reasonable based on information provided for this review. The final design results in an open pit with an overall length of 760 m; maximum width of 320 m; and maximum depth of 144 m which WGM considers to be reasonable and should support the scale of production proposed. Mineral Reserves are 12.0 million tonnes averaging 19.5% Fe and 4.2% TiO2. The designed pit contains waste rock totalling 20.2 million tonnes for an average stripping ratio of 1.68 with a pre-production stripping period of 1.5 years. First year production is scheduled at 1.5 Mt ore. Subsequent annual ore production is targeted at 2.6 Mt per year. Infrastructure Infrastructure planning has been on the basis of achieving potential capacity at a rate of 5.0 Mt/ a (mining and concentrating). Key infrastructure components that would be impacted by a change in the production level are Water and Power supply. The provision for Land and Infrastructure rebate is contingent on the project’s commitment to the development of the metallurgical plant(s) near Yumen. A 160 km, 30 cm water pipeline with 4 pumping stations will be constructed from the Chijinxia Reservoir to service the northern operations. The Chijinxia Reservoir will provide water for the metallurgical plants. It is estimated that 80-85% of the process water will be recycled. Initial estimate of the land required is approximately 1,000 acres (Chinese mu) and ultimately 2,000 acres. Land purchased from the government is estimated at RMB80 million with approximately 90% of the cost to be returned to support the development of the Infrastructure. No site layout designs have yet been developed for the mine and metallurgical plant. All proposed project sites have been visited and the data collected by ENFI Environmental personnel. While the data is incomplete the sites are deemed to have minimal issues. There are no concerns for the Road, Power and Pipeline corridor. Although Existing LRM Mine is located within the Asian Biological Zone and a Military Zone, permission to proceed has already been granted from the appropriate government agencies. – 239 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Capital Cost Estimate Capital costs for the project were provided by Hong Kong FSMI and Central South University (CSU). The HKFS Business Plan (May 2007) outlines costs for a proposed 5.0 Mt/a production facility including pre-development costs, infrastructure, mining, ore dressing plant and metallurgical plants. CSU have estimated capital costs for revised downstream metallurgical processing plants based on recent bench scale testwork. A detailed review of pre-development and infrastructure costs by WGM concludes that these are reasonable costs. Following discussion with Hong Kong FSMI, and using a fixed/variable cost approach, WGM have estimated various scaling factors to generate the possible cost for a 2.6 Mt/a project. The overall cost estimate, developed principally from cost manuals and comparison to other operations, is considered by WGM to be preliminary in nature. ENFI plan to develop a feasibility level cost estimate later in 2007 based on finalized production schedules and flowsheets for ore dressing and metallurgical processing. The following table outlines the preliminary estimated RMB 1.13 billion CAPEX required for construction of the Existing LRM Mine project. CAPITAL COST ESTIMATE Capital Expenditure Production Rate Pre-Development Expenses Infrastructure Business Plan Adjust Factor RMB M % of total Mt/a — Ore 5.0 0.52 2.6 Roads Power Water Communications Community Land 61 162 154 114 9 83 0 1.0 0.60 0.90 0.90 1.00 0.66 61 97 139 103 9 55 8 5% 9% 12% 9% 1% 5% 1% Subtotal 522 0.79 410 36% Business Plan Adjust Factor RMB M Forecast RMB M % of total Capital Expenditure Mining Forecast RMB M Equipment Pre-production strip 230 20 0.60 1.00 138 20 12% 2% Subtotal 250 0.63 158 14% – 240 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Capital Cost Estimate (continued) CAPITAL COST ESTIMATE Capital Expenditure Business Plan Adjust Factor RMB M Forecast RMB M % of total 240 869 21% 77% Total Changsha Input 174 90 264 15% 8% 23% TOTAL INITIAL PROJECT CAPEX 1,133 100% Ore Dressing Plant Total HKFS Input Metallurgical Plants 400 1,233 Iron DRI Titanium DRI 0.60 0.70 Operating Cost Estimate Operating costs for the Existing LRM Mine project were obtained from three sources: a) Hong Kong FSMI Business Plan (May 2007) plus discussion with HKFS project team; b) ENFI; and, c) the Central South University. All operating costs are considered by WGM to be preliminary nature. The operating costs for Mining provided by HKFS is RMB15.5/t ore; this includes the mining cost of waste rock. Based on ENFI pit strip ratio of 1.7 tonnes waste per tonne ore, the calculated unit mining cost is therefore RMB5.8/t. WGM agrees that the proposed mining costs appear reasonable. Ore Dressing Plant operating cost per HKFS for the production of three concentrates, iron, titanium and phosphate, and based on an average yield of 23.2%, is RMB48.8/t ore. WGM agree that the proposed ore dressing plant costs appear reasonable. An estimated Resources Tax of RMB 5.6/t ore was used by ENFI in the pit optimization is net of rebate per government policy. Costs of trucking concentrate from the ore dressing plant to the metallurgical plant were estimated by Hong Kong FSMI at RMB80/t concentrate. WGM agree that this cost is reasonable considering the haulage distance involved. Based on an average plant yield of 23.2%, concentrate trucking cost is equivalent to RMB18.5/t ore mined. – 241 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Operating Cost Estimate (continued) Operating cost for the Direct Reduction Iron metallurgical plant developed by Central South University on the basis of 147 kt DRI annual production is RMB1,784/t DRI. The by-product credits for titanium concentrate and powdered vanadium oxide are estimated at RMB828/t DRI for a net cost of RMB956/t DRI. Similarly the operating costs for Direction Reduction Titanium on the basis of 62 kt high grade TiO2 annual production is estimated at RMB1,343/t with by-product credits at RMB1,012/t for a net cost of RMB956/t high grade TiO2. WGM considers the operating cost estimates by Central South University to be preliminary and these costs will need to be adjusted when the engineering studies are completed. Conclusions and Recommendations The following are the conclusions and recommendations by WGM from the technical review. WGM recognize that considerable technical studies have been carried out on the deposit to date and that additional studies are in progress however, the studies completed are insufficient to support a full feasibility study. Mineral Resource and Mineral Reserve estimates have been developed using acceptable industry standards and procedures. The mineral deposit, however, has not been fully defined; potential for increasing resources and reserves is considered to be good. Sufficient Mineral Reserves have been identified to support the proposed 2.6 million tonne per year Mining and Ore Dressing operation for only five years. Additions to mineral reserves should be a high priority objective of project development. Detailed studies of a feasibility level have been completed by ENFI. However, specific reports, particularly those in support of mineral dressing and metallurgical assumptions, and specifically the finalization of the flowsheets have not yet been received and therefore not reviewed for this technical assessment. Recent metallurgical results, issued by Central South University, are based only on bench scale testwork and comparison to similar operations. Key assumptions for metallurgical recoveries are not yet confirmed. Significant differences exist between concentrate yields currently projected by ENFI and Changsha. The capital cost estimate for mine, ore dressing plant, infrastructure and iron and titanium direct reduction plants is estimated to be RMB1.13 billion. Cost estimates for both Capex and Opex are largely adapted from similar operations or developed from cost manuals and should be considered preliminary (Ó35%) at best. Proposed Mining and Ore Dressing operating costs are considered reasonable. All cost estimates for a feasibility study level must be developed in detail. – 242 – APPENDIX VII 1. TECHNICAL REPORT SUMMARY (continued) Conclusions and Recommendations (continued) In summary, most of the business projections appear to be based on preliminary studies and cost estimates. The WGM technical assessment review therefore concludes that the Xiao Hong Shan project is technically at a Scoping Study or Preliminary Assessment level. WGM has concluded that the preliminary studies show that the Xiao Hong Shan deposit merits ongoing exploration and could potentially support a viable project provided that sufficient additional Mineral Resource/Reserves are developed. WGM agrees with ENFI that additional Mineral Resources/Reserves are required and that diamond drilling in both the proposed pit area and to the east over the untested magnetic anomalies be continued to fully assess the potential of the site. WGM recommends the sample preparation of the subsamples for analysis be prepared at an independent laboratory prior to being sent for analysis and to include blind, standard, repeat and blank samples to meet international quality assurance/quality control standards. WGM recognizes that much of the ENFI feasibility study is based on the assumption of achieving a 2.6 Mt/year production rate. Efforts should therefore be focussed on increasing mineral resources/reserves through on-site exploration activities as well as re-assessment of potentially recoverable mineral reserves through on-going pit optimization studies. Assessment of threshold mineral reserves required to support minimum project investment is highly recommended both to minimize financial exposure and to optimize project capacity and development timeline. WGM recommends that full documentation of all technical studies, key assumptions, and cost estimates become an on-going process as part of the project development plan and that a Project Director assume full responsibility for organization and management of all aspects of project development. – 243 – APPENDIX VII 2. TECHNICAL REPORT INTRODUCTION, BACKGROUND AND SCOPE OF WORK 2.1 INTRODUCTION Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (“Aurora Global”) is a company listed on the Stock Exchange of Hong Kong (under stock code 353). Aurora Global is considering acquiring an interest in the Xiao Hong Shan, Little Red Mountain iron, titanium, vanadium property located in Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, People’s Republic of China (“PRC”) from Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited (“HKFS”). Aurora Global requires an independent technical assessment report on the property for inclusion in a circular to be issued by Aurora Global to fulfil some regulatory requirements in Hong Kong. 2.2 BACKGROUND AND SCOPE OF WORK 2.2.1 BACKGROUND OF THE PROJECT In a July 2007 engagement letter, Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (“Aurora Global”) contracted Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited (“WGM”) to review the current engineering studies being carried out by China ENFI Engineering Corporation (“ENFI”) of Beijing, PRC for HKFS and to prepare an independent technical assessment report of the project. WGM has made site visits to the property in October 2005, and in May 2006, completed a NI 43-101 compliant report by Velasquez Spring., P.Eng., Senior Geologist, title “A Review of the Iron-Vanadium-Titanium Deposit, Little Red Mountain, People’s Republic of China for Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited” dated April 12, 2007. WGM met with ENFI and HKFS personnel in Beijing, PRC during July 12 to 18, 2007. Since no additional technical work has been conducted on the property since WGM’s last visit, it was decided that a new site-visit was not required at this time. 2.2.2 SCOPE OF WORK The scope of work comprised of a review of the current engineering studies being carried out by China ENFI of Beijing, PRC for Aurora Global and preparation of an independent technical assessment report of the project. To complete the scope of work, WGM held numerous meetings and discussions with various ENFI personnel in Beijing, PRC during July 12 to 18, 2007 and reviewed the progress and results of the engineering studies presently being carried out by ENFI as well as the additional studies programmed to be done. WGM also held several meetings with HKFS to review HKFS’s latest Business Plan for Project Development, Market and Product Development and Preliminary Economic Analysis. – 244 – APPENDIX VII 2. TECHNICAL REPORT INTRODUCTION, BACKGROUND AND SCOPE OF WORK (continued) 2.2 BACKGROUND AND SCOPE OF WORK (continued) 2.2.2 SCOPE OF WORK (continued) WGM reviewed prioritized and supplemented the HKFS proposed drillholes for 2007. The initial six drillholes (1,350 m) to begin drilling at the end of July are designed to locate additional Mineral Resources/Reserves on the southwest and eastern sides of the ENFI designed pit. 3. OBJECTIVES AND WORK PROGRAM 3.1 PROGRAM OBJECTIVES The objectives of the program were to complete the scope of work by reviewing the available data and completing a draft independent technical assessment report by August 15, 2007. The final report is to be completed by August 29, 2007. Also, prior to completing the draft report, a list of the technical data was to be provided to LCH, near the end of July 2007, so that they could commence the valuation process. 3.2 PURPOSE OF THE REPORT Aurora Global has entered into an arrangement with HKFS to acquire an interest in the mineral property and requires the report for inclusion in a circular to be issued by Aurora Global to fulfil some regulatory requirements in Hong Kong. 3.3 REPORTING STANDARD This report has been prepared to comply with the guidelines of Canadian Securities Administrators National Instrument 43-101 (“NI 43-101”) that governs all public disclosure of scientific and technical information concerning mineral projects based on information prepared by a Qualified Person (“QP”). A QP is an individual who is an engineer or geoscientist with at least five years of experience in mineral exploration, mine development or operation or mineral project assessment or any combination of these; has experience relevant to the subject matter of the mineral project and the technical report; and is a member on good standings of a professional association. This report is not a Valuation Report and does not express an opinion as to the value of mineral assets. Aspects reviewed in this report, do include product prices, socio-political issues and environmental considerations, however, WGM does not express an opinion regarding the specific value of the assets and tenements involved. – 245 – APPENDIX VII 3. TECHNICAL REPORT OBJECTIVES AND WORK PROGRAM (continued) 3.4 WORK PROGRAM The work program included the following: • • • • • • • • 3.5 A review of all available data prior to departure to Beijing PRC; Travel to Beijing, PRC; Discussions with ENFI technical personnel in Beijing, PRC; Discussions with HKFS personnel in Beijing, PRC; Collection of data and documents; Return to Canada and data review; Preparation of a draft report to Aurora Global for comment; and Completion of final Independent Technical Assessment Report. PROJECT TEAM The WGM project team and their duties are as follows: Joe Hinzer, P.Geo., President and Senior Geologist Velasquez Spring., P.Eng., Senior Geologist Robert S. Didur, P.Eng., Team Leader Principal Geologist Team Coordinator Production and Costs Senior Associate Mining Engineer John Starkey, P.Eng., Senior Associate Metallurgist Dorota El-Rassi, P.Eng., Geological Engineer Peter Zhang, WGM Chief Representative, Processing and Metallurgy Resource Estimate Translator Beijing Office 3.6 STATEMENT OF WGM INDEPENDENCE Neither WGM nor any of the authors of this report have any material present or contingent interest in the outcome of this report, nor do they have any pecuniary or other interest that could be reasonably regarded as being capable of affecting their independence or that of WGM. WGM has no prior association with Aurora Global in regard to the mineral assets that are the subject of this Report. WGM has no beneficial interest in the outcome of the technical assessment being capable of affecting its independence. WGM’s fee for completing this Technical Assessment report is based on its normal professional daily rates plus reimbursement of incidental expenses. The payment of that professional fee is not contingent upon the outcome of the report. – 246 – APPENDIX VII 3. TECHNICAL REPORT OBJECTIVES AND WORK PROGRAM (continued) 3.7 WGM EXPERIENCE Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited is an independent firm of consulting geologists and engineers. Since 1962, WGM has successfully completed projects for the international mining community on precious, base and rare metals, industrial minerals and diamonds. From offices in Toronto, Vancouver and Beijing, WGM provides consulting services to mining and exploration companies, Canadian and international banks, financing agencies, governments and law firms. In addition to its permanent staff members, the firm is supported by a large group of high-calibre associates specializing in all of the key aspects of exploration and mining. This team of permanent and associate professionals gives WGM’s clients the assurance that all of their specific geological and mining needs are met. WGM’s proficiency in project management and its technical expertise have contributed to the firm’s worldwide reputation of excellence and solid project execution. 3.8 FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS Estimates of mineral resources, ore reserves and mine and processing plant production are inherently forward-looking statements, which being projections of future performance will necessarily differ from the actual performance. The errors in such projections result from the inherent uncertainties in the interpretation of geologic data, in variations in the execution of mining and processing plans, in the ability to meet construction and production schedules due to many factors including weather, availability of necessary equipment and supplies, fluctuating prices and changes in regulations. The possible sources of error in the forward-looking statements are addressed in more detail in the appropriate sections of this report. Also provided in the report are comments on the risks inherent in the different mining and processing operations. 4. PROPERTY DESCRIPTION AND LOCATION 4.1 LOCATION The Xiaohongshan (Little Red Mountain) vanadium mineral concession is located 180 km north of the city of Jiayugan, central-western PRC. The property’s geographic coordinates lie between latitudes 41˚25’00"N and 41˚27’00"N, and longitudes 97˚58’00"E and 98˚01’00"E, in Erjina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region just east of the Gansu Provincial border (Figure 1). – 247 – APPENDIX VII 4. TECHNICAL REPORT PROPERTY DESCRIPTION AND LOCATION (continued) 4.2 PROPERTY DESCRIPTION The Existing LRM Mine comprises a single mineral exploration concession (Figure 2, Appendix 1) licence number 0100000410104, covering 15.47 km2 that was granted to QHF on November 25, 2004 and was valid until November 25, 2005. Subsequently the concession was re-granted and the exploration rights are valid until November 25, 2008. The mineral concession is located between Longitudes 97˚58’00”E and 98˚01’00”E and Latitudes 41˚25’00”N and 41˚27’00”N. The detailed exploration has been concentrated in a 2 km x 1 km rectangular area oriented NW-SE with the following corner coordinates: 41˚26’44”N 41˚26’14”N 41˚25’45”N 41˚26’15”N Figure 1. 97˚58’51”E 98˚00’07”E 97˚59’47”E 97˚58’31”E Location map – 248 – APPENDIX VII 4. TECHNICAL REPORT PROPERTY DESCRIPTION AND LOCATION (continued) 4.2 PROPERTY DESCRIPTION (continued) Figure 2. Property concession map – 249 – APPENDIX VII 5. TECHNICAL REPORT AC C E S S , C L I M AT E , L O C A L R E S O U R C E S , I N F R A S T RU C T U R E A N D PHYSIOGRAPHY 5.1 ACCESS The Existing LRM Mine mineral concession is readily accessible by vehicle driving north some 150 km on the paved highway from Jiuquan and Jiayuguan through Beishan towards Yeh-ma-ching and the border of Mongolia, then west for about 60 km on gravel road across the Bandanjilin desert. Total driving time is approximately 5 hours. Jiuquan and Jiayuguan are connected by daily rail service from the capital city of Beijing. Air China Northwest also provides daily flights to and from Beijing and to several other Chinese cities. 5.2 CLIMATE The climate is classified as a continental desert climate and is characteristically windy with the winds coming from the west throughout almost the entire year. The annual precipitation is less than 60 mm and the average annual temperature is approximately 6.8˚C. The maximum temperature occurs in July at near 40˚C with the minimum in January at -36˚C. A high evaporation rate is present with the annual total at more than 3,000 mm. 5.3 LOCAL RESOURCES The project is located in the Bandanjilin desert without any local resources. All goods, equipment, food and supplies (including water) must be brought into the project from the nearest cities, Jiuquan and Jiayuguan, or from the nearby Yumen Village. No nearby power source is available and no water wells, or natural springs, occur in the concession area. However, it is believed that a limited supply of probable poor quality water, sufficient to meet the requirements during construction and mine production should be available in the nearby Huangshan Basin but the basin will require the exploration by the drilling of water-well holes. Vegetation is limited to a few grasses and thorny bushes along the valleys of the dry arroyos. The area is uninhabited except for the occasional nomadic Mongolian herdsman tending to their sheep and goats. Wild camels are present in the area and wolves are reported. – 250 – APPENDIX VII 5. TECHNICAL REPORT AC C E S S , C L I M AT E , L O C A L R E S O U R C E S , I N F R A S T RU C T U R E A N D PHYSIOGRAPHY (continued) 5.4 INFRASTRUCTURE The project, located in the northern part of central-western China in the western district of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, is some 25 km from the border of Gansu Province. Gansu Province covers an area of approximately 450,000 km2 and has a population estimated at near 25 million. It is a rugged, barren province that consists mainly of mountains and deserts. It has played an important part in Chinese history as it lies along the famed Silk Road, the ancient highway along which camel caravans carried goods in and out of China. Traditionally the towns/cities of Gansu have been established at oases along the caravan route particularly where agriculture was possible. Gansu is home to a variety of minority people, including the Hui, Mongols, Tibetans and Kazaks. Although the Chinese Han are now in the vast majority. The city of Jiayuguan is an example of a city developed along the Silk Road and is now an important steel producing commercial and industrial centre. A poorly paved road that runs north, and provides part of the access to the Existing LRM Mine, is the main road transporting iron ore from the Black Eagle Iron Mine some 270 km north from Jiayuguan. Jiayuguan, and the nearby city of Jiuquan, contain all the infrastructure for industry and commerce with a large work force and all modern facilities that include banking communications, transport, medical, housing and the closest city to the Chinese Space Craft Launch Centre. 5.5 PHYSIOGRAPHY The concession is located in a gentle, well rounded, low-hilly land forms, in the eastern end of the Beishan Mountain Range, on the western margin of the Bandanjilin Desert. Elevations range from 1,470 m above sea level (“asl”) to 1,580 m asl with the difference in elevation generally about 60 m. – 251 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING 6.1 INTRODUCTION China is subdivided into a number of geological domains which reflect current modelling of China’s evolution over time (Table 1). The model is largely based on continental accretion with attendant tectonism and subduction. Movement by the Siberian Plate to the north and the Pacific-Philippine plates to the east were major factors in China’s evolution. TABLE 1 GEOLOGICAL EVENTS HISTORY OF CHINA Geological Time Scale Era Period Geotectonics Tectonic Development Ma. Tectonic or Magmatic Period Quaternary Cenozoic Tertiary Uplift of Qingzang Plateau. Himalayan 2.48 66 Cretaceous Intracontinental Development 135 P Mesozoic H A N E R O Z O I C Jurassic Yanshanian 205 Triassic Indosinian 250 Permian 285 Carboniferous Variscan 355 Devonian Paleozoic 405 Silurian 435 Ordovician Continental Margin Development Caledonian 500 Cambrian 600 P R O T E R O Z O I C A R C H E A N Late Proterozoic Sinian Sinian 800 Qingbaikouan Jinningian 1000 Middle Proterozoic Early Proterozoic Jixianian 1400 Continental Changchengian Hutuoan Major Geological Event Sibaoan Block Development 1800 Convergence of Himalayan plate and Xizang-Yunnan Plate. South China Sea area rifting begins. Intracontinental faulting begins in circum-Pacific region and eastern China. Convergence of Xizang-Yunnan and South China plates and South China and Tarim-North China Plates. Convergence of Tarim-North China and Siberian Plates; Closure of paleo-Tethys. Rifting on western margin of Yangtze Block. Consolidation and accretion of SE part of the Yangtze Block; Formation of Paleo-Chinese continent. Development of Tianshan-Hinggan, Kunlun-Qinling and Nanhua continental margins. Formation of primitive Chinese continent including North China, Tarim, Yangtze and Cathaysia Blocks. Formation of North China Block. Luliangian 2500 Wutaian Late Archean Fupingian Early to Middle Archean 2600 2900 Qianxiian Development of Continental Nucleus Fupingian Qianxiian Formation of North China nucleus and western Sichuan, Jiamusi and South Tarim micronuclei. (after C. Yuki, 2000) – 252 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.1 INTRODUCTION (continued) The regional geological setting of the Existing LRM Mine is: “within the Tianshan-Hinggan Domain along the northern border of China, stretching across the Xinjiang Uygur Autonomous Region, Gansu Province, the Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, Jilin Province and Heilongjiang Province. The domain is bounded by neighbouring countries including Mongolia, Russia, Kazakhstan, Kirghizia, Tadzhikistan and Korea, and is adjacent mainly to Tarim North China domain on the south. “Tectonically, this domain occupies the continental-margin mobile belts on both sides of the Palaeo-Asiatic ocean and the northern part of the Circum-Pacific continental-margin mobile belt. Strata of all ages are developed in the domain and are mostly of mobile and transitional types. Magmatic activity was intense, with paired magmatic rock belts occurring orderly on the margins of palaeo-continents. The geology of this domain is also characterized by the diversity of metamorphism, metamorphic facies and metamorphic rock types. The earth’s crust within the limits of the Tianshan-Hinggan domain has experienced three megastages of evolution i.e., the continental basement formation and evolution megastage, the Paleo-Asiatic ocean’s marginal accretion and the Circum-Pacific tectonics and intracontinental faulting megastage. The Palaeo-Asiatic ocean’s marginal accretion and evolution megastage is the principal one characterized by the drifting of the Junggar, Ili, Xilinhot and Jiamusi microblocks in the Paleo-Asiatic ocean. These blocks and the old continents on both sides of the ocean accreted gradually in the Caledonian and early Variscan and, finally, the south and north continents collided and converged together in the late Variscan. Afterwards, the western part of the domain tectonically underwent mainly fault-block uplifting and subsidence, while the eastern part was involved in the Circum-Pacific continental-margin mobilization and was enrolled as a part of the mobile zone with the NE-ENE-trending tectonomagmatic belts as the product of intense tectonic activization and magmatic activities, superimposed on the accretion margin of the Palaeo-Asiatic continent. From the Yanshanian on, the magmatic activities shifted to both sides from Songliao Basin-western Liaoning area roughly as the centre.” 6.2 REGIONAL GEOLOGY The Existing LRM Mine is south of the Kangurtage-Hongshi Mountain domain, with the 2 km2 detailed exploration area in the Baluntai Hanshan Mountain Massif between the domain of the South Tianshan Mountain-Kumishi-Hongliu River-Liujiaojing-Yueya Mountain fold belt (Figure 3). The property is in the same regional geological setting and at a similar latitude as the famous producing vanadium-titanium-iron mine in Damiao, Hebei Province PRC. – 253 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.2 REGIONAL GEOLOGY (continued) Figure 3. Regional geology The Existing LRM Mine occurs within a sequence of early Proterozoic meta-sedimentary rocks located along the northern margin of the North China platform. In the northern part of the concession area, large areas of Jurassic, Cretaceous and Tertiary age rocks outcrop while in the southern part, a wide range of Quaternary age rocks outcrop. In general, the deposit is made up of two broad west to east geological belts: the middle belt, the Gong Po Quan-Hong Liu Da Quan and the southern belt the structural zone of the south hill to the Tianshan Mountain. – 254 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.2 REGIONAL GEOLOGY (continued) 6.2.1 GUTONGJING GROUP The oldest rocks in the concession area are those of the Gutongjing Group of the Great Wall System mainly outcropping as linear belts in a NW-SE direction in the Xiaohong Mountain. The outcrops consisting of a series of low-grade metamorphic clastic rocks that can be divided into two units: Lower unit consisting mainly of grey-green to yellow-brown, fine-grained sandy slates, fine-grained shales, sandy slates, phyllites, crystalline limestone, marble and almond coloured andesitic-basalts; and upper unit, consisting of grey-green to yellow-green, schistose, fine-grained sandy quartzites, grey-white quartzites, grey-blue sandy slates and calcareous fine-grained phyllitic slates. 6.2.2 PINGTOU MOUNTAIN FORMATION Limited outcroppings occur in the southern part of the Xiaohong Mountain area conformably overlying the Gutongjing Group. The base consisting of a dark reddish to purple coloured conglomerate, followed by middle and upper parts of thick beds of dark grey siliceous slate thin beds of grey-black limestone and thick beds of yellow-brown clastic, siliceous limestones. 6.2.3 BAISHANG MOUNTAIN FORMATION The Baishang Mountain Formation of Carboniferous Age outcrops in the south part of the Xiaohong Mountain and consists of grey, grey-green, dark-green to purple coloured, schistose, intermediate to acidic, tuffs and crystal tuffs containing lenses of limestone. 6.2.4 CHIJINBOA FORMATION The rocks of the Chijinbao Formation (upper Jurassic Age) are the principal rocks outcropping around Xiaohong Mountain and consist of a series of continental clastic rocks of sandstones, mudstones and marlites. 6.2.5 QUATERNARY The Quaternary, covering the older rocks, are composed of loose sands, gravels and scree material and are mainly distributed along the valleys (arroyos). – 255 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.2 REGIONAL GEOLOGY (continued) 6.2.6 REGIONAL TECTONICS Faulting in the region occurs mainly as thrust faults striking near E-W that were later crosscut by NE, NW and NS faults. South of Existing LRM Mine, the Hongliu Daquanbei deep regional fault, formed during the Late Proterozoic, controlled the emplacement of the ultramafic, basic and acidic magmatic rocks and is a particularly important fault that controlled the intrusion and distribution of the gabbro and related intrusions that contain the V/ T/Fe mineralization. North of Existing LRM Mine, another deep regional fault, but of early Paleozoic age, the Sandao Mingshu-Dakouzi fault (part of the Baiyun Mountain-Yueya Mountain deep fault) also contains ultramafics and acid intrusives intruded as pods (beads) along a linear magnetic anomaly and containing a well-developed ophiolite suite of rocks. Complex fold structures have been caused by fault movement, accompanied by strong magmatic activity. The axes of early Caledonian (early Paleozoic) folds are in NWW, W or E-W direction and are in the form of compact or reverse folds while the folds of late Caledonia are relatively wide and gentle. The axes of late Paleozic folds (Hercynian orogeny) are generally NW and occasionally NWW. Due to the large scale intrusions associated with the Hercynian orogeny, the fold structures are incompletely preserved. The NE wide and gentle Yanshonian (Jurassic) folding overlaps earlier folding. The fold and fault structures have no obvious relationship to the V/Ti magnetite mineralization. The V/Ti Magnetite mineralization is associated with the Hercynian (late Paleozoic) intrusions. These intrusions are mainly located along faults or at the contact zone of fold structure. The NE fault structures developed to the north of Existing LRM Mine, in the Xisha Spring-Xiaohaung Mountain Sandao Minghui-Shibanjing areas, control the distribution of the Jurassic basins. – 256 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.2 REGIONAL GEOLOGY (continued) 6.2.7 INTRUSIVE ROCKS The Existing LRM Mine has been subjected to frequent magmatic activity from Caledonian (early Paleozoic) through to Cretaceous times but the Hercynian (late Paleozoic) period experienced the most intense, wide spread, largest and different types of intrusives. The Hercynian has been divided into three periods (early, mid and late). The early period (Devonian) rocks are mainly plagioclase granites and quartz diorites in the form of stocks. The mid period (carboniferous) rocks includes batholiths of granites and granodiorites and are mainly in the south part of Existing LRM Mine while the late period (Permian Age) are mainly ultramafics, gabbro diabase, biotite-plagioclase granites and diorite. The gabbro intrusives have a close relationship to the V-Ti-Magnetite mineralization. 6.3 PROPERTY GEOLOGY 6.3.1 LITHOLOGY Apart from intrusive rocks two sedimentary lithological units are found at Existing LRM Mine, the sediments of the Gutongjing Group of the Great Wall System of middle Proterozoic age, and the unconsolidated sediments of the Quaternary (Figure 4). Gutongying Group The Gutongying Group can be divided into two units, the upper metamorphic sandstones (Pt2gS) and the lower carbonate rocks (Pt2gD). Figure 4. Exploration drillholes and trenches geology map – 257 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.3 PROPERTY GEOLOGY (continued) 6.3.1 LITHOLOGY (continued) The carbonate rocks include grey-white, grey and pure white, “ophiolitized” marble, garnitiferous marbles and pure white granular marbles. The marbles often exhibit skarn “ophiolization” when in contact with the gabbros and granitic dykes. Also they often exhibit “idomorphic” or “crystalloblastic” textures resulting from contact metamorphism. The upper (Pt 2gS) units consist of grey, grey-purple coloured, metamorphic sandstone to pure quartz granular sandstones with minor amounts of feldspar, muscovite, biotite and chlorite. Quaternary The unconsolidated sands consisting of loess and eroded fine-grained, wind-blown fragments are found mainly in gullies or as “gobi” masses at the lower elevations. 6.3.2 MAGMATIC ROCKS Various intrusives rocks are present at Existing LRM Mine, from ultramafic to intermediate to acidic units, that include gabbro, granodiorites and granites and occur in the form of batholiths, stocks and dykes as well as some granite porphyry, pegmatite and quartz veins. Gabbro is the principal intrusive occurring in an E-W direction over 2 km and in a N-S direction 1 km; the outcrops increasing in number towards the west. The intruded rocks occur as fragments or have been completely assimilated within the gabbro. The gabbros are mainly medium grained but coarse and fine-grained sections occur. The vanadium-titanium-magnetite mineralized bodies occur within the gabbros. The gabbro’s main mineral composition is composed of 40% to 60% pyroxene (hyperstene), 5% to 20% hornblende, 20% to 40% basic feldspars, 5% to 15% vanadium-titanium-magnetite minerals, and secondary minerals of 5% to 10% apatite and 1% to 5% biotite. Alteration includes sericitization and development of clays. The V, Ti, magnetite mineralization infills fissures or fractures accompanied with some limonite. Apatite occurs as short, columnar, hexagonal crystals between 0.1 to 1.0 mm in size. Most of the ore mineralization is finegrained. – 258 – APPENDIX VII 6. TECHNICAL REPORT GEOLOGICAL SETTING (continued) 6.3 PROPERTY GEOLOGY (continued) 6.3.3 STRUCTURAL GEOLOGY Major fold structures were destroyed at Existing LRM Mine by the intrusion of the later Hercynian gabbros and only small scale secondary folding can be observed. Faults and fracturing however are well developed. Three groups of faulting are observed at Existing LRM Mine and have been numbered F-1, F-2 and F-3. The F-1 fault is located in the NW part between lines 49 and 48 and exposed in six exploratory engineering trenches. The fault zone is made up of gabbro and quartz rock breccia and gouge and strikes 080˚ to 100˚ and dips north at 70˚. The fault exhibits multiple fault movements. The F-2 fault lies in the central and western part of the Existing LRM Mine (between lines 26 and 66) and strikes 110˚ and is several metres wide. The angle and direction of the dip of the fault is unknown but a gentle undulance of the faults is observed. Intense gouge and schistose material are present along the fault. The F-3 fault is found in the central area trending in a NNE direction and although not observed on surface, it was intersected in drillhole ZK66-5. The clear linear nature and dislocation of lithology and dykes can be clearly observed on remote sensing satellite data. The western part of the fault shows low, hilly and cliff landforms while the eastern part exhibits gentle, flat landforms. On the satellite image, the extensive Pt2gS sandstones on the west side of the fault disappear on the NE side. The gabbros on SW side of the fault extend in a near E-W direction with the V-Ti-Magnetite mineralization also distributed in the same direction thus this fault controls the distribution of the gabbro and mineralization and is worthy of further study. – 259 – APPENDIX VII 7. TECHNICAL REPORT DEPOSIT TYPES The Existing LRM Mine type of deposit is described as a late stage magmatic segregation from the parent gabbroic magma. The segregation, a vanadium bearing titaniferous magnetite, was at a later time due to tectonic movements injected along layers of the gabbro. A total of eight separate lenticular bodies of magnetite occur within the gabbro, numbered from N to S (I to VIII) and are concentrated in the western end of the detailed study area. The bodies strike between 090˚ to 120˚ and the Chinese have described their outcrop pattern as looking like a series of parallel flying geese formations with the nose of the flight lines occurring at line 17. The bodies to the west of line 17 strike at or near 90˚ and those to the east strike at or near 120˚. The bodies dip south, or southwestward at angles of between 80˚ to 88˚. The magnetite bodies vary in width both along strike and down dip with bodies I to IV of relatively larger size. In general, according to Chinese classification, the magnetite bodies are described as medium scale and ranging from simple to complex in shape but with a good continuity of the bodies (i.e., few faults) and gradual changes in grades. TABLE 2 CHARACTERISTICS OF THE OREBODIES Orebody Number I II III IV V VI VII 8. Location between lines Length L35 to L14 L49 to L14 L49 to L14 L43 to L24 L29 to L14 L29 to L14 L14 to L7 (m) 650 840 780 500 300 440 320 Maximum Maximum width known depth Total Fe (m) ~65 40 39 25-40 12-20 3.6-64.6 25 (m) 320 330 300 190 120 290 210 (%) 19.6 19.47 19.15 21.51 18.30 19.11 18.17 TiO2 Intersected by (%) 3.75 3.64 3.60 3.40 2.73 3.12 3.12 No. of No. of Trenches DDH 9 19 13 21 10 16 6 9 1 2 1 12 1 4 MINERALIZATION Iron mineralization, a primary metal of interest, occurs mainly in minerals of titaniferous magnetite, ilmenite, magnetite and some pyrrhotite. The mineral occurs, as disseminations (xenomorphic to hypautomorphic granular texture) and as discrete lenticular masses within a gabbro. The gabbro exhibiting medium to fine-grained, gabbroic texture is composed of gangue minerals of pyroxene (40% to 60%) calcic feldspars (20% to 40%) and hornblende (5% to 20%). The mineralization, under the Chinese classification, is classified in three categories: 1) oxidized (down to depths of 1.7 and 12.9 m); 2) compound (10 to less than 30 m depth); and, 3) primary (below 30 m depth). – 260 – APPENDIX VII 8. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERALIZATION (continued) The total iron content of the ores varies from 17.0% to 31.7% and the deposit is classified in China as a medium grade iron-ore deposit requiring mineral dressing for commercialisation. Secondary metals of interest are titanium and vanadium (intergrown with the iron) with the percentages of TiO2 and V2O5 in the iron ores at industrial index levels as stipulated in People’s Republic of China. Also of interest is the P2O 5 content. All P 2O5 values occur in apatite as idiomorphic, columnar-granular crystal forms of uniform grain size (0.04 to 0.3 mm). Apatite crystals, generally occur in the ores with high iron and titanium contents. Thin and polished sections studies coupled with field observation show that the order of mineralization to be first, titaniferous magnetite and ilmenite, followed by micro to fine crystalline-titaniferous magnetite, followed by micro to fine crystalline pyrite, then finally the oxidation of the titaniferous magnetite and the limonitic alteration. Sulphur is the most deleterious element present in the ores but is at very low contents (0.01% to 0.49%) and should be easily separated during the magnetic mineral dressing process. TABLE 3 AVERAGE CHEMICAL ANALYSIS FOR THE DIFFERENT EXISTING LRM MINE ORE TYPES Type of Ore Coarse grained V-Ti magnetite Fined grained V-Ti magnetite Medium grained V-Ti magnetite Disseminated V-Ti magnetite Gabbro SiO2 Al3O2 TiO2 F32O3 FeO MnO MgO CaO Na2O K2O P 2O 5 LOI TFeO3 28.96 8.12 13.75 14.91 0.49 6.58 11.95 0.58 0.62 2.90 2.53 30.15 30.25 16.26 5.68 8.95 15.42 0.33 3.13 11.33 1.32 0.92 2.88 1.22 25.91 41.28 15.87 1.73 7.08 16.92 0.54 3.39 5.65 2.41 1.35 0.36 0.81 25.67 42.15 14.06 3.52 4.90 15.03 0.40 3.38 9.58 2.92 0.49 1.76 0.67 20.12 49.41 20.86 0.95 2.48 0.21 2.30 7.55 4.17 1.50 0.53 1.37 11.41 6.54 8.15 – 261 – APPENDIX VII 9. TECHNICAL REPORT EXPLORATION The exploration conducted on the Existing LRM Mine prior to November 2005, is outlined in Section 6 History. In early November 2005, a contract was signed by HKFS with SINOREX Resource and Environment Engineering (Beijing) Co., Ltd. (“Sinorex”) for Sinorex to carry out the first stage and second stage exploration programs, as mandated by the Chinese requirements. The following table outlines the exploration works that were completed during the first stage and second stage, starting with geological mapping, followed by trenching then by diamond drilling: Description Amount Geological mapping at 1:2,000 scale Geological profile mapping at 1:500 scale Geological profile mapping at 1:1,000 scale Trenching Diamond drilling Trench sampling Diamond drill core samples Hydrogeology drillhole monitoring Groundwater level monitoring Engineering, environmental and hydrogeological mapping Drill core logging Hydrogeological logging of drill core Standard assay sampling Complete assaying Surveying GPS Samples (individual) Polished and thin sections 2 km2 8 linear km 4 linear km 3,053.4 m3 7,510.24 m 2,614.6 m 6,921.33 m 26 dh 3 locations 2 km2 7,510.24 m (26 ddh) 11 ddh 31,617 samples 188 samples 105 stations 100 48 During the first stage exploration program the main orebodies (iron) within the detailed exploration area were explored by a grid at an approximate 40 to 60 m spaced data points while the general concession area is at 100 m spacing data points. The data points were also spaced at approximately 40 to 60 m during the second stage exploration. All the diamond drilling has been concentrated in an area of about 0.7 km2 on the west side of the 2 km x 1 km (2 km2) area designated for the detailed exploration program. It is WGM’s understanding that additional exploration will be carried out in the remaining portion (east side) of the 2 km2 area. – 262 – APPENDIX VII 10. TECHNICAL REPORT DRILLING The diamond drilling at Existing LRM Mine was carried out by SINOREX in two stages, the first stage during 2005 consisting of 13 drillholes (2,461.94 m) and the second stage also consisting of 13 drillholes (5,048.30 m) during 2006. The holes were all drilled in a N28˚15’E direction at angles near -50˚ along crosslines on a grid at a spacing of 100 m (Figure 5). The location of the drillhole collars were controlled by GPS readings (Global Position System Survey Standards-CH2001-92) and both the drillhole direction and the angle of the drillhole were set and later confirmed by the site geologist. Japanese drill machines (Models NL-38 and NL-55) were used throughout the drilling campaign and the drillhole diameter was predominantly 89 mm (H size core) with some at 75 mm (N size core). Core recoveries were excellent at near 100%. Single shot down-the-hole readings for drillhole azimuth and dip angle, using a gyroscope type instrument were carried out at 50 m intervals, following standard Chinese regulations. All down-the-hole drillhole surveys reportedly showed virtually no variance in the hole direction or in the dip angle of the hole. Figure 5. Cross section Line 15 – 263 – APPENDIX VII 11. TECHNICAL REPORT SAMPLING METHOD AND APPROACH The drill core at the drill site is placed in wooden core boxes, by the driller with the drill advances clearly marked with felt tipped pens. The core in each core box is photographed then geological logged and the Rock Quality Designations (“RQD”) determined and the sample intervals marked. Geological logging is completed by qualified geologists under the Chinese Logging Code that includes a description of the lithology, alteration, mineralization, structure and sampled interval. Wooden covers are put on each core tray box and then the boxes delivered to the core storage area where the core is diamond sawed in half at sampled intervals of near 1.5 m intervals (average sample length 1.34 m). Each sample is separately bagged, labelled and sealed for shipment to the assay laboratory. Trenches were machine excavated to fresh rock to an average depth of 1.0 to 3.0 m at widths greater than 0.8 m. Geological mapping is carried out in the trenches on one wall and on the bottom of the trench, similar to the drill core, mapping was carried out at a scale of 1:100. Trench samples (about 6 kg to 7 kg) are similarly collected at intervals of approximately 1.5 m from a channel cut in the floor along the trench, all sample locations are GPS controlled. The co-ordinates (Eastern, Northern and elevation) of the trench are marked at each end on a wooden peg determined (GPS), except when the channel slope changes where additional coordinates are determined. Trench samples are similarly bagged, tagged and sent for sample preparation to the assay laboratory. All the sampling procedures are supervised by the site geologists. 12. SAMPLE PREPARATION, ANALYSES AND SECURITY During the initial site visit to Existing LRM Mine, WGM visited the No.4 Laboratory, Gansu Bureau of Geology and Mineral Resources where the Existing LRM Mine samples were prepared (i.e., crushed, split and ground) and a subsample collected to be analyzed. The No.4 Laboratory is located at 52 Liberation Rd., Jiuquan, Gansu. The complete sample preparation was reviewed from the initial sample registry through to crushing, splitting and grinding. Although the equipment is not the most modern, all the required safety steps are taken. The laboratory had a Class A Chinese qualification certification displayed on the wall showing that it met the requirements to be a certified government laboratory. It is WGM’s understanding that laboratories are regulated by the government and therefore all laboratories are required to follow standard procedures established by the Chinese government authorities (quality control specifications for laboratory testing of geological minerals). It was reported that 5% of the total number of samples are repeated as a duplicate samples. However at the Jiuguan laboratory no blank, or standard samples are routinely entered into the sample flow. Various analytical methods are carried out for the contents of TFe for: magnetic iron, Si by volumetric methods, S by combustion methods, and P, TiO2, Co, and V 2O 5 by X-Ray fluorescent spectrophotometry and by AA methods. – 264 – APPENDIX VII 12. TECHNICAL REPORT SAMPLE PREPARATION, ANALYSES AND SECURITY (continued) WGM comparison data derived from Chinese laboratories and Canadian laboratories have in the past shown good agreement. WGM is satisfied that the results as reported for the Existing LRM Mine are reliable but recommend, that for quality assurance and quality control that selected duplicate and blank samples in the future also be analyzed at a Canadian laboratory. It may be justified for future drilling programs to consider some level of sample preparation on site to reduce shipping costs and to control QA/AC by the inserting of repeat, blank and standard samples into the sample stream prior to shipping the samples to the analytical laboratory. Security has not been a concern to the Chinese geologists, as in the past, in a government operation there was little advantage to be gained by the salting or altering of the samples. 13. DATA VERIFICATION 13.1 GENERAL WGM’s field examination of the concession confirmed the geological setting and verified the existence of the diamond drillholes and of the well developed trenches both with their clearly marked sample intervals. The audit of selected drill core verified the reported mineralized intervals, the sample intervals, the core recovery and the reported RQD of the rocks. WGM feels confident that the geology as represented on the property geological map at a scale of 1:2,000 of the 2 km2 detailed study area fairly represents the geology as observed in the field. 13.2 WGM SITE VISIT SAMPLING WGM on the initial visit collected two chip channel samples from surface outcrops that were prepared (crushed, ground and sub-sampled) and analyzed at ALS Chemex Laboratory (“ALS”) in Mississauga, Ontario, and analyzed by ALS-XRF06 (whole rock) and for V by ALS AA-62 (Table 4 and Appendix 2). TABLE 4 ALS ANALYSES Fe2O3(%) TiO2 (%) V (%) 55.04 49.23 12.02 6.91 0.16 (0.29% V2O5) 0.02 (0.04% V2O5) – 265 – APPENDIX VII 13. TECHNICAL REPORT DATA VERIFICATION (continued) 13.2 WGM SITE VISIT SAMPLING (continued) On the second visit, the core of three drillholes were chip samples over short, selected intervals and sent to SGS Mineral Services (“SGS”) laboratory in Toronto, Canada and analyzed by SGS-XRF 762 (whole rock) and SGS-ICP90A for V (Table 5 and Appendix 2). TABLE 5 SGS ANALYSES DDH ZK-25-1 ZK-4-1 ZK-66-5 Interval (m) 164.9-165.9 282.1-282.9 176.7-178.7 SGS Fe2O3 (%) TiO2 (%) V (ppm) 21.3 5.28 870 32.1 4.21 200 34.3 7.34 630 Chinese Laboratory V 2O 5 (0.155) (0.036) (0.112) TFe (%) TiO2 (%) V2O5 (%) 14.95 5.21 0.114 25.69 6.31 0.036 34.55 8.76 0.104 The samples were carried by WGM to Toronto and then shipped to the laboratories for sample preparation. The sample confirmed that TFe, V2O5 and TiO2 are present at Existing LRM Mine and in quantities as indicated by the Chinese analyzed samples (see Table 5). WGM believes that the analytical results of the samples analyzed at the Chinese laboratories fairly represent the amounts present in the samples. – 266 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES 14.1 GENERAL WGM has prepared Mineral Resource estimates for the Existing LRM Mine three zones based on 3D wireframes interpreted by Golder Associates Consulting Ltd. (“Golder”). The estimates were prepared from a block model and exclude all blocks grading less than 15% TFe. A summary of the estimates is provided in Table 6. TABLE 6 EXISTING LRM MINE INDICATED AND INFERRED MINERAL RESOURCES Prepared by WGM (using a 15% TFe cutoff grade) Tonnes %TFe %TiO2 %V2O5 6,821,539 7,326,882 2,058,591 20.13 19.34 17.68 4.03 3.84 3.40 0.04 0.03 0.03 16,207,012 19.46 3.86 0.03 Zone 103 259,689 17.69 3.25 0.02 Total Inferred 259,689 17.69 3.25 0.02 Zone Zone 101 Zone 102 Zone 103 Total Indicated Note: WGM has lowered the cutoff grade of the TFe from the 17% as stipulated in the China regulations for iron deposits to 15% because of the increased recoverable values in the ore from TiO2 and V2O5. The classification of mineral resources and mineral reserves used in this report conforms with the definitions provided in the final version of National Instrument 43-101 (“NI 43101”), which came into effect on February 1, 2001, as revised on December 11, 2005. We further confirm that, in arriving at our classification, we have followed the guidelines adopted by the Council of the Canadian Institute of Mining Metallurgy and Petroleum (the “CIM Standards”). The relevant definitions for the CIM Standards/NI 43-101 are as follows: A Mineral Resource is a concentration or occurrence of diamonds, natural, solid, inorganic or fossilized organic material including base and precious metals, coal, and industrial minerals in or on the Earth’s crust in such form and quantity and of such a grade or quality that it has reasonable prospects for economic extraction. The location, quantity, grade, geological characteristics and continuity of a Mineral Resource are known, estimated or interpreted from specific geological evidence and knowledge. – 267 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.1 GENERAL (continued) An Inferred Mineral Resource is that part of a Mineral Resource for which quantity and grade or quality can be estimated on the basis of geological evidence and limited sampling and reasonably assumed, but not verified, geological and grade continuity. The estimate is based on limited information and sampling gathered through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings and drill holes. An Indicated Mineral Resource is that part of a Mineral Resource for which quantity, grade or quality, densities, shape and physical characteristics, can be estimated with a level of confidence sufficient to allow the appropriate application of technical and economic parameters, to support mine planning and evaluation of the economic viability of the deposit. The estimate is based on detailed and reliable exploration and testing information gathered through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings and drill holes that are spaced closely enough for geological and grade continuity to be reasonably assumed. A Measured Mineral Resource is that part of a Mineral Resource for which quantity, grade or quality, densities, shape, physical characteristics are so well established that they can be estimated with confidence sufficient to allow the appropriate application of technical and economic parameters, to support production planning and evaluation of the economic viability of the deposit. The estimate is based on detailed and reliable exploration, sampling and testing information gathered through appropriate techniques from locations such as outcrops, trenches, pits, workings and drill holes that are spaced closely enough to confirm both geological and grade continuity. A Mineral Reserve is the economically mineable part of a Measured or Indicated Mineral Resource demonstrated by at least a Preliminary Feasibility Study. This Study must include adequate information on mining, processing, metallurgical, economic and other relevant factors that demonstrate, at the time of reporting, that economic extraction can be justified. A Mineral Reserve includes diluting materials and allowances for losses that may occur when the material is mined. A Probable Mineral Reserve is the economically mineable part of an Indicated, and in some circumstances a Measured Mineral Resource demonstrated by at least a Preliminary Feasibility Study. This Study must include adequate information on mining, processing, metallurgical, economic, and other relevant factors that demonstrate, at the time of reporting, that economic extraction can be justified. A Proven Mineral Reserve is the economically mineable part of a Measured Mineral Resource demonstrated by at least a Preliminary Feasibility Study. This Study must include adequate information on mining, processing, metallurgical, economic, and other relevant factors that demonstrate, at the time of reporting, that economic extraction is justified. – 268 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.2 GENERAL MINERAL RESOURCE ESTIMATION PROCEDURES The Mineral Resource estimate procedures consisted of: • Database compilation and verification; • Development of 3-D wireframe models within major lithological units, using the assays available for each drillhole sample interval; and • Generation of block models for Mineral Resource estimates for the three zones using a geostatistical approach applying the Inverse Distance Squared (“ID2”) method. 14.3 DATABASE 14.3.1 GENERAL Data used to generate the Mineral Resource estimates originated from Microsoft Excel files containing collar, survey, and assay information for the drillholes. The trench data contained the starting and ending points of the trenches as well as the assay information. The Existing LRM Mine drillhole database consisted of 26 collar drillhole locations and 36 trench locations, and 6,863 multi-element assay (TFe, V2O5, TiO2 and MFe) intervals. The data were provided to WGM in digital form (via email from Golder). The 3D Wireframes representing six orebodies, interpreted by Golder, were supplied as Drawing Interchange Files (DXF). Additional information, including historical “mineral resource” estimates and geological interpretations on sections were as Acrobat pdf files. Thirteen northeast-southwest cross sections (with spacing varying between 50 and 100 m), were generated by WGM to coincide with the historical sections interpreted by Golder. 14.3.2 DATA VALIDATION Upon receipt of the data, WGM performed the following validation steps: • Checking minimum and maximum values for each quality value field and confirming/modifying those outside of expected ranges; and • Checking for gaps, overlaps and out of sequence intervals for assays tables. The files containing drillhole collar coordinates obtained directly from client had mistakenly changed Northing into Easting and vice versa. To keep consistency in the data WGM decided to use coordinates as defined in Golder Report. The data was generally in good shape. – 269 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.3 DATABASE (continued) 14.3.3DATABASE MANAGEMENT The drillhole data were stored in a Gemcom’s GEMS © software multi-tabled workspace specifically designed to manage collar and interval data. Other data, like surface contours or cross sectional geological interpretations, were stored in multi-tabled polyline workspaces. The project database also stored section and level plan definitions, 3-D surfaces and solids, and the block models, such that all data pertaining to the project are stored within the same project database. 14.4 GEOLOGICAL MODELLING PROCEDURES 14.4.1 GENERAL In general, the modelling procedures were as follows: • Geological re-interpretation based on new information and digitizing of lithological outlines; • 3-D surface (TIN) and solid/wireframe creation; • Database manipulation and compositing; • Statistical analysis; • Block grade estimation; and • Classification and reporting of Mineral Resources. 14.4.2 GEOLOGICAL INTERPRETATION AND DIGITIZING Section Definition The vertical sections were defined by WGM to coincide with the historical Golder vertical sections, which were oriented at 28˚ to the North. The sections had spacing that varied from section to section, from 50 to 100 m. In total, 13 northwest-looking vertical cross sections were defined for the three main zones. Figure 6 shows the drillhole plan and the section locations. – 270 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.4 GEOLOGICAL MODELLING PROCEDURES (continued) 14.4.2 GEOLOGICAL INTERPRETATION AND DIGITIZING (continued) Geological Interpretation The boundaries of the mineralized bodies were re-interpreted on 13 drill sections ranging spatially from 50 to 100 m apart, orientated SW-NE. WGM relied heavily on historical interpretations that served as a guideline for the present work. The orebodies were defined based primarily on an assay cutoff of 15% TFe. Boundaries were drawn halfway between drillholes, and if no holes existed to limit the mineralization outlines, the boundaries were extended to a maximum of 25 m away from the nearest hole. WGM has re-interpreted only those boundary that showed new drillhole and trench information on the particular section. Digitizing Geological Interpretations and Solid/3-D Wireframe Creation The cross sectional interpretations of the mineralization were digitized into a GEMS© polyline workspace. Each polyline was assigned an appropriate rock type and stored with its section definition. Three types of polylines were created, each representing the three orebodies. In total, 13 sections have digitized sectional polylines. Digitized sectional interpretations of geological polylines and drillhole information were analyzed for verification and potential changes. Where necessary, the polylines were modified to better represent the overall mineralization and to provide a base for valid 3-D solid generation. All changes were digitally updated and stored in the GEMS© polyline workspace. The geological polylines digitized on the vertical cross sections were joined using special polylines (tie lines) in order to produce separate 3-D solids/wireframes for each zone, so individual volumes and tonnages could be reported. Six geological wireframes were created, one for Ore Zone I and II and three for Ore Zone II (Figure 7). – 271 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.4 GEOLOGICAL MODELLING PROCEDURES (continued) 14.4.2 GEOLOGICAL INTERPRETATION AND DIGITIZING (continued) Topographic Surface A topographic surface or triangulated irregular network (“TIN”) was created using dxf file provided by Golder. Figure 6. Drillhole and trench plan – 272 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.4 GEOLOGICAL MODELLING PROCEDURES (continued) 14.4.2 GEOLOGICAL INTERPRETATION AND DIGITIZING (continued) Topographic Surface (continued) Figure 7. 3-D Wireframes of the ore zones – 273 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.5 DATABASE PREPARATION, STATISTICAL ANALYSIS AND COMPOSITING 14.5.1 BACK-CODING OF ROCK CODE FIELD The 3-D solids that represented the interpreted mineralized zones were used to back-code a rock code field into the drillhole workspace. Each interval in the assay table was assigned a new rock code value based on the rock type solid that the interval midpoint fell within. The six geological solids were back-coded and considered for the Mineral Resource estimate. 14.5.2 PREPARATION OF ASSAY COMPOSITES In order to carry out the Mineral Resource block modelling, a set of equal length composites of 3 m was generated from the raw drillhole intervals. Table 7 summarizes the statistics of the composites inside the mineralized envelope for all three ore zones. The statistical distributions of TFe for the entire project area, as well as the three ore zones, show normal distributions (Figures 8 to 15). TABLE 7 BASIC STATISTICS OF 6 ft COMPOSITES Sector Number Minimum (% TFe) Maximum (% TFe) Mean (% TFe) C.O.V.* Zone 101 Zone 102 Zone 103 249 312 144 0 0 0 40.87 33.20 35.01 18.32 18.74 17.37 0.391 0.274 0.380 Total 705 0 40.87 18.31 0.341 * Coefficient of variation – 274 – APPENDIX VII MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.6 MINERAL RESOURCE BLOCK MODELLING 14.6.1 GENERAL The Mineral Resources have been estimated using the Inverse Distance Squared (“ID2”) estimation technique. ID2 belongs to a distance-weighted interpolation class of methods, similar to Kriging, where the grade of a block is interpolated from several composites within a defined distance range of that block. Figure 8. Normal Histogram for All Zone composites Normal Hitogram - All Zones 111 Frequency Count 89 67 44 22 0 4.80 9.60 14.40 19.20 24.00 28.80 33.60 38.40 43.20 48.00 % TFe Software By Gemcom Figure 9. Normal Histogram for Zone 101 composites Normal Histogram - Zone 101 33 26 Frequency Count 14. TECHNICAL REPORT 20 13 7 0 4.80 9.60 14.40 19.20 24.00 28.80 % TFe Software By Gemcom – 275 – 33.60 38.40 43.20 48.00 APPENDIX VII MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.6 MINERAL RESOURCE BLOCK MODELLING (continued) 14.6.1 GENERAL (continued) Figure 10. Normal Histogram for Zone 102 composites Normal Histogram - Zone 102 43 Frequency Count 34 26 17 9 0 4.80 9.60 14.40 19.20 24.00 28.80 33.60 38.40 43.20 48.00 % TFe Software By Gemcom Figure 11. Normal Histogram for Zone 103 composites Normal Histogram - Zone 103 28 22 Frequency Count 14. TECHNICAL REPORT 17 11 6 0 4.80 9.60 14.40 19.20 24.00 28.80 % TFe Software By Gemcom – 276 – 33.60 38.40 43.20 48.00 APPENDIX VII MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.6 MINERAL RESOURCE BLOCK MODELLING (continued) 14.6.1 GENERAL (continued) Figure 12. Normal probability plot for All Zone composites Normal Probability Plot - All Zones 100.00 99.74 Probability 91.28 50.00 8.72 0.26 0 4.00 8.00 12.00 16.00 20.00 24.00 28.00 32.00 36.00 40.00 % TFe Software By Gemcom Figure 13. Normal probability plot for Zone 101 composites Normal Probability Plot - Zones 101 100.00 99.74 91.28 Probability 14. TECHNICAL REPORT 50.00 8.72 0.26 0 4.00 8.00 12.00 16.00 20.00 % TFe Software By Gemcom – 277 – 24.00 28.00 32.00 36.00 40.00 APPENDIX VII MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.6 MINERAL RESOURCE BLOCK MODELLING (continued) 14.6.1 GENERAL (continued) Figure 14. Normal probability plot for Zone 102 composites Normal Probability Plot - Zone 102 100.00 99.74 Probability 91.28 50.00 8.72 0.26 0 3.50 7.00 10.50 14.00 17.50 21.00 24.50 28.00 31.50 35.00 % TFe Software By Gemcom Figure 15. Normal probability plot for Zone 103 composites Normal Probability Plot - Zone 103 100.00 99.74 91.28 Probability 14. TECHNICAL REPORT 50.00 8.72 0.26 0 3.50 7.00 10.50 14.00 17.50 % TFe Software By Gemcom – 278 – 21.00 24.50 28.00 31.50 35.00 APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.6 MINERAL RESOURCE BLOCK MODELLING (continued) 14.6.2 BLOCK MODEL GRID PARAMETERS The Mineral Resources have been estimated in a grid of regular blocks. The block model grid covers the three ore zones and is shown in Table 8. The block model is rotated 28˚ clockwise around the origin. TABLE 8 BLOCK MODEL GRID PARAMETERS Model Origin X Y Z Grid 414,500E 4,589,900N 1,600Z Model Dimension Rows Columns Levels Orientation 65 93 40 28˚ clockwise Block Dimension Row width Column width Level height 10 m 10 m 10 m 14.6.3 GRADE INTERPOLATION Inverse Distance Squared All the Existing LRM Mine zones were interpolated using following search parameters. Search ellipsoid: 100 m in the East-West direction 100 m in the North-South direction 100 m in the Vertical direction Minimum number of composites used to estimate a block: 1 Maximum number of composites coming from a single hole: 8 Ellipsoidal search strategy was used with rotation about Z,X,Z — 0˚, 0˚,0˚. 14.6.4 SPECIFIC GRAVITY The specific gravity (“SG”) used to derive tonnes from the block volumes is constant at 3.23. This SG was provided by HKFSS and WGM has accepted this specific gravity as reasonable for this type of mineralization. – 279 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.7 MINERAL RESOURCE CLASSIFICATION AND TABULATION WGM has classified the Existing LRM Mine Mineral Resource estimate as Indicated and Inferred. WGM has lowered the cutoff grade of the TFe from the 17% as stipulated in the China regulations for iron deposits to 15% because of the increased recoverable values in the ore from TiO2 and V2O5. Each unit of TiO2 that is expected to be recovered from one tonne of Existing LRM Mine ore is worth approximately ten times the value of an iron unit and WGM believes that just on the basis of the increased value from the TiO2 alone, that the lower 15% cutoff grade is justified. Table 9 summarizes the Existing LRM Mine Mineral Resources constrained by 3-D wireframes at different cutoff grades. Table 10 reports the resources for each zone at cutoff of 15% TFe and exclude all the blocks that fall below this grade. TABLE 9 EXISTING LRM MINE INDICATED RESOURCES (prepared by WGM at different cutoff grades) % TFe Cutoff 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 Tonnes %TFe %TiO2 %V2O5 17,129,803 16,991,233 16,780,110 16,207,012 14,866,698 13,154,685 11,188,171 19.17 19.22 19.30 19.46 19.82 20.25 20.72 3.80 3.81 3.83 3.86 3.92 4.00 4.09 0.03 0.03 0.03 0.04 0.03 0.03 0.03 TABLE 10 EXISTING LRM MINE INDICATED AND INFERRED MINERAL RESOURCES (prepared by WGM using a 15% TFe cutoff grade) Tonnes %TFe %TiO2 %V2O5 6,821,539 7,326,882 2,058,591 20.13 19.34 17.68 4.03 3.84 3.40 0.04 0.03 0.03 16,207,012 19.46 3.86 0.03 Zone 103 259,689 17.69 3.25 0.02 Total Inferred 259,689 17.69 3.25 0.02 Zone Zone 101 Zone 102 Zone 103 Total Indicated The representation of the block model on the vertical sections and the level plans is plotted in Figure 16. – 280 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.8 SINOREX MINERAL RESOURCE ESTIMATE The following outlines the methodology of the SINOREX Mineral Resource estimate at Existing LRM Mine. Although the computer block modelling approach to estimate the Mineral Resource/Mineral Reserves (“MR/MR”) figures is being implemented in China’s geological exploration sector the traditional “geometrical method” for the estimation of the Mineral Resources at Existing LRM Mine was used. Figure 16. Block model — section line 15 The “geometrical method” is based on a sectional method where the average area of a mineral body measured on two vertical cross sections, both at right angles to the strike of the mineral body (m12+m22)/2 when multiplied by the distance (m) between the sections gives a volume (m3), that when multiplied by the average SG of the body gives the tonnage between the two cross sections. A weighted average of the assayed metal values of all the samples (drillholes and trenches) along the two sections gives the average metal values of the tonnage block. According to the “Standards of Geological Exploration of Iron, Manganese and Chrome Mines”, the Mineral Resources are divided into three categories: category (331) based on data at 50 m spacing; category (332) based on data at 100 m spacing; and, category (333) data extrapolated laterally 12.5 m (a maximum of one quarter of the 50 x 50 m drillhole grid. If the length of the orebody has been defined, the maximum depth projection permitted is one quarter of the orebody’s defined length. These three categories approximate the CIM Mineral Resource categories of Measured (331), Indicated (332) and Inferred (333), however, WGM reports the following Mineral Resources for historical purposes only and because they are relevant, but has not attempted to rationalize them to conform with the guidelines published by the CIM standards. The author checked the methodology used for these Mineral Resources and has no reason to dispute them. Total Mineral Resource 29,513,786 tonnes @ 19.64% TFe and 3.53% TiO2 distributed in the categories for each mineral body (Table 11). – 281 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.8 SINOREX MINERAL RESOURCE ESTIMATE (continued) TABLE 11 SINOREX RESOURCE ESTIMATES No. of Body I II III IV VI Category Tonnes 331 331 331 331 331 Total I II III IV VI 332 332 332 332 332 Total I II III IV V VI VII 333 333 333 333 333 333 333 Total – 282 – Average Grade (TFe %) (TiO2 %) 4,043,353 6,163,677 922,575 116,971 633,736 19.11 19.43 19.25 19.55 19.21 4.06 3.63 3.84 2.89 3.49 11,880,312 19.30 3.78 1,427,289 1,916,365 69,229 436,476 489,603 20.56 19.45 21.00 17.81 19.74 3.39 4.03 4.50 3.31 2.80 4,338,962 19.71 3.62 1,947,635 2,102,517 1,415,438 3,506,549 653,807 1,913,158 1,755,408 19.94 19.61 18.99 22.04 18.30 19.20 18.17 3.36 3.30 3.40 3.43 2.73 3.21 3.12 13,294,512 19.64 3.53 APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.9 ENFI MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES 14.9.1 RESOURCES The following represents a summary of the process and criteria used by ENFI for the feasibility study to determine the Mineral Resource/Mineral Reserve estimates at Xiao Hong Shan (Little Red Mountain) Fe-Ti-V deposit. Resource Definition The database comprised 26 diamond drillholes and 36 trenches. Sample data from trenches were used in a similar manner to drillhole data with samples typically 11.5 m in length. A 3D grade block model was developed using Datamine, an accepted mineral industry software that is used world-wide. The model consists of blocks 12 m x 12 m 12 m. Grade interpolation utilized inverse distance squared methodology. Search ellipsoid dimensions were varied to establish different resource classifications: • Measured: 100 m (strike) x 50 m (perpendicular to strike) x 60 m (dip); • Indicated: 200 m (strike) x 100 m (perpendicular to strike) x 120 m (dip); and • Inferred: beyond Indicated. Specific gravity used for determining Ore tonnage is 3.23 t/m3; and for Waste 2.8 t/m3. Table 12 summarizes the defined Mineral Resources which form the basis for the Mineral Reserve estimate. TABLE 12 MINERAL RESOURCE SUMMARY Classification Millions Tonnes Total %Fe %TiO2 Measured Indicated 14.39 4.39 19.45 19.41 3.89 3.82 Measured and Indicated 18.78 19.44 3.87 Inferred 11.68 19.75 3.21 – 283 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.9 ENFI MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.9.1 RESOURCES Mineral Resource Potential Current resources are defined within a limited area of 0.7 km2. WGM believes that there is an excellent probability that additional diamond drilling may expand resources potentially to the east and southwest of the present known mineral resource. In addition, there is reasonable potential to the east of the current resources as defined by broad magnetic anomaly. WGM agrees with the conclusions by ENFI that additional drilling is required immediately to increase the Mineral Resource/Reserve to produce a viable and profitable operation. It is understood that additional drilling to the east and southwest of the present known mineral resource was started at the beginning of August. Mineral Resource Issues Sample Representation Trench sampling has been used extensively to define the upper portions of the mineralized zones. Trench samples and assays are treated essentially as horizontal drillholes, thereby providing significant grade weighting to the upper portions of the block model given the 60 m vertical component of the search ellipsoid. WGM is not aware of any analysis that indicates that chip samples have the same degree of sample representation as cored drillhole samples. However the average of all the assay results of the 3 m composites used in the WGM Mineral Resource estimate (starting 2 m below the surface) is 18.42% Fe @ a 15% Fe cutoff grade, similarly the average for the trenches is 18.22% Fe also at a 15% Fe cutoff grade. Mineral Resource Comparison The WGM Indicated Mineral Resource estimate at 16.2 million tonnes @ 19.46% Fe and 3.86% TiO2 compares favourable with ENFI Measured and Indicated Mineral Resources of 18.78 million tonnes at 19.44% Fe and 3.87% TiO2. WGM mineral resources were estimated only for Zones I, II, and III. SINOREX estimated 1.7 Mt for Zones IV and V in classifications 331 and 332, equivalent to Measured and Indicated categories. – 284 – APPENDIX VII 14. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.9 ENFI MINERAL RESOURCE AND MINERAL RESERVE ESTIMATES (continued) 14.9.2 MINERAL RESERVES Mineral Reserve Basis ENFI developed the Mineral Reserves for the project using pit optimization software in Datamine. Optimization is based on Measured, Indicated and Inferred Mineral Resources from the grade block model plus assumptions concerning product recovery, price, operating costs, pit slope, dilution and mining losses. Mineral Reserves reflect a final design pit that incorporates a haul road. Costs used for pit optimization comprise operating costs required for concentrate production and include mine and ore dressing cost centres. Revenue for the pit optimization process is limited to the value of concentrates produced. Value derived from downstream product upgrading is not included. WGM agree with this approach. Mineral Reserves Mine recoverable Mineral Reserves contained within the designed open pit total 12.0 million tonnes @ 19.5% Fe and 4.2% TiO2. 15. EXPLORATION POTENTIAL 15.1 MINERAL RESOURCE POTENTIAL The Chinese category 333 allows the mineral resource estimate to be projected downwards one quarter the length of the orebody, however, much of this tonnage is not included in the WGM block model estimate. Nonetheless WGM believes there is an excellent probability with future exploration (diamond drilling) that these additional Chinese mineral resources will be confirmed. The proposed initial diamond drilling program was reviewed and prioritized by WGM. Drilling began in early August with two rigs on the south side of the present design pit and a third rig arrived on August 8, 2007 to begin drilling the untested magnetic anomalies to the east of the pit within the 2 km2 area. – 285 – APPENDIX VII 15. TECHNICAL REPORT EXPLORATION POTENTIAL (continued) 15.2 MINERAL RESERVE POTENTIAL WGM believe that ENFI have taken a conservative approach with respect to pit optimization parameters. Potential exists to increase mineable reserves through changes to optimization parameters including decreasing operating costs and increasing concentrate revenue. Depreciation charges should be removed from Management cost centre since depreciation is an Indirect cost and only direct costs should be used in pit optimization. Concentrate transportation and community costs should be added as these are costs directly related to production and delivery of concentrate to the downstream metallurgical plants. The net effect should be lower operating costs. ENFI has used significantly lower prices for concentrates as compared with the market prices from the last 6 to 18 months (per details provided by HKFS). Recent prices would generate 36% to 59% higher concentrate revenue than ENFI prices (Table 13). TABLE 13 PRICE RMB/t Concentrate ENFI 18 mo. avg 12 mo. avg Fe TiO2 P2O 5 480 700 280 690 915 318 725 997 327 6 mo. avg 790 1,155 325 In addition, the base value of Fe concentrate produced could be increased by including credit for contained TiO2. WGM suggests that the net effect of higher block values, resulting from improvements to concentrate value, plus reduced production costs should result in expansion of the pit and subsequent increase in mineable reserves. Additional Mineral Reserves could also result from expansion of the current Mineral Resource base following additional diamond drilling below and lateral to the current defined Mineral Resource/Reserve; and testing of the extensive magnetic anomalies on the property. – 286 – APPENDIX VII 15. TECHNICAL REPORT EXPLORATION POTENTIAL (continued) 15.2 MINERAL RESERVE POTENTIAL (continued) An illustration of the potential to increased Mineral Reserves/Resources in the immediate mine area is presented in Figure 17. Figure 17. Design pit overlain onto magnetic contour map Designed Pit Potential resource area defined by magnetic contours Potential resource and pit expansion Reserve Sensitivity Analysis ENFI recently conducted a sensitivity analysis on the effect of increasing market price on mineable reserve. Results suggest that a 20% increase in price, from that used in pit optimization, increases mineable reserves by 29% to 15.5 Mt. A 44% increase in price increases mineable reserves by 35% to 16.2 Mt. WGM recommends that pit optimization be performed following revision to the block model based on new drilling results. The process should incorporate revisions to costs and prices to better reflect the proposed operation and market conditions. – 287 – APPENDIX VII 16. TECHNICAL REPORT ADJACENT PROPERTIES There are no adjacent properties to the 15.47 km2 Existing LRM Mine concession. The Existing LRM Mine deposit was discovered and the initial exploration and geological mapping was carried out by local government geologists and at present is the only exploration concession in the area. However, the property shows evidence of former illegal mining from shallow pits where an estimated few hundred tonnes of titaniferous magnetite have been removed. 17. INTRODUCTION AND DESIGN ASSUMPTIONS The proposed project is based on establishment of stand-alone northern operations including a 2.6 Mt/a Open Pit Mine and Ore Dressing Plant at Xiao Hong Shan (Little Red Mountain). Key support infrastructure required for the operation includes shops and personnel accommodation facilities. Development of a single infrastructure corridor between the northern and southern operation, is to include a new Road and Power and Water supply. Infrastructure planning has been on the basis of achieving potential ultimate capacity of 5.0 Mt/a mining and concentrating. Preliminary metallurgical planning has been on the basis of achieving increased resources and reserves to support a 2.6 Mt/a mining and concentrating operation. Preliminary ore dressing flow sheet (per HKFS Business Plan) comprises: • Crushing and Grinding; • Weak Magnetic separation producing Iron Concentrate @ 56-57% Fe (contains 5% TiO2); • Strong Magnetic separation followed by Flotation producing: — Phosphate Concentrate @ 28-35% P2O5; and — Titanium Concentrate @ 43-48% TiO2. Annual Concentrate production forecast is based on 2.6 Mt/a ore mined and processed. Concentrate yield figures used by ENFI in their pit optimization assumptions are lower than those based on the metallurgical tests conducted by Changsha Research Institute Mining and Metallurgy in October 2006. Revised figures reflecting the proposed final flowsheet are expected following completion of recent testwork. – 288 – APPENDIX VII 17. TECHNICAL REPORT INTRODUCTION AND DESIGN ASSUMPTIONS (continued) Table 14 presents concentrate forecast basis per Changsha Research: TABLE 14 CONCENTRATE FORECAST BASIS Process Product Yield Magnetic Separation Flotation Flotation Iron Concentrate Titanium Concentrate Phosphorus Concentrate 12.6% 6.0% 4.8% Concentrate will be trucked approximately 150 km to the new metallurgical complex at Qing Shan (Yumen). Downstream metallurgical plants will be constructed to produce upgraded and increased value products including Direct Reduced Iron products (including high grade iron powder and associated titanium oxide and vanadium oxide) and Direct Reduced Titanium products (including high grade titanium oxide and iron concentrate), Figure 18. Figure 18. Planned product line Ore Iron Concentrate (56-57%) Phosphate Concentrate (28-35%) Titanium Concentrate (43-48%) Direct Reduction of Titanium Pellet Direct Reduction of Iron Direct Reduced Iron (TFe ≥ 90%) V2O5 (99%) Iron Concentrate (TFe ≥ 56%) Iron Oxide Red (Fe2O2) TiO2 (≥ 36%) High-end Direct Reduced Iron Powder (TFe ≥ 98%) – 289 – High grade Titanium Oxide (90%) APPENDIX VII 18. TECHNICAL REPORT MINING ASSESSMENT 18.1 INTRODUCTION AND MINE DESCRIPTION Mining Method Open pit mining has been selected on the basis of proximity to surface of the orebodies and their relatively simplicity. Open pit mining would utilize readily available equipment and operations would follow a standard drill, blast, load and haul methodology. Ore would be delivered to primary crushers (average 2 km one-way haul) and waste rock would be hauled to waste dumps (1.5 km average one-way haul). Pre-production stripping is estimated at 1.5 years to properly develop the mine for production. Mine Equipment The following equipment has been selected by ENFI based on the mineable reserve and proposed annual production rate. Equipment choice reflects typical mining equipment that should be readily available in China: • 6 — Drills: 15 — 20 cm diameter down-the-hole (DTH) drills with air compressors; • 6 — Shovels: 4 m3 electric shovels, or 6m3 hydraulic shovels; • 32 — Trucks 25 t capacity; or • 25 — Trucks 32 t capacity (preferred). Equipment productivity calculations were not available for WGM to confirm projected equipment numbers. Production Rate Target is 2.6 Mt/a ore; maximum annual total material mined is 7.8 million tonnes (ENFI). Average annual total material movement is likely in the range of 5 to 6 Mt/a. Explosives Powder factor is estimated at 0.5 kg/t resulting in maximum annual explosives (ANFO — ammonium nitrate fuel oil) consumption of 1,950 tonnes/a; and maximum blasting cap consumption @ 140,000/a. – 290 – APPENDIX VII 18. TECHNICAL REPORT MINING ASSESSMENT (continued) 18.1 INTRODUCTION AND MINE DESCRIPTION (continued) Mine Life On the basis of current mineable reserves totalling 12 Mt, mine life at 2.6 Mt/a is 5 years. However, the potential for increasing mineable reserves, and mine life, through revised pit optimization and additional drilling is considered by WGM to be highly probable. As noted in section 15.2, a recent pit optimization sensitivity analysis performed by ENFI indicates that an increase in reserves of 35% to 16.2 Mt is possible by applying concentrate prices that better reflect recent market prices. The current 2007 drilling program is expected to increase Mineral Resources and Mineral Reserves by upgrading resource classification and extending known mineralized zones. Mining Issue A larger pit/reserve will likely be required to support positive economics for a 2.6 Mt/a ore dressing plant and related downstream metallurgical plants. As the pit is expanded to incorporate a larger resource it will likely increase the stripping ratio and ultimately result in increased daily mine production rate. If the mining rate is increased significantly it will be necessary to review the mining equipment selection and potentially increase equipment size and unit productivity to meet the higher demands of the operation. 18.2 MINE DESIGN Pit Optimization An optimized pit was developed by ENFI using NPV (net present value) software in Datamine followed by practical design to incorporate a final haul road. Pit optimization process followed standard industry protocol utilizing Measured and Indicated Resources only. The 2007 drilling program could result in reclassification of some Inferred Resources to a higher category and subsequently increase pit recoverable resources. The revenue component of the block model was based on concentrate equivalent value assuming three concentrates: iron, titanium and phosphorus. Concentrate yields used by ENFI are lower than yields suggested from Changsha Institute testwork; ENFI prices used for concentrate value are lower than recent market prices. – 291 – APPENDIX VII 18. TECHNICAL REPORT MINING ASSESSMENT (continued) 18.2 MINE DESIGN (continued) Pit Optimization (continued) Concentrate product prices used for pit optimization are: • 55% Fe conc. — RMB480/t conc.; • 47% TiO2 conc — RMB700/t conc.; and • 28% P2O5 conc — RMB280/t conc. Operating costs used for ENFI pit optimization were: • Mining — RMB6.5/tonne mined; • Ore Dressing — RMB40.0/tonne; • Management — RMB32.0/tonne; and • Resource Tax — RMB5.6/tonne To allow for time value of money a Discount Rate of 8% was applied. For the purposes of the pit optimization process, Pit Slope angles were set at 47 degrees. Overall the pit optimization criteria are considered to be reasonable, if not conservative, and provide opportunity for potential pit expansion. Final Pit Design Basis Following the pit optimization process it is standard procedure to incorporate detailed parameters that reflect the proposed mining equipment, and physical conditions. The following criteria were used to establish the final pit design: • Bench height 12 m; • Bench face angle 60 degrees; • Final pit slope 47 degrees; • Haul road gradient 8%; • Haul road width 12 m; and • Dilution 3%; and Mining losses 3%. Design criteria are considered to be reasonable based on information provided for this review. – 292 – APPENDIX VII 18. TECHNICAL REPORT MINING ASSESSMENT (continued) 18.2 MINE DESIGN (continued) Design Issue Geological plans indicate the north wall of the pit is located in metamorphic sandstone and that a major east-west fault passes through the north wall of the pit (Figure 19). Surface exposure of the fault indicates that it is a sub-vertical feature that dips northward into the pit wall. Geotechnical review of potential wall rock conditions is recommended. 18.3 FINAL PIT The final design results in an open pit with an overall length of 760 m; maximum width of 320 m; and maximum depth of 144 m. Pit dimensions are considered by WGM to be reasonable and should support the scale of production proposed. Figure 19 presents the final pit design according to the parameters used. N Fault Figure 19. Pit design – 293 – APPENDIX VII 18. TECHNICAL REPORT MINING ASSESSMENT (continued) 18.3 FINAL PIT (continued) Pit Reserves Mineral Reserves are 12.0 million tonnes averaging 19.5% Fe and 4.2% TiO 2. The designed pit contains waste rock totalling 20.2 million tonnes for an average stripping ratio of 1.68. Ore grades for the final pit reserves are slightly higher in the upper benches of the pit averaging 20% Fe and 4.8% TiO2. Average bench grades decline with depth in the pit to 18.5% Fe and 3.3% TiO2. Details of Mineral Reserves and stripping by bench are provided in Table 15. TABLE 15 MINERAL RESERVES AND STRIPPING RESULTS Bench 1566 1554 1542 1530 1518 1506 1494 1482 1470 1458 1446 1434 1422 1410 1398 Ore kt TFe% TiO2% 2 123 941 1,477 1,647 1,612 1,525 1,410 1,199 926 628 315 139 79 20.2 20.2 19.8 20.2 20.2 19.7 19.2 19.0 18.8 18.8 19.0 18.8 18.4 17.9 TOTAL 12,023 19.5 – 294 – Strip Ratio 5.4 5.2 4.7 4.7 4.6 4.4 4.3 4.1 3.7 3.5 3.4 3.3 3.2 3.2 Waste kt 80 239 1,527 1,863 3,580 3,266 2,872 2,227 1,661 1,184 834 545 222 48 16 4.2 20,164 1.7 132.0 12.4 2.0 2.4 2.0 1.8 1.5 1.2 1.0 0.9 0.9 0.7 0.3 0.2 APPENDIX VII 18. TECHNICAL REPORT MINING ASSESSMENT (continued) 18.4 MINE PRODUCTION The plan is to prepare the pit for production with a pre-production stripping period of 1.5 years. First year production is scheduled at 1.5 Mt ore. Subsequent annual ore production is targeted at 2.6 Mt per year. Maximum material mined in a year is estimated to total 7.8 Mt (per ENFI). No details of annual production rates were provided for this technical review. However, WGM does not see any impediment to achievement of planned annual ore production rates as the waste stripping ratio declines as haulage distances and truck cycle times increase with depth. 19. MINERAL PROCESSING AND METALLURGICAL TESTING 19.1 INITIAL BENCH SCALE TESTS Initial bench scale metallurgical processing was carried out on the Existing LRM Mine ores by the Technological Department of the Mineral Processing Plan at the Panzihua Iron and Steel (Group) Company, an operating mining company, to determine the feasibility of producing various commercial products and to determine the relative processing methods prior to pilot plant tests. Initial testwork was done on individual mineralized zones: I, II and III. Samples were composited from both diamond drillhole and trench material to achieve expected grades as follows: # DDH’s # Trenches DDH-kg DDH-% Fe Trench-kg Trench-% Fe Total Sample-kg Average % Fe Zone I Zone II Zone III 3 3 91.5 21.1 91.5 20.6 183.0 20.9 3 3 36.0 20.6 36.0 21.0 72.0 20.8 3 3 22.5 21.0 22.5 20.5 45.0 20.8 Total sample available for Bench scale testwork: 300 kg at average grade of 20.9% Fe. Two samples were crushed and ground to -20 mm size as required for the tests. Assay results of the two samples showed that 33.99% Fe and 8.87% of the TiO2 were liberated and distributed in the following grain sizes 5.98% in the +12 mm grain size; 64.75% in the +3 mm grain size; 25.42% in the 0.074 mm grain size and 4.75% in the <0.074 mm grain size. It was concluded that the two samples were representative of the overall average grade of the ore and when compared with other operating mines in China, it was concluded that the Existing LRM Mine ores were “well worthy of exploitation” from the mineral dressing point of view. – 295 – APPENDIX VII 19. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL PROCESSING AND METALLURGICAL TESTING (continued) 19.1 INITIAL BENCH SCALE TESTS (continued) Various tests were carried out to determine the grain size composition, distribution and uniformity of the various mineral components to determine the milling liberation limits (to eliminate middling fractions) to obtain the best recovery rate and to maximize the economic benefits of the mineral processing. Several comparisons of the products were made with other operating mines for the degree of liberation at various grind sizes. The tests showed that the Existing LRM Mine samples were easy to grind and to liberate the various chemical components, i.e., TFe, TiO2, V2O5, MnO, SiO2, Al2O3 and CaO. The testing concluded that after processing: • The concentrate grades of Fe and TiO2 of the Existing LRM Mine ore at -200 mesh were 33.99% and 8.87% respectively and that the grindability of the ore was better when compared to the Panzihua mine; • When the ore is ground to 90.87% -200 mesh (in one stage grinding) the Fe concentrate is 54.86% and the TiO2 grade is 9.89%; • After two stage grinding (discarding of the coarse fraction) when the -200 mesh attains 88.67% the total iron TFe grade is 55.0% and the TiO2 grade about 10% at an iron recovery rate of 65.25%; • The Existing LRM Mine ore, when compared to the Panzihua mine’s ores, iron concentrate has a better grindability but requires a higher percentage of -200 mesh and more grinding time but with the dressed iron concentrate containing a higher content of Fe, S and SiO2 and a lower content of vanadium and titanium; • In the magnetic processing of the tailings, the Fe grade is 6.44% higher than that of Panzihua but lower in SiO2, Al2O3, S and Cu; and • The titanium processing test was only carried using a shaking table and the titanium concentrate was only 26.28%. It was recommended that although the single and two stage grinding produced an iron concentrate of about 55% Fe it was recommended that two stage grinding be carried out because of the small grain size required to liberate the minerals and the requirement of 90% -200 mesh together with the regrinding and reprocessing of the coarse grain concentrate. It was also recommended that a scavenging process of the tailings be considered to increase the recovery rate. – 296 – APPENDIX VII 19. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL PROCESSING AND METALLURGICAL TESTING (continued) 19.2 PILOT PLANT SCALE DRESSING TEST A Pilot Plant test was conducted on two composited ore samples of the Existing LRM Mine ores by Changsha Research Institute of Mining and Metallurgy. Continuous process testing was performed using samples composited from diamond drillholes, trenches and pits. Material was sourced only from Zones I, II and III which are considered to be the principal ore zones. Testwork is complete and an interim report is expected end of July 2007. Final mixed samples for metallurgical testing (per ENFI) have following average grades: NMD (average ore) : NML (high grade) : 22.1% Fe, 5.6% TiO2 27.6% Fe, 7.3% TiO2 19.3 BULK SAMPLES Two main bulk samples were prepared prior to Pilot Plant testwork to reflect expected mineralization: 1) average grade, and 2) high grade. Individual ore zones were composited separately within each sample. Material for compositing of the bulk sample was sourced primarily from surface trenches and pits and is detailed in the following table (compiled from HKFSS data): Composite Description NMD Average Grade NML High Grade Trench Sample kg % Fe % TiO2 23,570 19.9 6.5 7,170 26.8 8.1 Pit Sample kg % Fe % TiO2 1,000 27.0 8.7 9,200 31.5 9.6 kg % Fe % TiO2 24,570 20.2 6.6 16,400 29.4 8.9 Total Bulk Sample – 297 – APPENDIX VII 19. TECHNICAL REPORT MINERAL PROCESSING AND METALLURGICAL TESTING (continued) 19.4 ADDITIONAL SAMPLES A total of 15 diamond drillholes provided 6,128 kg of assay reject material with an average grade of 16.2% Fe, a lower grade than the deposit average. Apparently all the higher grade samples had been used in previous testing (per HKFSS) as earlier thinking was that the upper 30 m of the deposit was higher grade material, roughly 30% Fe. Support for this concept possibly came from a 36m long hole drilled in November 2004 that averaged 31.6% Fe and 9.0% TiO2. However, as the hole was drilled vertically, it is entirely possible that it followed a higher grade band within the mineralized zone and therefore may not be representative of the entire upper portion of the zone. In addition, there was available a number of samples from 10 trenches that provided 1,936 kg of material at an average grade of 16.7% Fe. The following list summarizes the additional material available for compositing: 15 DDH kg % Fe 6,128 16.2 10 Trenches kg % Fe 1,936 16.7 Composites were prepared under the direction of the Mineral Institute. Actual details of the composites have not been received but are expected to be included in the interim report expected upon completion of the testwork end of July 2007. The high grade NML sample is apparently used only as a ‘reference’ during testing. Principal flowsheet development is based only on the NMD sample. – 298 – APPENDIX VII MINERAL PROCESSING AND METALLURGICAL TESTING (continued) 19.5 GRADE DISTRIBUTION OF BULK SAMPLE MATERIAL (FROM HKFSS DATA) Figure 20 present distribution of grade and weight for various samples. The first graph, Trench and Pit samples, shows a skewed distribution to higher grades. Figure 20. Distribution of grade and weight WEIGHT CONTRIBUTION LITTLE RED MOUNTAIN IRON GRADE DISTRIBUTION FROM TRENCHES & PITS - PRIMARY BASIS for NMD BULK SAMPLE 60% Average Grade 20.2% TFe 50% Total Sample Weight 24.57 t 40% 30% 20% 10% 0% < 9% 9 - 11% 11 - 13% 13 - 15% 15 - 17% 17 - 20% 20 - 25% 25 - 30% > 20% TOTAL IRON GRADE WEIGHT CONTRIBUTION LITTLE RED MOUNTAIN IRON GRADE DISTRIBUTION FROM 15 DDH - Samples Available for NMD BULK SAMPLE (Note: high grade samples removed) 30% Total Sample Weight 6135 kg Average Grade 16.1% TFe 25% 20% 15% 10% 5% 0% < 9% 9 - 11% 11 - 13% 13 - 15% 15 - 17% 17 - 20% 20 - 25% 25 - 30% > 20% TOTAL IRON GRADE LITTLE RED MOUNTAIN IRON GRADE DISTRIBUTION FROM 15 DDH - Samples Available for NMD BULK SAMPLE (Note: high grade samples removed) WEIGHT CONTRIBUTION 19. TECHNICAL REPORT 30% Total Sample Weight 6135 kg Average Grade 16.1% TFe 25% 20% 15% 10% 5% 0% < 9% 9 - 11% 11 - 13% 13 - 15% 15 - 17% 17 - 20% 20 - 25% 25 - 30% TOTAL IRON GRADE – 299 – > 20% APPENDIX VII 20. TECHNICAL REPORT INFRASTRUCTURE 20.1 INFRASTRUCTURE ISSUES Infrastructure planning has been on the basis of achieving potential capacity of 5.0 Mt/a mining and concentrating. Key infrastructure components that would be impacted by a change in production level are Water and Power supply. Potential capital cost reduction may be realized if infrastructure is sized only for the proposed 2.6 Mt/a operation. Provision of Land and infrastructure rebate is contingent on commitment to development of metallurgical plant(s) near Yumen. 20.2 ROADS Access to both the northern and southern operations will require construction of 150 km of roads. Design is planned for 50 t (concentrate haul) trucks. Initial width will be 8 m. Construction materials will be primarily granite that will be quarried and crushed near Yumen and the mine site. 20.3 POWER A 140 km power line, possibly 110 kV or 220 kV, will be constructed to the northern operations. An additional 30 km line is required for the southern metallurgical complex. Two transformer stations will be required. Power will be drawn from the main grid and is expected to cost RMB0.28/kWh with a maximum of RMB0.40/kWh. 20.4 WATER A 160 km, 30 cm water pipeline will be constructed from the Chijinxia Reservoir (20 km from Yumen) to service the northern operations. A total of 4 pumping stations will be required due to the rolling terrain that must be traversed. The Chijinxia Reservoir will also provide water for the metallurgical plants at Quingshan. It is estimated that 80-85% of the process water will be recycled. Water will be required for process water make-up, drilling, road watering, sewage and potable water consumption. – 300 – APPENDIX VII 20. TECHNICAL REPORT INFRASTRUCTURE (continued) 20.5 LAND Initial estimate is that approximately 1,000 acres (Chinese mu) of land are required. Ultimately the project will require 2,000 acres. Land cost (purchased from the government) is estimated to be RMB80 million. Approximately 90% of the cost is expected to be returned to support development of Infrastructure. 20.6 MINE SITE LAYOUT No site layout design has yet been prepared for location of ore dressing plant, support facilities, tailings pond, or waste rock dump. 20.7 METALLURGICAL PLANT SITE No site layout design has yet been developed. 21. ENVIRONMENTAL ASSESSMENT (REF. ENFI) All proposed project sites have been visited and data collected by ENFI Environmental personnel. Data is incomplete but sites are deemed to have minimal issues. One Asian archaeological site was identified; operations are required to stay 500m away. Little Red Mountain is located within the Asian Biological Zone and Military Zone. Permission to proceed has already been granted from appropriate government agencies. Apparently the Government has no specific regulations for the Xiao Hong Shan site. Project development plan is to engage an environmental consultant to manage the environmental assessment process including identification of potential pollutants and proposed treatment; the environmental impact analysis; and overall supervision of the process. Four levels of government will be involved in the approval process. Specific plans for the mine site are to provide relocation compensation to the solitary “herdsman” in the area and to minimize project impacts such as animal entry into mining area and water flow. There are no concerns for the Road, Power and Pipeline corridor. The Government is to provide the route; the pipeline is buried; and the issues are minimal. – 301 – APPENDIX VII 22. TECHNICAL REPORT CAPITAL COST SUMMARY Capital costs for this review were initially only from the HKFS Business Plan (May 2007). ENFI intend to develop feasibility level costs once final metallurgical testing is completed. Cost estimates for Direct Reduction of Iron and Titanium Concentrates were recently received from Central South University (Changsha) following completion of bench scale testing of iron pellet reduction. These cost estimates have been incorporated into the technical assessment. 22.1 PRE-CONSTRUCTION Pre-construction costs are estimated at RMB61 million for drilling, surveys, metallurgical testing, feasibility study, environmental report, administration and management fees. Costs appear reasonable although the extent of drilling required to increase resource/ reserves to target levels may be significantly higher. 22.2 INFRASTRUCTURE Capital cost estimate for Infrastructure is based on supporting ultimate production rate of 5.0 Mt/a concentrate. Detailed costs were developed based on experience and standard cost basis. Road construction is estimated at RMB162 million and includes allowance for 10 cm asphalt which could possibly be eliminated for significant cost saving (30-50%). Power supply cost is estimated at RMB154.5 million. Water supply, principally pipeline and pumping stations, is estimated at RMB114.5 million. Communications are estimated at RMB8.5 million. Community and Amenities cost is estimated at RMB35.6 million (reduced from published number following review that identified double-count). Land cost is estimated at RMB80 million (purchase from government). The company expects to receive 90% rebate from the Government for infrastructure development. 22.3 MINING Capital cost estimate for Mining for the 5.0 Mt/a scenario is RMB250 million and is based on known equipment costs plus government-established target costs for preproduction stripping (per HKFS). No details were available for WGM’s review of the costs allocated for mine equipment and mine development. – 302 – APPENDIX VII 22. TECHNICAL REPORT CAPITAL COST SUMMARY (continued) 22.3 MINING (continued) WGM estimate that approximately 1.5 million tonnes of waste should be mined in the pre-production phase to ensure adequate ore is available for start-up and possible blending. Pioneering costs can be two to three times normal (RMB6.5/t mined per ENFI) production costs due to uneven terrain, poor access, and resulting low equipment productivities. Mine development costs would be in the range of RMB13 to 20 per tonne mined or approximately RMB20 million. It is assumed that mine development costs are independent of the planned production rate. The cost of the required mining fleet and support equipment for the 2.6 Mt/a scenario is estimated as RMB138 million or 60% of the cost of the equipment fleet required for the 5.0 Mt/a operation (basis: 20% fixed; 80% variable). 22.4 ORE DRESSING PLANT Capital cost estimate for the Ore Dressing Plant is considered to be at a Scoping Study basis (i.e., Ó35%) with costs developed from similar operations, experience, and manuals. The HKFS Business Plan estimates RMB400 million total cost for a 5.0 Mt/a plant. WGM and HKFS agree that some factors of scale be applied to estimate the cost of a 2.6 Mt/a plant as capital costs are not directly proportional to production rate. Using a factor of 0.6 (basis: 20% fixed; 80% variable) the cost of a 2.6 Mt/a ore dressing plant would be RMB240 million. 22.5 METALLURGICAL PLANTS For the purpose of this technical assessment HKFS have suggested that the cost estimate include metallurgical plants only for the production of Direct Reduced Iron and Direct Reduced Titanium. Details supporting the preliminary cost estimate for both direct reduction plants were prepared by Central South University. The estimates include allowances for equipment and facilities; construction; design and installation; plus contingency. Land costs estimated by Changsha are excluded as land cost is estimated separately. Estimated capital cost for a 260,000 tonne annual capacity Iron Concentrate processing plant is RMB174 million. Estimated capital cost for a 130,000 tonne annual capacity Titanium Concentrate processing plant is RMB90 million. – 303 – APPENDIX VII 22. TECHNICAL REPORT CAPITAL COST SUMMARY (continued) 22.6 TOTAL PROJECT CAPITAL Estimated Project capital costs are a combination of factored costs from the HKFS Business Plan as well as preliminary capital cost estimate for metallurgical plants provided by Central South University. Total capital cost for the 2.6 Mt/a mine, ore dressing and DRI plants scenario is estimated to be RMB1.13 billion. Estimated costs are distributed among three principle areas: Infrastructure (36%), northern Primary Operations (35%), and southern Metallurgical Complex (23%). Cost detail was not available for several significant cost components for this technical review at this stage. Therefore the reasonableness of the cost estimate and adjustment factors cannot be assured. These costs, however, can be considered indicative of the magnitude required to develop this project. Finalization of process and metallurgical flowsheets are required prior to development of final feasibility cost estimates by ENFI (Table 16). TABLE 16 CAPITAL COST ESTIMATE Capital Expenditure Production Rate Business Plan Adjust Factor RMB M Mt/a — Ore Mining 0.52 2.6 61 1.0 61 5% Roads Power Water Communications Community Land Subtotal 162 154 114 9 83 0 522 0.60 0.90 0.90 1.00 0.66 0.79 97 139 103 9 55 8 410 9% 12% 9% 1% 5% 1% 36% Equipment Pre-production strip Subtotal 230 20 250 0.60 1.00 0.63 138 20 158 12% 2% 14% 400 1,233 0.60 0.70 240 869 21% 77% 174 90 264 15% 8% 23% 1,133 100% Ore Dressing Plant Total HKFS Input Metallurgical Plants % of total 5.0 Pre-Development Expenses Infrastructure Forecast RMB M Iron DRI Titanium DRI Total Changsha Input TOTAL INITIAL PROJECT CAPEX – 304 – APPENDIX VII 23. TECHNICAL REPORT OPERATING COSTS Sources of operating costs available for this technical review include: 1. 2. 3. HKFS Business Plan (May 2007). ENFI. Central South University. HKFS Business Plan developed operating cost estimates for each business unit based on fairly standard cost breakdown: wages and benefits, consumables, repair and maintenance, management and administration. Separate cost centres for transportation of supplies and end products are provided. Unit costs developed through this process were verified for Mining and Ore Dressing and found to be reasonable and comparable to preliminary costs used by ENFI in the pit optimization process. All costs presented by HKFS are of a preliminary or scoping study basis and developed largely from research and comparison to similar operations. The costs presented by ENFI are also of a preliminary basis although potentially founded on the technical bases of the project. 23.1 MINING HKFS Business Plan presents a Mining cost of RMB15.5 per tonne ore. Considering this cost includes waste mining as well as ore, and assuming the average stripping ratio from ENFI pit optimization, the calculated unit cost of mining is RMB5.8/tonne mined. – 305 – APPENDIX VII 23. TECHNICAL REPORT OPERATING COSTS (continued) 23.1 MINING (continued) In comparison, ENFI have used a mining cost of RMB6.5/tonne mined for the pit optimization studies. Mining costs were developed from similar operation comparison. No cost breakdown was available for review. Given the small scale of equipment proposed, the relatively low labour cost component, and the fact that Management, Technical and Supervisor costs are not included in the ENFI cost estimate, WGM agree that the proposed costs are reasonable. 23.2 ORE DRESSING PLANT HKFS Business Plan presents estimates annual concentrate production and unit cost of production for three concentrates: iron, titanium and phosphorus. Using calculated annual costs and production plus the suggested average weight yield of 23.2%, the average Ore Dressing cost of RMB48.8/tonne ore was determined. In comparison, ENFI have used an Ore Dressing cost of RMB40.0/tonne ore. Costs were developed from similar operation comparison. No cost breakdown was available for review. Given the scale of processing (approximately 7,500 t/d), the relatively low labour cost component, and the fact that Management, Technical and Supervisor costs are not included in ENFI cost estimate, WGM agree that the proposed costs appear reasonable. 23.3 MINE MANAGEMENT ENFI have estimated Mine Management cost of RMB32.0/tonne ore for pit optimization process. This cost centre includes Management/Supervision and Technical personnel costs for the Mine and Ore Dressing Plant as well as other general personnel costs (i.e., Human Resources). Included in this cost centre is an allowance for Depreciation (value unknown) which is considered an Indirect cost and should not be included in Direct costs. Further details are required to assess this cost fully. 23.4 RESOURCES TAX ENFI have estimated Resources Tax at RMB5.6/tonne ore for the purpose of the pit optimization process. This amount is net of rebate per government policy. – 306 – APPENDIX VII 23. TECHNICAL REPORT OPERATING COSTS (continued) 23.5 CONCENTRATE TRANSPORT Cost of trucking concentrate from the ore dressing plant to the metallurgical plant were estimated by HKFS at RMB80/t concentrate. WGM agree that this cost is reasonable considering the haulage distance involved. Based on an average plant yield of 23.2%, concentrate trucking cost is equivalent to RMB18.5/t ore mined. No allowance was made by ENFI in the pit optimization process for the cost of Concentrate Transport. This cost is considered to be a cost of concentrate production. 23.6 METALLURGICAL PLANTS Operating cost for Direct Reduction of Iron Concentrate plant was developed by Central South University on the basis of 147 kt DRI annual production rate. Cost breakdown includes raw materials, power and water, wages and benefits, depreciation and maintenance, and management fee. Total operating cost is estimated at RMB1,784/t DRI. By-product credits for titanium concentrate and powdered vanadium oxide are estimated at RMB828/t DRI for a net cost of RMB956/t DRI. Operating cost for Direct Reduction of Titanium Concentrate plant was developed by Central South University on the basis of 62 kt high grade titanium oxide annual production rate. Cost breakdown includes raw materials, power and water, wages and benefits, depreciation and maintenance, and management fee. Total operating cost is estimated at RMB1343/t high grade titanium oxide. By-product credits for hematite oxide and iron concentrate are estimated at RMB1,012/ t high grade titanium oxide for a net cost of RMB956/t high grade titanium oxide. Operating costs in the Tables 17 and 18 were estimated by Central South University for the direct reduction plants and should be considered preliminary in nature although costs reflect similar operations. – 307 – APPENDIX VII 23. TECHNICAL REPORT OPERATING COSTS (continued) 23.6 METALLURGICAL PLANTS (continued) TABLE 17 OPEX (DIRECT REDUCTION OF IRON CONCENTRATE) Item Raw materials Iron concentrate Reducing coal Additive Na2SO4 Unit Consumption (t/t DRI) Unit Cost (Yuan/t) Cost (Yuan/t DRI) 1.77 1.416 0.0354 0.0343 500 300 3000 500 885 424.8 106.2 17.15 Other reagent Subtotal Power and Water Water (m3) Power (wh) Subtotal 2% of iron concentrate 20% of titanium and vanadium oxide 50 1,483.15 30 100 1.5ʏ/m3 0.4ʏ/kwh Wages and Benefits 45 40 85 29.35 Depreciation and Maintenance 10% 126.59 Management Fee Value added tax 3.5% 0% 60.34 0.00 By-products Titanium concentrate Powdered V2O5 Subtotal Remarks 0.3 0.00616 400 115000 TOTAL COST (120) (708.4) (828.4) 956.03 – 308 – 200 workers, wages: 18,000 yuan per worker per year, Benefit: 20% of wages base on 188,670,000 investment, pay back period is 5 years base on 2,380 yuan per tonne of DRI, minus cost for purchasing raw materials APPENDIX VII 23. TECHNICAL REPORT OPERATING COSTS (continued) 23.6 METALLURGICAL PLANTS (continued) TABLE 18 OPEX (DIRECT REDUCTION OF TITANIUM CONCENTRATE) Items Raw materials Titanium concentrate Reducing coal Additive Other Reagent Subtotal Power and water Water(m3) Power(kwh) Subtotal Unit Consumption (t/t High Grade Ti oxide) Unit cost (Yuan/t) Cost (Yuan/t High Grade Ti oxide) 2.096 2.096 0.06288 100 300 3000 209.60 628.8 188.64 20 1,027.04 10 150 1.5yuan/m3 0.4yaun/kwh 15 60 75 Wages and benefits 34.83 Depreciation and maintenance 10% 161.35 Management fee Value added tax 3.5% 0% 45.44 0.00 By-products Hematite oxide Iron concentrate Subtotal 0.118 1.01 Total cost 24. 4300 500 Remarks 3% of titanium concentrate 100 workers, wages: 18,000 yuan per worker per year, Benefit: 20% of wages base on 102,690,000 investment, pay back period is 5 years base on 5,500 yuan per tonne of DRI, minus cost for purchasing raw materials (507.4) (505) (1,012.4) 331.26 CONCLUSIONS AND RECOMMENDATIONS The following are the conclusions and recommendations by WGM from the technical review during July 12 to 18, 2007 of the Xiao Hong Shan Iron-Titanium-Vanadium deposit in Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region, People Republic of China for Aurora Global. – 309 – APPENDIX VII 24. TECHNICAL REPORT CONCLUSIONS AND RECOMMENDATIONS (continued) WGM recognize that considerable technical studies have been carried out on the deposit to date and that additional studies are in progress however, the studies completed are insufficient to support a full feasibility study. Mineral Resource and Mineral Reserve estimates have been developed using acceptable industry standards and procedures. The mineral deposit, however, has not been fully defined; potential for increasing resources and reserves is considered to be good. Sufficient Mineral Reserves have been identified to support the proposed 2.6 million tonne per year Mining and Ore Dressing operation for only five years. Additions to mineral reserves should be a high priority objective of project development. Detailed studies of a feasibility level have been completed by ENFI. However, specific reports, particularly those in support of mineral dressing and metallurgical assumptions, and specifically the finalization of the flowsheets have not yet been received and therefore not reviewed for this technical assessment. Recent metallurgical results, issued by Central South University, are based only on bench scale testwork and comparison to similar operations. Key assumptions for metallurgical recoveries are not yet confirmed. Significant differences exist between concentrate yields currently projected by ENFI and Changsha. The capital cost estimate for mine, ore dressing plant, infrastructure and iron and titanium direct reduction plants is estimates to be RMB1.13 billion. Cost estimates for both Capex and Opex are largely adapted from similar operations or developed from cost manuals and should be considered preliminary (Ó35%) at best. Proposed Mining and Ore Dressing operating costs are considered reasonable. All cost estimates for a feasibility study level must be developed in detail. In summary, most of the business projections appear to be based on preliminary studies and cost estimates. The WGM technical assessment review therefore concludes that the Xiao Hong Shan project is technically at a Scoping Study or Preliminary Assessment level. WGM has concluded that the preliminary studies show that the Xiao Hong Shan deposit merits ongoing exploration and could potentially support a viable project provided that sufficient additional Mineral Resource/Reserves are developed. WGM agrees with ENFI that additional Mineral Resources/Reserves are required and that diamond drilling in both the proposed pit area and to the east over the untested magnetic anomalies be continued to fully assess the potential of the site. WGM recommends the sample preparation of the subsamples for analysis be prepared at an independent laboratory prior to being sent for analysis and to include blind, standard, repeat and blank samples to meet international quality assurance/quality control standards. – 310 – APPENDIX VII 24. TECHNICAL REPORT CONCLUSIONS AND RECOMMENDATIONS (continued) WGM recognizes that much of the ENFI feasibility study is based on the assumption of achieving a 2.6 Mt/year production rate. Efforts should therefore be focussed on increasing mineral resources/reserves through on-site exploration activities as well as re-assessment of potentially recoverable mineral reserves through on-going pit optimization studies. Assessment of threshold mineral reserves required to support minimum project investment is highly recommended both to minimize financial exposure and to optimize project capacity and development timeline. WGM recommends that full documentation of all technical studies, key assumptions, and cost estimates become an on-going process as part of the project development plan and that a Project Director assume full responsibility for organization and management of all aspects of project development. – 311 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT Watts, Griffis and McOuat APPENDIX 1: EXPLORATION PERMIT – 312 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT – 313 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT Watts, Griffis and McOuat APPENDIX 2: CERTIFICATE OF ANALYSES – 314 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT – 315 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT – 316 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT – 317 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT – 318 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT CERTIFICATE To Accompany the Report titled “An Independent Technical Assessment on the Little Red Mountain, Iron-Vanadium-Titanium Deposit, Xiao Hong Shan, People’s Republic of China for Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited” dated 15 October, 2007 I, Velasquez Spring, do hereby certify that: 1. I reside at 1020 Walden Circle, Unit 17, Mississauga, Ontario, Canada, L5J 4J9. 2. I am a graduate from the University of Toronto, Toronto, Ontario with a B.A.Sc. Degree in Applied Geology (1957), and I have practised my profession continuously since that time. 3. I am a registered Professional Engineer with Association of Professional Engineers Ontario (Membership Number 43927011). 4. I am a Senior Geologist with Watts Griffis and McOuat Limited, a firm of consulting geologists and engineers, which has been authorized to practice professional engineering by Professional Engineers Ontario since 1969, and professional geoscience by the Association of Professional Geoscientists of Ontario. 5. I am a qualified person for the purpose of NI 43-101 with regard to epithermal mineral deposits and resource and reserve audits. 6. I visited the property on October 14 and 15, 2005 and on May 17 and 19, 2006, and I visited Beijing during July 12 to 18, 2007 and met with the technical personnel of ENFI Engineering Corporation and Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited. 7. I am the co-author of this report. 8. I have no personal knowledge as of the date of this certificate of any material fact or change, which is not reflected in this report. 9. Neither I, nor any affiliated entity of mine, is at present, under an agreement, arrangement or understanding or expects to become, an insider, associate, affiliated entity or employee of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited or any associated or affiliated entities. 10. Neither I, nor any affiliated entity of mine own, directly or indirectly, nor expect to receive, any interest in the properties or securities of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited or any associated or affiliated companies. 11. Neither I, nor any affiliated entity of mine, have earned the majority of our income during the preceding three years from Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited or any associated or affiliated companies. – 319 – APPENDIX VII 12. TECHNICAL REPORT I have read NI 43-101 and Form 43-101F1 and have prepared the technical report in compliance with NI 43-101 and Form 43-101F1; and have prepared the report in conformity with generally accepted Canadian mining industry practice, and as of the date of the certificate, to the best of my knowledge, information and belief, the technical report contains all scientific and technical information that is required to be disclosed to make the technical report not misleading. Velasquez Spring, P.Eng., B.A.Sc. 15 October, 2007 – 320 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT VELASQUEZ SPRING, P. Eng. Senior Geologist Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited Velasquez Spring has 50 years of experience in the mineral industry with a solid background in the planning and managing of exploration programs, due diligence, feasibility studies, and valuations of both large and small deposits, and operating mines. The experience has been worldwide dealing with governments at all levels, diplomatic offices and institutional organizations and covering deposits of precious and base metals, iron, nickel, uranium, manganese and a suite of industrial minerals including dimension stones. During his career, Mr. Spring has investigated hundreds of mineral deposits with particular experience in tropical weathered laterite/saprolitic type deposits in Africa, Brazil, Cuba, Columbia, Dominican Republic, Guatemala, and Puerto Rico. EDUCATION The New Manager (Management Program) — University of Colorado (1971) Graduate Studies (Economic Geology) — University of Toronto, Canada (1958 — 1961) B.A.Sc. (Applied Geology) — University of Toronto, Canada (1957) PROFESSIONAL EXPERIENCE Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited (since 1986) • In the past 16 years, Mr. Spring has worked worldwide on a broad range of metallic and industrial minerals projects, producing specialized property and company evaluations, and feasibility and due diligence type studies, as well as recommendations for exploration programs, and has provided independent ore reserve estimates. Recent assignments have included preparation of a NI-43-101 report on the silver/gold mines of Luismin SA in Mexico for Wheaton River Minerals Ltd., a NI-43-101 report on the lateritic nickel deposits held by Canico in Brazil, and the lateritic nickel deposits of Jaguar Nickel Inc. in Guatemala. Mr Spring has special experience and knowledge of epithermal gold silver deposits in Latin America, Asia and Nevada. Other commodities have included lateritic deposits, placer deposits for gold, gemstones, diamonds and heavy mineral deposits and dimension stones. Eluma S.A. Industria e Comercio (1985) • As Director of Geology, Mr. Spring was responsible for the company’s mineral programs throughout Brazil. These programs were primarily for “jungle-type” placer gold deposits but also included evaluation of copper, tin, diamonds and primary gold deposits. The placer gold program covered 50,000 km2 and involved exploration, development and exploitation phases. Special evaluation and processing considerations were also developed to handle the particular characteristics of “jungle type” placer deposits (including eluvial and alluvial phases). – 321 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT Noranda Exploration Co. Ltd. (1973 — 1984) • As Exploration Manager for South America, Mr. Spring administered Noranda’s district offices in Chile, Brazil, Argentina and Peru, comprising some 30 geologists and other professional staff. Feasibility studies were carried out on the Chapada (Cu-Au “porphyry”) deposit, Brazil, and the Andacollo (porphyry Cu) deposit in Chile. Exploration resulted in the discovery of a volcanic massive sulphide belt in the extreme south of Chile and Mississippi type Pb-Zn deposits in both Peru and Brazil. • Through the period 1973-1984, hundreds of South American mineral deposits were examined under Mr. Spring’s direction. These include among many others: Camaqua, Salobo, Caraiba, Pedra Verde, Nova Lima, Rio das Velhas Greenstone Belt, Morro Agudo, Niquelandia, and Santa Teresinha de Goias in Brazil; The Bambas, Cerro Verde, Pashpap, Antamina in Peru; Quebrada Blanca, Collahausi, El Toqui and El Teniente and Chile; and Cerro Pintada, Los Gigantes, Cerro Castillo and Fatima in Argentina. Texasgulf Inc. (1970 — 1973) / Texasgulf Sulphur (1967 — 1970) • Mr. Spring served as Senior Staff Geologist responsible for the United States east of the Rocky Mountains. Activity was directed mainly in the search for VMS and Mississippi lead-zinc deposits. Extensive airborne magnetic and electromagnetic surveys coupled with ground geophysics and diamond drilling led to the discovery of massive sulphide deposits in Wisconsin and a buried iron deposit in western Minnesota. As Exploration Manager for Texasgulf Sulphur, Mr. Spring was responsible for the administration and technical work on programs throughout Mexico (volcanic massive sulphides, porphyry copper and epithermal precious metal deposits. Earlier Experience (prior to 1967) • As a consultant in 1967, Mr. Spring carried out independent geological investigations for clients in Puerto Rico, Dominican Republic and Central America. In the previous year, he developed a preliminary manganese exploration program for Union Carbide Corporation over extensive areas of unmapped, virgin Amazon that led to the discovery of a new manganese belt and to the Carajas iron deposits. Mr. Spring served as Exploration Manager for Amax Exploration in 1965, responsible for the phosphate programs of Florida, South Georgia and South Carolina. As Exploration Geologist for Ponce Mining Co. (1961 — 1965), Mr. Spring assisted in the evaluation of the Rio Vivi Porphyry Cu-Au deposit of central Puerto Rico. – 322 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT PROFESSIONAL AFFILIATIONS Member, CSA Mining Technical Advisory and Monitoring Committee. Member, Professional Engineers Ontario. Member, Prospectors and Developers Association of Canada. Member, Canadian Institute of Mining and Metallurgy. Past Affiliations Member, the Canada committee of the TSE and the Ontario Securities Commission on joint recommendations for “Exploration Guidelines and Reporting Standards”. Reviewer, the CIMM Standards on Mineral Resource/Mineral Reserve Definitions and Guidelines. Member, the Halton Association of Geoscientists on the Ontario Professional Geoscientists Act. Member, the Committee of Association of Geoscientists of Ontario (AGO), the forerunner of the Association of Professional Geoscientist of Ontario (APGO). Public Appointee Council Member, the Transitional and Elected Council of the APGO. Member, the CIMM group on Standards for Estimation of Mineral Resource/Reserve and Classifications and Best Practice Guideline for laterite deposits, placer diamonds, alluvial deposits, and heavy mineral deposits. LANGUAGES Portuguese, Spanish and French. – 323 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT CERTIFICATE To Accompany the Report titled “An Independent Technical Assessment on the Little Red Mountain, Iron-Vanadium-Titanium Deposit, Xiao Hong Shan, People’s Republic of China for Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited” dated 15 October, 2007 I, Robert Didur, do hereby certify that: 1. I reside at 75 Prominence View SW, Calgary, AB T3H 3M8. 2. I am a graduate from the University of Toronto, Toronto, Ontario with a B.A.Sc. Degree in Geological Engineering (1972), and I have practised my profession since that time. 3. I am a registered Professional Engineer with the Association of Professional Engineers, Geologists and Geophysicists of Alberta (Membership Number 31648). 4. I am a Senior Associate Mining Engineer with Watts Griffis and McOuat Limited, a firm of consulting geologists and engineers, which has been authorized to practice professional engineering by Professional Engineers Ontario since 1969, and professional geoscience by the Association of Professional Geoscientists of Ontario. 5. I am a qualified person for the purpose of NI 43-101. 6. I have never visited the property but I visited the offices of ENFI Engineering Corporation and Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited, and met with their technical personnel during July 12 to 18, 2007. 7. I am the co-author of this report. 8. I have no personal knowledge as of the date of this certificate of any material fact or change, which is not reflected in this report. 9. Neither I, nor any affiliated entity of mine, is at present, under an agreement, arrangement or understanding or expects to become, an insider, associate, affiliated entity or employee of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited or any associated or affiliated entities. 10. Neither I, nor any affiliated entity of mine own, directly or indirectly, nor expect to receive, any interest in the properties or securities of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited or any associated or affiliated companies. 11. Neither I, nor any affiliated entity of mine, have earned the majority of our income during the preceding three years from Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited or any associated or affiliated companies. – 324 – APPENDIX VII 12. TECHNICAL REPORT I have read NI 43-101 and Form 43-101F1 and have prepared the technical report in compliance with NI 43-101 and Form 43-101F1; and have prepared the report in conformity with generally accepted Canadian mining industry practice, and as of the date of the certificate, to the best of my knowledge, information and belief, the technical report contains all scientific and technical information that is required to be disclosed to make the technical report not misleading. Robert Didur, P.Eng., B.A.Sc. 15 October, 2007 – 325 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT ROBERT DIDUR, P.Eng. Senior Associate Mining Engineer Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited Robert Didur is a Professional Engineer with over 34 years experience in mine engineering, planning and development, project planning and evaluation, civil construction and open pit mining in Arctic and northern environments. Mr. Didur is familiar with project study and evaluation requirements of world-class organizations, including the Canadian diamond mining industry. EDUCATION B.A.Sc. (Geological Engineering) University of Toronto, Toronto, ON (1972) PROFESSIONAL EXPERIENCE Independent Consultant, Calgary, AB (since February 2007) Nuna Logistics, Edmonton, AB (2005 — 2007) • As Project Manager at the Jericho Diamond Mine, Nunavut, Mr. Didur provided operational analysis and direction regarding improvements to the planning and mine development process. From June 2006 to January 2007, Mr. Didur was Project Manager for Comaplex Minerals’ Meliadine West Gold Project, Nunavut, and was responsible for re-focus of the project and preparation of a conceptual development plan as a basis for a Scoping/Pre-feasibility Study. From January 2005 to May 2006, Mr. Didur was Project Manager Site Preparation at De Beers’ Snap Lake Diamond Project (value $45 million), responsible for a team of 80 on-site personnel engaged in first stage surface construction activities, including quarrying, crushing, excavation, and construction of all site infrastructure including airstrip extension, tailings impoundment, fuel tank pads, roads, fresh water inlet, treated water outlet, conveyor portal, camp pad and laydown areas. BHP Billiton Diamonds Inc., Yellowknife, NT (2001 — 2004) • As Surface Mine and Infrastructure Project Manager, Mr. Didur created a leading-edge Resource Development Plan for the Ekati Diamond Mine, incorporating detailed cost and operational analyses, and utilizing sophisticated software, resulting in major shifts in the mine development plan and a significant project NPV increase. He coordinated and delivered: surface mine infrastructure development projects achieving time, quality and budget targets; a Feasibility Study for timely power house expansion; and fuel storage and accommodation requirements for expanded operations. Mr. Didur coordinated preparation of a Pre-Feasibility Study that examined Plant expansion alternatives based on progressive de-bottlenecking of the Ekati diamond processing plant, integrated with strategic mine development options, to maximize project NPV. He also provided independent early stage project assessment to Scoping level for BHPB’s international Business Development and World Exploration groups. – 326 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT Iron Ore Company of Canada, Labrador City, NL (1994 — 2001) • From 1996 to 2001, Mr. Didur was Superintendent Technical Services at the massive, multi-pit iron ore operation. He coordinated a multi-discipline team responsible for mine planning, geology, grade control, survey and blast design and was responsible for the development of a modern 25-year mine plan that supported cost reduction, production expansion, mining efficiencies, and increased project value. Mr. Didur directed exploration, project evaluation, environmental studies, and government interface, resulting in approval for a phased mine approach, and fast-track development, of the new billion tonne, surface-mineable Luce iron ore deposit. Mr. Didur coordinated mine development and contractors to achieve production, only 20 months from drilling of the ‘discovery’ hole. The Luce Mine has evolved, as planned, into IOC’s keystone operation. He also managed the evolution of mine planning and quality control processes to accurately predict operating costs and ore quality, and supported mine optimization, product development and reduced product variability during a period of significant ore quality transition and product diversification. • From 1994 to 1996, Mr. Didur was Senior Mine Planning Engineer and developed detailed planning processes to manage active Mineral Reserves, mine sequencing and crude ore blending to achieve process objectives. Mr. Didur managed contractors and a $7 million budget to achieve on-time and on-budget development and start-up of two new pits. Fernie, BC and Calgary, AB (1991 — 1994) • Examined various entrepreneurial opportunities. Esso Resources, Coal Mountain Mine, Sparwood, BC (1985 — 1990) • Mr. Didur was Assistant General Manager during 1988 to 1990, and was influential in coal quality improvements and acquisition and development of an adjacent property to expand reserves at the open pit thermal coal mine. He guided technological and organizational change through innovative techniques in a flattened organization to achieve efficiency improvements and cost reduction. As Plant Superintendent during 1986 to 1987, Mr. Didur was responsible for start-up and operation of a new $50 million heavy media coal preparation plant, including maintenance, quality control, engineering and shipping. From 1985 to 1986, Mr. Didur was Engineering Manager responsible for improvements to mine planning, surveying, geology, exploration and environment. He implemented a new mine plan and restructuring to achieve reduced costs and improved effectiveness. Esso Minerals Canada, Calgary, AB (1978 — 1984) • As Senior Mining Engineer, Mr. Didur coordinated redesign of the Coal Mountain Mine open pit mining sequence and operating philosophy to achieve a positive Feasibility Study supporting plant and mine expansion. He managed a comprehensive 3-year Pre-feasibility Study of the Kutcho Creek, BC, 20 Mt Cu/Zn massive sulphide deposit project, including all geology, mining (O/P and U/G components), metallurgical, environmental and economic issues. – 327 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT Patino Mines Quebec, Chibougamau, PQ (1972 — 1978) • Mr. Didur was a Geologist responsible for exploration, ore definition, grade control and reserves at the underground Cu/Au and Cu/Zn/Ag/Au operations (Copper Rand, Portage, Lemoine). He prepared structural analysis and interpretation of new gold zone controls. International Nickel Company (INCO) Limited (1967 — 1971) • Summer employment: Mr. Didur has two seasons of exploration experience employing geophysics and field mapping techniques and two seasons of stope mining at the Levack Mine. PROFESSIONAL ASSOCIATIONS Member, Association of Professional Engineers, Geologists, and Geophysicists of Alberta. Member, Association of Professional Engineers, Geologists and Geophysicists of the Northwest Territories. Member, Canadian Institute of Mining, Metallurgy and Petroleum. LANGUAGES English and French – 328 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT REFERENCES Central South University (Changsha) (Professor Guo Yu Feung) Aug. 2007 Cost Estimate for Reduction of Iron and Titanium Concentrate. pp 1-11 (translation Chinese to English) Changsha Research Institute of Mining and Metallurgy Oct. 2006 Ore Dressing Test Report on the Vanadium-Titanium-Magnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. Large scale dressing. pp. 1-106. Mar. 2006 March Proving Test Research of Sub-Marginal Ores Dressing of the VanadiumTitanium-Magnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. pp. 1-37. Chendu Cartographic Publishing House 2005 Map of the People Republic of China. China ENFI Engineering Corp. Jul. 2007 Open Pit Design Parameters And Assumptions Provided During Technical Meeting. 3 p. Geological and Mineral Resources Bureau Jan. 2006 Gansu Province Central Laboratory Assay Report — Official Results for Quinghai Senyuan Mining Co. Ltd., 61 p. Borehole logs, 26ZK. Core logging information (English translation of core log geology). pp. 1-92 Geological Publishing House, China 2000 Concise Regional Geology of China. Chief Editor, Cheng Yugi. 430 p. Golder Associates Apr. 2006 Report on Resource Modelling and Estimation Study for the Xiaohongshan Iron-Vanadium-Titanium-Ilmenite Project, Inner Mongolia, China. pp. 1-28. Oct. 2005 Report on Geological Site Visit Xiaohongshan Iron-Vanadium-TitaniumIlmenite Project Inner Mongolia, China. pp. 1-23. – 329 – APPENDIX VII TECHNICAL REPORT Hong Kong Forest Source Mining Industry Holding Company Limited May 2007 Iron-Titanium-Vanadium-Ilmenite Mine in XiaoHongShan, Business Plan (prepared by Danield Brothers Limited). pp. 1-124. Undated Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region Vanadium-TitaniumMagnetite Exploration and Development in Xiaohong Mountain, Business Plan. pp. 1-148. Schandl, Eva S. Nov. 2005 Detailed Petrographic and Mineralogical Study. Science Press Beijing China 2002 Mineral Facts of China. Editor-in-Chief, Zhu Xun. pp. 305-315. SINOREX Resource and Environment Engineering (Beijing) Co. Ltd. Oct. 2006 Average Grade Calculation Table of Drilling Project of the Vanadium-TitaniumMagnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. pp. 1-59. Oct. 2006 Average Grade Calculation Table of Single (Appendix 2) Engineering of Vanadium-Titanium-Magnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. pp. 1-35. Oct. 2006 Picture Gallery of Laminas and Polished Section of the Vanadium-TitaniumMagnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. pp. 1-37. Oct. 2006 Resource Calculation Table of the Vanadium (Appendix 1) Titanium-Magnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. pp. 1-73. Oct. 2006 The First Stage Exploration Report of Vanadium-Titanium-Magnetite Mine in Xiaohong Mountain, Ejina Banner of Inner Mongolia Autonomous Region. pp. 1-121. Undated Various geological cross sections and geological surface maps. Technology Department of the Mineral Processing Plant, Panzihua Iron and Steel (Group) Company Undated Small-scale Mineral Processing Feasibility Test Report of Xiaohong Mountain Mine of Qinghai Province Comprehensive Analysis. – 330 – APPENDIX VIII 1. GENERAL INFORMATION RESPONSIBILITY STATEMENT This circular includes particulars given in compliance with the Listing Rules for the purpose of giving information with regard to the Company. The Directors collectively and individually accept full responsibility for the accuracy of the information contained in this circular and confirm, having made all reasonable enquiries, that to the best of their knowledge and belief, there are no other facts the omission of which would make any statement herein misleading. 2. SHARE CAPITAL The authorised and issued share capital of the Company as at the Latest Practicable Date were, and immediately following issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares will be, as follows: As at the Latest Practicable Date Authorised share capital: 20,000,000,000 HK$ Shares 200,000,000 Issued and fully paid share capital or credited as fully paid: 952,720,000 Shares 9,527,200 Upon allotment and issue of the Consideration Shares and the Conversion Shares Issued and fully paid share capital or credited as fully paid: 952,720,000 Shares 9,527,200 270,000,000 Consideration Shares 2,700,000 1,275,000,000 Conversion Shares (Note) 12,750,000 2,497,720,000 Shares of HK$0.01 each 24,977,200 Note: This represent the maximum number of the Conversion Shares to be issued upon the exercise of the conversion rights attached to the Convertible Bonds in full. All the issued shares in the capital of the Company rank pari passu with each other in all respects including the rights as to voting, dividends and return of capital. The Consideration Shares and Conversion Shares to be allotted and issued will, when issued and fully paid, rank pari passu in all respects with the then existing Shares in issue on the date of their allotment. The Company had no debt securities in issue as at the Latest Practicable Date. – 331 – APPENDIX VIII GENERAL INFORMATION Save as disclosed in this circular, the Company did not have any other options, warrants and other convertible securities or rights affecting the Shares and no capital of any member of the Group is under option, or agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be put under option as at the Latest Practicable Date. 3. DIRECTORS’ INTERESTS (a) As at the Latest Practicable Date, the interests and short positions of each Director in the shares or underlying shares and debentures of the Company and its associated corporations (within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO) which were required to be notified to the Company and the Stock Exchange pursuant to Divisions 7 and 8 of Part XV of the SFO (including interests and short positions in which he was deemed or taken to have under such provisions of the SFO), or which were required, pursuant to section 352 of the SFO, to be entered in the register maintained by the Company referred to therein, or which were required, pursuant to the Model Code for Securities Transactions by Directors of Listed Companies set out in Appendix 10 to the Listing Rules, to be notified to the Company and the Stock Exchange were as follows: Interests in the Shares of the Company Number and class of securities Approximate percentage of interest 120,000,000 Shares 12.60% Beneficial owner 3,000,000 Shares 0.31% Beneficial owner 500,000 Shares 0.05% Name Capacity Tsao Ke Wen Calvin Interest of a controlled corporation (Note) Law Fei Shing Ma Chung Wo Cameron Note: These Shares are held by L & L Holdings Limited, the entire issued share capital of which is beneficially owned by Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin. – 332 – APPENDIX VIII 4. GENERAL INFORMATION (b) Save as disclosed in this circular, as at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors or chief executive of the Company had any interest and short positions in the shares, underlying shares and debentures of the Company or any associated corporations (within the meaning of Part XV of the SFO) which were required to be notified to the Company and the Stock Exchange pursuant to Divisions 7 and 8 of Part XV of the SFO (including the interests and short positions in which they were deemed or taken to have under such provisions of the SFO), or which are required, pursuant to section 352 of the SFO, to be entered in the register maintained by the Company referred to therein, or which were required, pursuant to the Model Code for Securities Transactions by Directors of Listed Companies set out in Appendix 10 to the Listing Rules, to be notified to the Company and the Stock Exchange. (c) As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors had any direct or indirect interest in any asset which had been acquired, or disposed of by, or leased to any member of the Enlarged Group, or was proposed to be acquired, or disposed of by, or leased to any member of the Enlarged Group since 31 December 2006, the date to which the latest published audited financial statements of the Group were made up. (d) As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors was materially interested, directly or indirectly, in any contract or arrangement entered into by any member of the Enlarged Group which was subsisting as at the date of this circular. (e) As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors or their respective associates was interested in any business apart from the business of the Group, which competed or was likely to compete, either directly or indirectly, with that of the Group. SUBSTANTIAL SHAREHOLDERS’ INTERESTS As at the Latest Practicable Date, so far as is known to the Directors, the following persons, other than a Director or chief executive of the Company, had an interest or short position in the shares and underlying shares of the Company which would fall to be disclosed to the Company under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or were directly or indirectly, interested in 10% or more of the nominal value of any class of share capital carrying rights to vote in all circumstances at general meetings of the members of the Enlarged Group: (a) Interests in the Shares of the Company Name of Shareholder Number and class of securities L & L Holdings Limited 120,000,000 Shares Interest of a controlled corporation (Note) 12.60% Leung Lai Ching, Margaret 270,000,000 Shares Beneficial owner 28.34% – 333 – Capacity Approximate percentage of interest APPENDIX VIII GENERAL INFORMATION Note: L & L Holdings Limited is an investment holding company incorporated in the Republic of the Marshall Islands, the entire issued share capital of which is wholly and beneficially owned by Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, an executive Director and the chief executive officer of the Company. (b) Interests in underlying Shares of the Company Name of Shareholder Number and class of securities Leung Lai Ching, Margaret 1,275,000,000 Shares Capacity Beneficial owner Approximate percentage of interest 133.83% Save as disclosed in this circular, so far as is known to the Directors, there is no other person (other than a Director or chief executive of the Company) who had an interest or short position in the shares and underlying shares of the Company which would fall to be disclosed to the Company under the provisions of Divisions 2 and 3 of Part XV of the SFO, or, had a direct or indirect interests amounting to 10% or more of the nominal value of any class of share capital carrying rights to vote in all circumstances at general meetings of any members of the Enlarged Group. 5. MATERIAL CONTRACTS Within the two years immediately preceding the date of this circular, the following agreements, being contracts not entered into in the ordinary course of business, have been entered into by members of the Enlarged Group and is or may be material: (a) acquisition agreement dated 20 October 2005 entered into between CMST Guangzhou China National Materials Storage and Transportation Guangzhou Corp. (“CMST”) as vendor and Aurora Logistic Finance (Hong Kong) Limited, an indirectly wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, as purchaser in relation to the acquisition of 70% equity interests in Guangzhou Haoyida Software Development Limited for a total consideration of HK$10,000,000. The consideration shall be satisfied (i) as to HK7,000,000 by issuing the convertible note to CMST at its full face value on completion and (ii) as to HK3,000,000 by paying cash but which had become null and void on 30 November 2005 for non-fulfilment of condition precedent. Please refer to the Company’s announcements dated 21 October 2005 and 1 December 2005 and circular dated 18 November 2005 for further details; (b) placing and subscription agreement dated 20 October 2005 entered into between Prime Orient International Limited (“POIL”) as subscriber and the Company as issuer in relation to the placing of up to 41,700,000 shares at the placing price of HK$0.79 per placing share on behalf of POIL to not less than six individual investors who were third parties independent of the Company and its connected persons on a best effort basis. Please refer to the Company’s announcement dated 20 October 2005 for further details; – 334 – APPENDIX VIII GENERAL INFORMATION (c) acquisition agreement dated 3 December 2005 entered into between CMST as vendor and Aurora Logistic Software Development Limited, an indirectly wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, as purchaser in relation to the acquisition of the Logistic and Financial Management System at a total consideration RMB6,000,000. The consideration shall be satisfied (i) as to RMB3,500,000 by issuing of 10,516,827 shares of the Company, and (ii) as to RMB2,500,000 by paying cash. However, an agreement dated 24 November 2006 entered into between CMST, the Company and Aurora Logistic Software Development Limited pursuant to which both parties has agreed to terminate the acquisition agreement and the Company has agreed under the agreement to purchase from CMST the Logistic and Financial Management System for a total consideration of HK$3,000,000. Please refer to the Company’s announcements dated 3 January 2006 and 27 November 2006 for further details; (d) subscription agreement dated 30 May 2006 entered into between GP Capital Limited as subscriber and the Company as issuer in relation to the placing of the convertible notes in an aggregate principal amount of HK$40,000,000 maximum. The convertible notes will carry a right to convert into new shares at the conversion price of HK$0.40 per shares of the Company. However, as GP Capital Limited failed to comply with the subscription agreement, a legal proceeding was brought by the Company and based on the court order issued on 12 February 2007, GP Capital Limited is required to pay to the Company the sum of HK$35,000,000, interest on the sum of HK$35,000,000 at judgment rate from 1 August 2006 until date of payment and costs of the action in gross sum of HK$25,000. Please refer to the Company’s announcements dated 23 and 25 May 2006, 1 and 12 June 2006, 27 and 28 September 2006 and 27 November 2006 for further details; (e) acquisition agreement dated 3 October 2006 entered into between Summer Lake International Ent. Corp and Meta Vision Medicals (WUHU) Co., Ltd. collectively as vendor and Wise Mount Management Limited (“Wise Mount”), an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of the Company as purchaser in relation to the acquisition of 70% equity interest in Eye Good Medical (Zhuhai) Co. Ltd. for a total consideration of HK$26,600,000 satisfied by the allotment and issue by the Company of 60,454,545 consideration shares at HK$0.44 per share but which had become null and void on 8 November 2006 for non-fulfilment of condition precedent. Please refer to the Company’s announcements dated 20 October 2006 and 8 November 2006 for further details; (f) sale and purchase agreement dated 8 December 2006 entered into between Sheng De Cruz Li as vendor and Wise Mount Management Limited, an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, as purchaser in relation to the acquisition of 70% equity interest in Win Alliance Development Limited for a total consideration of HK$14,000,000. The consideration shall be satisfied (i) as to HK$9,000,000 by procuring the Company to allot and issue a total of 18,000,000 consideration shares at HK$0.50 per share and (ii) as to HK$5,000,000 by paying cash. Please refer to the Company’s announcement dated 14 December 2006 and the circular dated 2 January 2007 for further details; – 335 – APPENDIX VIII 6. GENERAL INFORMATION (g) placing agreement dated 5 March 2007 entered into between Enlighten Securities Limited as placing agent and the Company, pursuant to which an aggregate of 87,000,000 new shares of the Company were placed by the placing agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis at the price of HK$0.308 per placing share with at least six independent investors. Please refer to the Company’s announcement dated 5 March 2007 for further details; (h) the agreement dated 27 March 2007 entered into between Aurora Logistic Capital Assurance Limited, Liaohai International Investments Limited and Hebei Da Sheng Warranty Company Limited for the investment into a Chinese-foreign equity joint venture company in Zhangjiakou, Hebei Province, PRC for logistic, investment and project guarantee business as amended by a supplemental agreement dated 20 April 2007 entered into between the same parties; (i) placing agreement dated 11 June 2007 entered into between Enlighten Securities Limited as placing agent and the Company, pursuant to which an aggregate of 135,000,000 new shares of the Company were placed by the placing agent on behalf of the Company, on a fully underwritten basis at the price of HK$0.50 per placing share with at least six independent investors. Please refer to the Company’s announcement dated 11 June 2007 for further details; (j) the placing agreement dated 18 July 2007 entered between the Company and Guotai Junan Securities (Hong Kong) Limited as placing agent, pursuant to which 135,000,000 new shares of the Company were placed by the placing agent, on a fully underwritten basis at the price of HK$0.69 per share. Please refer to the Company’s announcement dated 20 July 2007 for further details; and (k) the Share Transfer Agreement. LITIGATION (i) As disclosed in the 2006 interim report of the Company, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, namely యඈԾௗṄΔಇτࠉʔ̇ transliterated as Hui Yang Xie Kai Cheng Carpet Co. Ltd. (now known as యή̟ʿΔಇ́ଐτࠉʔ̇ transliterated as Hui Zhou Orient Carpet Manufacturing Co., Ltd. (“HZOCM”)) has been made defendant of proceedings in the PRC. The proceedings were brought by ૯Γജጙۺஉ τࠉʔ̇transliterated as Shenzhen Hua Xing Development Co. Ltd. (“SHXD”) against HZOCM at the People’s Court of the Hui Yang District, Hui Zhou City, Guangdong Province in respect of installation cost due and interest payable. The amount claimed under this set of proceedings was HK$1,520,000 (RMB1,520,000), interest payable and other costs for the sum of HK$1,288,269 (RMB1,288,269). HZOCM was ordered to pay the installation cost and interest to SHXD by the PRC’s court judgment. HZOCM is seeking legal advice for the judgment, and the Company had provided HK$1,520,000 in financial statement and the interest were provided in year 2006. – 336 – APPENDIX VIII (ii) GENERAL INFORMATION On 27 November 2006, the Company announced that it had issued a writ of summons against GP Capital Limited in relation to the two dishonored cheques totaling HK$35,000,000 drawn by GP Capital Limited. On 12 February 2007, a judgment was handed down against GP Capital Limited to pay to the Company the sum of HK$35,000,000, the interests thereon from 1 August 2006 until the date of payment and costs of the said application assessed in a gross sum at HK$25,000. Save as disclosed herein, as at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the members of the Enlarged Group was engaged in any litigation or arbitration of material importance and no litigation or claim of material importance is known to the Directors to be pending or threatened by or against any member of the Enlarged Group. As at the Latest Practicable Date, there was no claim in relation to exploration rights made or notified either by third parties against the Company. 7. DIRECTORS’ SERVICE CONTRACTS As at the Latest Practicable Date, none of the Directors had a service contract with the Company which is not determinable by the Company within one year without payment of compensation other than statutory compensation. 8. EXPERT AND CONSENT (a) The following are the qualifications of the expert who has given its opinions and advice which are included in this circular: Name Qualification Macquarie (Hong Kong) Limited (“Macquarie”) a corporation licensed to carry on 6 (advising on corporate finance) regulated activity under the SFO Veda Capital a corporation licensed to carry on 6 (advising on corporate finance) regulated activity under the SFO Grant Thornton Certified Public Accountants LCH Chartered surveyors Watts, Griffis and McOuat Limited (“WGM”) Independent technical advisers Jingtian & Gongcheng PRC lawyers (b) None of Macquarie, Veda Capital, Grant Thornton, LCH, Jingtian & Gongcheng and WGM has any shareholding, directly or indirectly, in any member of the Group or any right (whether legally enforceable or not) to subscribe for or to nominate persons to subscribe for securities in any member of the Group. (c) Each of Macquarie, Veda Capital, Grant Thornton, LCH, Jingtian & Gongcheng and WGM has given and has not withdrawn its written consent to the issue of this circular, with the inclusion of the references to its name and/or its opinion in the form and context in which they are included. – 337 – APPENDIX VIII 9. 10. GENERAL INFORMATION (d) None of Macquarie, Veda Capital, Grant Thornton, LCH, Jingtian & Gongcheng and WGM had any direct or indirect interest in any asset which had been acquired, or disposed of by, or leased to any member of the Enlarged Group, or was proposed to be acquired, or disposed of by, or leased to any member of the Enlarged Group since 31 December 2006, the date to which the latest published audited financial statements of the Group were made up. (e) Neither WGM nor any Directors are interested in the promotion of, or in any assets which have been within the two years immediately preceding the issue of this circular, acquired or disposed of by or leased to the Group or any of its subsidiaries. MISCELLANEOUS (a) The registered office of the Company is located at Cricket Squares Hutchins Drive, P.O. Box 2682, Grand Cayman KY1-1111, Cayman Islands. (b) The head office and principal place of business of the Company in Hong Kong is at Suites 5303-4, 53rd Floor, Central Plaza, 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong. (c) The Company secretary and qualified accountant of the Company is Mr. Law Fei Shing, Mr. Law is a practicing Certified Public Accountant in Hong Kong. He is also a member of American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA), USA and associate member of the Hong Kong Institute of Certified Public Accountants (HKICPA). (d) The branch share registrar and transfer office of the Company is Tricor Tengis Limited at 26th Floor, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Hong Kong. (e) In the event of inconsistency, the English text of this circular shall prevail over the Chinese text. DOCUMENTS AVAILABLE FOR INSPECTION Copies of the following documents are available for inspection during normal business hours at the head office and principal place of business of the Company in Hong Kong, Suites 5303-4, 53rd Floor, Central Plaza, 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong, up to and including the date of the EGM: (a) the memorandum and articles of association of the Company; (b) the letter from the Independent Board Committee containing the recommendation to the Independent Shareholders regarding the Refreshed Issue Mandate; (c) the letter from Veda Capital to the Independent Board Committee and the Independent Shareholders regarding the Refreshed Issue Mandate; (d) the consolidated audited financial statements of the Group for the two years ended 31 December 2006; – 338 – APPENDIX VIII GENERAL INFORMATION (e) the accountants’ report of the Group, the text of which is set out in Appendix I to this circular; (f) the accountants’ report of the Target Group, the text of which is set out in Appendix IIA to this circular; (g) the letter from Grant Thornton in respect of the pro forma financial information of the Enlarged Group, the text of which is set out in Appendix III to this circular; (h) the summary valuation report on the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007 prepared by LCH, the text of which is set out in Appendix IV to this circular; (i) the report from Grant Thornton in connection with the cash flow forecasts underlying the asset valuation on the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007, the text of which is set out in part (A) of Appendix V to this circular; (j) the report from Macquarie in connection with the cash flow forecasts underlying the asset valuation on the Target Mine — First Portion as at 31 August 2007, the text of which is set out in part (B) of Appendix V to this circular; (k) the letter and valuation certificate on property interest of the Group as at 31 August 2007 prepared by LCH, the text of which is set out in Appendix VI to this circular; (l) the technical report prepared by WGM, the text of which is set out in Appendix VII to this circular; (m) the PRC legal opinion issued by Jingtian & Gongcheng; (n) the letters of consent referred to under the paragraph headed “Expert and Consent” in this appendix; (o) a copy of each of the material contracts referred to in the paragraph headed “Material contracts” in this appendix; and (p) a copy of the Company’s circulars dated 2 January 2007 and 28 May 2007 respectively. – 339 – NOTICE OF EGM AURORA GLOBAL INVESTMENT HOLDINGS LIMITED ρˀଈҙ༅ઁٖτࠉʔ̇* (Incorporated in the Cayman Islands with limited liability) (Stock code: 353) NOTICE OF EXTRAORDINARY GENERAL MEETING NOTICE IS HEREBY GIVEN that an extraordinary general meeting (“EGM”) of Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited (the “Company”) will be held on 31 October 2007 at 10:30 a.m. at Suites 5303-5304, 53rd Floor, Central Plaza, 18 Harbour Road, Wanchai, Hong Kong for the purpose of considering and, if thought fit, passing the following resolutions as ordinary resolutions of the Company: ORDINARY RESOLUTIONS 1. “THAT (a) the share transfer agreement (the “Share Transfer Agreement”) (copy of which has been produced to the meeting marked “A” and signed by the chairman of the meeting for the purpose of identification) and made between Smooth Way International Limited, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company and Leung Lai Ching, Margaret and the Company in relation to acquisition of 51% equity interests in Kanson Development Limited as set out in the circular (the “Circular”) of the Company dated 15 October 2007 (copy of which has been produced to the meeting marked as “B” and signed by the Chairman of the meeting for purpose of identification) and all the transactions contemplated thereby be and they are hereby approved; (b) the issue of the Consideration Shares (as defined in the Circular), on and subject to the terms of the Share Transfer Agreement, be and it is hereby approved; (c) the creation and issue of the Convertible Bonds (as defined in the Circular), on and subject to the terms of the Share Transfer Agreement, be and it is hereby approved; (d) the directors of the Company (the “Directors”) be and they are hereby authorised to allot and issue of the Conversion Shares (as defined in the Circular); and (e) the Directors be and they are hereby authorised to do all such acts and things, to sign and execute all such further documents and to take such steps as the Directors may consider necessary, appropriate, desirable or expedient to give effect to or in connection with the Share Transfer Agreement, the issue of the Consideration Shares and the issue of the Convertible Bonds, the issue of the Conversion Shares or any of the transactions contemplated under the Share Transfer Agreement (including but not limited to the execution of the CB Instrument (as defined in the Circular), the entering into the Shareholders’ Agreement (as defined in the Circular)) and the amendments to the Share Transfer Agreement (to the extent such amendments are not material in the context of the entire transaction as a whole).” * for identification purpose only – 340 – NOTICE OF EGM 2. “THAT (a) the Existing General Mandate (as defined in the Circular), to the extent not already exercised, be and is hereby revoked (without prejudice to any valid exercise of such Existing General Mandate prior to the passing of this resolution); (b) subject to paragraph (d) below, pursuant to the Rules Governing the Listing of Securities on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited, the exercise by the Directors during the Relevant Period (as hereinafter defined) of all the powers of the Company to allot, issue and deal with the unissued shares in the share capital of the Company and to make or grant offers, agreements and options, including warrants to subscribe for Shares, which might require the exercise of such powers be and the same is hereby generally and unconditionally approved; (c) the approval in paragraph (b) above shall be in addition to any other authorisations given to the Directors and shall authorise the Directors during the Relevant Period to make or grant offers, agreements and options which would or might require the exercise of such powers after the end of the Relevant Period; (d) the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital allotted or agreed conditionally or unconditionally to be allotted (whether pursuant to options or otherwise), issued or dealt with by the Directors pursuant to the approval in paragraph (b) above, otherwise than pursuant to (i) a Rights Issue (as hereinafter defined); or (ii) the exercise of any options granted under the share option scheme of the Company; or (iii) any scrip dividend or similar arrangements providing for the allotment and issue of shares of the Company in lieu of the whole or part of dividend on shares of the Company in accordance with the articles of association of the Company in force from time to time; or (iv) any issue of shares of the Company upon the exercise of rights of subscription or conversion under the terms of any warrants of the Company or any securities which are convertible into shares of the Company, shall not exceed the aggregate of : (i) 20 per cent. of the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company in issue on the date of the passing of this resolution; and (ii) (if the Directors are so authorised by a separate ordinary resolution of the shareholders of the Company) the nominal amount of any share capital of the Company repurchased by the Company subsequent to the passing of this resolution (up to a maximum equivalent to 10 per cent. of the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company in issue on the date of the AGM (as defined in the Circular)), and the authority pursuant to paragraph (b) of this resolution shall be limited accordingly; and – 341 – NOTICE OF EGM (e) for the purpose of this resolution: “Relevant Period” means the period from the date of the passing of this resolution until whichever is the earliest of: (i) the conclusion of the next annual general meeting of the Company; (ii) the expiration of the period within which the next annual general meeting of the Company is required by the articles of association of the Company, the Companies Law, Cap 22 (Law 3 of 1961, as consolidated and revised) of the Cayman Islands or any other applicable law of the Cayman Islands to be held; and (iii) the passing of an ordinary resolution by the shareholders of the Company in general meeting revoking or varying the authority given to the Directors by this resolution. “Right Issue” means an offer of shares of the Company, or offer or issue of warrants, options or other securities giving rights to subscribe for shares of the Company open for a period fixed by the Directors to holders of shares of the Company on the register on a fixed record date in proportion to their then holdings of shares of the Company (subject to such exclusion or other arrangements as the Directors may deem necessary or expedient in relation to fractional entitlements, or having regard to any restrictions or obligations under the laws of, or the requirements of, or the expense or delay which may be involved in determining the existence or extent of any restrictions or obligations under the laws of, or the requirements of, any jurisdiction outside Hong Kong or any recognized regulatory body or any stock exchange outside Hong Kong).” 3. “THAT conditional upon the passing of resolution no. 2 above, the mandate granted to the Directors at the AGM to extend the Existing General Mandate to allot and issue shares of the Company to shares of the Company repurchased by the Company be and is hereby revoked and THAT the general mandate granted to the Directors pursuant to paragraph (b) of resolution no. 2 above be and is hereby extended by the addition to the aggregate nominal amount of the shares of the Company which may be allotted and issued by the Directors pursuant to or in accordance with such general mandate of an amount representing the aggregate nominal amount of the share capital of the Company repurchased after the passing of this resolution by the Company pursuant to or in accordance with the authority granted and approved by the shareholders of the Company at the AGM.” 4. “THAT subject to and conditional upon the Listing Committee of The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong Limited granting approval of the listing of, and permission to deal in, any Shares (as defined in the Circular) to be issued pursuant to the exercise of options which may be granted under the Refreshed General Mandate Scheme Limit (as defined below), the existing limit on the grant of options under the share option scheme adopted by the Company on 6 June 2002 (the “Share Option Scheme”) and refreshed pursuant to the resolution passed at the extraordinary general meeting of the Company held on 16 March 2006 be and is hereby refreshed so that the total number of Shares to be allotted and issued upon exercise of any options to be – 342 – NOTICE OF EGM granted under the Share Option Scheme shall not exceed 10% of the total number of shares in issue as at the date of the passing of this resolution (the “Refreshed General Scheme Limit”) and the Directors be and are hereby authorised to do such acts and execute such documents to effect the Refreshed General Scheme Limit and to exercise all powers of the Company to allot, issue and deal with the Shares pursuant to the exercise of such options.” Yours faithfully, For and on behalf of the Board Aurora Global Investment Holdings Limited Law Fei Shing Executive Director Hong Kong, 15 October 2007 Notes: (1) A member entitled to attend and vote at the EGM may appoint a proxy to attend and, on a poll vote on his behalf and such proxy need not be a member of the Company. (2) In order to be valid, the form of proxy, together with any power of attorney or authority under which it is signed or a notarially certified copy of that power of attorney or authority, must be deposited at the Company’s branch share registrar in Hong Kong, Tricor Tengis Limited at 26th Floor, Tesbury Centre, 28 Queen’s Road East, Wanchai, Hong Kong not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for holding the EGM or any adjournment thereof. (3) Completion and return of the form of proxy will not preclude a shareholder of the Company from attending and voting in person at the EGM or any adjournment thereof and in such event, the authority of the proxy shall be deemed to be revoked. As at the date hereof, the executive Directors are Mr. Owen Tam, Mr. Tsao Ke Wen Calvin, Mr. Law Fei Shing, Mr. So Chi Keung, Mr. Fok Po Tin, Mr. Leung Kai Hung and Mr. Delon Yeung; the non-executive Director is Dr. Ma Chung Wo, Cameron and the independent non-executive Directors are Mr. Lum Pak Sum, Mr. Wan Hon Keung and Mr. Sun Tak Keung. – 343 –